Document/ExhibitDescriptionPagesSize 1: 10-K Annual Report HTML 10.51M
2: EX-10.F Material Contract HTML 93K
3: EX-10.H Material Contract HTML 68K
4: EX-10.MM Material Contract HTML 67K
5: EX-21 Subsidiaries List HTML 75K
6: EX-23 Consent of Experts or Counsel HTML 56K
7: EX-24 Power of Attorney HTML 77K
8: EX-31.A Certification -- §302 - SOA'02 HTML 61K
9: EX-31.B Certification -- §302 - SOA'02 HTML 61K
10: EX-32.A Certification -- §906 - SOA'02 HTML 57K
11: EX-32.B Certification -- §906 - SOA'02 HTML 57K
18: R1 Document and Entity Information HTML 88K
19: R2 Consolidated Statement of Income HTML 172K
20: R3 Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income HTML 90K
21: R4 Consolidated Balance Sheet HTML 180K
22: R5 Consolidated Balance Sheet (Parenthetical) HTML 110K
23: R6 Consolidated Statement of Changes in Shareholders' HTML 139K
Equity
24: R7 Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows HTML 188K
25: R8 Summary of Significant Accounting Principles HTML 150K
26: R9 Noninterest Income HTML 103K
27: R10 Derivatives HTML 866K
28: R11 Securities HTML 583K
29: R12 Outstanding Loans and Leases HTML 1.23M
30: R13 Allowance for Credit Losses HTML 291K
31: R14 Securitizations and Other Variable Interest HTML 481K
Entities
32: R15 Goodwill and Intangible Assets HTML 121K
33: R16 Deposits HTML 100K
34: R17 Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities HTML 237K
Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and
Restricted Cash
35: R18 Long-term Debt HTML 264K
36: R19 Commitments and Contingencies HTML 205K
37: R20 Shareholders' Equity HTML 290K
38: R21 Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) HTML 282K
39: R22 Earnings Per Common Share HTML 103K
40: R23 Regulatory Requirements and Restrictions HTML 190K
41: R24 Employee Benefit Plans HTML 742K
42: R25 Stock-based Compensation Plans HTML 87K
43: R26 Income Taxes HTML 252K
44: R27 Fair Value Measurements HTML 1.04M
45: R28 Fair Value Option HTML 195K
46: R29 Fair Value of Financial Instruments HTML 107K
47: R30 Business Segment Information HTML 539K
48: R31 Parent Company Information HTML 200K
49: R32 Performance by Geographical Area HTML 120K
50: R33 Summary of Significant Accounting Principles HTML 216K
(Policies)
51: R34 Noninterest Income (Tables) HTML 102K
52: R35 Derivatives (Tables) HTML 955K
53: R36 Securities (Tables) HTML 579K
54: R37 Outstanding Loans and Leases (Tables) HTML 1.22M
55: R38 Allowance for Credit Losses (Tables) HTML 291K
56: R39 Securitizations and Other Variable Interest HTML 448K
Entities (Tables)
57: R40 Goodwill and Intangible Assets (Tables) HTML 119K
58: R41 Deposits (Tables) HTML 98K
59: R42 Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities HTML 298K
Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and
Restricted Cash (Tables)
60: R43 Long-term Debt (Tables) HTML 258K
61: R44 Commitments and Contingencies (Tables) HTML 132K
62: R45 Shareholders' Equity (Tables) HTML 273K
63: R46 Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) HTML 284K
(Tables)
64: R47 Earnings Per Common Share (Tables) HTML 96K
65: R48 Regulatory Requirements and Restrictions (Tables) HTML 175K
66: R49 Employee Benefit Plans (Tables) HTML 969K
67: R50 Stock-based Compensation Plans (Tables) HTML 74K
68: R51 Income Taxes (Tables) HTML 280K
69: R52 Fair Value Measurements (Tables) HTML 1.39M
70: R53 Fair Value Option (Tables) HTML 184K
71: R54 Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Tables) HTML 104K
72: R55 Business Segment Information (Tables) HTML 523K
73: R56 Parent Company Information (Tables) HTML 202K
74: R57 Performance by Geographical Area (Tables) HTML 121K
75: R58 Summary of Significant Accounting Principles - New HTML 60K
Accounting Standards (Details)
76: R59 Summary of Significant Accounting Principles - HTML 59K
Significant Accounting Principles: Collateral
(Details)
77: R60 Summary of Significant Accounting Principles - HTML 55K
Significant Accounting Policies: Loans and Leases
(Details)
78: R61 Summary of Significant Accounting Principles - HTML 60K
Significant Accounting Principles: Allowance for
Credit Losses (Details)
79: R62 Summary of Significant Accounting Principles - HTML 86K
Significant Accounting Principles: Nonperforming
Loans and Leases, Charge-offs and Delinquencies,
TDRs (Details)
80: R63 Summary of Significant Accounting Principles - HTML 59K
Significant Accounting Principles: Premises and
Equipment (Details)
81: R64 Summary of Significant Accounting Principles - HTML 62K
Revenue Recognition (Details)
82: R65 Noninterest Income (Details) HTML 97K
83: R66 Derivatives - Derivative Balances (Details) HTML 241K
84: R67 Derivatives - Offsetting Assets (Details) HTML 103K
85: R68 Derivatives - Offsetting Liabilities (Details) HTML 104K
86: R69 Derivatives - Gains and Losses on Derivatives HTML 77K
Designated as Fair Value Hedges (Details)
87: R70 Derivatives - Designated Fair Value Hedged Assets HTML 62K
(Liabilities) (Details)
88: R71 Derivatives - Narrative (Details) HTML 105K
89: R72 Derivatives - Derivatives Designated as Cash Flow HTML 87K
and Net Investment Hedges (Details)
90: R73 Derivatives - Other Risk Management Derivatives HTML 68K
(Details)
91: R74 Derivatives - Sales and Trading Revenue (Details) HTML 100K
92: R75 Derivatives - Credit Derivatives (Details) HTML 129K
93: R76 Derivatives - Credit-related Contingent Features HTML 70K
and Collateral (Details)
94: R77 Derivatives - Valuation Adjustments (Details) HTML 73K
95: R78 Securities - Debt Securities (Details) HTML 173K
96: R79 Securities - Narrative (Details) HTML 80K
97: R80 Securities - Other Debt Securities Carried at Fair HTML 64K
Value (Details)
98: R81 Securities - Gains and Losses on Sales of AFS Debt HTML 63K
Securities (Details)
99: R82 Securities - Temporarily Impaired and HTML 138K
Other-than-temporarily Impaired AFS Debt
Securities (Details)
100: R83 Securities - Significant Assumptions (Details) HTML 76K
101: R84 Securities - Maturities of Debt Securities Carried HTML 200K
at Fair Value and Held-to-maturity Debt Securities
(Details)
102: R85 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Past Due (Details) HTML 295K
103: R86 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Nonperforming, HTML 98K
Narrative (Details)
104: R87 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Nonperforming, HTML 105K
Credit Quality (Details)
105: R88 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Consumer Real HTML 136K
Estate - Credit Quality Indicators (Details)
106: R89 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Credit Card and HTML 86K
Other Consumer - Credit Quality Indicators
(Details)
107: R90 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Commercial - Credit HTML 109K
Quality Indicators (Details)
108: R91 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Consumer Real HTML 126K
Estate - Impaired Loans (Details)
109: R92 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Consumer Real HTML 71K
Estate - TDRs Entered into During the Period
(Details)
110: R93 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Consumer Real HTML 83K
Estate - Modification Programs (Details)
111: R94 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Consumer Real HTML 70K
Estate - TDRs Entering Payment Default That Were
Modified During the Preceding 12 Months (Details)
112: R95 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Credit Card and HTML 104K
Other Consumer - Impaired Loans (Details)
113: R96 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Credit Card and HTML 80K
Other Consumer - TDRs by Program Type (Details)
114: R97 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Credit Card and HTML 76K
Other Consumer - TDRs Entered into During the
Period (Details)
115: R98 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Credit Card and HTML 66K
Other Consumer - TDRs Entered into During the
Period, Narrative (Details)
116: R99 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Commercial Loans - HTML 116K
Impaired Loans (Details)
117: R100 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Commercial - TDRs HTML 80K
Entered Into During the Period (Details)
118: R101 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Rollforward of HTML 69K
Accretable Yield (Details)
119: R102 Outstanding Loans and Leases - Loans Held-for-Sale HTML 63K
(Details)
120: R103 Allowance for Credit Losses - Allowance by HTML 131K
Portfolio Segment (Details)
121: R104 Allowance for Credit Losses - Allowance and HTML 128K
Carrying Value by Portfolio Segment (Details)
122: R105 Securitizations and Other Variable Interest HTML 63K
Entities - Additional Information (Details)
123: R106 Securitizations and Other Variable Interest HTML 93K
Entities - First Lien Mortgage Securitizations
(Details)
124: R107 Securitizations and Other Variable Interest HTML 128K
Entities - First Lien Mortgages VIE (Details)
125: R108 Securitizations and Other Variable Interest HTML 157K
Entities - Home Equity Loan, Credit Card and Other
Asset-backed VIEs (Details)
126: R109 Securitizations and Other Variable Interest HTML 82K
Entities - Other Asset-backed Securitizations,
Additional Information (Details)
127: R110 Securitizations and Other Variable Interest HTML 118K
Entities - Other Variable Interest Entities
(Details)
128: R111 Securitizations and Other Variable Interest HTML 96K
Entities - Other Variable Interest Entities,
Additional Information (Details)
129: R112 Goodwill and Intangible Assets - Schedule of HTML 83K
Goodwill (Details)
130: R113 Goodwill and Intangible Assets - Schedule of HTML 74K
Intangible Assets (Details)
131: R114 Goodwill and Intangible Assets - Additional HTML 75K
Information (Details)
132: R115 Deposits (Details) HTML 70K
133: R116 Deposits - Contractual Maturities (Details) HTML 77K
134: R117 Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities HTML 78K
Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and
Restricted Cash - Schedule (Details)
135: R118 Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities HTML 64K
Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and
Restricted Cash - Additional Information (Details)
136: R119 Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities HTML 99K
Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and
Restricted Cash - Securities Financing Agreements
(Details)
137: R120 Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities HTML 81K
Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and
Restricted Cash - Remaining Contractual Maturity
(Details)
138: R121 Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities HTML 82K
Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and
Restricted Cash - Class of Collateral Pledged
(Details)
139: R122 Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities HTML 57K
Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and
Restricted Cash - Restricted Cash (Details)
140: R123 Long-term Debt - Balances (Details) HTML 140K
141: R124 Long-term Debt - Narrative (Details) HTML 87K
142: R125 Long-term Debt - Long-term Debt by Maturity HTML 132K
(Details)
143: R126 Long-term Debt - Trust Preferred Securities HTML 61K
(Details)
144: R127 Commitments and Contingencies - Credit Extension HTML 69K
Commitments Narrative (Details)
145: R128 Commitments and Contingencies - Credit Extension HTML 95K
Commitments (Details)
146: R129 Commitments and Contingencies - Other Commitments HTML 97K
(Details)
147: R130 Commitments and Contingencies - Other Guarantees HTML 78K
(Details)
148: R131 Commitments and Contingencies - Representations HTML 75K
and Warranties Obligations and Corporate
Guarantees (Details)
149: R132 Commitments and Contingencies - Litigation and HTML 107K
Regulatory Matters (Details)
150: R133 Shareholders' Equity - Declared Quarterly Cash HTML 61K
Dividends on Common Stock (Details)
151: R134 Shareholders' Equity - Common Stock Narrative HTML 100K
(Details)
152: R135 Shareholders' Equity - Common Stock Repurchase HTML 69K
Summary (Details)
153: R136 Shareholders' Equity - Preferred Stock Narrative HTML 110K
(Details)
154: R137 Shareholders' Equity - Preferred Stock Summary HTML 243K
(Details)
155: R138 Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) - HTML 96K
Change in Accumulated OCI (Details)
156: R139 Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) - HTML 148K
Changes in OCI Components Pre- and After-tax
(Details)
157: R140 Earnings Per Common Share - Basic and Diluted HTML 91K
(Details)
158: R141 Earnings Per Common Share - Narrative (Details) HTML 93K
159: R142 Regulatory Requirements and Restrictions - HTML 123K
Schedule of Capital Under Basel 3 (Details)
160: R143 Regulatory Requirements and Restrictions - HTML 79K
Narrative (Details)
161: R144 Employee Benefit Plans - Narrative (Details) HTML 109K
162: R145 Employee Benefit Plans - Pension and HTML 192K
Postretirement Plans (Details)
163: R146 Employee Benefit Plans - ABO and PBO in Excess of HTML 70K
Plan Assets (Details)
164: R147 Employee Benefit Plans - Components of Net HTML 103K
Periodic Benefit Cost (Details)
165: R148 Employee Benefit Plans - Pretax Amounts Included HTML 78K
in Accumulated OCI (Details)
166: R149 Employee Benefit Plans - Pretax Amounts Recognized HTML 86K
in OCI (Details)
167: R150 Employee Benefit Plans - Target Allocation HTML 93K
(Details)
168: R151 Employee Benefit Plans - Fair Value Measurements HTML 163K
(Details)
169: R152 Employee Benefit Plans - Level 3 Fair Value HTML 93K
Measurements (Details)
170: R153 Employee Benefit Plans - Projected Benefit HTML 83K
Payments (Details)
171: R154 Stock-based Compensation Plans - Additional HTML 109K
Information (Details)
172: R155 Stock-based Compensation Plans - Restricted Stock HTML 102K
Units (Details)
173: R156 Stock-based Compensation Plans - Stock Options, HTML 71K
Narrative (Details)
174: R157 Income Taxes - Components of Income Tax Expense HTML 85K
(Benefit) (Details)
175: R158 Income Taxes - Narrative (Details) HTML 92K
176: R159 Income Taxes - Reconciliation of Income Tax HTML 127K
Expense (Details)
177: R160 Income Taxes - Reconciliation of the Change in HTML 70K
Unrecognized Tax Benefits (Details)
178: R161 Income Taxes - Deferred Tax Assets and Deferred HTML 104K
Tax Liabilities (Details)
179: R162 Income Taxes - Net Operating Loss and Tax Credit HTML 92K
Carryforwards (Details)
180: R163 Fair Value Measurements - Recurring Fair Value HTML 268K
(Details)
181: R164 Fair Value Measurements - Level 3 Reconciliation HTML 275K
(Details)
182: R165 Fair Value Measurements - Level 3 Reconciliation, HTML 88K
Narrative (Details)
183: R166 Fair Value Measurements - Recurring Fair Value HTML 298K
Inputs (Details)
184: R167 Fair Value Measurements - Mortgage Servicing HTML 71K
Rights (Details)
185: R168 Fair Value Measurements - Nonrecurring Fair Value HTML 84K
(Details)
186: R169 Fair Value Measurements - Nonrecurring Fair Value HTML 75K
Inputs (Details)
187: R170 Fair Value Option - Elections (Details) HTML 103K
188: R171 Fair Value Option - Gains (Losses) Relating to HTML 96K
Assets and Liabilities (Details)
189: R172 Fair Value of Financial Instruments (Details) HTML 82K
190: R173 Business Segment Information - Narrative (Details) HTML 56K
191: R174 Business Segment Information - Results of Business HTML 108K
Segments and All Other (Details)
192: R175 Business Segment Information - Noninterest Income HTML 170K
by Business Segment and All Other (Details)
193: R176 Business Segment Information - Business Segment HTML 75K
Reconciliations (Details)
194: R177 Business Segment Information - Segments' Total HTML 65K
Assets (Details)
195: R178 Parent Company Information - Income Statement HTML 96K
(Details)
196: R179 Parent Company Information - Balance Sheet HTML 106K
(Details)
197: R180 Parent Company Information - Statement of Cash HTML 118K
Flows (Details)
198: R181 Performance by Geographical Area (Details) HTML 87K
199: R9999 Uncategorized Items - bac-1231201810xk.htm HTML 54K
201: XML IDEA XML File -- Filing Summary XML 392K
17: XML XBRL Instance -- bac-1231201810xk_htm XML 27.68M
200: EXCEL IDEA Workbook of Financial Reports XLSX 377K
13: EX-101.CAL XBRL Calculations -- bac-20181231_cal XML 783K
14: EX-101.DEF XBRL Definitions -- bac-20181231_def XML 3.64M
15: EX-101.LAB XBRL Labels -- bac-20181231_lab XML 5.98M
16: EX-101.PRE XBRL Presentations -- bac-20181231_pre XML 4.33M
12: EX-101.SCH XBRL Schema -- bac-20181231 XSD 699K
202: JSON XBRL Instance as JSON Data -- MetaLinks 1,060± 1.77M
203: ZIP XBRL Zipped Folder -- 0000070858-19-000012-xbrl Zip 1.51M
Securities registered pursuant to section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of each class
Name of each exchange on which registered
Common
Stock, par value $0.01 per share
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of Floating Rate Non-Cumulative
Preferred Stock, Series E
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share
of 6.625% Non-Cumulative
Preferred Stock, Series W
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of 6.500% Non-Cumulative
Preferred Stock, Series Y
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares,
each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of 6.200% Non-Cumulative
Preferred Stock, Series CC
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of 6.000% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series EE
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary
Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of 6.000% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series GG
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of 6.000% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series HH
New York Stock Exchange
7.25%
Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Preferred Stock, Series L
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,200th interest in a share of Bank of America Corporation Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series 1
New York Stock Exchange
1Bank
of America 2018
Title
of each class
Name of each exchange on which registered
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,200th interest in a share of Bank of America Corporation Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series 2
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,200th interest in a share of Bank of America
Corporation Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series 4
New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,200th interest in a share of Bank of America Corporation Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series 5
New York Stock Exchange
Floating Rate Preferred Hybrid Income Term Securities
of BAC Capital Trust XIII (and the guarantee related thereto)
New York Stock Exchange
5.63% Fixed to Floating Rate Preferred Hybrid Income Term Securities of BAC Capital Trust XIV (and the guarantee related thereto)
New York Stock Exchange
Income Capital Obligation Notes initially due December 15, 2066 of Bank of America
Corporation
New York Stock Exchange
Senior Medium-Term Notes, Series A, Step Up Callable Notes, due November 28, 2031 of BofA Finance LLC (and the guarantee of the Registrant with respect thereto)
New York Stock Exchange
Securities
registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes o No ☑
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act. Yes o No ☑
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes ☑No o
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files). Yes ☑ No
o
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. ☑
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,”“accelerated filer,”“smaller reporting company” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check
one):
Large accelerated filer ☑
Accelerated filero
Non-accelerated filer o
Smaller reporting company o
Emerging
growth company o
If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. o
Indicate
by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act). Yes o No ☑
The aggregate market value of the registrant’s common stock (“Common Stock”) held on June 30, 2018 by non-affiliates was approximately $i282,258,554,953
(based on the June 30, 2018 closing price of Common Stock of $28.19 per share as reported on the New York Stock Exchange). At February 25, 2019, there were i9,658,759,764 shares of Common Stock outstanding.
Bank of America Corporation is a Delaware corporation, a bank holding company (BHC) and a financial holding company. When used in this report, “the Corporation” may refer to Bank of America Corporation individually, Bank of America Corporation and its subsidiaries, or certain of Bank of America Corporation’s subsidiaries or affiliates. As part of our efforts to streamline the
Corporation’s organizational structure and reduce complexity and costs, the Corporation has reduced and intends to continue to reduce the number of its corporate subsidiaries, including through intercompany mergers.
Bank of America is one of the world’s largest financial institutions, serving individual consumers, small- and middle-market businesses, institutional investors, large corporations and governments with a full range of banking, investing, asset management and other financial and risk management products and services. Our principal executive offices are located in the
Bank of America’s website is www.bankofamerica.com and the Investor Relations portion of our website is http://investor.bankofamerica.com. We use our website
to distribute company information, including as a means of disclosing material, non-public information and for complying with our disclosure obligations under Regulation FD. We routinely post and make accessible financial and other information regarding the Corporation on our website. Accordingly, investors should monitor the Investor Relations portion of our website, in addition to following our press releases, U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) filings, public conference calls and webcasts. Our Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the
1Bank of America 2018
Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (Exchange Act) are available on the Investor Relations portion of our website
under the heading Financial Information (accessible by clicking on the SEC Filings link) as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such reports with, or furnish them to, the SEC and at the SEC’s website, www.sec.gov. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the information contained on our website as referenced in this paragraph is not incorporated by reference into this Annual Report on Form 10-K. Also, we make available on the Investor Relations portion of our website under the heading Corporate Governance: (i) our Code of Conduct (including our insider trading
policy); (ii) our Corporate Governance Guidelines (accessible by clicking on the Governance Highlights link); and (iii) the charter of each active committee of our Board of Directors (the Board) (accessible by clicking on the committee names under the Committee Composition link). We also intend to disclose any amendments to our Code of Conduct and waivers of our Code of Conduct required to be disclosed by the rules of the SEC and the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) on the Investor Relations portion of our website. All of these corporate governance materials are also available free of charge in print to shareholders who request them in writing to: Bank of America Corporation, Attention: Office of the Corporate Secretary, Hearst Tower, 214 North Tryon Street, NC1-027-18-05, Charlotte,
North Carolina28255.
Segments
Through our banking and various nonbank subsidiaries throughout the U.S. and in international markets, we provide a diversified range of banking and nonbank financial services and products through four business segments: Consumer Banking, Global Wealth & Investment Management (GWIM), Global Banking and Global Markets, with the remaining operations recorded in All Other. Additional information related
to our business segments and the products and services they provide is included in the information set forth on pages 30 through 39 of Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (MD&A) and Note 23 – Business Segment Informationto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Competition
We operate in a highly competitive environment. Our competitors include banks, thrifts, credit unions, investment banking firms, investment advisory firms, brokerage firms, investment companies, insurance companies, mortgage banking companies, credit card issuers, mutual fund companies, hedge funds, private equity firms, and e-commerce and other internet-based
companies. We compete with some of these competitors globally and with others on a regional or product specific basis.
Competition is based on a number of factors including, among others, customer service, quality and range of products and services offered, price, reputation, interest rates on loans and deposits, lending limits and customer convenience. Our ability to continue to compete effectively also depends in large part on our ability to attract new employees and retain and motivate our existing employees, while managing compensation and other costs.
Employees
At December 31, 2018, we had approximately 204,000 employees. None of our domestic employees are subject to a collective bargaining
agreement. Management considers our employee relations to be good.
Government Supervision and Regulation
The following discussion describes, among other things, elements of an extensive regulatory framework applicable to BHCs, financial holding companies, banks and broker-dealers, including specific information about Bank of America.
We are subject to an extensive regulatory framework applicable to BHCs, financial holding companies and banks and other financial services entities. U.S. federal regulation of banks, BHCs and financial holding companies is intended primarily for the protection of depositors and the Deposit Insurance Fund (DIF) rather than for the protection of shareholders and creditors.
As a registered financial holding company and
BHC, the Corporation is subject to the supervision of, and regular inspection by, the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve). Our U.S. bank subsidiaries (the Banks) organized as national banking associations are subject to regulation, supervision and examination by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (OCC), the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) and the Federal Reserve. U.S. financial holding companies, and the companies under their control, are permitted to engage in activities considered “financial in nature” as defined by the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act and related Federal Reserve interpretations. Unless otherwise limited by the Federal Reserve, a financial holding company may engage directly or indirectly in activities considered financial in nature provided the financial holding company gives the Federal Reserve after-the-fact
notice of the new activities. The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act also permits national banks to engage in activities considered financial in nature through a financial subsidiary, subject to certain conditions and limitations and with the approval of the OCC.
The scope of the laws and regulations and the intensity of the supervision to which we are subject have increased in recent years in response to the financial crisis, as well as other factors such as technological and market changes. In addition, the banking and financial services sector is subject to substantial regulatory enforcement and fines. Many of these changes have occurred as a result of the 2010 Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the Financial Reform Act). We cannot assess whether there will be any additional major changes in the regulatory environment and expect that our business will remain subject to extensive regulation and supervision.
We
are also subject to various other laws and regulations, as well as supervision and examination by other regulatory agencies, all of which directly or indirectly affect our operations and management and our ability to make distributions to shareholders. For instance, our broker-dealer subsidiaries are subject to both U.S. and international regulation, including supervision by the SEC, New York Stock Exchange and Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, among others; our commodities businesses in the U.S. are subject to regulation by and supervision of the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC); our U.S. derivatives activity is subject to regulation and supervision of the CFTC, National Futures Association and SEC, and in the case of the Banks, certain banking regulators; our insurance activities are subject to licensing and regulation by state insurance regulatory agencies;
and our consumer financial products and services are regulated by the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (CFPB).
Our non-U.S. businesses are also subject to extensive regulation by various non-U.S. regulators, including governments, securities exchanges, prudential regulators, central banks and other regulatory bodies, in the jurisdictions in which those businesses operate. For example, our financial services operations in the United Kingdom (U.K.) are subject to regulation by the Prudential Regulatory Authority and Financial Conduct
Bank
of America 2018 2
Authority (FCA) and, in Ireland, the European Central Bank and Central Bank of Ireland.
Source of Strength
Under the Financial Reform Act and Federal Reserve policy, BHCs are expected to act as a source of financial strength to each subsidiary bank and to commit resources to support each such subsidiary. Similarly, under the cross-guarantee provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (FDICIA), in the event of a loss suffered or anticipated by the FDIC, either as a result of default of a bank subsidiary or related to FDIC assistance provided to such a subsidiary in danger of default, the affiliate banks of such a subsidiary may be
assessed for the FDIC’s loss, subject to certain exceptions.
Transactions with Affiliates
Pursuant to Section 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act, as implemented by the Federal Reserve’s Regulation W, the Banks are subject to restrictions that limit certain types of transactions between the Banks and their nonbank affiliates. In general, U.S. banks are subject to quantitative and qualitative limits on extensions of credit, purchases of assets and certain other transactions involving its nonbank affiliates. Additionally, transactions between U.S. banks and their nonbank affiliates are required to be on arm’s length terms and must be consistent with standards of safety and soundness.
Deposit Insurance
Deposits placed at U.S. domiciled banks are insured by the FDIC, subject to limits and conditions
of applicable law and the FDIC’s regulations. Pursuant to the Financial Reform Act, FDIC insurance coverage limits are $250,000 per customer. All insured depository institutions are required to pay assessments to the FDIC in order to fund the DIF.
The FDIC is required to maintain at least a designated minimum ratio of the DIF to insured deposits in the U.S. The Financial Reform Act requires the FDIC to assess insured depository institutions to achieve a DIF ratio of at least 1.35 percent by September 30, 2020. In November 2018, the FDIC announced that the DIF ratio exceeded 1.35 in advance of the deadline and that the related surcharges ceased. Additionally, the FDIC adopted regulations that establish a long-term target DIF ratio of greater than two percent. As of the date of this report, the DIF ratio is below this required target and the FDIC has adopted a restoration plan
that may result in increased deposit insurance assessments. Deposit insurance assessment rates are subject to change by the FDIC and will be impacted by the overall economy and the stability of the banking industry as a whole. For more information regarding deposit insurance, see Item 1A. Risk Factors – Regulatory, Compliance and Legal on page 13.
Capital, Liquidity and Operational Requirements
As a financial holding company, we and our bank subsidiaries are subject to the regulatory capital and liquidity guidelines issued by the Federal Reserve and other U.S. banking regulators, including the FDIC and the OCC. These rules are complex and are evolving as U.S. and international regulatory authorities
propose and enact enhanced capital and liquidity rules. The Corporation seeks to manage its capital position to maintain sufficient capital to meet these regulatory guidelines and to support our business activities. These evolving rules are likely to influence our planning processes and may require additional regulatory capital and liquidity, as well as impose additional operational and compliance costs on the Corporation. In addition, the Federal Reserve and the OCC have adopted guidelines that establish minimum standards for the design, implementation and board oversight of BHCs’ and national
banks’ risk governance frameworks. The Federal Reserve also issued a final rule, which became effective January 1, 2019, that includes minimum external total loss-absorbing capacity (TLAC) and long-term debt requirements.
For
more information on regulatory capital rules, capital composition and pending or proposed regulatory capital changes, see Capital Management – Regulatory Capital in the MD&A on page 44, and Note 16 – Regulatory Requirements and Restrictionsto the Consolidated Financial Statements, which are incorporated by reference in this Item 1.
Distributions
We are subject to various regulatory policies and requirements relating to capital actions, including payment of dividends and common stock repurchases. For instance, Federal Reserve regulations require major U.S. BHCs to submit a capital plan as part of an annual Comprehensive Capital Analysis and
Review (CCAR). The purpose of the CCAR for the Federal Reserve is to assess the capital planning process of the BHC, including any planned capital actions, such as payment of dividends and common stock repurchases.
Our ability to pay dividends is also affected by the various minimum capital requirements and the capital and non-capital standards established under the FDICIA. The right of the Corporation, our shareholders and our creditors to participate in any distribution of the assets or earnings of our subsidiaries is further subject to the prior claims of creditors of the respective subsidiaries.
If the Federal Reserve finds that any of our Banks are not “well-capitalized” or “well-managed,”
we would be required to enter into an agreement with the Federal Reserve to comply with all applicable capital and management requirements, which may contain additional limitations or conditions relating to our activities. Additionally, the applicable federal regulatory authority is authorized to determine, under certain circumstances relating to the financial condition of a bank or BHC, that the payment of dividends would be an unsafe or unsound practice and to prohibit payment thereof.
For more information regarding the requirements relating to the payment of dividends, including the minimum capital requirements, see Note 13 – Shareholders’ Equity and Note 16 – Regulatory Requirements and Restrictionsto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Many
of our subsidiaries, including our bank and broker-dealer subsidiaries, are subject to laws that restrict dividend payments, or authorize regulatory bodies to block or reduce the flow of funds from those subsidiaries to the parent company or other subsidiaries.
Resolution Planning
As a BHC with greater than $50 billion of assets, the Corporation is required by the Federal Reserve and the FDIC to periodically submit a plan for a rapid and orderly resolution in the event of material financial distress or failure.
Such
resolution plan is intended to be a detailed roadmap for the orderly resolution of the BHC and its material entities pursuant to the U.S. Bankruptcy Code and other applicable resolution regimes under one or more hypothetical scenarios assuming no extraordinary government assistance.
If both the Federal Reserve and the FDIC determine that the BHC’s plan is not credible, the Federal Reserve and the FDIC may jointly impose more stringent capital, leverage or liquidity requirements or restrictions on growth, activities or operations. A description of our plan is available on the Federal Reserve and FDIC websites.
3Bank
of America 2018
The FDIC also requires the submission of a resolution plan for Bank of America, N.A. (BANA), which must describe how the insured depository institution would be resolved under the bank resolution provisions of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act. A description of this plan is available on the FDIC’s website.
We continue to
make substantial progress to enhance our resolvability, including simplifying our legal entity structure and business operations, and increasing our preparedness to implement our resolution plan, both from a financial and operational standpoint.
Across international jurisdictions, resolution planning is the responsibility of national resolution authorities (RA). Of most impact to the Corporation are the requirements associated with subsidiaries in the U.K., Ireland and France, where rules have been issued requiring the submission of significant information about locally-incorporated subsidiaries, as well as the Corporation’s affiliated branches located in those jurisdictions (including information on intra-group dependencies, legal entity separation
and barriers to resolution) to allow the RA to plan their resolution strategies. As a result of the RA’s review of the submitted information, we could be required to take certain actions over the next several years which could increase operating costs and potentially result in the restructuring of certain businesses and subsidiaries.
For more information regarding our resolution plan, see Item 1A. Risk Factors – Liquidity on page 6.
Insolvency and the Orderly Liquidation Authority
Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, the FDIC may be appointed receiver of an insured depository institution if it is insolvent or in certain other circumstances. In addition,
under the Financial Reform Act, when a systemically important financial institution (SIFI) such as the Corporation is in default or danger of default, the FDIC may be appointed receiver in order to conduct an orderly liquidation of such institution. In the event of such appointment, the FDIC could, among other things, invoke the orderly liquidation authority, instead of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, if the Secretary of the Treasury makes certain financial distress and systemic risk determinations. The orderly liquidation authority is modeled in part on the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, but also adopts certain concepts from the U.S. Bankruptcy Code.
The orderly liquidation authority contains certain differences from the U.S. Bankruptcy Code. For example, in certain circumstances, the FDIC could permit payment of obligations it determines to be systemically significant (e.g., short-term creditors or operating creditors) in lieu
of paying other obligations (e.g., long-term creditors) without the need to obtain creditors’ consent or prior court review. The insolvency and resolution process could also lead to a large reduction or total elimination of the value of a BHC’s outstanding equity, as well as impairment or elimination of certain debt.
Under the FDIC’s “single point of entry” strategy for resolving SIFIs, the FDIC could replace a distressed BHC with a bridge holding company, which could continue operations and result in an orderly resolution of the underlying bank, but whose equity is held solely for the benefit of creditors of the original BHC.
Furthermore, the Federal Reserve requires that BHCs maintain minimum levels of long-term debt required to provide adequate loss absorbing capacity in the event of a resolution.
For more information regarding
our resolution, see Item 1A. Risk Factors – Liquidity on page 6.
Limitations on Acquisitions
The Riegle-Neal Interstate Banking and Branching Efficiency Act of 1994 permits a BHC to acquire banks located in states other
than its home state without regard to state law, subject to certain conditions, including the condition that the BHC, after and as a result of the acquisition, controls no more than 10 percent of the total amount of deposits of insured depository institutions in the U.S. and no more than 30 percent or such lesser or greater amount set by state law of such deposits in that state. At June 30, 2018, we held greater than 10 percent of
the total amount of deposits of insured depository institutions in the U.S.
In addition, the Financial Reform Act restricts acquisitions by a financial institution if, as a result of the acquisition, the total liabilities of the financial institution would exceed 10 percent of the total liabilities of all financial institutions in the U.S. At June 30, 2018, our liabilities did not exceed 10 percent of the total liabilities of all financial institutions in the U.S.
The Volcker Rule
The Volcker Rule prohibits insured depository institutions and companies affiliated with insured depository institutions (collectively, banking entities) from engaging in short-term proprietary trading of certain securities, derivatives, commodity futures and options for their own account. The Volcker Rule also
imposes limits on banking entities’ investments in, and other relationships with, hedge funds and private equity funds. The Volcker Rule provides exemptions for certain activities, including market-making, underwriting, hedging, trading in government obligations, insurance company activities and organizing and offering hedge funds and private equity funds. The Volcker Rule also clarifies that certain activities are not prohibited, including acting as agent, broker or custodian. A banking entity with significant trading operations, such as the Corporation, is required to maintain a detailed compliance program to comply with the restrictions of the Volcker Rule.
Derivatives
Our derivatives operations are subject to extensive regulation globally. These operations are subject to regulation under the Financial Reform Act, the European Union (EU) Markets in Financial Instruments Directive
and Regulation, the European Market Infrastructure Regulationand similar regulatory regimes in other jurisdictions, that regulate or will regulate the derivatives markets in which we operate by, among other things: requiring clearing and exchange trading of certain derivatives; imposing new capital, margin, reporting, registration and business conduct requirements for certain market participants; imposing position limits on certain over-the-counter (OTC) derivatives; and imposing derivatives trading transparency requirements. Regulations of derivatives are already in effect in many markets in which we operate.
In addition, many G-20 jurisdictions, including the U.S., U.K., Germany and Japan, have adopted resolution stay regulations to address concerns that the close-out of derivatives and other financial contracts
in resolution could impede orderly resolution of global systemically important banks (G-SIBs), and additional jurisdictions are expected to follow suit. We and 24 other G-SIBs have adhered to a protocol amending certain financial contracts to provide for contractual recognition of stays of termination rights under various statutory resolution regimes and a stay on the exercise of cross-default rights based on an affiliate’s entry into U.S. bankruptcy proceedings. As resolution stay regulations of a particular jurisdiction go into effect, we amend financial contracts in compliance with such regulations.
Consumer Regulations
Our consumer businesses are subject to extensive regulation and oversight by federal
and state regulators. Certain federal consumer finance laws to which we are subject, including the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, Electronic Fund
Bank of America 2018 4
Transfer Act, Fair Credit Reporting Act, Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act, Truth in Lending Act and Truth in Savings Act, are enforced by the CFPB. Other federal consumer finance
laws, such as the Servicemembers Civil Relief Act, are enforced by the OCC.
Privacy and Information Security
We are subject to many U.S. federal, state and international laws and regulations governing requirements for maintaining policies and procedures to protect the non-public confidential information of our customers and employees. The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act requires us to periodically disclose Bank of America’s privacy policies and practices relating to sharing such information and enables retail customers to opt out of our ability to share information with unaffiliated third parties, under certain circumstances. Other laws and regulations, at the international, federal and state level, impact our ability to share certain information with affiliates and non-affiliates for marketing and/or non-marketing purposes, or to contact customers with marketing offers, including California’s
consumer privacy law that established basic rights of consumers in connection with their personal information. The Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act also requires us to implement a comprehensive information security program that includes administrative, technical and physical safeguards to provide the security and confidentiality of customer records and information. These security and privacy policies and procedures for the protection of personal and confidential information are in effect across all businesses and geographic locations. In the EU, the General Data Protection Regulation (GDPR) replaced the Data Protection Directive and related implementing national laws in its member states. The GDPR’s impact on the Corporation was assessed and addressed through a comprehensive compliance implementation program. Additionally, other legislative and regulatory activity in the U.S. and abroad, as well as court proceedings and bilateral U.S. and EU political developments on the validity
of cross-border data transfer mechanisms from the EU, continue to lend uncertainty to privacy compliance globally.
Item 1A. Risk Factors
In the course of conducting our business operations, we are exposed to a variety of risks, some of which are inherent in the financial services industry and others of which are more specific to our own businesses. The discussion below addresses the most significant factors, of which we are currently aware, that could affect our businesses, results of operations and financial condition. Additional factors that could affect our businesses, results of operations and financial condition are discussed in Forward-looking Statements in the MD&A on page 20.
However, other factors not discussed below or elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K could also adversely affect our businesses, results of operations and financial condition. Therefore, the risk factors below should not be considered a complete list of potential risks that we may face. For more information on how we manage risks, see Managing Risk in the MD&A on page 40.
Any risk factor described in this Annual Report on Form 10-K or in any of our other SEC filings could by itself, or together with other factors, materially adversely affect our liquidity, competitive position, business, reputation, results of operations, capital position or financial condition, including by materially increasing our expenses or decreasing our revenues, which could result in material losses.
Market
Our business and results of operations may be adversely affected by the U.S. and international financial markets, U.S. and non-U.S. fiscal and monetary policies and economic conditions generally.
Financial markets and general economic, political and social conditions in the U.S. and in one or more countries abroad, including the level and volatility of interest rates, unexpected changes in market financing conditions, gross domestic product (GDP) growth, inflation, consumer spending, employment levels, wage stagnation, prolonged federal government shutdowns, energy prices, home prices, bankruptcies, fluctuations or other significant changes in both debt and equity capital markets and currencies, liquidity of the global financial markets, the growth of global trade and commerce, trade policies, the availability and cost of capital and
credit, terrorism, disruption of communication, transportation or energy infrastructure, investor sentiment and confidence, the sustainability of economic growth and any potential slowdown in economic activity may affect markets in the U.S. and abroad and our businesses. Any market downturn in the U.S. or abroad would likely result in a decline in revenue and adversely affect our results of operations and financial condition, including capital and liquidity levels.
In the U.S. and abroad, uncertainties surrounding fiscal and monetary policies present economic challenges. Actions taken by the Federal Reserve, including potential further increases in its target funds rate and the ongoing reduction in its balance sheet, and other central banks are beyond our control and difficult to predict and can affect interest rates and the value of financial instruments and other assets, such as debt securities and mortgage servicing rights
(MSRs) and impact our borrowers, potentially increasing delinquency and default rates as interest rates rise.
Changes to existing U.S. laws and regulatory policies including those related to financial regulation, taxation, international trade, fiscal policy and healthcare may adversely impact us. For example, significant fiscal policy initiatives may increase uncertainty surrounding the formulation and direction of U.S. monetary policy, and volatility of interest rates. Higher U.S. interest rates relative to other major economies could increase the likelihood of a more volatile and appreciating U.S. dollar. Changes, or proposed changes to certain U.S. trade policies, particularly with important trading partners, including China, could upset financial markets, disrupt world trade and commerce and lead to trade retaliation through the use of tariffs, foreign exchange measures or the large-scale sale of U.S. Treasury Bonds.
Any
of these developments could adversely affect our consumer and commercial businesses, our securities and derivatives portfolios, our level of charge-offs and provision for credit losses, the carrying value of our deferred tax assets, our capital levels and liquidity and the costs of running our business, and our results of operations. Additionally, events and ongoing uncertainty related to the planned exit of the U.K. from the EU could magnify any negative impact of these developments on our business and results of operations.
Increased market volatility and adverse changes in other financial or capital market conditions may increase our market risk.
Our liquidity, competitive position, business, results of operations and financial condition are affected by market risks such as changes in interest and currency exchange rates, fluctuations in equity and futures prices, lower trading
volumes and prices of securitized products, the implied volatility of interest rates and credit spreads and other economic and business factors. These market risks may adversely affect, among other things, (i) the value of our on- and off-balance sheet securities, trading assets, other financial instruments and MSRs, (ii) the cost of debt capital and our access to credit markets, (iii) the value of assets under management (AUM), (iv) fee income relating to AUM, (v) customer allocation of capital among investment alternatives, (vi)
5Bank of America 2018
the
volume of client activity in our trading operations, (vii) investment banking fees, (viii) the general profitability and risk level of the transactions in which we engage and (ix) our competitiveness with respect to deposit pricing. For example, the value of certain of our assets is sensitive to changes in market interest rates. If the Federal Reserve or a non-U.S. central bank changes or signals a change in monetary policy, market interest rates could be affected, which could adversely impact the value of such assets. In addition, the low but rising interest rate environment and recent flattening of the yield curve could negatively impact our liquidity, financial condition or results of operations, including future revenue and earnings growth.
We use various models and strategies to assess and control our market risk exposures but those are subject to inherent limitations. For more information regarding models and strategies,
see Item 1A. Risk Factors – Other on page 16. In times of market stress or other unforeseen circumstances, previously uncorrelated indicators may become correlated and vice versa. These types of market movements may limit the effectiveness of our hedging strategies and cause us to incur significant losses. These changes in correlation can be exacerbated where other market participants are using risk or trading models with assumptions or algorithms similar to ours. In these and other cases, it may be difficult to reduce our risk positions due to activity of other market participants or widespread market dislocations, including circumstances where asset values are declining significantly or no market exists for certain assets. To the extent that we own securities that do not have an established liquid trading market or are otherwise subject to restrictions on sale or hedging,
we may not be able to reduce our positions and therefore reduce our risk associated with such positions. In addition, challenging market conditions may also adversely affect our investment banking fees.
For more information about market risk and our market risk management policies and procedures, see Market Risk Management in the MD&A on page 70.
We may incur losses if the value of certain assets declines, including due to changes in interest rates and prepayment speeds.
We have a large portfolio of financial instruments, including certain loans and loan commitments, loans held-for-sale, securities financing agreements, asset-backed secured financings, long-term deposits, long-term debt, trading account assets and liabilities, derivative
assets and liabilities, available-for-sale (AFS) debt and marketable equity securities, other debt securities, equity method investments, certain MSRs and certain other assets and liabilities that we measure at fair value and other accounting values, subject to impairment assessments. We determine these values based on applicable accounting guidance, which for financial instruments measured at fair value, requires an entity to base fair value on exit price and to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs in fair value measurements. The fair values of these financial instruments include adjustments for market liquidity, credit quality, funding impact on certain derivatives and other transaction-specific factors, where appropriate.
Gains or losses on these instruments can have a direct impact on our results of operations, including higher or lower mortgage banking income and earnings,
unless we have effectively hedged our exposures. For example, decreases in interest rates and increases in mortgage prepayment speeds, which are influenced by interest rates and other factors such as reductions in mortgage insurance premiums and origination costs, could adversely impact the value of our MSR asset, and cause a significant acceleration of purchase premium amortization on our mortgage portfolio, because a decline in long-term interest rates shortens the expected lives of the securities, and adversely affects our net
interest margin. Conversely, increases in interest rates may result in a decrease in residential mortgage loan originations. In addition, increases in interest rates may adversely impact the fair value of debt securities and, accordingly, for debt securities classified as AFS, may adversely affect accumulated other comprehensive income and, thus, capital
levels.
Fair values may be impacted by declining values of the underlying assets or the prices at which observable market transactions occur and the continued availability of these transactions. The financial strength of counterparties, with whom we have economically hedged some of our exposure to these assets, also will affect the fair value of these assets. Sudden declines and volatility in the prices of assets may curtail or eliminate trading activities in these assets, which may make it difficult to sell, hedge or value these assets. The inability to sell or effectively hedge assets reduces our ability to limit losses in such positions and the difficulty in valuing assets may increase our risk-weighted assets, which requires us to maintain additional capital and increases our funding costs. Asset values also directly impact revenues in our wealth management and related advisory businesses. We receive asset-based management
fees based on the value of our clients’ portfolios or investments in funds managed by us and, in some cases, we also receive performance fees based on increases in the value of such investments. Declines in asset values can reduce the value of our clients’ portfolios or fund assets, which in turn can result in lower fees earned for managing such assets.
For more information on fair value measurements, see Note 20 – Fair Value Measurementsto the Consolidated Financial Statements. For more information on our asset management businesses, see GWIM in the MD&A on page 33. For more information on interest rate risk management, see Interest Rate Risk Management for the Banking Book in the
MD&A on page 74.
Liquidity
If we are unable to access the capital markets, continue to maintain deposits, or our borrowing costs increase, our liquidity and competitive position will be negatively affected.
Liquidity is essential to our businesses. We fund our assets primarily with globally sourced deposits in our bank entities, as well as secured and unsecured liabilities transacted in the capital markets. We rely on certain secured funding sources, such as repo markets, which are typically short-term and credit-sensitive in nature. We also engage in asset securitization transactions, including with the government-sponsored enterprises (GSEs), to fund consumer lending activities. Our liquidity could be adversely affected by any inability to access the capital markets; illiquidity or
volatility in the capital markets; the decrease in value of eligible collateral or increased collateral requirements due to credit concerns for short-term borrowing; changes to our relationships with our funding providers based on real or perceived changes in our risk profile; prolonged federal government shutdowns; changes in regulations, guidance or GSE status that impact our funding avenues or ability to access certain funding sources; the refusal or inability of the Federal Reserve to act as lender of last resort; simultaneous draws on lines of credit; the withdrawal of customer deposits, which could result from customer attrition for higher yields or the desire for more conservative alternatives; increased regulatory liquidity, capital and margin requirements for our U.S. or international banks and their nonbank subsidiaries; failure by a significant market participant or third
party, such as a clearing agent or custodian; reputational issues; or negative perceptions about our short- or long-term business prospects, including downgrades of our credit ratings. Several of these factors may arise due to circumstances beyond our control, such as general
Bank of America 2018 6
market volatility, disruption, shock or stress, fluctuations in interest rates, negative
views about the Corporation or financial services industry generally or a specific news event, changes in the regulatory environment, actions by credit rating agencies or an operational problem that affects third parties or us. The impact of these events, whether within our control or not, could include an inability to sell assets or redeem investments, unforeseen outflows of cash, the need to draw on liquidity facilities, debt repurchases to support the secondary market or meet client requests, the need for additional funding for commitments and contingencies, as well as unexpected collateral calls, among other things, the result of which could be a liquidity shortfall and/or impact on our liquidity coverage ratio.
Our cost of obtaining funding is directly related to prevailing market interest rates and to our credit spreads. Credit spreads are the amount in excess of the interest rate of U.S. Treasury securities, or other
benchmark securities, of a similar maturity that we need to pay to our funding providers. Increases in interest rates and our credit spreads can increase the cost of our funding and result in mark-to-market or credit valuation adjustment exposures. Changes in our credit spreads are market-driven and may be influenced by market perceptions of our creditworthiness. Changes to interest rates and our credit spreads occur continuously and may be unpredictable and highly volatile. Additionally, concentrations within our funding profile, such as maturities, currencies or counterparties, can reduce our funding efficiency.
For more information about our liquidity position and other liquidity matters, including credit ratings and outlooks and the policies and procedures we use to manage our liquidity risks, see Liquidity Risk in the MD&A on page 47.
Adverse
changes to our credit ratings from the major credit rating agencies could significantly limit our access to funding or the capital markets, increase our borrowing costs or trigger additional collateral or funding requirements.
Our borrowing costs and ability to raise funds are directly impacted by our credit ratings. In addition, credit ratings may be important to customers or counterparties when we compete in certain markets and seek to engage in certain transactions, including OTC derivatives. Credit ratings and outlooks are opinions expressed by rating agencies on our creditworthiness and that of our obligations or securities, including long-term debt, short-term borrowings, preferred stock and asset securitizations. Our credit ratings are subject to ongoing review by rating agencies, which consider a number of factors, including our own financial strength, performance, prospects and operations as well as factors not under
our control such as the likelihood of the U.S. government providing meaningful support to us or our subsidiaries in a crisis.
Rating agencies could make adjustments to our credit ratings at any time, and there can be no assurance as to when and whether downgrades will occur. A reduction in certain of our credit ratings could result in a wider credit spread and negatively affect our liquidity, access to credit markets, the related cost of funds, our businesses and certain trading revenues, particularly in those businesses where counterparty creditworthiness is critical. If the short-term credit ratings of our parent company, bank or broker-dealer subsidiaries were downgraded by one or more levels, we may suffer the potential loss of access to short-term
funding sources such as repo financing, and/or increased cost of funds. Under the terms of certain OTC derivative contracts and other trading agreements, if our or our subsidiaries’ credit ratings are downgraded, the counterparties may require additional collateral or terminate these contracts or agreements.
While certain potential impacts are contractual and quantifiable, the full consequences of a credit rating downgrade
to a financial institution are inherently uncertain, as they depend upon numerous dynamic, complex and inter-related factors and assumptions, including
whether any downgrade of a firm’s long-term credit ratings precipitates downgrades to its short-term credit ratings, and assumptions about the potential behaviors of various customers, investors and counterparties.
For more information on the amount of additional collateral required and derivative liabilities that would be subject to unilateral termination at December 31, 2018, if the rating agencies had downgraded their long-term senior debt ratings for the Corporation or certain subsidiaries by each of two incremental notches, see Credit-related Contingent Features and Collateral in Note 3 – Derivativesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
For
more information about our credit ratings and their potential effects to our liquidity, see Liquidity Risk – Credit Ratings in the MD&A on page 50 and Note 3 – Derivativesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Bank of America Corporation is a holding company and we depend upon our subsidiaries for liquidity, including the ability to pay dividends to shareholders and to fund payments on other obligations. Applicable laws and regulations, including capital and liquidity requirements, and actions taken pursuant to our resolution plan could restrict our ability to transfer funds from subsidiaries
to Bank of America Corporation or to other subsidiaries, which could adversely affect our cash flow and financial condition.
Bank of America Corporation, as the parent company, is a separate and distinct legal entity from our banking and nonbank subsidiaries. We evaluate and manage liquidity on a legal entity basis. Legal entity liquidity is an important consideration as there are legal, regulatory, contractual and other limitations on our ability to utilize liquidity from one legal entity to satisfy the liquidity requirements of another, including the parent company, which could result in adverse liquidity events. The parent company depends on dividends, distributions, loans, advances and other payments from our banking and nonbank subsidiaries
to fund dividend payments on our common stock and preferred stock and to fund all payments on our other obligations, including debt obligations. Many of our subsidiaries, including our bank and broker-dealer subsidiaries, are subject to laws that restrict dividend payments, or authorize regulatory bodies to block or reduce the flow of funds from those subsidiaries to the parent company or other subsidiaries. Our bank and broker-dealer subsidiaries are subject to restrictions on their ability to lend or transact with affiliates
and to minimum regulatory capital and liquidity requirements, as well as restrictions on their ability to use funds deposited with them in bank or brokerage accounts to fund their businesses. Intercompany arrangements we entered into in connection with our resolution planning submissions could restrict the amount of funding available to the parent company from our subsidiaries under certain adverse conditions.
Additional restrictions on related party transactions, increased capital and liquidity requirements and additional limitations on the use of funds on deposit in bank or brokerage accounts, as well as lower earnings, can reduce the amount of funds available to meet the obligations of the parent company and even require the parent company to provide additional funding to such subsidiaries.
Also, regulatory action that requires additional liquidity at each of our subsidiaries could impede access to funds we need to pay our obligations or pay dividends. In addition, our right to participate in a distribution of assets upon a subsidiary’s liquidation or reorganization is subject to prior claims of the subsidiary’s creditors. For more information regarding our ability to pay dividends, see Capital Management in the MD&A on page 43 and Note 13 – Shareholders’ Equityto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
7Bank
of America 2018
In the event of a resolution, whether in a bankruptcy proceeding or under the orderly liquidation authority of the FDIC, such resolution could materially adversely affect our liquidity and financial condition and the ability to pay dividends to shareholders and to pay obligations.
Bank of America Corporation, our parent holding company, is required to periodically submit a plan to the FDIC and Federal Reserve describing its resolution
strategy under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code in the event of material financial distress or failure. In the current plan, Bank of America Corporation’s preferred resolution strategy is a “single point of entry” strategy. This strategy provides that only the parent holding company files for resolution under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code and contemplates providing certain key operating subsidiaries with sufficient capital and liquidity to operate through severe stress and to enable such subsidiaries to continue operating or be wound down in a solvent manner following a bankruptcy of the parent holding company. Bank of America Corporation has entered into intercompany arrangements resulting in the contribution of most of its capital and liquidity to key subsidiaries.
Pursuant to these arrangements, if Bank of America Corporation’s liquidity resources deteriorate so severely that resolution becomes imminent, Bank of America Corporation will no longer be able to draw liquidity from its key subsidiaries, and will be required to contribute its remaining financial assets to a wholly-owned holding company subsidiary, which could materially and adversely affect our liquidity and financial condition and the ability to pay dividends to shareholders and meet our payment obligations.
In addition, if the FDIC and Federal Reserve jointly determine that Bank of America Corporation’s resolution plan is not credible, they could impose more stringent capital, leverage or liquidity requirements or restrictions on our growth, activities or operations. Further, we could be required to take certain actions that could
impose operating costs and could potentially result in the divestiture or restructuring of certain businesses and subsidiaries.
Under the Financial Reform Act, when a G-SIB such as Bank of America Corporation is in default or danger of default, the FDIC may be appointed receiver in order to conduct an orderly liquidation of such institution. In the event of such appointment, the FDIC could, among other things, invoke the orderly liquidation authority, instead of the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, if the Secretary of the Treasury makes certain financial distress and systemic risk determinations. In 2013, the FDIC issued a notice describing its preferred “single point of entry” strategy for resolving a G-SIB. Under this approach, the FDIC could replace Bank of America Corporation with a bridge holding company, which could continue operations
and result in an orderly resolution of the underlying bank, but whose equity would be held solely for the benefit of our creditors. The FDIC’s “single point of entry” strategy may result in our security holders suffering greater losses than would have been the case under a bankruptcy proceeding or a different resolution strategy.
For more information about resolution planning, see Item 1. Business – Resolution Planning on page 3. For more information about the FDIC’s orderly liquidation, see Item 1. Business – Insolvency and the Orderly Liquidation Authority on page 4.
Credit
Economic
or market disruptions, insufficient credit loss reserves or concentration of credit risk may result in an increase in the provision for credit losses, which could have an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
A number of our products expose us to credit risk, including loans, letters of credit, derivatives, debt securities, trading account assets and assets held-for-sale. The financial condition of our
consumer and commercial borrowers, counterparties and underlying collateral could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.
Global and U.S. economic conditions and macroeconomic events, including a decline in global GDP, consumer spending or real estate prices, as well as increasing leverage, rising unemployment and/or fluctuations in
foreign exchange or interest rates, particularly if inflation is rising, may impact our credit portfolios. Economic or market stress or disruptions, including as a result of natural disasters, would likely increase the risk that borrowers or counterparties would default or become delinquent in their obligations to us, resulting in credit loss. Increases in delinquencies and default rates could adversely affect our consumer credit card, home equity, residential mortgage and purchased credit-impaired portfolios through increased charge-offs and provision for credit losses. A deteriorating economic environment could also adversely affect our consumer and commercial loan portfolios with weakened client and collateral positions. Additionally, simultaneous drawdowns on lines of credit or an increase in a borrower’s leverage in a weakening economic environment could result in deterioration in our credit portfolio, should borrowers be unable to fulfill competing financial obligations.
Specifically, our consumer portfolio could be negatively impacted by drastic reductions in employment, or increases in underemployment, resulting in lower disposable income.
We estimate and establish an allowance for credit losses for losses inherent in our lending activities (including unfunded lending commitments), excluding those measured at fair value, through a charge to earnings. The process for determining the amount of the allowance requires us to make difficult and complex judgments, including loss forecasts on how borrowers will react to changing economic conditions. The ability of our borrowers or counterparties to repay their obligations will likely be impacted by changes in future economic conditions, which in turn could impact the accuracy of our loss forecasts and allowance estimates. There is also the possibility that we will fail to accurately identify the appropriate economic indicators or that we will fail
to accurately estimate their impacts.
We may suffer unexpected losses if the models and assumptions we use to establish reserves and make judgments in extending credit to our borrowers or counterparties prove inaccurate in predicting future events. In addition, external factors, such as natural disasters, can influence recognition of credit losses in our portfolios and impact our allowance for credit losses. Although we believe that our allowance for credit losses was in compliance with applicable accounting standards at December 31, 2018, there is no guarantee that it will be sufficient to address credit losses, particularly if economic conditions deteriorate. In such an event, we may increase the size of our allowance which would reduce our earnings.
In the ordinary course of our
business, we also may be subject to a concentration of credit risk in a particular industry, geographic location, counterparty, borrower or issuer. A deterioration in the financial condition or prospects of a particular industry or a failure or downgrade of, or default by, any particular entity or group of entities could negatively affect our businesses, and the processes by which we set limits and monitor the level of our credit exposure to individual entities, industries and countries may not function as we have anticipated. While our activities expose us to many different industries and counterparties, we routinely execute a high volume of transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including broker-dealers, commercial banks, investment banks, insurers, mutual funds and hedge funds, and other institutional clients. This has resulted in significant credit
Bank
of America 2018 8
concentration with respect to this industry. Financial services institutions and other counterparties are inter-related because of trading, funding, clearing or other relationships. As a result, defaults by, or even market uncertainty about the financial stability of one or more financial services institutions, or the financial services industry generally, could lead to market-wide liquidity disruptions, losses and defaults. Many of these transactions expose us to credit risk and, in some cases, disputes and litigation in the event of default of a counterparty. In addition, our credit risk may be heightened by market risk when the collateral held by us cannot be liquidated or is liquidated at prices not sufficient to recover the full amount of the loan
or derivatives exposure due to us. Further, disputes with obligors as to the valuation of collateral could increase in times of significant market stress, volatility or illiquidity, and we could suffer losses during such periods if we are unable to realize the fair value of the collateral or manage declines in the value of collateral.
In the ordinary course of business, we also enter into transactions with sovereign nations, U.S. states and U.S. municipalities. Unfavorable economic or political conditions, disruptions to capital markets, currency fluctuations, changes in oil prices, social instability and changes in government policies could impact the operating budgets or credit ratings of these government entities and expose us to credit risk.
We also have a concentration of credit risk with respect to our consumer real estate, auto, consumer credit card and commercial real estate
portfolios, which represent a significant percentage of our overall credit portfolio. Additionally, decreases in home price valuations or commercial real estate valuations in certain markets where we have large concentrations, including as a result of natural disasters, as well as more broadly within the U.S. or globally, could result in increased defaults, delinquencies or credit loss. For more information, see Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management in the MD&A on page 51. Furthermore, our commercial portfolios include exposures to certain industries, including the energy sector. For more information, see Commercial Portfolio Credit Risk Management in the MD&A on page 59. Economic weaknesses, adverse business conditions, market disruptions, rising interest or capitalization
rates, the collapse of speculative bubbles, greater volatility in areas where we have concentrated credit risk or deterioration in real estate values or household incomes may cause us to experience a decrease in cash flow and higher credit losses in either our consumer or commercial portfolios or cause us to write down the value of certain assets.
Liquidity disruptions in the financial markets may result in our inability to sell, syndicate or realize the value of our positions, leading to increased concentrations, which could increase the credit and market risk associated with our positions, as well as increase our risk-weighted assets.
For more information about our credit risk and credit risk management policies and procedures, see Credit Risk Management in the MD&A on page 51,
Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles,Note 5 – Outstanding Loans and Leases and Note 6 – Allowance for Credit Lossesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
If the U.S. housing market weakens or home prices decline, our consumer loan portfolios, credit quality, credit losses, representations and warranties exposures and earnings may be adversely affected.
While U.S. home prices continued to generally improve during 2018, declines in future periods may negatively impact the demand for many of our products. Additionally, our mortgage loan production volume is generally influenced by the rate of growth in residential mortgage
debt outstanding and the size of the residential mortgage market, both of which may be adversely
affected by rising interest rates. Conditions in the U.S. housing market in prior years resulted in both significant write-downs of asset values in several asset classes, notably mortgage-backed securities, and exposure to monolines. If the U.S. housing market were to weaken, the value of real estate could decline, which could result in increased credit losses and delinquent servicing expenses and negatively affect our representations and warranties exposures, which could have an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
Our derivatives businesses may expose us to unexpected risks and potential losses.
We are party to a large number of derivatives transactions, including
credit derivatives. Our derivatives businesses may expose us to unexpected market, credit and operational risks that could cause us to suffer unexpected losses. Severe declines in asset values, unanticipated credit events or unforeseen circumstances that may cause previously uncorrelated factors to become correlated and vice versa, may create losses resulting from risks not appropriately taken into account or anticipated in the development, structuring or pricing of a derivative instrument. Certain of our OTC derivative contracts and other trading agreements provide that upon the occurrence of certain specified events, such as a change in the credit rating of a particular Bank of America entity or entities, we may be required to provide additional collateral or take other remedial actions, or our counterparties may have the right to terminate or otherwise diminish our rights under
these contracts or agreements.
In addition, in the event of a downgrade of our credit ratings, certain derivative and other counterparties may request we substitute BANA (which has generally had equal or higher credit ratings than the parent company) as counterparty for certain contracts. Our ability to substitute or make changes to these agreements may be subject to certain limitations including, counterparty willingness, operational considerations, regulatory limitations on having BANA as a counterparty and collateral constraints. It is possible that such limitations on our ability to substitute or make changes to these agreements, including having BANA as the new counterparty, could adversely affect our results of operations.
Many
derivative instruments are individually negotiated and non-standardized, which can make exiting, transferring or settling some positions difficult. Many derivatives require that we deliver to the counterparty the underlying security, loan or other obligation in order to receive payment. In a number of cases, we do not hold, and may not be able to obtain, the underlying security, loan or other obligation.
We are also a member of various central counterparty clearinghouses (CCPs) due to regulatory requirements for mandatory clearing of derivative transactions, which potentially increases our credit risk exposures to CCPs. In the event that one or more members of the CCP defaults on its obligations, we may be required to pay a portion of any losses incurred by the CCP as a result of that default. Also, as a clearing member, we are exposed to the risk of non-performance by our clients for which we clear transactions, which may
not be covered by available collateral.
For more information on our derivatives exposure, see Note 3 – Derivativesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Geopolitical
We are subject to numerous political, economic, market, reputational, operational, legal, regulatory and other risks in the jurisdictions in which we operate.
We do business throughout the world, including in emerging markets. Our businesses and revenues derived from non-U.S. jurisdictions are subject to risk of loss from currency fluctuations,
9Bank
of America 2018
financial, social or judicial instability, changes in governmental policies or policies of central banks, expropriation, nationalization and/or confiscation of assets, price controls, capital controls, redenomination risk, exchange controls, protectionist trade policies, increasing trade tensions between the U.S. and important trading partners, particularly China, increasing the risk of escalating tariffs and other restrictive actions, unfavorable political and diplomatic developments,
oil price fluctuation and changes in legislation. These risks are especially elevated in emerging markets. A number of non-U.S. jurisdictions in which we do business have been or may be negatively impacted by slowing growth or recessionary conditions, market volatility and/or political unrest. The political and economic environment in Europe, including the debt concerns of certain EU countries, remains challenging and the current degree of political and economic uncertainty, including potential recessionary conditions, could increase. For example, the ongoing negotiations of the terms of the U.K.’s planned exit from the EU may create uncertainty and increase risk, which could adversely affect us.
Potential risks of default on or devaluation of sovereign debt in some non-U.S. jurisdictions could expose us to substantial losses. Risks in one nation can limit our opportunities for portfolio growth and negatively affect our operations
in other nations, including our U.S. operations. Market and economic disruptions of all types may affect consumer confidence levels and spending, corporate investment and job creation, bankruptcy rates, levels of incurrence and default on consumer and corporate debt, economic growth rates and asset values, among other factors. Any such unfavorable conditions or developments could have an adverse impact on our company.
We also invest or trade in the securities of corporations and governments located in non-U.S. jurisdictions, including emerging markets. Revenues from the trading of non-U.S. securities may be subject to negative fluctuations as a result of the above factors. Furthermore, the impact of these fluctuations could be magnified because non-U.S. trading markets, particularly in emerging markets, are generally smaller, less liquid and
more volatile than U.S. trading markets.
Our non-U.S. businesses are also subject to extensive regulation by governments, securities exchanges and regulators, central banks and other regulatory bodies. In many countries, the laws and regulations applicable to the financial services and securities industries are uncertain and evolving, and it may be difficult for us to determine the exact requirements of local laws in every market or manage our relationships with multiple regulators in various jurisdictions. Our potential inability to remain in compliance with local laws in a particular market and manage our relationships with regulators could have an adverse effect not only on our businesses in that market but also on our reputation in general.
In addition to non-U.S. legislation, our international operations are also subject to U.S. legal requirements. For example, our operations
are subject to U.S. and non-U.S. laws and regulations relating to bribery and corruption, anti-money laundering, and economic sanctions, which can vary by jurisdiction. The increasing speed and novel ways in which funds circulate could make it more challenging to track the movement of funds. Our ability to comply with these legal requirements depends on our ability to continually improve detection and reporting and analytic capabilities.
In the U.S., debt ceiling and budget deficit concerns, which have increased the possibility of U.S. government defaults on its debt and/or downgrades to its credit ratings, and prolonged government shutdowns could negatively impact the global economy and banking system and adversely affect our financial condition, including our liquidity. Additionally, changes in fiscal,
monetary or regulatory policy
could increase our compliance costs and adversely affect our business operations, organizational structure and results of operations. We are also subject to geopolitical risks, including acts or threats of terrorism, and actions taken by the U.S. or other governments in response thereto, and/or military conflicts, which could adversely affect business and economic conditions abroad, as well as in the U.S.
For more information on our non-U.S. credit and trading portfolios, see Non-U.S. Portfolio in the MD&A on page 65.
The U.K. Referendum, and the planned exit of the U.K. from the EU, could adversely affect us.
We conduct business in Europe, the Middle East and Africa primarily through our subsidiaries
in the U.K. and Ireland. For the year ended December 31, 2018, our operations in Europe, the Middle East and Africa, including the U.K., represented approximately six percent of our total revenue, net of interest expense.
A referendum was held in the U.K. in 2016, which resulted in a majority vote in favor of exiting the EU on March 29, 2019. Negotiations between the EU and U.K. regarding this exit consist of three phases: a withdrawal agreement, a new trade deal and an arrangement for a transition period. Significant political and economic uncertainty persists regarding the timing, details and viability of each phase. There may be heightened uncertainty if the terms of the U.K.’s exit from the EU are not agreed upon at the time
of its exit. The ultimate impact and terms of the U.K.’s planned exit remain unclear, and short- and long-term global economic and market volatility may occur, including as a result of currency fluctuations and trade relations. If uncertainty resulting from the U.K.’s exit negatively impacts economic conditions, financial markets and consumer confidence, our business, results of operations, financial position and/or operational model could be adversely affected.
We are also subject to different laws, regulations and regulatory authorities and may incur additional costs and/or experience negative tax consequences as a result of establishing our principal EU banking and broker-dealer operations outside of the U.K., which could adversely impact our EU business, results of operations and operational model. Additionally, changes to the legal and regulatory framework under which our subsidiaries
will continue to provide products and services in the U.K. following an exit by the U.K. from the EU may result in additional compliance costs and have an adverse impact on our results of operations. For more information on our EU operations outside of the U.K., see Executive Summary – Recent Developments – U.K. Exit from the EU in the MD&A on page 21.
Business Operations
A failure in or breach of our operational or security systems or infrastructure, or those of third parties, could disrupt our businesses, and adversely impact our results of operations, liquidity and financial condition, as well as cause legal or reputational harm.
The potential for operational risk exposure exists throughout our organization and, as a result of our
interactions with, and reliance on, third parties, is not limited to our own internal operational functions. Our operational and security systemsinfrastructure, including our computer systems, emerging technologies, data management and internal processes, as well as those of third parties, are integral to our performance. We rely on our employees and third parties in our day-to-day and ongoing operations, who may, as a result of human error, misconduct, malfeasance or failure or breach of systems or infrastructure, expose us to risk. We have taken measures to implement training, procedures, backup systems and other safeguards to support our operations, but our ability to conduct business may be adversely
Bank
of America 2018 10
affected by any significant disruptions to us or to third parties with whom we interact or upon whom we rely. For example, technology project implementation challenges may cause business interruptions. In addition, our ability to implement backup systems and other safeguards with respect to third-party systems is more limited than with respect to our own systems. Our financial, accounting, data processing, backup or other operating or security systems and infrastructure or those of third parties with whom we interact or upon whom we rely may fail to operate properly or become disabled or damaged as a result of a number of factors including events that are wholly or partially beyond our or such third party’s control, which could adversely affect our ability
to process transactions or provide services. There could be sudden increases in customer transaction volume due to electronic trading platforms and algorithmic trading applications; electrical, telecommunications or other major physical infrastructure outages; newly identified vulnerabilities in key hardware or software; natural disasters such as earthquakes, tornadoes, hurricanes and floods; pandemics; and events arising from local or larger scale political or social matters, including terrorist acts, which could result in prolonged operational outages. In the event that backup systems are utilized, they may not process data as quickly as our primary systems and some data might not have been backed up. We continuously update the systems on which we rely to support our operations and growth and to remain compliant with all applicable laws, rules and regulations globally. This updating entails significant costs and creates risks associated with implementing new systems
and integrating them with existing ones, including business interruptions. Operational risk exposures could adversely impact our results of operations, liquidity and financial condition, as well as cause reputational harm.
A cyber-attack, information or security breach, or a technology failure of ours or of a third party could adversely affect our ability to conduct our business, manage our exposure to risk or expand our businesses, result in the disclosure or misuse of confidential or proprietary information, increase our costs to maintain and update our operational and security systems and infrastructure, and adversely impact our results of operations, liquidity and financial condition, as well as cause legal or reputational harm.
Our businesses are highly dependent on the security, controls and efficacy of our infrastructure, computer and data management systems, as well as those
of our customers, suppliers, counterparties and other third parties with whom we interact or on whom we rely. Our businesses rely on effective access management and the secure collection, processing, transmission, storage and retrieval of confidential, proprietary, personal and other information in our computer and data management systems and networks, and in the computer and data management systems and networks of third parties. In addition, to access our network, products and services, our employees, customers, suppliers, counterparties and other third parties increasingly use personal mobile devices or computing devices that are outside of our network and control environments and are subject to their own cybersecurity risks.
We, our employees and customers, regulators and other third parties have been subject to, and are likely to continue to be the target of, cyber-attacks. These cyber-attacks include computer viruses,
malicious or destructive code (such as ransomware), phishing attacks, denial of service or information or other security breaches that could result in the unauthorized release, gathering, monitoring, misuse, loss or destruction of confidential, proprietary and other information of ours, our employees, our customers or of third parties, damages to systems, or otherwise material disruption to our or our customers’ or other third parties’ network
access or business operations. As cyber threats continue to evolve, we may be required to expend significant additional resources to continue to modify or enhance our protective measures or to investigate and remediate any information security vulnerabilities or incidents. Cyber threats are rapidly evolving, and despite substantial efforts to protect the integrity of our systems and implement controls, processes, policies and other protective
measures, we may not be able to anticipate all cyber-attacks or information or security breaches, nor may we be able to implement effective preventive or defensive measures to address such attacks or breaches.
Cybersecurity risks for financial services organizations have significantly increased in recent years in part because of the proliferation of new and emerging technologies, and the use of the Internet and telecommunications technologies to conduct financial transactions. For example, cybersecurity risks may increase in the future as we continue to increase our mobile-payment and other internet-based product offerings, expand our internal usage of web- or cloud-based products and applications and continue to develop our use of process automation and artificial intelligence. In addition, cybersecurity risks have significantly increased in recent years in part due to the increasingly sophisticated activities of organized
crime groups, hackers, terrorist organizations, hostile foreign governments, disgruntled employees or vendors, activists and other external parties, including those involved in corporate espionage. Even the most advanced internal control environment may be vulnerable to compromise. Internal access management failures could result in the compromise or unauthorized exposure of confidential data. Targeted social engineering attacks are becoming more sophisticated and are extremely difficult to prevent. The techniques used by bad actors change frequently and may not be recognized until well after a breach has occurred, at which time the materiality of the breach may be difficult to assess. Additionally, the existence of cyber-attacks or security breaches at third parties with access to our data, such as vendors, may not be disclosed to us in a timely manner.
Although to date we have not experienced any material losses or other
material consequences relating to technology failure, cyber-attacks or other information or security breaches, whether directed at us or third parties, there can be no assurance that we will not suffer such material losses or consequences in the future. Our risk and exposure to these matters remain heightened because of, among other things, the evolving nature of these threats, our prominent size and scale, and our role in the financial services industry and the broader economy, our plans to continue to implement our internet banking and mobile banking channel strategies and develop additional remote connectivity solutions to serve our customers when and how they want to be served, our continuous transmission of sensitive information to, and storage of such information by, third parties, including our vendors and regulators, our geographic footprint and international presence, the outsourcing of some of our business operations, threats of cyber terrorism, external extremist
parties, including foreign state actors, in some circumstances as a means to promote political ends, and system and customer account updates and conversions. As a result, cybersecurity and the continued development and enhancement of our controls, processes and practices designed to protect our systems, computers, software, data and networks from attack, damage or unauthorized access remain a critical priority.
We also face indirect technology, cybersecurity and operational risks relating to the customers, clients and other third parties with whom we do business or upon whom we rely to facilitate or enable our business activities, including financial counterparties;
11Bank
of America 2018
financial intermediaries such as clearing agents, exchanges and clearing houses; vendors; regulators; providers of critical infrastructure such as internet access and electrical power; and retailers for whom we process transactions. As a result of increasing consolidation, interdependence and complexity of financial entities and technology systems, a technology failure, cyber-attack or other information or security breach that significantly degrades, deletes or compromises the systems
or data of one or more financial entities or third-party or downstream service providers could have a material impact on counterparties or other market participants, including us. This consolidation, interconnectivity and complexity increases the risk of operational failure, on both individual and industry-wide bases, as disparate systems need to be integrated, often on an accelerated basis. Any technology failure, cyber-attack or other information or security breach, termination or constraint of any third party, including downstream service providers, could, among other things, adversely affect our ability to conduct day-to-day business activities, effect transactions, service our clients, manage our exposure to risk, expand our businesses or result in the misappropriation or destruction of the personal, proprietary or confidential information of our employees, customers, suppliers, counterparties and other third parties.
Cyber-attacks
or other information or security breaches, whether directed at us or third parties, may result in significant lost revenue, give rise to losses or have other negative consequences. Furthermore, the public perception that a cyber-attack on our systems has been successful, whether or not this perception is correct, may damage our reputation with customers and third parties with whom we do business. Although we maintain cyber insurance, there can be no assurance that liabilities or losses we may incur will be covered under such policies or that the amount of insurance will be adequate. Also, successful penetration or circumvention of system security could result in negative consequences, including loss of customers and business opportunities, the withdrawal of customer deposits, prolonged computer and network outages resulting in disruptions to our critical business operations and customer services, misappropriation or destruction of our confidential information and/or
the confidential, proprietary or personal information of certain parties, such as our employees, customers, suppliers, counterparties and other third parties, or damage to their computers or systems. This could result in a violation of applicable privacy and other laws in the U.S. and abroad, litigation exposure, regulatory fines, penalties or intervention, loss of confidence in our security measures, reputational damage, reimbursement or other compensatory costs, additional compliance costs and our internal controls or disclosure controls being rendered ineffective. The occurrence of any of these events could adversely impact our results of operations, liquidity and financial condition.
Our mortgage loan repurchase obligations or claims from third parties could result in additional losses.
We and our legacy companies have sold significant amounts of residential mortgage loans.
In connection with these sales, we or certain of our subsidiaries or legacy companies made various representations and warranties, breaches of which may result in a requirement that we repurchase the mortgage loans, or otherwise make whole or provide other remedies to counterparties. At December 31, 2018, we had $14.4 billion of unresolved repurchase claims, net of duplicate claims and excluding claims where the statute of limitations has expired without litigation being commenced.
At December 31, 2018, our liability for obligations under representations and warranties exposures was $2.0 billion.
We also have an estimated range of possible loss (RPL) for
representations and warranties exposures that is combined with the litigation RPL, which we disclose in Note 12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements. The recorded liability and estimated RPL are based on currently available information, significant judgment and a number of assumptions that are subject to change. There can be no assurance that the Corporation will reach future settlements or, if it does, that the terms of past settlements can be relied upon to predict the terms of future settlements. Future representations and warranties losses may occur in excess of our recorded liability and estimated RPL, and such losses could have a material adverse effect on our liquidity, financial condition
and results of operations.
Additionally, our recorded liability for representations and warranties exposures and the corresponding estimated RPL do not consider certain losses related to servicing, including foreclosure and related costs, fraud, indemnity or claims (including for residential mortgage-backed securities) related to securities law. Losses with respect to one or more of these matters could be material to our results of operations or liquidity.
For more information about our representations and warranties exposure, see Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements and Contractual Obligations – Representations and Warranties in the MD&A on page 40, Complex Accounting Estimates – Representations and Warranties Liability in the MD&A on
page 79 and Note 12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Failure to satisfy our obligations as servicer for residential mortgage securitizations, along with other losses we could incur in our capacity as servicer, and foreclosure delays and/or investigations into our residential mortgage foreclosure practices could cause losses.
We and our legacy companies have securitized a significant portion of the residential mortgage loans that we originated or acquired. We service a portion of the loans we have securitized and also service loans on behalf of third-party securitization vehicles and other investors. If we commit a material breach of our obligations as servicer or master servicer, we may be subject
to termination if the breach is not cured within a specified period of time following notice, which could cause us to lose servicing income. In addition, for loans principally held in private-label securitization trusts, we may have liability for any failure by us, as a servicer or master servicer, for any act or omission on our part that involves willful misfeasance, bad faith, gross negligence or reckless disregard of our duties. If any such breach was found to have occurred, it may harm our reputation, increase our servicing costs or adversely impact our results of operations. Additionally, with respect to foreclosures, we may incur costs or losses due to irregularities in the underlying documentation, or if the validity of a foreclosure action is challenged by a borrower or overturned by a court because of errors or deficiencies in the foreclosure process. We may also incur costs or losses relating to delays or alleged deficiencies in processing documents necessary
to comply with state law governing foreclosure.
Changes in the structure of the GSEs and the relationship among the GSEs, the government and the private markets, or the conversion of the current conservatorship of Fannie Mae or Freddie Mac into receivership, could result in significant changes to our business operations and may adversely impact our business.
During 2018, we sold approximately $3.0 billion of loans to Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac. Each is currently in a conservatorship with its primary regulator, the Federal Housing Finance Agency (FHFA), acting as conservator. We cannot predict whether the conservatorships will end, any associated changes to their business structure that could result or whether the conservatorships will end in receivership, privatization or other
Bank
of America 2018 12
change in business structure. There are several proposed approaches to reform that, if enacted, could change the structure and the relationship among the GSEs, the government and the private markets, including the trading markets for agency conforming mortgage loans and markets for mortgage-related securities in which weparticipate. Although the FHFA has taken steps to unify underwriting parameters and business practices between GSEs, we cannot predict the prospects for the enactment, timing or content of legislative or rulemaking proposals regarding the future status of any GSEs and/or their impact on the guarantees, demand or price of mortgage-related securities. Accordingly, uncertainty regarding their
future continues to exist, including whether the GSEs will continue to exist in their current forms or continue to guarantee mortgages and provide funding for mortgage loans.
Any of these developments could adversely affect the value of our securities portfolios, capital levels and liquidity and results of operations.
Our risk management framework may not be effective in mitigating risk and reducing the potential for losses.
Our risk management framework is designed to minimize risk and loss to us. We seek to effectively identify, measure, monitor, report and control the types of risk to which we are subject, including strategic, credit, market, liquidity, compliance, operational and reputational risks. While we employ a broad and diversified set of controls and risk mitigation techniques, including hedging strategies and techniques that
seek to balance our ability to profit from trading positions with our exposure to potential losses, our ability to control and mitigate risks that result in losses is inherently limited by our ability to identify all risks, including emerging and unknown risks, anticipate the timing of risks, apply effective hedging strategies, manage and aggregate data correctly and efficiently, and develop risk management models to assess and control risk.
Our ability to manage risk is limited by our ability to develop and maintain a culture of managing risk well throughout the Corporation and manage risks associated with third parties and vendors, to enable effective risk management and ensure that risks are appropriately considered, evaluated and responded to in a timely manner. Uncertain economic conditions, heightened legislative and regulatory scrutiny of the financial services industry and the overall complexity of our operations,
among other developments, may result in a heightened level of risk for us. Accordingly, we could suffer losses as a result of our failure to properly anticipate, manage, control or mitigate risks.
For more information about our risk management policies and procedures, see Managing Risk in the MD&A on page 40.
We may not be successful in reorganizing the current business of Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated (MLPF&S) into two affiliated broker-dealers.
As a result of resolution planning, the current business of MLPF&S is expected to be reorganized, subject to regulatory approval, into two affiliated broker-dealers during 2019, MLPF&S and BofA Securities, Inc. In the event that the broker-dealer reorganization
is not fully realized or takes longer to realize than expected, we could experience unexpected expenses, reputational damage, compliance and regulatory issues, and lost revenue. For more information about the broker-dealer reorganization, see Capital Management – Broker-dealer Regulatory Capital and Securities Regulation in the MD&A on page 47.
Regulatory, Compliance and Legal
We are subject to comprehensive government legislation and regulations, both domestically and internationally, which impact our operating costs, and could require us to make changes to our operations and result in an adverse impact on our results of operations. Additionally, these regulations and uncertainty surrounding the scope and requirements of the final rules
implementing recently enacted and proposed legislation, as well as certain settlements and consent orders we have entered into, have increased and could continue to increase our compliance and operational risks and costs.
We are subject to comprehensive regulation under federal and state laws in the U.S. and the laws of the various jurisdictions in which we operate. These laws and regulations significantly affect and have the potential to restrict the scope of our existing businesses, limit our ability to pursue certain business opportunities, including the products and services we offer, reduce certain fees and rates or make our products and services more expensive for clients and customers.
In response to the financial crisis as well as other factors such as technological and market changes, the U.S. adopted the Financial Reform Act, which has resulted in significant rulemaking
and proposed rulemaking by the U.S. Department of the Treasury, Federal Reserve, OCC, CFPB, Financial Stability Oversight Council, FDIC, Department of Labor, SEC and CFTC. For example, under the provisions of the Financial Reform Act known as the “Volcker Rule,” we are prohibited from proprietary trading and limited in our sponsorship of, and investment in, hedge funds, private equity funds and certain other covered private funds. Non-U.S. regulators, such as the U.K. financial regulators and the European Parliament and Commission, have adopted or proposed laws and regulations regarding financial institutions located in their jurisdictions, which have required and could require us to make significant modifications to our non-U.S. businesses, operations and legal entity structure in order to comply with these requirements.
We continue to make adjustments to our business and operations, legal entity structure and capital
and liquidity management policies, procedures and controls to comply with these laws and regulations, as well as final rulemaking, guidance and interpretation by regulatory authorities. Further, we could become subject to future regulatory requirements beyond those currently proposed, adopted or contemplated. The cumulative effect of all of the legislation and regulations on our business, operations and profitability remains uncertain. This uncertainty necessitates that in our business planning we make certain assumptions with respect to the scope and requirements of the proposed rules. If these assumptions prove incorrect, we could be subject to increased regulatory and compliance risks and costs as well as potential reputational harm. In addition, U.S. and international regulatory initiatives may overlap, and non-U.S. regulations and initiatives may be inconsistent or may conflict with current or proposed U.S. regulations, which could lead to compliance risks and increased
costs.
Our regulators’ prudential and supervisory authority gives them broad power and discretion to direct our actions, and they have assumed an active oversight, inspection and investigatory role across the financial services industry. However, regulatory focus is not limited to laws and regulations applicable to the financial services industry specifically, but also extends to other significant laws and regulations that apply across industries and jurisdictions,
13Bank of America 2018
including
related to anti-money laundering, anti-corruption and economic sanctions. Additionally, we are subject to laws in the U.S. and abroad, including GDPR, regarding personal and confidential information of certain parties, such as our employees, customers, suppliers, counterparties and other third parties.
As part of their enforcement authority, our regulators have the authority to, among other things, assess significant civil or criminal monetary penalties, fines or restitution, issue cease and desist or removal orders and initiate injunctive actions. The amounts paid by us and other financial institutions to settle proceedings or investigations have been substantial and may increase. In some cases, governmental authorities have required criminal pleas or other extraordinary terms as part of such settlements, which could have significant consequences for a financial institution, including reputational harm, loss of customers,
restrictions on the ability to access capital markets, and the inability to operate certain businesses or offer certain products for a period of time.
The Corporation and its employees and representatives are subject to regulatory scrutiny across jurisdictions. Additionally, the complexity of the federal and state regulatory and enforcement regimes in the U.S., coupled with the global scope of our operations and the aggressiveness of the regulatory environment worldwide also means that a single event or practice or a series of related events or practices may give rise to a large number of overlapping investigations and regulatory proceedings, either by multiple federal and state agencies in the U.S. or by multiple regulators and other governmental entities in different jurisdictions. Responding to inquiries, investigations, lawsuits and proceedings, regardless of the ultimate outcome of the matter, is time-consuming and expensive
and can divert the attention of our senior management from our business. The outcome of such proceedings may be difficult to predict or estimate until late in the proceedings, which may last a number of years.
We are currently subject to the terms of settlements and consent orders that we have entered into with government agencies and regulatory authorities and may become subject to additional settlements or orders in the future. Such settlements and consent orders impose significant operational and compliance costs on us as they typically require us to enhance our procedures and controls, expand our risk and control functions within our lines of business, invest in technology and hire significant numbers of additional risk, control and compliance personnel. Moreover, if we fail to meet the requirements of the regulatory settlements and orders to which we are subject, or more generally, to maintain risk and control procedures
and processes that meet the heightened standards established by our regulators and other government agencies, we could be required to enter into further settlements and orders, pay additional fines, penalties or judgments, or accept material regulatory restrictions on our businesses.
While we believe that we have adopted appropriate risk management and compliance programs to identify, assess, monitor and report on applicable laws, policies and procedures, compliance risks will continue to exist, particularly as we adapt to new rules and regulations. Additionally, there is no guarantee that our risk management and compliance programs will be consistently executed to successfully manage compliance risk. We also rely upon third parties who may expose us to compliance and legal risk. Future legislative or regulatory actions, and any required changes to our business or operations, or those of third parties upon whom we rely, resulting
from such developments and actions, could result in a significant loss of revenue, impose additional compliance and other costs or otherwise reduce our profitability, limit the products and services that we offer or our ability to pursue certain business opportunities, require us to dispose of or curtail certain businesses, affect the value of assets
that we hold, require us to increase our prices and therefore reduce demand for our products, or otherwise adversely affect our businesses. In addition, legal and regulatory proceedings and other contingencies will arise from time to time that may result in fines, regulatory sanctions, penalties, equitable relief and changes to our business practices. As a result, we are and will continue to be subject to heightened compliance and operating costs that could adversely affect our results of operations.
We
are subject to significant financial and reputational risks from potential liability arising from lawsuits and regulatory and government action.
We face significant legal risks in our business, and the volume of claims and amount of damages, penalties and fines claimed in litigation and other disputes, and regulatory and government proceedings against us and other financial institutions continue to be high. Greater than expected litigation and investigation costs, substantial legal liability or significant regulatory or government action against us could have adverse effects on our financial condition, including liquidity, and results of operations or cause significant reputational harm to us. We continue to experience a significant volume of litigation and other disputes, including claims for contractual indemnification with counterparties regarding relative rights and responsibilities. Consumers, clients and other counterparties
continue to be litigious. Among other things, financial institutions, including us, continue to be the subject of claims alleging anti-competitive conduct with respect to various products and markets, including U.S. antitrust class actions claiming joint and several liability for treble damages. In addition, regulatory authorities have had a supervisory focus on enforcement, including in connection with alleged violations of law and customer harm. For example, U.S. regulators and government agencies have pursued claims against financial institutions under the Financial Institutions Reform, Recovery, and Enforcement Act, False Claims Act and antitrust laws. Such claims may carry significant and, in certain cases, treble damages. The ongoing environment of extensive regulation, regulatory compliance burdens, litigation and regulatory and government enforcement, combined with uncertainty related to the continually evolving
regulatory environment, may affect operational and compliance costs and risks, which may limit our ability to continue providing certain products and services.
Additionally, misconduct by employees, including improper or illegal conduct, can cause significant reputational harm as well as litigation and regulatory action.
For more information on litigation risks, see Note 12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
U.S. federal banking agencies may require us to increase our regulatory capital, TLAC, long-term debt or liquidity requirements, which could result in the need to issue additional qualifying securities or to take other actions, such as to sell company assets.
We
are subject to U.S. regulatory capital and liquidity rules. These rules, among other things, establish minimum requirements to qualify as a “well-capitalized” institution. If any of our subsidiary insured depository institutions fails to maintain its status as “well capitalized” under the applicable regulatory capital rules, the Federal Reserve will require us to agree to bring the insured depository institution back to “well-capitalized” status. For the duration of such an agreement, the Federal Reserve may impose restrictions on our activities. If we were to fail to enter into or comply with such an agreement, or fail to comply with the terms of such agreement, the Federal Reserve may impose more severe restrictions on our activities, including requiring us to cease and desist activities permitted under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956.
Bank
of America 2018 14
In the current regulatory environment, capital and liquidity requirements are frequently introduced and amended. It is possible that regulators may increase regulatory capital requirements including TLAC and long-term debt requirements, change how regulatory capital is calculated or increase liquidity requirements. Our risk-based capital surcharge (G-SIB surcharge) may increase from current estimates, and we are also subject to a countercyclical capital buffer which, while currently set at zero, may be increased by regulators. In 2018, the Federal Reserve issued a proposal to implement a stress capital buffer into its capital requirements, which may increase our regulatory capital requirements, if adopted. A significant component of regulatory capital
ratios is calculating our risk-weighted assets and our leverage exposure which may increase. The Basel Committee on Banking Supervision has also revised several key methodologies for measuring risk-weighted assets, including a standardized approach for credit risk, standardized approach for operational risk and constraints on the use of internal models, as well as a capital floor based on the revised standardized approaches. U.S. banking regulators may update the U.S. Basel 3 rules to incorporate the Basel Committee revisions. In 2018, U.S. banking regulators published a proposal outlining a standardized approach for counterparty credit risk, which updates the calculation of the exposure amount for derivative contracts under the regulatory capital rule. Additionally, Net Stable Funding Ratio requirements have been proposed, which would apply to us and our subsidiary depository institutions,
and target longer term liquidity risk. While the impact of these proposals remains uncertain, they could have a negative impact on our capital and liquidity positions.
As part of its annual CCAR review, the Federal Reserve conducts stress testing on parts of our business using hypothetical economic scenarios prepared by the Federal Reserve. Those scenarios may affect our CCAR stress test results, which may have an effect on our projected regulatory capital amounts in the annual CCAR submission, including the CCAR capital plan affecting our dividends and stock repurchases.
Changes to and compliance with the regulatory capital and liquidity requirements may impact our operations by requiring us to liquidate assets, increase borrowings, issue additional equity or other securities, cease or alter certain operations, sell company assets, or hold highly liquid assets, which may adversely
affect our results of operations. We may be prohibited from taking capital actions such as paying or increasing dividends, or repurchasing securities if the Federal Reserve objects to our CCAR capital plan.
For more information, see Capital Management – Regulatory Capital in the MD&A on page 44 and Note 16 – Regulatory Requirements and Restrictionsto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Changes in accounting standards or assumptions in applying accounting policies could adversely affect us.
Our accounting policies and methods are fundamental to how we record and report our financial condition and results of operations. Some of these policies
require use of estimates and assumptions that may affect the reported value of our assets or liabilities and results of operations and are critical because they require management to make difficult, subjective and complex judgments about matters that are inherently uncertain. If those assumptions, estimates or judgments were incorrectly made, we could be required to correct and restate prior-period financial statements. Accounting standard-setters and those who interpret the accounting standards, the SEC, banking regulators and our independent registered public accounting firm may also amend or even reverse their previous interpretations or positions on how various standards should be applied. These changes may be difficult to predict and could impact how we prepare and report
our financial statements. In some cases, we could be required to apply a new or revised standard retrospectively,
resulting in us revising prior-period financial statements.
In June 2016, the Financial Accounting Standards Board issued a new accounting standard with respect to accounting for credit losses that will become effective for the Corporation on January 1, 2020. The standard replaces the existing measurement of the allowance for credit losses, which is based on management’s best estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the Corporation’s lending activities, with management’s best estimate of lifetime expected credit losses inherent in the Corporation’s financial assets that are recognized at amortized cost. The standard will also expand credit quality disclosures. The impact of this new accounting standard may be an increase in the Corporation’s allowance for credit losses at the date of adoption which would result in a negative adjustment to retained earnings. The ultimate
impact will depend on the characteristics of the Corporation’s portfolio at adoption date as well as the macroeconomic conditions and forecasts as of that date. For more information on some of our critical accounting policies and recent accounting changes, see Complex Accounting Estimates in the MD&A on page 77 and Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principlesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
We may be adversely affected by changes in U.S. and non-U.S. tax laws and regulations.
On December 22, 2017, the President signed into law the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (the Tax Act) which made significant changes to federal income tax
law including, among other things, reducing the statutory corporate income tax rate to 21 percent from 35 percent and changing the taxation of our non-U.S. business activities.
In addition, we have U.K. net deferred tax assets which consist primarily of net operating losses that are expected to be realized by certain subsidiaries over an extended number of years. Adverse developments with respect to tax laws or to other material factors, such as prolonged worsening of Europe’s capital markets or changes in the ability of our U.K. subsidiaries to conduct business in the EU, could lead our management to reassess and/or change its current conclusion that no valuation allowance is necessary with respect to our U.K. net deferred tax assets.
It
is possible that governmental authorities in the U.S. and/or other countries could further amend tax laws that would adversely affect us, including the possibility that certain favorable aspects of the Tax Act could be amended in the future.
Reputation
Damage to our reputation could harm our businesses, including our competitive position and business prospects.
Our ability to attract and retain customers, clients, investors and employees is impacted by our reputation. Harm to our reputation can arise from various sources, including officer, director or employee misconduct, security breaches, unethical behavior, litigation or regulatory outcomes, compensation practices, the suitability or reasonableness of recommending particular trading or investment strategies, including the reliability of our research and models, prohibiting clients
from engaging in certain transactions and sales practices. Additionally, our reputation may be harmed by failing to deliver products, subpar standards of service and quality expected by our customers, clients and the community, compliance failures, inadequacy of responsiveness to internal controls, unintended disclosure of personal, proprietary or confidential information, perception of our environmental, social and governance practices and disclosures, and the activities of our clients, customers and counterparties, including vendors. Actions by the financial services industry
15Bank of America 2018
generally
or by certain members or individuals in the industry also can adversely affect our reputation. In addition, adverse publicity or negative information posted on social media, whether or not factually correct, may adversely impact our business prospects or financial results.
We are subject to complex and evolving laws and regulations regarding privacy, know-your-customer requirements, data protection, including the GDPR, cross-border data movement and other matters. Principles concerning the appropriate scope of consumer and commercial privacy vary considerably in different jurisdictions, and regulatory and public expectations regarding the definition and scope of consumer and commercial privacy may remain fluid. It is possible that these laws may be interpreted and applied by various jurisdictions in a manner inconsistent with our current or future practices, or that is inconsistent with one another. If personal, confidential
or proprietary information of customers or clients in our possession is mishandled or misused, or if we do not timely or adequately address mishandled or misused information, we may face regulatory, reputational and operational risks which could have an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
We could suffer reputational harm if we fail to properly identify and manage potential conflicts of interest. Management of potential conflicts of interests has become increasingly complex as we expand our business activities through more numerous transactions, obligations and interests with and among our clients.
The failure to adequately address, or the perceived failure to adequately address, conflicts of interest could affect the willingness of clients to use our products and services, or give rise to litigation or enforcement actions, which could adversely
affect our businesses.
Our actual or perceived failure to address these and other issues, such as operational risks, gives rise to reputational risk that could harm us and our business prospects. Failure to appropriately address any of these issues could also give rise to additional regulatory restrictions, legal risks and reputational harm, which could, among other consequences, increase the size and number of litigation claims and damages asserted or subject us to enforcement actions, fines and penalties and cause us to incur related costs and expenses. For more information on reputational risk, see Reputational Risk Management in the MD&A on page 77.
Other
We face significant and increasing competition in the financial services industry.
We
operate in a highly competitive environment and will continue to experience intense competition from local and global financial institutions as well as new entrants, in both domestic and foreign markets, in which we compete on the basis of a number of factors, including customer service, quality and range of products and services offered, technology, price, reputation, interest rates on loans and deposits, lending limits and customer convenience. Additionally, the changing regulatory environment may create competitive disadvantages for us given geography-driven capital and liquidity requirements. For example, U.S. regulators have in certain instances adopted stricter capital and liquidity requirements than those applicable to non-U.S. institutions. To the extent we expand into new business areas and new geographic regions, we may face competitors with more experience and more established relationships with clients, regulators and industry participants in the relevant
market, which could adversely affect our ability to compete. In addition, technological advances and the growth of e-commerce have lowered geographic barriers of other financial institutions, made
it easier for non-depository institutions to offer products and services that traditionally were banking products and allowed non-traditional financial service providers to compete with traditional financial service companies in providing electronic and internet-based financial solutions including electronic securities trading, marketplace lending and payment processing. Further, clients may choose to conduct business with other market participants who engage in business or offer products in areas we deem speculative or risky, such as cryptocurrencies. Increased competition may negatively affect our earnings by creating pressure to lower prices or credit standards on our products and
services requiring additional investment to improve the quality and delivery of our technology and/or reducing our market share, or affecting the willingness of our clients to do business with us.
Our inability to adapt our products and services to evolving industry standards and consumer preferences could harm our business.
Our business model is based on a diversified mix of businesses that provide a broad range of financial products and services, delivered through multiple distribution channels. Our success depends on our ability to adapt and develop our products, services and technology to evolving industry standards and consumer preferences. There is increasing pressure by competitors to provide products and services on more attractive terms, including higher interest rates on deposits, which may impact our ability to grow revenue and/or effectively compete. Additionally legislative
and regulatory developments may affect the competitive landscape. Further, the competitive landscape may be impacted by the growth of non-depository institutions that offer traditional banking products at higher rates or with no fees, or otherwise offer alternative products. This can reduce our net interest margin and revenues from our fee-based products and services. In addition, the widespread adoption of new technologies, including internet services, cryptocurrencies and payment systems, could require substantial expenditures to modify or adapt our existing products and services as we grow and develop our online and mobile banking channel strategies in addition to remote connectivity solutions. We may not be as timely or successful in developing or introducing new products and services, integrating new products or services into our existing offerings, responding or adapting to changes in consumer behavior, preferences, spending, investing and/or saving habits, achieving
market acceptance of our products and services, reducing costs in response to pressures to deliver products and services at lower prices or sufficiently developing and maintaining loyal customers. The inability to adapt our products and services to evolving industry standards and consumer preferences could harm our business and adversely affect our results of operations and reputation.
Our ability to attract and retain qualified employees is critical to the success of our business and failure to do so could hurt our business prospects and competitive position.
Our performance is heavily dependent on the talents and efforts of highly skilled individuals. Competition for qualified personnel within the financial services industry and from businesses outside the financial services industry is intense. Our competitors include non-U.S. based institutions and institutions subject to different
compensation and hiring regulations than those imposed on U.S. institutions and financial institutions.
In order to attract and retain qualified personnel, we must provide market-level compensation. As a large financial and banking institution, we may be subject to limitations on compensation practices (which may or may not affect our competitors) by the Federal Reserve, the OCC, the FDIC and other regulators around the world. EU and U.K. rules limit and subject to clawback certain forms of variable compensation for senior
Bank of
America 2018 16
employees. Current and potential future limitations on executive compensation imposed by legislation or regulation could adversely affect our ability to attract and maintain qualified employees. Furthermore, a substantial portion of our annual incentive compensation paid to our senior employees has in recent years taken the form of long-term equity-based awards. Therefore, the ultimate value of this compensation depends on the price of our common stock when the awards vest. If we are unable to continue to attract and retain qualified individuals, our business prospects and competitive position could be adversely affected.
We could suffer losses if our models and strategies fail to properly anticipate and manage
risk.
We use proprietary models and strategies extensively to measure and assess capital requirements for credit, country, market, operational and strategic risks and to assess and control our operations and financial condition. These models require oversight and periodic re-validation and are subject to inherent limitations due to the use of historical trends and simplifying assumptions, and uncertainty regarding economic and financial outcomes. Our models may not be sufficiently predictive of future results due to limited historical patterns, extreme or unanticipated market movements or customer behavior and illiquidity, especially during severe market downturns or stress events, and may not be effective if we fail to detect flaws in our models during our review process, our models contain erroneous data, valuations, formulas or algorithms or our applications running the models do not perform as expected. The models that
we use to assess and control our market risk exposures also reflect assumptions about the degree of correlation among prices of various asset classes or other market indicators. Market conditions in recent years have involved unprecedented dislocations and highlight the limitations inherent in using historical data to manage risk. We could suffer losses if models and strategies fail to properly anticipate and manage risks.
Failure to properly manage and aggregate data may result in our inability to manage risk and business needs and inaccurate financial, regulatory and operational reporting.
We rely on our ability to manage, aggregate, interpret and use data in an accurate, timely and complete manner for effective risk reporting and management. Our policies, programs, processes and practices govern how data is managed, aggregated, interpreted and used. While we continuously update
our policies, programs, processes and practices, and implement emerging technologies, such as artificial intelligence, our data management and aggregation processes are subject to failure, including human error or system failure. Failure to manage data effectively and to aggregate data in an accurate, timely and complete manner may limit our ability to manage current and emerging risk, to produce
accurate financial, regulatory and operational reporting as well as to manage changing business needs.
Reforms to and uncertainty regarding the London InterBank Offered Rate (LIBOR) and certain other indices may adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.
The U.K. FCA announced in July 2017, that it will no longer persuade or require banks to submit rates for LIBOR
after 2021. This announcement, in conjunction with financial benchmark reforms more generally and changes in the interbank lending markets, have resulted in uncertainty about the future of LIBOR and certain other rates or indices which are used as interest rate “benchmarks” in many of our products and contracts, including floating-rate notes and other adjustable-rate products. These actions and uncertainties may have the effect of triggering future changes in the rules or methodologies used to calculate benchmarks or lead to the discontinuation or unavailability of benchmarks. ICE Benchmark Administration is the administrator of LIBOR and maintains a reference panel of contributor banks, which includes BANA London branch for certain LIBOR rates. Uncertainty as to the nature and effect of such reforms and actions, and the potential or actual discontinuation of benchmark quotes,
may adversely affect the value of, return on and trading market for our financial assets and liabilities that are based on or are linked to benchmarks, including any LIBOR-based securities, loans and derivatives, or our financial condition or results of operations. Additionally, there can be no assurance that we and other market participants will be adequately prepared for an actual discontinuation of benchmarks, including LIBOR, that existing assets and liabilities based on or linked to benchmarks will transition successfully to alternative reference rates or benchmarks or of the timing of adoption and degree of integration of such alternative reference rates or benchmarks in the markets. The discontinuation of benchmarks, including LIBOR, may have an unpredictable impact on the contractual mechanics of outstanding securities, loans, derivatives or other products (including, but not limited to, interest rates to be paid to or by us), require renegotiation of outstanding
financial assets and liabilities, adversely affect the return on such outstanding products, cause significant disruption to financial markets that are relevant to our business segments, particularly Global Banking and Global Markets, increase the risk of litigation and/or increase expenses related to the transition to alternative reference rates or benchmarks, among other adverse consequences. Additionally, any transition from current benchmarks may alter the Corporation’s risk profiles and models, valuation tools, product design and effectiveness of hedging strategies, as well as increase the costs and risks related to potential regulatory requirements. Reforms to and uncertainty regarding transitions from current benchmarks may adversely affect our business, financial condition or results of operations.
Item
1B. Unresolved Staff Comments
None
Item 2. Properties
As of December 31, 2018, our principal offices and other materially important properties consisted of the following:
Facility
Name
Location
General Character of the Physical Property
Primary Business Segment
Property Status
Property Square Feet (1)
Bank of America Corporate Center
Charlotte,
NC
60 Story Building
Principal Executive Offices
Owned
1,212,177
Bank of America Tower at One Bryant Park
New York, NY
55 Story
Building
GWIM, Global Banking and
Global Markets
Leased (2)
1,836,575
Bank of America Merrill Lynch Financial Centre
London, UK
4 Building Campus
Global
Banking and Global Markets
Leased
562,595
Cheung Kong Center
Hong Kong
62 Story Building
Global Banking and Global Markets
Leased
149,790
(1)
For
leased properties, property square feet represents the square footage occupied by the Corporation.
(2)
The Corporation has a 49.9 percent joint venture interest in this property.
17Bank of America 2018
We
own or lease approximately 77.3 million square feet in over 20,000 facility and ATM locations globally, including approximately 72.2 million square feet in the U.S. (all 50 states and the District of Columbia, the U.S. Virgin Islands, Puerto Rico and Guam) and approximately 5.1 million square feet in more than 35 countries.
We believe our owned and leased properties are adequate for our business needs and are well maintained. We continue to evaluate our owned and leased real estate and may determine from time to time that certain of our premises and facilities, or ownership structures, are no longer necessary for our operations. In connection therewith, we are evaluating the sale or sale/
leaseback of certain properties and we may incur costs in connection with any such transactions.
Item
3. Legal Proceedings
See Litigation and Regulatory Matters in Note 12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements, which is incorporated herein by reference.
Item 5. Market
for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
The principal market on which our common stock is traded is the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “BAC.” As of February 25, 2019, there were 170,394 registered shareholders of common stock.
The table below presents share repurchase activity for the three months ended December 31, 2018. The primary source of funds for cash distributions by the Corporation to its shareholders is
dividends received from its
bank subsidiaries. Each of the bank subsidiaries is subject to various regulatory policies and requirements relating to the payment of dividends, including requirements to maintain capital above regulatory minimums. All of the Corporation’s preferred stock outstanding has preference over the Corporation’s common stock with respect to payment of dividends.
(Dollars
in millions, except per share information; shares in thousands)
Includes
shares of the Corporation’s common stock acquired by the Corporation in connection with satisfaction of tax withholding obligations on vested restricted stock or restricted stock units and certain forfeitures and terminations of employment-related awards and for potential re-issuance to certain employees under equity incentive plans.
(2)
On June 28, 2018, following the Federal Reserve’s non-objection to our 2018 CCAR capital plan, the Board authorized the repurchase of approximately $20.6 billion in common stock from July 1, 2018 through June 30, 2019, including approximately
$600 million to offset the effect of equity-based compensation issuances during the same period. During the three months ended December 31, 2018, pursuant to the Board’s authorizations, the Corporation repurchased $5.2 billion of common stock, which included common stock repurchases to offset equity-based compensation awards. On February 7, 2019, the Corporation announced that the Board authorized the repurchase of an additional $2.5 billion of common stock during the first and second quarters of 2019. Amounts shown do not include this additional repurchase authority. For more information, see Capital Management -- CCAR and Capital Planning on page 43 and Note 13 – Shareholders’ Equity
to the Consolidated Financial Statements.
The Corporation did not have any unregistered sales of equity securities during the three months ended December 31, 2018.
Management’s
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
Bank of America Corporation (the “Corporation”) and its management may make certain statements that constitute “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. These statements can be identified by the fact that they do not relate strictly to historical or current facts. Forward-looking statements often use words such as “anticipates,”“targets,”“expects,”“hopes,”“estimates,”“intends,”“plans,”“goals,”“believes,”“continue” and other similar expressions or future or conditional verbs such as “will,”“may,”“might,”“should,”“would” and “could.” Forward-looking statements represent the Corporation’s current expectations, plans or forecasts
of its future results, revenues, expenses, efficiency ratio, capital measures, strategy and future business and economic conditions more generally, and other future matters. These statements are not guarantees of future results or performance and involve certain known and unknown risks, uncertainties and assumptions that are difficult to predict and are often beyond the Corporation’s control. Actual outcomes and results may differ materially from those expressed in, or implied by, any of these forward-looking statements.
You should not place undue reliance on any forward-looking statement and should consider the following uncertainties and risks, as well as the risks and uncertainties more fully discussed under Item 1A. Risk Factors of this Annual Report on Form 10-K: the Corporation’s potential claims, damages, penalties, fines and reputational damage resulting from pending or future litigation, regulatory proceedings and
enforcement actions and the possibility that amounts may be in excess of the Corporation’s recorded liability and estimated range of possible loss for litigation and regulatory exposures; the possibility that the Corporation could face increased servicing, securities, fraud, indemnity, contribution or other claims from one or more counterparties, including trustees, purchasers of loans, underwriters, issuers, other parties involved in securitizations, monolines or private-label and other investors; the possibility that future representations and warranties losses may occur in excess of the Corporation’s recorded liability and estimated range of possible loss for its representations and warranties exposures; the Corporation’s ability to resolve representations and warranties repurchase and related claims, including claims brought by investors or trustees seeking to avoid the statute of limitations for repurchase claims; the risks related to the discontinuation of the
London InterBank Offered Rate and other reference rates, including increased expenses and litigation and the effectiveness of hedging strategies; uncertainties about the financial stability and growth rates of non-U.S. jurisdictions, the risk that those jurisdictions may face difficulties servicing their sovereign debt, and related stresses on financial markets, currencies and trade, and the Corporation’s exposures to such risks, including direct, indirect and operational; the impact of U.S. and global interest rates, inflation, currency exchange rates, economic conditions, trade policies, including tariffs, and potential geopolitical instability; the impact on the Corporation’s business, financial condition and results of operations of a potential higher interest rate environment; the possibility that future credit losses may be higher than currently expected due to changes in economic assumptions, customer behavior, adverse developments with respect to U.S. or global
economic conditions and other uncertainties; the Corporation’s ability to achieve its expense targets and expectations regarding net interest income, net charge-offs, loan growth or other projections; adverse changes to the Corporation’s credit ratings from the major credit rating agencies; an inability to access capital markets or maintain deposits; estimates of the fair value and other accounting values, subject to
impairment assessments, of certain of the Corporation’s assets and liabilities; uncertainty regarding the content, timing and impact of regulatory capital and liquidity requirements; the impact of adverse changes to total loss-absorbing capacity requirements and/or global systemically important bank surcharges; the success of our reorganization of Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated; the potential impact
of actions of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System on the Corporation’s capital plans; the effect of regulations, other guidance or additional information on the impact from the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act; the impact of implementation and compliance with U.S. and international laws, regulations and regulatory interpretations, including, but not limited to, recovery and resolution planning requirements, Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation assessments, the Volcker Rule, fiduciary standards and derivatives regulations; a failure in or breach of the Corporation’s operational or security systems or infrastructure, or those of third parties, including as a result of cyber-attacks; the impact on the Corporation’s business, financial condition and results of operations from the planned exit of the United Kingdom from the European Union; the impact of a prolonged federal government shutdown and uncertainty regarding
the federal government’s debt limit; and other similar matters.
Forward-looking statements speak only as of the date they are made, and the Corporation undertakes no obligation to update any forward-looking statement to reflect the impact of circumstances or events that arise after the date the forward-looking statement was made.
Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements referred to in the Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (MD&A) are incorporated by reference into the MD&A. Certain prior-year amounts have been reclassified to conform to current-year presentation. Throughout the MD&A, the Corporation uses certain acronyms and abbreviations which are defined in the Glossary.
Executive
Summary
Business Overview
The Corporation is a Delaware corporation, a bank holding company (BHC) and a financial holding company. When used in this report, “the Corporation” may refer to Bank of America Corporation individually, Bank of America Corporation and its subsidiaries, or certain of Bank of America Corporation’s subsidiaries or affiliates. Our principal executive offices are located in Charlotte, North Carolina. Through our banking and various nonbank subsidiaries throughout the U.S. and in international markets, we provide a diversified range of banking and nonbank financial services and products
through four business segments: Consumer Banking, Global Wealth & Investment Management (GWIM), Global Banking and Global Markets, with the remaining operations recorded in All Other. We operate our banking activities primarily under the Bank of America, National Association (Bank of America, N.A. or BANA) charter. At December 31, 2018, the Corporation had approximately $2.4 trillion in assets and a headcount of approximately 204,000 employees.
As of December
31, 2018, we served clients through operations across the U.S., its territories and more than 35 countries. Our retail banking footprint covers approximately 85 percent of the U.S. population, and we serve approximately 66 million consumer and small business clients with approximately 4,300 retail financial centers, approximately 16,300ATMs, and
Bank
of America 2018 20
leading digital banking platforms (www.bankofamerica.com) with more than 36 million active users, including over 26 million active mobile users. We offer industry-leading support to approximately three million small business owners. Our wealth management businesses, with client balances of approximately $2.6 trillion, provide tailored solutions to meet client needs through a full set of investment management, brokerage, banking, trust and retirement
products. We are a global leader in corporate and investment banking and trading across a broad range of asset classes serving corporations, governments, institutions and individuals around the world.
Recent Developments
Capital Management
During 2018, we repurchased $20.1 billion of common stock pursuant to the Board of Directors’ (the Board) repurchase authorizations under our 2018 and 2017 Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (CCAR) plans, including repurchases to offset equity-based compensation awards. Also, in addition to the previously announced repurchases associated with the 2018 CCAR capital plan, on February
7, 2019, we announced a plan to repurchase an additional $2.5 billion of common stock through June 30, 2019, which was approved by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve). For additional information, see Capital Management on page 43.
U.K. Exit from the EU
We conduct business in Europe, the Middle East and Africa primarily through our subsidiaries in the U.K. and Ireland. A referendum held in the U.K. in 2016 resulted in a majority vote in favor of exiting the European Union (EU). In March 2017, the U.K. notified the EU of its intent to withdraw from the EU, which is scheduled to occur on March
29, 2019. Negotiations between the U.K. and the EU regarding the terms, conditions and timing of the withdrawal are ongoing and the outcome remains uncertain. In preparation for the withdrawal, we have implemented changes to our operating model in the region, including establishing our principal EU banking and broker-dealer operations outside the U.K. The changes are expected to enable us to continue to service our clients with minimal disruption, retain operational flexibility, minimize transition risks and maximize legal entity efficiencies, independent of the outcome and timing of the withdrawal.
LIBOR and Other Benchmark Rates
The U.K. Financial Conduct Authority (FCA), which regulates the London InterBank Offered Rate (LIBOR), announced in July 2017 that it will no longer persuade or require banks to submit rates for LIBOR
after 2021. This announcement along with financial benchmark reforms more generally and changes in the interbank lending markets have resulted in uncertainty about the future of LIBOR and certain other rates or indices used as interest rate “benchmarks.” These actions and uncertainties may trigger future changes in the rules or methodologies used to calculate benchmarks or lead to the discontinuation or unavailability of benchmarks.
The Corporation has established an enterprise-wide initiative to identify, assess and monitor risks associated with the potential discontinuation or unavailability of benchmarks, including LIBOR, and the transition to alternative reference rates. As part of this initiative, the Corporation is actively engaged with global regulators, industry working groups and trade associations to develop strategies for transitions from current benchmarks to alternative reference rates. We are updating
our operational processes and models to support new alternative reference rate
activity. In addition, we continue to analyze and evaluate legacy contracts across all productstodetermine the impact of adiscontinuation of LIBOR or other benchmarks and to address consequential changes to those legacy contracts. Certain actions required to mitigate risks associated with the unavailability of benchmarks and implementation of new methodologies and contractual mechanics are dependent on a consensus being reached by the industry or the markets in various jurisdictions
around the world. As a result, there is uncertainty as to the solutions that will be developed to address the unavailability of LIBOR or other benchmarks, as well as the overall impact to our businesses, operations and results. Additionally, any transition from current benchmarks may alter the Corporation’s risk profiles and models, valuation tools, product design and effectiveness of hedging strategies, as well as increase the costs and risks related to potential regulatory requirements.
Financial Highlights
Table
1
Summary Income Statement and Selected Financial Data
(Dollars in millions, except per share information)
2018
2017
Income statement
Net
interest income
$
47,432
$
44,667
Noninterest income
43,815
42,685
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
91,247
87,352
Provision for credit losses
3,282
3,396
Noninterest expense
53,381
54,743
Income before
income taxes
34,584
29,213
Income tax expense
6,437
10,981
Net income
28,147
18,232
Preferred
stock dividends
1,451
1,614
Net income applicable to common shareholders
$
26,696
$
16,618
Per
common share information
Earnings
$
2.64
$
1.63
Diluted earnings
2.61
1.56
Dividends
paid
0.54
0.39
Performance ratios
Return on average assets
1.21
%
0.80
%
Return
on average common shareholders’ equity
11.04
6.72
Return on average tangible common shareholders’ equity (1)
15.55
9.41
Efficiency
ratio
58.50
62.67
Balance sheet at year end
Total loans and leases
$
946,895
$
936,749
Total
assets
2,354,507
2,281,234
Total deposits
1,381,476
1,309,545
Total common shareholders’ equity
242,999
244,823
Total
shareholders’ equity
265,325
267,146
(1)
Return on average tangible common shareholders’ equity is a non-GAAP financial measure. For more information and a corresponding reconciliation to accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (GAAP) financial measures, see on page 25.
Net income was $28.1 billion, or $2.61 per diluted share in 2018 compared to $18.2 billion, or $1.56 per diluted share in 2017. The improvement in net income was driven by a decrease in income tax expense due to the impacts of the Tax Cuts and Jobs Act (the Tax Act), an increase in net interest income, higher noninterest income, lower provision for credit losses and a decline in noninterest expense. Impacts from the Tax Act include a reduction in the federal corporate income tax rate to 21 percent from 35 percent. In addition, results for 2017 included a reduction in net income of $2.9 billion due to the Tax Act, driven largely
by a lower valuation of certain U.S. deferred tax assets and liabilities.
21Bank of America 2018
Net Interest Income
Net interest income
increased$2.8 billion to $47.4 billion in 2018 compared to 2017. Net interest yield on a fully taxable-equivalent (FTE) basis increased five basis points (bps) to 2.42 percent for 2018. These increases were primarily driven by higher interest rates as well as loan and deposit growth, partially offset by tightening spreads, higher Global Markets funding costs and the impact of the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business in 2017. For more information on net interest yield and the FTE basis, see Supplemental Financial Data on page 24,
and for more information on interest rate risk management, see Interest Rate Risk Management for the Banking Book on page 74.
Noninterest Income
Table
2
Noninterest Income
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
Card income
$
6,051
$
5,902
Service charges
7,767
7,818
Investment
and brokerage services
14,160
13,836
Investment banking income
5,327
6,011
Trading account profits
8,540
7,277
Other
income
1,970
1,841
Total noninterest income
$
43,815
$
42,685
Noninterest
income increased$1.1 billion to $43.8 billion in 2018 compared to 2017. The following highlights the significant changes.
●
Card income increased$149 million primarily driven by an increase in credit and debit card spending, as well as increased late fees and annual fees, partially offset by higher rewards costs, lower cash advance fees, and the impact of the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business in 2017.
•
Investment
and brokerage services income increased$324 million primarily due to assets under management (AUM) flows and higher market valuations, partially offset by the impact of changing market dynamics on transactional revenue and AUM pricing.
●
Investment banking income decreased$684 million.
●
Trading
account profits increased$1.3 billion primarily due to increased client activity in equity financing and derivatives, higher market interest rates and strong trading performance in equity derivatives, partially offset by weakness in credit products.
●
Other income increased$129 million primarily due to gains on sales of consumer real estate loans, primarily non-core, of $731 million, offset by a $729 million charge related to the redemption of certain
trust preferred securities in 2018. Other income for 2017 included a downward valuation adjustment of $946 million on tax-advantaged energy investments in connection with the Tax Act and a $793 million pretax gain recognized in connection with the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business.
Provision for Credit Losses
The provision for credit losses decreased$114 million to $3.3 billion in 2018 compared to 2017, primarily reflecting a 2017 single-name non-U.S. commercial charge-off and improvement in the commercial portfolio. In the consumer portfolio, the impact of the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business
in 2017 was more than offset by a slower pace of improvement in the consumer real estate portfolio, and portfolio seasoning and loan growth in the U.S. credit card portfolio. For more information on the provision for credit losses, see Provision for Credit Losses on page 67.
Noninterest Expense
Table
3
Noninterest Expense
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Personnel
$
31,880
$
31,931
Occupancy
4,066
4,009
Equipment
1,705
1,692
Marketing
1,674
1,746
Professional
fees
1,699
1,888
Data processing
3,222
3,139
Telecommunications
699
699
Other
general operating
8,436
9,639
Total noninterest expense
$
53,381
$
54,743
Noninterest
expense decreased$1.4 billion to $53.4 billion in 2018 compared to 2017. The decrease was primarily due to lower other general operating expense, primarily driven by a decline in litigation and Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) expense as well as a $316 million impairment charge in 2017 related to certain data centers.
Income Tax Expense
Table
4
Income Tax Expense
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Income
before income taxes
$
34,584
$
29,213
Income tax expense
6,437
10,981
Effective
tax rate
18.6
%
37.6
%
Tax expense for 2018 reflected the new 21 percent federal income tax rate and the other provisions of the Tax Act, as well as our recurring tax preference benefits.
Tax expense for 2017 included a charge of $1.9 billion reflecting the initial impact of the Tax Act, including a tax charge of $2.3 billion related primarily to a lower valuation of certain deferred tax assets and liabilities and a $347 million tax benefit on the pretax loss from the lower valuation of our tax-advantaged energy
investments. Other than the impact of the Tax Act, the effective tax rate for 2017 was driven by our recurring tax preference benefits as well as an expense from the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business, largely offset by benefits related to stock-based compensation and the restructuring of certain subsidiaries.
We expect the effective tax rate for 2019 to be approximately 19 percent, absent unusual items.
Bank
of America 2018 22
Balance Sheet Overview
Table
5
Selected Balance Sheet Data
December 31
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
% Change
Assets
Cash
and cash equivalents
$
177,404
$
157,434
13
%
Federal funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell
261,131
212,747
23
Trading
account assets
214,348
209,358
2
Debt securities
441,753
440,130
—
Loans
and leases
946,895
936,749
1
Allowance for loan and lease losses
(9,601
)
(10,393
)
(8
)
All
other assets
322,577
335,209
(4
)
Total assets
$
2,354,507
$
2,281,234
3
Liabilities
Deposits
$
1,381,476
$
1,309,545
5
Federal
funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase
186,988
176,865
6
Trading account liabilities
68,220
81,187
(16
)
Short-term
borrowings
20,189
32,666
(38
)
Long-term debt
229,340
227,402
1
All
other liabilities
202,969
186,423
9
Total liabilities
2,089,182
2,014,088
4
Shareholders’
equity
265,325
267,146
(1
)
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
$
2,354,507
$
2,281,234
3
Assets
At
December 31, 2018, total assets were approximately $2.4 trillion, up$73.3 billion from December 31, 2017. The increase in assets was primarily due to higher securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell due to investment of excess cash levels in higher yielding assets and increased client activity, and higher cash and cash equivalents driven by deposit growth.
Cash and Cash Equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents increased$20.0 billion primarily
driven by deposit growth, partially offset by investment of short-term excess cash into securities purchased under agreements to resell, and loan growth.
Federal Funds Sold and Securities Borrowed or Purchased Under Agreements to Resell
Federal funds transactions involve lending reserve balances on a short-term basis. Securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell are collateralized lending transactions utilized to accommodate customer transactions, earn interest rate spreads, and obtain securities for settlement and for collateral. Federal funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell increased$48.4 billion due to investment of excess cash levels in higher yielding assets and a higher level of customer financing activity.
Trading
Account Assets
Trading account assets consist primarily of long positions in equity and fixed-income securities including U.S. government and agency securities, corporate securities and non-U.S. sovereign debt. Trading account assets increased$5.0 billion primarily driven by additional inventory in fixed-income, currencies and commodities (FICC) to meet expected client demand.
Debt Securities
Debt securities primarily include U.S. Treasury and agency securities, mortgage-backed securities (MBS), principally agency MBS, non-U.S. bonds, corporate bonds and municipal debt. We use the debt securities portfolio primarily to manage interest rate
and liquidity
risk and to take advantage of market conditions that create economically attractive returns on these investments. Debt securities increased$1.6 billion primarily driven by the deployment of deposit inflows. In 2018, the Corporation transferred available-for-sale (AFS) debt securities with an amortized cost of $64.5 billion to held to maturity. For more information on debt securities, see Note 4 – Securitiesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Loans and Leases
Loans and leases increased$10.1 billion
primarily due to net loan growth driven by client demand for commercial loans and increases in residential mortgage. For more information on the loan portfolio, see Credit Risk Management on page 51.
Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses
The allowance for loan and lease losses decreased $792 million primarily due to the impact of improvements in credit quality from a stronger economy and continued runoff and sales in the non-core consumer real estate portfolio. For additional information, see Allowance for Credit Losses on page 67.
Liabilities
At December
31, 2018, total liabilities were approximately $2.1 trillion, up$75.1 billion from December 31, 2017, primarily due to deposit growth.
Deposits
Deposits increased$71.9 billion primarily due to an increase in retail deposits.
Federal Funds Purchased and Securities Loaned or Sold Under Agreements to Repurchase
Federal funds transactions involve borrowing reserve balances on a short-term basis. Securities loaned or sold under agreements
to repurchase are collateralized borrowing transactions utilized to accommodate customer transactions, earn interest rate spreads and finance assets on the balance sheet. Federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase increased$10.1 billion primarily due to an increase in matched book funding within Global Markets.
23Bank of America 2018
Trading
Account Liabilities
Trading account liabilities consist primarily of short positions in equity and fixed-income securities including U.S. Treasury and agency securities, corporate securities and non-U.S. sovereign debt. Trading account liabilities decreased$13.0 billion primarily due to lower levels of short positions in government and corporate bonds driven by expected client demand within Global Markets.
Short-term Borrowings
Short-term borrowings provide an additional funding source and primarily consist of Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB) short-term borrowings, notes payable and various other borrowings that generally have maturities of one year or less. Short-term borrowings decreased$12.5 billion primarily due to a decrease in short-term FHLB advances. For more information on short-term borrowings, see Note 10 – Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and Restricted Cashto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Long-term Debt
Long-term debt increased$1.9 billion primarily driven by issuances outpacing maturities and redemptions. For more information on long-term debt, see Note 11 – Long-term Debtto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Shareholders’
Equity
Shareholders’ equity decreased$1.8 billion driven by returns of capital to shareholders of $27.0 billion through common and preferred stock dividends and share repurchases and a $4.0 billion after-tax decrease in the fair value of AFS debt securities recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income (OCI), largely offset by earnings.
Cash Flows Overview
The Corporation’s operating assets and liabilities support our global markets and lending activities. We believe that cash flows from operations, available cash balances and our ability to generate cash through short- and long-term debt are sufficient to fund our operating liquidity needs. Our investing activities primarily include the
debt securities portfolio and loans and leases. Our financing activities reflect cash flows primarily related to customer deposits, securities financing agreements and long-term debt. For more information on liquidity, see Liquidity Risk on page 47.
Supplemental Financial Data
In this Form 10-K, we present certain non-GAAP financial measures. Non-GAAP financial measures exclude certain items or otherwise include components that differ from the most directly comparable measures calculated in accordance with GAAP. Non-GAAP financial measures are provided as additional useful information to assess our financial condition, results of operations (including period-to-period
operating performance) or compliance with prospective regulatory requirements. These non-GAAP financial measures are not intended as a substitute for GAAP financial measures and may not be defined or calculated the same way as non-GAAP financial measures used by other companies.
We view net interest income and related ratios and analyses on an FTE basis, which when presented on a consolidated basis, are non-GAAP financial measures. To derive the FTE basis, net interest income is adjusted to reflect tax-exempt income on an equivalent before-tax basis with a corresponding increase in income tax expense. For purposes of this calculation, we used the federal statutory tax rate of 21 percent for 2018 (35 percent for all prior periods) and a representative state tax rate. Net interest yield, which measures the basis points we earn over the cost of funds, utilizes net interest income (and
thus total revenue) on an FTE basis. We believe that presentation of these items on an FTE basis allows for comparison of amounts from both taxable and tax-exempt sources and is consistent with industry practices.
We may present certain key performance indicators and ratios excluding certain items (e.g., debit valuation adjustment (DVA) gains (losses)) which result in non-GAAP financial measures. We believe that the presentation of measures that exclude these items is useful because such measures provide additional information to assess the underlying operational performance and trends of our businesses and to allow better comparison of period-to-period operating performance.
We also evaluate our business based on certain ratios that utilize tangible equity, a non-GAAP financial measure. Tangible equity represents an adjusted shareholders’ equity or common shareholders’ equity amount
which has been reduced by goodwill and certain acquired intangible assets (excluding mortgage servicing rights (MSRs)), net of related deferred tax liabilities. These measures are used to evaluate our use of equity. In addition, profitability, relationship and investment models use both return on average tangible common shareholders’ equity and return on average tangible shareholders’ equity as key measures to support our overall growth goals. These ratios are as follows:
●
Return on average tangible common shareholders’ equity measures our earnings contribution as a percentage of adjusted common shareholders’ equity. The tangible common equity ratio represents adjusted ending common shareholders’ equity divided by total assets less goodwill and certain
acquired intangible assets (excluding MSRs), net of related deferred tax liabilities.
●
Return on average tangible shareholders’ equity measures our earnings contribution as a percentage of adjusted average total shareholders’ equity. The tangible equity ratio represents adjusted ending shareholders’ equity divided by total assets less goodwill and certain acquired intangible assets (excluding MSRs), net of related deferred tax liabilities.
●
Tangible book value per common share represents adjusted ending
common shareholders’ equity divided by ending common shares outstanding.
We believe that the use of ratios that utilize tangible equity provides additional useful information because they present measures of those assets that can generate income. Tangible book value per share provides additional useful information about the level of tangible assets in relation to outstanding shares of common stock.
The aforementioned supplemental data and performance measures are presented in Tables 8 and 9.
Bank
of America 2018 24
Non-GAAP Reconciliations
Tables 6 and 7 provide reconciliations of certain non-GAAP financial measures to GAAP financial measures.
Table
6
Five-year Reconciliations to GAAP Financial Measures (1)
(Dollars
in millions, shares in thousands)
2018
2017
2016
2015
2014
Reconciliation of average shareholders’ equity to average tangible shareholders’ equity and average tangible common shareholders’ equity
Shareholders’
equity
$
264,748
$
271,289
$
265,843
$
251,384
$
238,317
Goodwill
(68,951
)
(69,286
)
(69,750
)
(69,772
)
(69,809
)
Intangible
assets (excluding MSRs)
(2,058
)
(2,652
)
(3,382
)
(4,201
)
(5,109
)
Related
deferred tax liabilities
906
1,463
1,644
1,852
2,090
Tangible
shareholders’ equity
$
194,645
$
200,814
$
194,355
$
179,263
$
165,489
Preferred
stock
(22,949
)
(24,188
)
(24,656
)
(21,808
)
(15,410
)
Tangible
common shareholders’ equity
$
171,696
$
176,626
$
169,699
$
157,455
$
150,079
Reconciliation
of year-end shareholders’ equity to year-end tangible shareholders’ equity and year-end tangible common shareholders’ equity
Shareholders’
equity
$
265,325
$
267,146
$
266,195
$
255,615
$
243,476
Goodwill
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(69,744
)
(69,761
)
(69,777
)
Intangible
assets (excluding MSRs)
(1,774
)
(2,312
)
(2,989
)
(3,768
)
(4,612
)
Related
deferred tax liabilities
858
943
1,545
1,716
1,960
Tangible
shareholders’ equity
$
195,458
$
196,826
$
195,007
$
183,802
$
171,047
Preferred
stock
(22,326
)
(22,323
)
(25,220
)
(22,272
)
(19,309
)
Tangible
common shareholders’ equity
$
173,132
$
174,503
$
169,787
$
161,530
$
151,738
Reconciliation
of year-end assets to year-end tangible assets
Assets
$
2,354,507
$
2,281,234
$
2,188,067
$
2,144,606
$
2,104,539
Goodwill
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(69,744
)
(69,761
)
(69,777
)
Intangible
assets (excluding MSRs)
(1,774
)
(2,312
)
(2,989
)
(3,768
)
(4,612
)
Related
deferred tax liabilities
858
943
1,545
1,716
1,960
Tangible
assets
$
2,284,640
$
2,210,914
$
2,116,879
$
2,072,793
$
2,032,110
(1)
Presents
reconciliations of non-GAAP financial measures to GAAP financial measures. For more information on non-GAAP financial measures and ratios we use in assessing the results of the Corporation, see Supplemental Financial Data on page 24.
Table
7
Quarterly Reconciliations to GAAP Financial Measures (1)
2018
Quarters
2017 Quarters
(Dollars in millions)
Fourth
Third
Second
First
Fourth
Third
Second
First
Reconciliation
of average shareholders’ equity to average tangible shareholders’ equity and average tangible common shareholders’ equity
Shareholders’
equity
$
263,698
$
264,653
$
265,181
$
265,480
$
273,162
$
273,238
$
270,977
$
267,700
Goodwill
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,954
)
(68,969
)
(69,489
)
(69,744
)
Intangible
assets (excluding MSRs)
(1,857
)
(1,992
)
(2,126
)
(2,261
)
(2,399
)
(2,549
)
(2,743
)
(2,923
)
Related
deferred tax liabilities
874
896
916
939
1,344
1,465
1,506
1,539
Tangible
shareholders’ equity
$
193,764
$
194,606
$
195,020
$
195,207
$
203,153
$
203,185
$
200,251
$
196,572
Preferred
stock
(22,326
)
(22,841
)
(23,868
)
(22,767
)
(22,324
)
(24,024
)
(25,221
)
(25,220
)
Tangible
common shareholders’ equity
$
171,438
$
171,765
$
171,152
$
172,440
$
180,829
$
179,161
$
175,030
$
171,352
Reconciliation
of period-end shareholders’ equity to period-end tangible shareholders’ equity and period-end tangible common shareholders’ equity
Shareholders’
equity
$
265,325
$
262,158
$
264,216
$
266,224
$
267,146
$
271,969
$
270,660
$
267,990
Goodwill
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,968
)
(68,969
)
(69,744
)
Intangible
assets (excluding MSRs)
(1,774
)
(1,908
)
(2,043
)
(2,177
)
(2,312
)
(2,459
)
(2,610
)
(2,827
)
Related
deferred tax liabilities
858
878
900
920
943
1,435
1,471
1,513
Tangible
shareholders’ equity
$
195,458
$
192,177
$
194,122
$
196,016
$
196,826
$
201,977
$
200,552
$
196,932
Preferred
stock
(22,326
)
(22,326
)
(23,181
)
(24,672
)
(22,323
)
(22,323
)
(25,220
)
(25,220
)
Tangible
common shareholders’ equity
$
173,132
$
169,851
$
170,941
$
171,344
$
174,503
$
179,654
$
175,332
$
171,712
Reconciliation
of period-end assets to period-end tangible assets
Assets
$
2,354,507
$
2,338,833
$
2,291,670
$
2,328,478
$
2,281,234
$
2,284,174
$
2,254,714
$
2,247,794
Goodwill
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,951
)
(68,968
)
(68,969
)
(69,744
)
Intangible
assets (excluding MSRs)
(1,774
)
(1,908
)
(2,043
)
(2,177
)
(2,312
)
(2,459
)
(2,610
)
(2,827
)
Related
deferred tax liabilities
858
878
900
920
943
1,435
1,471
1,513
Tangible
assets
$
2,284,640
$
2,268,852
$
2,221,576
$
2,258,270
$
2,210,914
$
2,214,182
$
2,184,606
$
2,176,736
(1)
Presents
reconciliations of non-GAAP financial measures to GAAP financial measures. For more information on non-GAAP financial measures and ratios we use in assessing the results of the Corporation, see Supplemental Financial Data on page 24.
25Bank of America 2018
Table
8
Five-year Summary of Selected Financial Data
(In
millions, except per share information)
2018
2017
2016
2015
2014
Income statement
Net
interest income
$
47,432
$
44,667
$
41,096
$
38,958
$
40,779
Noninterest
income
43,815
42,685
42,605
44,007
45,115
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
91,247
87,352
83,701
82,965
85,894
Provision
for credit losses
3,282
3,396
3,597
3,161
2,275
Noninterest
expense
53,381
54,743
55,083
57,617
75,656
Income
before income taxes
34,584
29,213
25,021
22,187
7,963
Income
tax expense
6,437
10,981
7,199
6,277
2,443
Net
income
28,147
18,232
17,822
15,910
5,520
Net
income applicable to common shareholders
26,696
16,618
16,140
14,427
4,476
Average
common shares issued and outstanding
10,096.5
10,195.6
10,284.1
10,462.3
10,527.8
Average
diluted common shares issued and outstanding
10,236.9
10,778.4
11,046.8
11,236.2
10,584.5
Performance
ratios
Return
on average assets
1.21
%
0.80
%
0.81
%
0.74
%
0.26
%
Return
on average common shareholders’ equity
11.04
6.72
6.69
6.28
2.01
Return
on average tangible common shareholders’ equity (1)
15.55
9.41
9.51
9.16
2.98
Return
on average shareholders’ equity
10.63
6.72
6.70
6.33
2.32
Return
on average tangible shareholders’ equity (1)
14.46
9.08
9.17
8.88
3.34
Total
ending equity to total ending assets
11.27
11.71
12.17
11.92
11.57
Total
average equity to total average assets
11.39
11.96
12.14
11.64
11.11
Dividend
payout
20.31
24.24
15.94
14.49
28.20
Per
common share data
Earnings
$
2.64
$
1.63
$
1.57
$
1.38
$
0.43
Diluted
earnings
2.61
1.56
1.49
1.31
0.42
Dividends
paid
0.54
0.39
0.25
0.20
0.12
Book
value
25.13
23.80
23.97
22.48
21.32
Tangible
book value (1)
17.91
16.96
16.89
15.56
14.43
Market
capitalization
$
238,251
$
303,681
$
222,163
$
174,700
$
188,141
Average
balance sheet
Total
loans and leases
$
933,049
$
918,731
$
900,433
$
876,787
$
898,703
Total
assets
2,325,246
2,268,633
2,190,218
2,160,536
2,145,393
Total
deposits
1,314,941
1,269,796
1,222,561
1,155,860
1,124,207
Long-term
debt
230,693
225,133
228,617
240,059
253,607
Common
shareholders’ equity
241,799
247,101
241,187
229,576
222,907
Total
shareholders’ equity
264,748
271,289
265,843
251,384
238,317
Asset
quality (2)
Allowance
for credit losses (3)
$
10,398
$
11,170
$
11,999
$
12,880
$
14,947
Nonperforming
loans, leases and foreclosed properties (4)
5,244
6,758
8,084
9,836
12,629
Allowance
for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total loans and leases outstanding (4)
1.02
%
1.12
%
1.26
%
1.37
%
1.66
%
Allowance
for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total nonperforming loans and leases (4)
194
161
149
130
121
Net
charge-offs (5)
$
3,763
$
3,979
$
3,821
$
4,338
$
4,383
Net
charge-offs as a percentage of average loans and leases outstanding (4, 5)
0.41
%
0.44
%
0.43
%
0.50
%
0.49
%
Capital
ratios at year end (6)
Common
equity tier 1 capital
11.6
%
11.5
%
10.8
%
9.8
%
9.6
%
Tier 1
capital
13.2
13.0
12.4
11.2
11.0
Total
capital
15.1
14.8
14.2
12.8
12.7
Tier 1
leverage
8.4
8.6
8.8
8.4
7.8
Supplementary
leverage ratio
6.8
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Tangible
equity (1)
8.6
8.9
9.2
8.9
8.4
Tangible
common equity (1)
7.6
7.9
8.0
7.8
7.5
(1)
Tangible
equity ratios and tangible book value per share of common stock are non-GAAP financial measures. For more information on these ratios and corresponding reconciliations to GAAP financial measures, see Supplemental Financial Data on page 24.
(2)
Asset quality metrics include $75 million of non-U.S. consumer credit card net charge-offs in 2017 and $243 million of non-U.S. consumer credit card allowance for loan and lease losses, $9.2 billion of non-U.S. consumer credit card loans and $175 million of non-U.S. consumer credit card net
charge-offs in 2016. The Corporation sold its non-U.S. consumer credit card business in 2017.
(3)
Includes the allowance for loan and leases losses and the reserve for unfunded lending commitments.
(4)
Balances and ratios do not include loans accounted for under the fair value option. For additional exclusions from nonperforming loans, leases and foreclosed properties, see Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Nonperforming Consumer Loans,
Leases and Foreclosed Properties Activity on page 58 and corresponding Table 31 and Commercial Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Nonperforming Commercial Loans, Leases and Foreclosed Properties Activity on page 63 and corresponding Table 38.
(5)
Net charge-offs exclude $273 million, $207 million, $340 million, $808 million and $810 million of write-offs in the purchased
credit-impaired (PCI) loan portfolio for 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
(6)
Basel 3 transition provisions for regulatory capital adjustments and deductions were fully phased-in as of January 1, 2018. Prior periods are presented on a fully phased-in basis. For additional information, including which approach is used to assess capital adequacy, see Capital Management on page
43.
n/a = not applicable
Bank of America 2018 26
Table
9
Selected Quarterly Financial Data
2018
Quarters
2017 Quarters
(In millions, except per share information)
Fourth
Third
Second
First
Fourth
Third
Second
First
Income
statement
Net
interest income
$
12,304
$
11,870
$
11,650
$
11,608
$
11,462
$
11,161
$
10,986
$
11,058
Noninterest
income (1)
10,432
10,907
10,959
11,517
8,974
10,678
11,843
11,190
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
22,736
22,777
22,609
23,125
20,436
21,839
22,829
22,248
Provision
for credit losses
905
716
827
834
1,001
834
726
835
Noninterest
expense
13,133
13,067
13,284
13,897
13,274
13,394
13,982
14,093
Income
before income taxes
8,698
8,994
8,498
8,394
6,161
7,611
8,121
7,320
Income
tax expense (1)
1,420
1,827
1,714
1,476
3,796
2,187
3,015
1,983
Net
income (1)
7,278
7,167
6,784
6,918
2,365
5,424
5,106
5,337
Net
income applicable to common shareholders
7,039
6,701
6,466
6,490
2,079
4,959
4,745
4,835
Average
common shares issued and outstanding
9,855.8
10,031.6
10,181.7
10,322.4
10,470.7
10,197.9
10,013.5
10,099.6
Average
diluted common shares issued and outstanding
9,996.0
10,170.8
10,309.4
10,472.7
10,621.8
10,746.7
10,834.8
10,919.7
Performance
ratios
Return
on average assets
1.24
%
1.23
%
1.17
%
1.21
%
0.41
%
0.95
%
0.90
%
0.97
%
Four-quarter
trailing return on average assets (2)
1.21
1.00
0.93
0.86
0.80
0.91
0.89
0.88
Return
on average common shareholders’ equity
11.57
10.99
10.75
10.85
3.29
7.89
7.75
8.09
Return
on average tangible common shareholders’ equity (3)
16.29
15.48
15.15
15.26
4.56
10.98
10.87
11.44
Return
on average shareholders’ equity
10.95
10.74
10.26
10.57
3.43
7.88
7.56
8.09
Return
on average tangible shareholders’ equity (3)
14.90
14.61
13.95
14.37
4.62
10.59
10.23
11.01
Total
ending equity to total ending assets
11.27
11.21
11.53
11.43
11.71
11.91
12.00
11.92
Total
average equity to total average assets
11.30
11.42
11.42
11.41
11.87
12.03
11.94
12.00
Dividend
payout
20.90
22.35
18.83
19.06
60.35
25.59
15.78
15.64
Per
common share data
Earnings
$
0.71
$
0.67
$
0.64
$
0.63
$
0.20
$
0.49
$
0.47
$
0.48
Diluted
earnings
0.70
0.66
0.63
0.62
0.20
0.46
0.44
0.45
Dividends
paid
0.15
0.15
0.12
0.12
0.12
0.12
0.075
0.075
Book
value
25.13
24.33
24.07
23.74
23.80
23.87
24.85
24.34
Tangible
book value (3)
17.91
17.23
17.07
16.84
16.96
17.18
17.75
17.22
Market
capitalization
$
238,251
$
290,424
$
282,259
$
305,176
$
303,681
$
264,992
$
239,643
$
235,291
Average
balance sheet
Total
loans and leases
$
934,721
$
930,736
$
934,818
$
931,915
$
927,790
$
918,129
$
914,717
$
914,144
Total
assets
2,334,586
2,317,829
2,322,678
2,325,878
2,301,687
2,271,104
2,269,293
2,231,649
Total
deposits
1,344,951
1,316,345
1,300,659
1,297,268
1,293,572
1,271,711
1,256,838
1,256,632
Long-term
debt
230,616
233,475
229,037
229,603
227,644
227,309
224,019
221,468
Common
shareholders’ equity
241,372
241,812
241,313
242,713
250,838
249,214
245,756
242,480
Total
shareholders’ equity
263,698
264,653
265,181
265,480
273,162
273,238
270,977
267,700
Asset
quality (4)
Allowance
for credit losses (5)
$
10,398
$
10,526
$
10,837
$
11,042
$
11,170
$
11,455
$
11,632
$
11,869
Nonperforming
loans, leases and foreclosed properties (6)
5,244
5,449
6,181
6,694
6,758
6,869
7,127
7,637
Allowance
for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total loans and leases outstanding (6)
1.02
%
1.05
%
1.08
%
1.11
%
1.12
%
1.16
%
1.20
%
1.25
%
Allowance
for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total nonperforming loans and leases (6)
194
189
170
161
161
163
160
156
Net
charge-offs (7)
$
924
$
932
$
996
$
911
$
1,237
$
900
$
908
$
934
Annualized
net charge-offs as a percentage of average loans and leases outstanding (6, 7)
0.39
%
0.40
%
0.43
%
0.40
%
0.53
%
0.39
%
0.40
%
0.42
%
Capital
ratios at period end (8)
Common
equity tier 1 capital
11.6
%
11.4
%
11.4
%
11.3
%
11.5
%
11.9
%
11.5
%
11.0
%
Tier 1
capital
13.2
12.9
13.0
13.0
13.0
13.4
13.2
12.6
Total
capital
15.1
14.7
14.8
14.8
14.8
15.1
15.0
14.3
Tier 1
leverage
8.4
8.3
8.4
8.4
8.6
8.9
8.8
8.8
Supplementary
leverage ratio
6.8
6.7
6.7
6.8
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Tangible
equity (3)
8.6
8.5
8.7
8.7
8.9
9.1
9.2
9.1
Tangible
common equity (3)
7.6
7.5
7.7
7.6
7.9
8.1
8.0
7.9
(1)
Net
income for the fourth quarter of 2017 included a charge of $2.9 billion related to the Tax Act effects which consisted of $946 million in noninterest income and $1.9 billion in income tax expense.
(2)
Calculated as total net income for four consecutive quarters divided by annualized average assets for four consecutive quarters.
(3)
Tangible equity ratios and tangible book value per share of common stock are non-GAAP financial measures. For more information on these ratios
and corresponding reconciliations to GAAP financial measures, see Supplemental Financial Data on page 24.
(4)
Asset quality metrics include $31 million of non-U.S. consumer credit card net charge-offs for the second quarter of 2017 and $242 million of non-U.S. consumer credit card allowance for loan and lease losses, $9.5 billion of non-U.S. consumer credit card loans and $44 million of non-U.S. consumer credit card net charge-offs for the first quarter of 2017. The Corporation sold its non-U.S. consumer credit card business in the second quarter of 2017.
(5)
Includes
the allowance for loan and lease losses and the reserve for unfunded lending commitments.
(6)
Balances and ratios do not include loans accounted for under the fair value option. For additional exclusions from nonperforming loans, leases and foreclosed properties, see Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Nonperforming Consumer Loans, Leases and Foreclosed Properties Activity on page 58 and corresponding Table 31 and Commercial Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Nonperforming Commercial Loans, Leases and Foreclosed Properties Activity
on page 63 and corresponding Table 38.
(7)
Net charge-offs exclude $107 million, $95 million, $36 million and $35 million of write-offs in the PCI loan portfolio in the fourth, third, second and first quarters of 2018, and $46 million, $73 million, $55 million
and $33 million in the fourth, third, second and first quarters of 2017, respectively.
(8)
Basel 3 transition provisions for regulatory capital adjustments and deductions were fully phased-in as of January 1, 2018. Prior periods are presented on a fully phased-in basis. For additional information, including which approach is used to assess capital adequacy, see Capital Management on page 43.
n/a = not applicable
27Bank
of America 2018
Table
10
Average Balances and Interest Rates - FTE Basis
Average Balance
Interest Income/ Expense
Yield/ Rate
Average Balance
Interest Income/ Expense
Yield/ Rate
Average Balance
Interest Income/ Expense
Yield/ Rate
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Earning assets
Interest-bearing
deposits with the Federal Reserve, non-U.S. central banks and other banks
$
139,848
$
1,926
1.38
%
$
127,431
$
1,122
0.88
%
$
133,374
$
605
0.45
%
Time
deposits placed and other short-term investments
9,446
216
2.29
12,112
241
1.99
9,026
140
1.55
Federal
funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell (1)
251,328
3,176
1.26
222,818
1,806
0.81
216,161
967
0.45
Trading
account assets
132,724
4,901
3.69
129,007
4,618
3.58
129,766
4,563
3.52
Debt
securities
437,312
11,837
2.66
435,005
10,626
2.44
418,289
9,263
2.23
Loans
and leases (2):
Residential
mortgage
207,523
7,294
3.51
197,766
6,831
3.45
188,250
6,488
3.45
Home
equity
53,886
2,573
4.77
62,260
2,608
4.19
71,760
2,713
3.78
U.S.
credit card
94,612
9,579
10.12
91,068
8,791
9.65
87,905
8,170
9.29
Non-U.S.
credit card (3)
—
—
—
3,929
358
9.12
9,527
926
9.72
Direct/Indirect
and other consumer (4)
93,036
3,104
3.34
96,002
2,734
2.85
94,148
2,371
2.52
Total
consumer
449,057
22,550
5.02
451,025
21,322
4.73
451,590
20,668
4.58
U.S.
commercial
304,387
11,937
3.92
292,452
9,765
3.34
276,887
8,101
2.93
Non-U.S.
commercial
97,664
3,220
3.30
95,005
2,566
2.70
93,263
2,337
2.51
Commercial
real estate (5)
60,384
2,618
4.34
58,502
2,116
3.62
57,547
1,773
3.08
Commercial
lease financing
21,557
698
3.24
21,747
706
3.25
21,146
627
2.97
Total
commercial
483,992
18,473
3.82
467,706
15,153
3.24
448,843
12,838
2.86
Total
loans and leases (3)
933,049
41,023
4.40
918,731
36,475
3.97
900,433
33,506
3.72
Other
earning assets (1)
76,524
4,300
5.62
76,957
3,224
4.19
59,775
2,496
4.18
Total
earning assets (1,6)
1,980,231
67,379
3.40
1,922,061
58,112
3.02
1,866,824
51,540
2.76
Cash
and due from banks
25,830
27,995
27,893
Other
assets, less allowance for loan and lease losses
319,185
318,577
295,501
Total
assets
$
2,325,246
$
2,268,633
$
2,190,218
Interest-bearing
liabilities
U.S.
interest-bearing deposits:
Savings
$
54,226
$
6
0.01
%
$
53,783
$
5
0.01
%
$
49,495
$
5
0.01
%
NOW
and money market deposit accounts
676,382
2,636
0.39
628,647
873
0.14
589,737
294
0.05
Consumer
CDs and IRAs
39,823
157
0.39
44,794
121
0.27
48,594
133
0.27
Negotiable
CDs, public funds and other deposits
50,593
991
1.96
36,782
354
0.96
32,889
160
0.49
Total
U.S. interest-bearing deposits
821,024
3,790
0.46
764,006
1,353
0.18
720,715
592
0.08
Non-U.S.
interest-bearing deposits:
Banks
located in non-U.S. countries
2,312
39
1.69
2,442
21
0.85
3,891
32
0.82
Governments
and official institutions
810
—
0.01
1,006
10
0.95
1,437
9
0.64
Time,
savings and other
65,097
666
1.02
62,386
547
0.88
59,183
382
0.65
Total
non-U.S. interest-bearing deposits
68,219
705
1.03
65,834
578
0.88
64,511
423
0.66
Total
interest-bearing deposits
889,243
4,495
0.51
829,840
1,931
0.23
785,226
1,015
0.13
Federal
funds purchased, securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase, short-term borrowings and other interest-bearing liabilities (1)
269,748
5,839
2.17
274,975
3,146
1.14
252,585
1,933
0.77
Trading
account liabilities
50,928
1,358
2.67
45,518
1,204
2.64
37,897
1,018
2.69
Long-term
debt
230,693
7,645
3.31
225,133
6,239
2.77
228,617
5,578
2.44
Total
interest-bearing liabilities (1,6)
1,440,612
19,337
1.34
1,375,466
12,520
0.91
1,304,325
9,544
0.73
Noninterest-bearing
sources:
Noninterest-bearing
deposits
425,698
439,956
437,335
Other
liabilities (1)
194,188
181,922
182,715
Shareholders’
equity
264,748
271,289
265,843
Total
liabilities and shareholders’ equity
$
2,325,246
$
2,268,633
$
2,190,218
Net
interest spread
2.06
%
2.11
%
2.03
%
Impact
of noninterest-bearing sources
0.36
0.26
0.22
Net
interest income/yield on earning assets (7)
$
48,042
2.42
%
$
45,592
2.37
%
$
41,996
2.25
%
(1)
Certain
prior-period amounts have been reclassified to conform to current period presentation.
(2)
Nonperforming loans are included in the respective average loan balances. Income on these nonperforming loans is generally recognized on a cost recovery basis.
(3)
Includes assets of the Corporation’s non-U.S. consumer credit card business, which was sold during the second quarter of 2017.
(4)
Includes
non-U.S. consumer loans of $2.8 billion, $2.9 billion and $3.4 billion in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
(5)
Includes U.S. commercial real estate loans of $56.4 billion, $55.0 billion and $54.2 billion, and non-U.S. commercial real estate loans of $4.0 billion,
$3.5 billion and $3.4 billion in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
(6)
Interest income includes the impact of interest rate risk management contracts, which decreased interest income on the underlying assets by $171 million, $44 million and $176 million
in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Interest expense includes the impact of interest rate risk management contracts, which decreased interest expense on the underlying liabilities by $130 million, $1.4 billion and $2.1 billion in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. For more information, see Interest Rate Risk Management for the Banking Book on page 74.
(7)
Net
interest income includes FTE adjustments of $610 million, $925 million and $900 million in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
Bank of America 2018
28
Table
11
Analysis of Changes in Net Interest Income - FTE Basis
Due
to Change in (1)
Net Change
Due to Change in (1)
Net Change
Volume
Rate
Volume
Rate
(Dollars
in millions)
From 2017 to 2018
From 2016 to 2017
Increase (decrease) in interest income
Interest-bearing
deposits with the Federal Reserve, non-U.S. central banks and other banks
$
109
$
695
$
804
$
(32
)
$
549
$
517
Time
deposits placed and other short-term investments
(53
)
28
(25
)
48
53
101
Federal
funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell
230
1,140
1,370
36
803
839
Trading
account assets
134
149
283
(22
)
77
55
Debt
securities
44
1,167
1,211
438
925
1,363
Loans
and leases:
Residential
mortgage
329
134
463
335
8
343
Home
equity
(350
)
315
(35
)
(360
)
255
(105
)
U.S.
credit card
339
449
788
290
331
621
Non-U.S.
credit card (2)
(358
)
—
(358
)
(544
)
(24
)
(568
)
Direct/Indirect
and other consumer
(82
)
452
370
48
315
363
Total
consumer
1,228
654
U.S.
commercial
402
1,770
2,172
468
1,196
1,664
Non-U.S.
commercial
71
583
654
48
181
229
Commercial
real estate
70
432
502
29
314
343
Commercial
lease financing
(5
)
(3
)
(8
)
19
60
79
Total
commercial
3,320
2,315
Total
loans and leases
4,548
2,969
Other
earning assets
(18
)
1,094
1,076
721
7
728
Total
interest income
$
9,267
$
6,572
Increase
(decrease) in interest expense
U.S.
interest-bearing deposits:
Savings
$
—
$
1
$
1
$
—
$
—
$
—
NOW
and money market deposit accounts
74
1,689
1,763
20
559
579
Consumer
CDs and IRAs
(13
)
49
36
(12
)
—
(12
)
Negotiable
CDs, public funds and other deposits
132
505
637
20
174
194
Total
U.S. interest-bearing deposits
2,437
761
Non-U.S.
interest-bearing deposits:
Banks
located in non-U.S. countries
(1
)
19
18
(12
)
1
(11
)
Governments
and official institutions
(2
)
(8
)
(10
)
(3
)
4
1
Time,
savings and other
26
93
119
24
141
165
Total
non-U.S. interest-bearing deposits
127
155
Total
interest-bearing deposits
2,564
916
Federal
funds purchased, securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase, short-term borrowings and other interest-bearing liabilities
(71
)
2,764
2,693
184
1,029
1,213
Trading
account liabilities
140
14
154
206
(20
)
186
Long-term
debt
151
1,255
1,406
(85
)
746
661
Total
interest expense
6,817
2,976
Net
increase in net interest income (3)
$
2,450
$
3,596
(1)
The
changes for each category of interest income and expense are divided between the portion of change attributable to the variance in volume and the portion of change attributable to the variance in rate for that category. The unallocated change in rate or volume variance is allocated between the rate and volume variances.
(2)
The Corporation sold its non-U.S. credit card business in the second quarter of 2017.
(3)
Includes changes in FTE basis adjustments of a $315
million decrease from 2017 to 2018 and a $25 million increase from 2016 to 2017.
29Bank of America 2018
Business
Segment Operations
Segment Description and Basis of Presentation
We report our results of operations through the following four business segments: Consumer Banking, GWIM, Global Banking and Global Markets, with the remaining operations recorded in All Other. We manage our segments and report their results on an FTE basis. For more information on our presentation of financial information on an FTE basis, see Supplemental Financial Data on page 24. The primary activities, products and businesses of the business segments and All Other are shown below.
We
periodically review capital allocated to our businesses and allocate capital annually during the strategic and capital planning processes. We utilize a methodology that considers the effect of regulatory capital requirements in addition to internal risk-based capital models. Our internal risk-based capital models use a risk-adjusted methodology incorporating each segment’s credit, market, interest rate, business and operational risk components. For more information on the nature of these risks, see Managing Risk on page 40. The capital allocated to the business segments
is referred to as allocated capital. Allocated equity in the reporting
units is comprised of allocated capital plus capital for the portion of goodwill and intangibles specifically
assigned to the reporting unit. For more information, including the definition of reporting unit, see Note 8 – Goodwill and Intangible Assetsto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
For more information on the basis of presentation for business segments and reconciliations to consolidated total revenue, net income and year-end total assets, see Note 23 – Business Segment Informationto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Bank
of America 2018 30
Consumer Banking
Deposits
Consumer
Lending
Total Consumer Banking
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
%
Change
Net interest income
$
16,024
$
13,353
$
11,099
$
10,954
$
27,123
$
24,307
12
%
Noninterest
income:
Card income
8
8
5,281
5,062
5,289
5,070
4
Service
charges
4,298
4,265
2
1
4,300
4,266
1
All
other income
430
391
381
487
811
878
(8
)
Total
noninterest income
4,736
4,664
5,664
5,550
10,400
10,214
2
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
20,760
18,017
16,763
16,504
37,523
34,521
9
Provision
for credit losses
195
201
3,469
3,324
3,664
3,525
4
Noninterest
expense
10,522
10,388
7,191
7,407
17,713
17,795
—
Income
before income taxes
10,043
7,428
6,103
5,773
16,146
13,201
22
Income
tax expense
2,561
2,813
1,556
2,186
4,117
4,999
(18
)
Net
income
$
7,482
$
4,615
$
4,547
$
3,587
$
12,029
$
8,202
47
Effective
tax rate (1)
25.5
%
37.9
%
Net
interest yield
2.35
%
2.05
%
3.97
%
4.18
%
3.78
3.54
Return
on average allocated capital
62
38
18
14
33
22
Efficiency
ratio
50.68
57.66
42.90
44.88
47.20
51.55
Balance
Sheet
Average
Total
loans and leases
$
5,233
$
5,084
$
278,574
$
260,974
$
283,807
$
266,058
7
%
Total
earning assets (2)
682,600
651,963
279,217
261,802
717,197
686,612
4
Total
assets (2)
710,925
679,306
290,068
273,253
756,373
725,406
4
Total
deposits
678,640
646,930
5,533
6,390
684,173
653,320
5
Allocated
capital
12,000
12,000
25,000
25,000
37,000
37,000
—
Year
end
Total loans and leases
$
5,470
$
5,143
$
288,865
$
275,330
$
294,335
$
280,473
5
%
Total
earning assets (2)
694,676
675,485
289,249
275,742
728,817
709,832
3
Total
assets (2)
724,015
703,330
299,970
287,390
768,877
749,325
3
Total
deposits
691,666
670,802
4,480
5,728
696,146
676,530
3
(1)
Estimated
at the segment level only.
(2)
In segments and businesses where the total of liabilities and equity exceeds assets, we allocate assets from All Other to match the segments’ and businesses’ liabilities and allocated shareholders’ equity. As a result, total earning assets and total assets of the businesses may not equal total Consumer Banking.
Consumer Banking, which is comprised of Deposits and Consumer Lending, offers a diversified range of credit, banking and investment products and
services to consumers and small businesses. Deposits and Consumer Lending include the net impact of migrating customers and their related deposit, brokerage asset and loan balances between Deposits, Consumer Lending and GWIM, as well as other client-managed businesses. Our customers and clients have access to a coast to coast network including financial centers in 34 states and the District of Columbia. Our network includes approximately 4,300 financial centers, approximately 16,300 ATMs, nationwide call centers, and leading digital banking platforms with more than 36 million active users, including over 26 million active mobile users.
Consumer Banking Results
Net
income for Consumer Bankingincreased$3.8 billion to $12.0 billion in 2018 compared to 2017 primarily driven by higher pretax income and lower income tax expense from the reduction in the federal income tax rate. The increase in pretax income was driven by higher revenue and lower noninterest expense, partially offset by higher provision for credit losses. Net interest income increased$2.8 billion to $27.1 billion primarily due to the beneficial impact of an increase in investable assets as a result of an increase in deposits, as well as higher
interest rates, pricing discipline and loan growth. Noninterest income increased$186 million to $10.4 billion driven by higher card income, partially offset by lower mortgage banking income, which is included in all other income.
The provision for credit losses increased$139 million to $3.7 billion driven by portfolio seasoning and loan growth in the U.S. credit card portfolio. Noninterest expense decreased$82 million to $17.7 billion driven by operating
efficiencies and lower litigation and FDIC expense. These decreases were partially offset by investments in digital capabilities and business growth, including primary sales professionals, combined with investments in new financial centers and renovations.
The return on average allocated capital was 33 percent, up from 22 percent, driven by higher net income. For more information on capital allocated to the business segments, see Business Segment Operations on page 30.
Deposits
Deposits includes the results of consumer deposit activities which consist of a comprehensive range of products provided to consumers and small businesses. Our deposit products
include traditional savings accounts, money market savings accounts, CDs and IRAs, and noninterest- and interest-bearing checking accounts, as well as investment accounts and products. Net interest income is allocated to the deposit products using our funds transfer pricing process that matches assets and liabilities with similar interest rate sensitivity and maturity characteristics. Deposits generates fees such as account service fees, non-sufficient funds fees, overdraft charges and ATM fees, as well as investment and brokerage fees from Merrill Edge accounts. Merrill Edge is an integrated investing and banking service targeted at customers with less than $250,000 in investable assets. Merrill
31Bank
of America 2018
Edge provides investment advice and guidance, client brokerage asset services, a self-directed online investing platform and key banking capabilities including access to the Corporation’s network of financial centers and ATMs.
Net income for Deposits increased$2.9 billion to $7.5 billion in 2018
driven by higher revenue and lower income tax expense, partially offset by higher noninterest expense. Net interest income increased$2.7 billion to $16.0 billion primarily due to the beneficial impact of an increase in investable assets as a result of higher deposits, and pricing discipline. Noninterest income increased$72 million to $4.7 billion primarily driven by higher service charges.
The provision for credit losses decreased$6 million to $195 million in 2018.
Noninterest expense increased$134 million to $10.5 billion primarily driven by investments in digital capabilities and business growth, including primary sales professionals, combined with investments in new financial centers and renovations. These increases were partially offset by lower litigation and FDIC expense.
Average deposits increased$31.7 billion to $678.6 billion in 2018 driven by strong organic growth. Growth in checking, money market savings and traditional savings of $36.3 billion was partially offset by a decline in time deposits of $4.6 billion.
Key
Statistics – Deposits
2018
2017
Total deposit spreads (excludes noninterest costs) (1)
2.14
%
1.84
%
Year
end
Client brokerage assets (in millions)
$
185,881
$
177,045
Active digital banking users (units in thousands) (2)
36,264
34,855
Active
mobile banking users (units in thousands)
26,433
24,238
Financial centers
4,341
4,477
ATMs
16,255
16,039
(1)
Includes
deposits held in Consumer Lending.
(2)
Digital users represents mobile and/or online users across consumer businesses.
Client brokerage assets increased$8.8 billion in 2018 driven by strong client flows, partially offset by market performance. Active mobile banking users increased2.2 million reflecting continuing changes in our customers’ banking preferences. The number of financial centers declined
by a net 136 reflecting changes in customer preferences to self-service options as we continue to optimize our consumer banking network and improve our cost to serve.
Consumer Lending
Consumer Lending offers products to consumers and small businesses across the U.S. The products offered include credit and debit cards, residential mortgages and home equity loans, and direct and indirect loans such as automotive, recreational vehicle and consumer personal loans. In addition to earning net interest spread revenue on its lending activities, Consumer Lending generates interchange revenue from credit and debit card transactions, late fees, cash advance fees, annual credit card fees, mortgage banking fee income and other miscellaneous fees. Consumer Lending products are available to our customers
through our retail network, direct telephone, and online and mobile channels. Consumer Lending results also include the impact of
servicing residential mortgages and home equity loans in the core portfolio, including loans held on the balance sheet of Consumer Lending and loans serviced for others.
Net income for Consumer Lending increased$960 million to $4.5 billion in 2018 driven by lower income tax expense, higher revenue and lower noninterest expense, partially offset by higher provision for credit losses. Net interest income increased$145
million to $11.1 billion primarily driven by higher interest rates and the impact of an increase in loan balances. Noninterest income increased$114 million to $5.7 billion driven by higher card income, partially offset by lower mortgage banking income.
The provision for credit losses increased$145 million to $3.5 billion driven by portfolio seasoning and loan growth in the U.S. credit card portfolio. Noninterest expense decreased$216 million to $7.2
billion primarily driven by operating efficiencies.
Average loans increased$17.6 billion to $278.6 billion in 2018 driven by increases in residential mortgages and U.S. credit card loans, partially offset by lower home equity balances.
Key
Statistics – Consumer Lending
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Total U.S. credit card (1)
Gross interest yield
10.12
%
9.65
%
Risk-adjusted
margin
8.34
8.67
New accounts (in thousands)
4,544
4,939
Purchase volumes
$
264,706
$
244,753
Debit
card purchase volumes
$
318,562
$
298,641
(1)
In addition to the U.S. credit card portfolio in Consumer Banking, the remaining U.S. credit card portfolio is in GWIM.
During
2018, the total U.S. credit card risk-adjusted margin decreased33 bps compared to 2017, primarily driven by increased net charge-offs and higher credit card rewards costs. Total U.S. credit card purchase volumes increased$20.0 billion to $264.7 billion, and debit card purchase volumes increased$19.9 billion to $318.6 billion, reflecting higher levels of consumer spending.
Key
Statistics – Loan Production (1)
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Total (2):
First
mortgage
$
41,195
$
50,581
Home equity
14,869
16,924
Consumer
Banking:
First mortgage
$
27,280
$
34,065
Home equity
13,251
15,199
(1)
The
loan production amounts represent the unpaid principal balance of loans and, in the case of home equity, the principal amount of the total line of credit.
(2)
In addition to loan production in Consumer Banking, there is also first mortgage and home equity loan production in GWIM.
First mortgage loan originations in Consumer Banking and for the total Corporation decreased$6.8 billion and $9.4 billion
in 2018 primarily driven by a higher interest rate environment driving lower first-lien mortgage refinances.
Home equity production in Consumer Banking and for the total Corporation decreased$1.9 billion and $2.1 billion in 2018 primarily driven by lower demand.
Bank
of America 2018 32
Global Wealth & Investment Management
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
% Change
Net interest income
$
6,294
$
6,173
2
%
Noninterest
income:
Investment and brokerage services
11,959
11,394
5
All
other income
1,085
1,023
6
Total noninterest income
13,044
12,417
5
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
19,338
18,590
4
Provision
for credit losses
86
56
54
Noninterest expense
13,777
13,556
2
Income
before income taxes
5,475
4,978
10
Income tax expense
1,396
1,885
(26
)
Net
income
$
4,079
$
3,093
32
Effective
tax rate
25.5
%
37.9
%
Net
interest yield
2.42
2.32
Return on average allocated capital
28
22
Efficiency
ratio
71.24
72.92
Balance
Sheet
Average
Total
loans and leases
$
161,342
$
152,682
6
%
Total earning assets
259,807
265,670
(2
)
Total
assets
277,219
281,517
(2
)
Total deposits
241,256
245,559
(2
)
Allocated
capital
14,500
14,000
4
Year
end
Total loans and leases
$
164,854
$
159,378
3
%
Total
earning assets
287,197
267,026
8
Total assets
305,906
284,321
8
Total
deposits
268,700
246,994
9
GWIM consists of two primary businesses: Merrill Lynch Global Wealth Management (MLGWM) andU.S. Trust, Bank of America Private Wealth Management (U.S. Trust).
MLGWM’s advisory
business provides a high-touch client experience through a network of financial advisors focused on clients with over $250,000 in total investable assets. MLGWM provides tailored solutions to meet clients’ needs through a full set of investment management, brokerage, banking and retirement products.
U.S. Trust, together with MLGWM’s Private Banking & Investments Group, provides comprehensive wealth management solutions targeted to high net worth and ultra high net worth clients, as well as customized solutions to meet clients’ wealth structuring, investment management, trust and banking needs, including specialty asset management services.
Net income for GWIMincreased
$986 million to $4.1 billion in 2018 compared to 2017 due to higher revenue and lower income tax expense from the reduction in the federal income tax rate, partially offset by an increase in noninterest expense and provision for credit losses. The operating margin was 28 percent compared to 27 percent a year ago.
Net interest income increased $121 million to $6.3 billion due to higher deposit spreads and average loan balances, partially offset by lower loan spreads and average deposit balances.
Noninterest
income, which primarily includes investment and brokerage services income, increased $627 million to $13.0 billion. The increase was driven by the impact of AUM flows and higher market valuations, partially offset by the impact of changing market dynamics on transactional revenue and AUM pricing.
Noninterest expense increased $221 million to $13.8 billion primarily due to higher revenue-related incentive expense and investments for business growth, partially offset by continued expense discipline.
The return on average allocated capital was 28 percent,
up from 22 percent, as higher net income was partially offset by an increased capital allocation. For more information on capital allocated to the business segments, see Business Segment Operations on page 30.
Revenue from MLGWM of $15.9 billion and revenue from U.S. Trust of $3.4 billion both increasedfour percent due to higher asset management fees driven by higher net flows and market valuations, and an increase in net interest income. The increase in MLGWM revenue was partially offset by lower AUM pricing and transactional revenue.
33Bank
of America 2018
Key
Indicators and Metrics
(Dollars in millions, except as noted)
2018
2017
Revenue
by Business
Merrill Lynch Global Wealth Management
$
15,895
$
15,288
U.S.
Trust
3,432
3,295
Other
11
7
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
$
19,338
$
18,590
Client
Balances by Business, at year end
Merrill Lynch Global Wealth Management
$
2,193,562
$
2,305,664
U.S.
Trust
427,294
446,199
Total client balances
$
2,620,856
$
2,751,863
Client
Balances by Type, at year end
Assets under management
$
1,021,221
$
1,080,747
Brokerage
and other assets
1,162,997
1,261,990
Deposits
268,700
246,994
Loans
and leases (1)
167,938
162,132
Total client balances
$
2,620,856
$
2,751,863
Assets
Under Management Rollforward
Assets under management, beginning of year
$
1,080,747
$
886,148
Net
client flows
36,406
95,707
Market valuation/other
(95,932
)
98,892
Total
assets under management, end of year
$
1,021,221
$
1,080,747
Associates,
at year end (2)
Number of financial advisors
17,518
17,355
Total wealth advisors, including
financial advisors
19,459
19,238
Total primary sales professionals, including financial advisors and wealth advisors
20,556
20,318
Merrill
Lynch Global Wealth Management Metric
Financial advisor productivity (3) (in thousands)
$
1,034
$
1,005
U.S.
Trust Metric, at year end
Primary sales professionals
1,747
1,714
(1)
Includes
margin receivables which are classified in customer and other receivables on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
(2)
Includes financial advisors in the Consumer Banking segment of 2,722 and 2,402 at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(3)
Financial advisor productivity is defined as MLGWM total revenue, excluding the allocation of certain asset and liability management (ALM) activities, divided by the total average number of financial advisors (excluding financial advisors in the Consumer Banking segment).
Client Balances
Client balances managed under advisory and/or discretion of GWIM are AUM and are typically held in diversified portfolios. Fees earned on AUM are calculated as a percentage of clients’ AUM balances. The asset management fees charged to clients per year depend on various factors, but are commonly driven by the breadth
of
the client’s relationship. The net client AUM flows represent the net change in clients’ AUM balances over a specified period
of time, excluding market appreciation/depreciation and other adjustments.
Client balances decreased $131.0 billion, or five percent, in 2018 to $2.6 trillion, primarily due to lower market valuations on AUM and brokerage balances, as measured at December 31, 2018, partially offset by positive flows.
Bank
of America 2018 34
Global Banking
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
% Change
Net interest income
$
10,881
$
10,504
4
%
Noninterest
income:
Service charges
3,027
3,125
(3
)
Investment
banking fees
2,891
3,471
(17
)
All other income
2,845
2,899
(2
)
Total
noninterest income
8,763
9,495
(8
)
Total revenue, net of interest expense
19,644
19,999
(2
)
Provision
for credit losses
8
212
(96
)
Noninterest expense
8,591
8,596
—
Income
before income taxes
11,045
11,191
(1
)
Income tax expense
2,872
4,238
(32
)
Net
income
$
8,173
$
6,953
18
Effective
tax rate
26.0
%
37.9
%
Net
interest yield
2.98
2.93
Return on average allocated capital
20
17
Efficiency
ratio
43.73
42.98
Balance
Sheet
Average
Total
loans and leases
$
354,236
$
346,089
2
%
Total earning assets
364,748
358,302
2
Total
assets
424,353
416,038
2
Total deposits
336,337
312,859
8
Allocated
capital
41,000
40,000
3
Year
end
Total loans and leases
$
365,717
$
350,668
4
%
Total
earning assets
377,812
365,560
3
Total assets
441,477
424,533
4
Total
deposits
360,248
329,273
9
Global Banking, which includes Global Corporate Banking, Global Commercial Banking, Business Banking and Global Investment Banking, provides a wide range of lending-related products and services, integrated working capital management and treasury
solutions, and underwriting and advisory services through our network of offices and client relationship teams. Our lending products and services include commercial loans, leases, commitment facilities, trade finance, commercial real estate lending and asset-based lending. Our treasury solutions business includes treasury management, foreign exchange and short-term investing options. We also provide investment banking products to our clients such as debt and equity underwriting and distribution, and merger-related and other advisory services. Underwriting debt and equity issuances, fixed-income and equity research, and certain market-based activities are executed through our global broker-dealer affiliates, which are our primary dealers in several countries. Within Global Banking, Global Commercial Banking clients generally include
middle-market companies, commercial real estate firms and not-for-profit companies. Global Corporate Banking clients generally include large global corporations, financial institutions and leasing clients. Business Banking clients include mid-sized U.S.-based businesses requiring customized and integrated financial advice and solutions.
Net income for Global Bankingincreased$1.2 billion to $8.2 billion in 2018 compared to 2017
primarily driven by lower income tax expense from the reduction in the federal income tax rate and lower provision for credit losses, partially offset by lower revenue. Noninterest expense was relatively unchanged.
Revenue decreased$355 million to $19.6 billion driven by lower noninterest income, partially offset by higher net interest income. Net interest income increased$377 million to $10.9 billion primarily due to the impact of higher interest rates,
as well as loan and deposit growth. Noninterest income decreased$732 million to $8.8 billion primarily due to lower investment banking fees. The provision for credit losses improved $204 million to $8 million primarily driven by Global Banking’s portion of a 2017 single-name non-U.S. commercial charge-off and continued improvement in the commercial portfolio.
The return on average allocated capital was 20 percent, up from 17 percent, as higher net income
was partially offset by an increased capital allocation. For more information on capital allocated to the business segments, see Business Segment Operations on page 30.
Global Corporate, Global Commercial and Business Banking
Global Corporate, Global Commercial and Business Banking each include Business Lending and Global Transaction Services activities. Business Lending includes various lending-related products and services, and related hedging activities, including commercial loans, leases, commitment facilities, trade finance, real estate lending and asset-based lending. Global Transaction Services includes deposits, treasury management, credit card, foreign exchange and short-term investment products.
35Bank
of America 2018
The table below and following discussion present a summary of the results, which exclude certain investment banking activities in Global Banking.
Global
Corporate, Global Commercial and Business Banking
Global
Corporate Banking
Global Commercial Banking
Business Banking
Total
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
(Dollars
in millions)
Revenue
Business
Lending
$
4,122
$
4,387
$
4,039
$
4,280
$
393
$
404
$
8,554
$
9,071
Global
Transaction Services
3,656
3,322
3,288
3,017
973
849
7,917
7,188
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
$
7,778
$
7,709
$
7,327
$
7,297
$
1,366
$
1,253
$
16,471
$
16,259
Balance
Sheet
Average
Total
loans and leases
$
163,516
$
158,292
$
174,279
$
170,101
$
16,432
$
17,682
$
354,227
$
346,075
Total
deposits
163,559
148,704
135,337
127,720
37,462
36,435
336,358
312,859
Year
end
Total
loans and leases
$
174,378
$
163,184
$
175,937
$
169,997
$
15,402
$
17,500
$
365,717
$
350,681
Total
deposits
173,183
155,614
149,118
137,538
37,973
36,120
360,274
329,272
Business
Lending revenue decreased$517 million in 2018 compared to 2017. The decrease was primarily driven by the impact of tax reform on certain tax-advantaged investments and lower leasing-related revenues.
Global Transaction Services revenue increased$729 million to $7.9 billion in 2018 compared to 2017 driven by higher short-term rates and increased deposits.
Average loans and leases increasedtwo
percent in 2018 compared to 2017 driven by growth in the commercial and industrial, and commercial real estate portfolios. Average deposits increasedeight percent due to growth in domestic and international interest-bearing balances.
Global Investment Banking
Client teams and product specialists underwrite and distribute debt, equity and loan products, and provide advisory services and tailored risk management solutions. The economics of certain investment banking and underwriting activities are shared primarily between Global Banking originates certain deal-related transactions
with our corporate and commercial clients that are executed and distributed by Global Markets. To provide a complete discussion of our consolidated investment banking fees, the following table presents total Corporation investment banking Global Banking Global Banking originates certain deal-related transactions with our corporate and commercial clients that are executed and distributed by Global Markets. To provide a complete discussion of our consolidated investment banking fees, the following table presents total Corporation investment banking fees and the portion attributable to Global Banking.and Global Banking originates certain deal-related transactions
with our corporate and commercial clients that are executed and distributed by Global Markets. To provide a complete discussion of our consolidated investment banking fees, the following table presents total Corporation investment banking fees and the portion attributable to Global Banking.Global MarketsGlobal Banking originates certain deal-related transactions with our corporate and commercial clients that are executed and distributed by Global Markets. To provide a complete discussion of our consolidated investment banking fees, the following table presents total Corporation investment banking fees and the portion attributable to Global Banking. under an internal revenue-sharing arrangement.Global Banking originates certain deal-related transactions with our corporate and commercial clients that are executed and distributed by Global Markets. To provide a complete discussion of our consolidated investment banking fees, the following table presents total Corporation investment banking fees and the portion attributable to Global Banking.
fees and the portion attributable to Global Banking.
Investment
Banking Fees
Global Banking
Total
Corporation
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
Products
Advisory
$
1,152
$
1,557
$
1,258
$
1,691
Debt
issuance
1,327
1,506
3,084
3,635
Equity issuance
412
408
1,183
940
Gross
investment banking fees
2,891
3,471
5,525
6,266
Self-led deals
(68
)
(113
)
(198
)
(255
)
Total
investment banking fees
$
2,823
$
3,358
$
5,327
$
6,011
Total
Corporation investment banking fees, excluding self-led deals, of $5.3 billion, which are primarily included within Global Banking and Global Markets, decreased11 percent in 2018 compared to 2017primarily due to declines in advisory fees and debt underwriting, the latter of which was driven by lower fee pools.
Bank
of America 2018 36
Global Markets
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
% Change
Net interest income
$
3,171
$
3,744
(15
)%
Noninterest
income:
Investment and brokerage services
1,780
2,049
(13
)
Investment
banking fees
2,296
2,476
(7
)
Trading account profits
7,932
6,710
18
All
other income
884
972
(9
)
Total noninterest income
12,892
12,207
6
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
16,063
15,951
1
Provision
for credit losses
—
164
(100
)
Noninterest expense
10,686
10,731
—
Income
before income taxes
5,377
5,056
6
Income tax expense
1,398
1,763
(21
)
Net
income
$
3,979
$
3,293
21
Effective
tax rate
26.0
%
34.9
%
Return
on average allocated capital
11
9
Efficiency ratio
66.53
67.27
Balance
Sheet
Average
Trading-related
assets:
Trading account securities
$
215,112
$
216,996
(1
)%
Reverse
repurchases
125,084
101,795
23
Securities borrowed
78,889
82,210
(4
)
Derivative
assets
46,047
40,811
13
Total trading-related assets
465,132
441,812
5
Total
loans and leases
72,651
71,413
2
Total earning assets
473,383
449,441
5
Total
assets
666,003
638,673
4
Total deposits
31,209
32,864
(5
)
Allocated
capital
35,000
35,000
—
Year
end
Total trading-related assets
$
447,998
$
419,375
7
%
Total
loans and leases
73,928
76,778
(4
)
Total earning assets
457,224
449,314
2
Total
assets
641,922
629,013
2
Total deposits
37,841
34,029
11
Global
Marketsoffers sales and trading services and research services to institutional clients across fixed-income, credit, currency, commodity and equity businesses. Global MarketsGlobal Marketsprovides market-making, financing, securities clearing, settlement and custody services globally to our institutional investor clients in support of their investing and trading activities. We also work with our commercial and corporate clients to provide risk management products using interest rate, equity, credit, currency and commodity derivatives, foreign exchange, fixed-income and mortgage-related products. As a result of our market-making activities in these products,
we may be required to manage risk in a broad range of financial products including government securities, equity and equity-linked securities, high-grade and high-yield corporate debt securities, syndicated loans, MBS, commodities and asset-backed securities. The economics of certain investment banking and underwriting activities are shared primarily betweenGlobal Markets and Global Bankingunder an internal revenue-sharing arrangement. Global Banking originates certain deal product coverage includes securities and derivative products in both the primary and secondary markets.Global Marketsprovides market-making, financing, securities clearing, settlement and custody services globally to our institutional investor clients in support of their investing and trading activities. We also work with our commercial and corporate clients to provide risk management products using interest rate, equity, credit, currency and commodity derivatives, foreign exchange, fixed-income and mortgage-related products. As a result of our market-making activities in these products, we may be required to manage risk in a broad range of financial products including government securities, equity and equity-linked securities, high-grade and high-yield corporate debt securities, syndicated loans, MBS, commodities and asset-backed securities. The economics of certain investment
banking and underwriting activities are shared primarily betweenGlobal Markets and Global Ban
-related transactions with our corporate and commercial clients that are executed and distributed by Global Markets. For information on investment banking fees on a consolidated basis, see page 36.kingunder an internal revenue-sharing arrangement. Global Banking originates certain deal-related transactions with our corporate and commercial clients that are executed and distributed by Global Markets. For information
on investment banking fees on a consolidated basis, see page 36.
Net income for Global Marketsincreased$686 million to $4.0 billion in 2018 compared to 2017. Net DVA losses were $162 million compared to losses of $428 million in 2017. Excluding net DVA, net income increased$544 million to $4.1
billion. These increases were primarily driven by lower income tax expense from the reduction in the federal income tax rate, a decrease in the provision for credit losses and modestly higher revenue.
Sales and trading revenue, excluding net DVA, increased$19 million due to higher Equities revenue, largely offset by lower FICC revenue. The provision for credit losses decreased$164 million driven by Global Markets’ portion of a single-name non-U.S. commercial charge-off in 2017. Noninterest expense decreased$45 million to
$10.7 billion primarily due to lower operating costs.
37Bank of America 2018
Average
total assets increased$27.3 billion to $666.0 billion in 2018 primarily driven by increased levels of inventory in FICC to facilitate client demand and growth in Equities derivative client financing activities. Total year-end assets increased$12.9 billion to $641.9 billion at December 31, 2018 due to increased levels of inventory in FICC.
The return on average allocated capital was 11 percent, up from
9 percent, reflecting higher net income. For more information on capital allocated to the business segments, see Business Segment Operations on page 30.
Sales and Trading Revenue
Sales and trading revenue includes unrealized and realized gains and losses on trading and other assets, net interest income, and fees primarily from commissions on equity securities. Sales and trading revenue is segregated into fixed-income (government debt obligations, investment and non-investment grade corporate debt obligations, commercial MBS, residential mortgage-backed securities, collateralized loan obligations, interest rate and credit derivative contracts), currencies
(interest rate and foreign exchange contracts), commodities (primarily futures, forwards, swaps and options) and equities (equity-linked derivatives and cash equity activity). The following table and related discussion present sales and trading revenue, substantially all of which is in Global Markets, with the remainder in Global Banking. In addition, the following table and related discussion present sales and trading revenue, excluding net DVA, which is a non-GAAP financial measure. For more information on net DVA, see Supplemental Financial Data on page 24.
Sales
and Trading Revenue (1, 2)
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Sales and trading revenue
Fixed-income,
currencies and commodities
$
8,186
$
8,657
Equities
4,876
4,120
Total
sales and trading revenue
$
13,062
$
12,777
Sales and trading revenue, excluding net DVA (3)
Fixed-income,
currencies and commodities
$
8,328
$
9,051
Equities
4,896
4,154
Total
sales and trading revenue, excluding net DVA
$
13,224
$
13,205
(1)
Includes FTE adjustments of $249 million and $236 million for 2018
and 2017. For more information on sales and trading revenue, see Note 3 – Derivativesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
(2)
Includes Global Banking sales and trading revenue of $430 million and $236 million for 2018 and 2017.
(3)
FICC
and Equities sales and trading revenue, excluding net DVA, is a non-GAAP financial measure. FICC net DVA losses were $142 million and $394 million for 2018 and 2017. Equities net DVA losses were $20 million and $34 million for 2018 and 2017.
The following explanations for year-over-year changes in sales and trading, FICC and Equities revenue exclude net DVA, but would be the same whether net DVA was included or excluded. FICC revenue
decreased$723 million in 2018 primarily due to lower activity and a less favorable market in credit-related products. The decline in FICC revenue was also impacted by higher funding costs, which were driven by increases in market interest rates. Equities revenue increased$742 million in 2018 driven by strength in client financing and derivatives.
All Other
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
% Change
Net interest income
$
573
$
864
(34
)%
Noninterest
income (loss)
(1,284
)
(1,648
)
(22
)
Total revenue, net of interest expense
(711
)
(784
)
(9
)
Provision
for credit losses
(476
)
(561
)
(15
)
Noninterest expense
2,614
4,065
(36
)
Loss
before income taxes
(2,849
)
(4,288
)
(34
)
Income tax benefit
(2,736
)
(979
)
n/m
Net
loss
$
(113
)
$
(3,309
)
(97
)
Balance
Sheet
Average
Total
loans and leases
$
61,013
$
82,489
(26
)%
Total assets (1)
201,298
206,999
(3
)
Total
deposits
21,966
25,194
(13
)
Year
end
Total loans and leases
$
48,061
$
69,452
(31
)%
Total
assets (1)
196,325
194,042
1
Total deposits
18,541
22,719
(18
)
(1)
In
segments where the total of liabilities and equity exceeds assets, which are generally deposit-taking segments, we allocate assets from All Other to those segments to match liabilities (i.e., deposits) and allocated shareholders’ equity. Average allocated assets were $517.0 billion and $515.6 billion for 2018 and 2017, and year-end allocated assets were $540.8 billion and $520.4 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
n/m
= not meaningful
All Other consists of ALM activities, equity investments, non-core mortgage loans and servicing activities, the net impact of periodic revisions to the MSR valuation model for core and non-core MSRs and the related economic hedge results, liquidating businesses and residual expense allocations. ALM activities encompass certain residential mortgages, debt securities, interest rate and foreign currency risk management activities, the impact of certain
allocation methodologies and hedge ineffectiveness. The results of certain ALM activities are allocated to our business segments. For more information on our ALM activities, see Note 23 – Business Segment Informationto the Consolidated Financial Statements. Equity investments include our merchant services joint venture as well as a portfolio of equity, real estate and other alternative investments. For more information on our merchant services joint
Bank of America 2018 38
venture,
see Note 12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
The Corporation classifies consumer real estate loans as core or non-core based on loan and customer characteristics. For more information on the core and non-core portfolios, see Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management on page 51. Residential mortgage loans that are held for ALM purposes, including interest rate or liquidity risk management, are classified as core and are presented on the balance sheet of All Other. During 2018, residential mortgage loans held for ALM activities decreased $3.6 billion to $24.9 billion at December
31, 2018 primarily as a result of payoffs and paydowns. Non-core residential mortgage and home equity loans, which are principally runoff portfolios, are also held in All Other. During 2018, total non-core loans decreased $17.8 billion to $23.5 billion at December 31, 2018 due primarily to loan sales of $10.8 billion, as well as payoffs and paydowns.
The net loss for All Otherimproved$3.2 billion to a loss of $113 million, driven by a charge of $2.9 billion in 2017 due
to enactment of the Tax Act. The pretax loss for 2018 compared to 2017 decreased $1.4 billion primarily due to lower noninterest expense.
Revenue increased$73 million to a loss of $711 million primarily due to gains of $731 million from the sale of consumer real estate loans, primarily non-core, offset by a $729 million charge related to the redemption of certain trust preferred securities in 2018. Results for 2017 included a downward valuation adjustment of $946 million on tax-advantaged energy investments in connection with the Tax Act and a pretax gain of $793 million recognized in connection
with the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business in 2017.
Noninterest expense decreased$1.5 billion to $2.6 billion primarily due to lower non-core mortgage costs and reduced operational costs from the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business. Also, the prior-year period included a $316 million impairment charge related to certain data centers.
The income tax benefit was $2.7 billion in 2018 compared to a benefit of $1.0 billion in 2017. The increase in the tax benefit was primarily
driven by a charge of $1.9 billion in 2017 related to impacts of the Tax Act for the lower valuation of certain deferred tax assets and liabilities. Both periods included income tax benefit adjustments to eliminate the FTE treatment of certain tax credits recorded in Global Banking.
Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements and Contractual Obligations
We have contractual obligations to make future payments on debt and lease agreements. Additionally, in the normal course of business, we enter into contractual arrangements whereby we commit to future purchases of products or services from unaffiliated parties. Purchase obligations are defined as obligations that are legally binding
agreements whereby we agree to purchase products or services with a specific minimum quantity at a fixed, minimum or variable price over a specified period of time. Included in purchase obligations are vendor contracts, the most significant of which include communication services, processing services and software contracts. Debt, lease and other obligations are more fully discussed in Note 11 – Long-term Debt and Note 12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Other long-term liabilities include our contractual funding obligations related to the Non-U.S. Pension Plans and
Nonqualified and Other Pension Plans (together, the Plans). Obligations to the Plans are based on the current and projected obligations of the Plans, performance of the Plans’ assets, and any participant contributions, if applicable. During 2018 and 2017, we contributed $156 million and $514 million to the Plans, and we expect to make $127 million of contributions during 2019. The Plans are more fully discussed in Note 17 – Employee Benefit Plansto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
We enter into commitments to extend credit such as loan commitments,
standby letters of credit (SBLCs) and commercial letters of credit to meet the financing needs of our customers. For a summary of the total unfunded, or off-balance sheet, credit extension commitment amounts by expiration date, see Credit Extension Commitments in Note 12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
We also utilize variable interest entities (VIEs) in the ordinary course of business to support our financing and investing needs as well as those of our customers. For more information on our involvement with unconsolidated VIEs, see Note 7 – Securitizations and Other Variable Interest Entitiesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Estimated
interest expense on long-term debt and time deposits (1)
6,795
10,778
8,407
30,872
56,852
49,123
Total
contractual obligations
$
103,521
$
66,348
$
55,762
$
145,351
$
370,982
$
368,080
(1)
Represents
forecasted net interest expense on long-term debt and time deposits based on interest rates at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Forecasts are based on the contractual maturity dates of each liability, and are net of derivative hedges, where applicable.
39Bank of America 2018
Representations
and Warranties Obligations
For more information on representations and warranties obligations in connection with the sale of mortgage loans, see Note 12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements. For more information related to the sensitivity of the assumptions used to estimate our reserve for representations and warranties, see Complex Accounting Estimates – Representations and Warranties Liability on page 79.
Managing Risk
Overview
Risk is inherent in
all our business activities. Sound risk management enables us to serve our customers and deliver for our shareholders. If not managed well, risks can result in financial loss, regulatory sanctions and penalties, and damage to our reputation, each of which may adversely impact our ability to execute our business strategies. We take a comprehensive approach to risk management with a defined Risk Framework and an articulated Risk Appetite Statement which are approved annually by the Enterprise Risk Committee (ERC) and the Board.
The seven key types of risk faced by the Corporation are strategic, credit, market, liquidity, compliance, operational and reputational.
●
Strategic risk is the risk resulting from incorrect
assumptions about external or internal factors, inappropriate business plans, ineffective business strategy execution, or failure to respond in a timely manner to changes in the regulatory, macroeconomic or competitive environments in the geographic locations in which we operate.
●
Credit risk is the risk of loss arising from the inability or failure of a borrower or counterparty to meet its obligations.
●
Market risk is the risk that changes in market conditions may adversely impact the value of assets
or liabilities, or otherwise negatively impact earnings.
●
Liquidity risk is the inability to meet expected or unexpected cash flow and collateral needs while continuing to support our businesses and customers under a range of economic conditions.
●
Compliance risk is the risk of legal or regulatory sanctions, material financial loss or damage to the reputation of the Corporation arising from the failure of the Corporation to comply with the requirements of applicable laws, rules and regulations and our
internal policies and procedures.
●
Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed processes, people and systems, or from external events.
●
Reputational risk is the risk that negative perceptions of the Corporation’s conduct or business practices may adversely impact its profitability or operations.
The following sections address in more detail the specific procedures, measures and analyses of the major categories
of risk. This discussion of managing risk focuses on the current Risk Framework that, as part of its annual review process, was approved by the ERC and the Board.
As set forth in our Risk Framework, a culture of managing risk well is fundamental to fulfilling our purpose and our values and delivering responsible growth. It requires us to focus on risk in all activities and encourages the necessary mindset and behavior to enable effective risk management, and promotes sound risk-taking
within our risk appetite. Sustaining a culture of managing risk well throughout the organization is critical to our success and is a clear expectation of our executive management team and the Board.
Our Risk Framework serves as the foundation for the consistent and effective management of risks facing the Corporation.
The Risk Framework sets forth clear roles, responsibilities and accountability for the management of risk and provides a blueprint for how the Board, through delegation of authority to committees and executive officers, establishes risk appetite and associated limits for our activities.
Executive management assesses, with Board oversight, the risk-adjusted returns of each business. Management reviews and approves the strategic and financial operating plans, as well as the capital plan and Risk Appetite Statement, and recommends them annually to the Board for approval. Our strategic plan takes into consideration return objectives and financial resources, which must align with risk capacity and risk appetite. Management sets financial objectives for each business by allocating capital and setting a target for return on capital for each business. Capital allocations and operating limits are regularly evaluated as part of our
overall governance processes as the businesses and the economic environment in which we operate continue to evolve. For more information regarding capital allocations, see Business Segment Operations on page 30.
The Corporation’s risk appetite indicates the amount of capital, earnings or liquidity we are willing to put at risk to achieve our strategic objectives and business plans, consistent with applicable regulatory requirements. Our risk appetite provides a common and comparable set of measures for senior management and the Board to clearly indicate our aggregate level of risk and to monitor whether the Corporation’s risk profile remains in alignment with our strategic and capital plans. Our risk appetite is formally articulated in the Risk Appetite Statement, which includes both qualitative components and quantitative limits.
Our
overall capacity to take risk is limited; therefore, we prioritize the risks we take in order to maintain a strong and flexible financial
position so we can withstand challenging economic conditions and take advantage of organic growth opportunities. Therefore, we set objectives and targets for capital and liquidity that are intended to permit us to continue to operate in a safe and sound manner, including during periods of stress.
Our lines of business operate with risk limits (which may include credit, market and/or operational limits, as applicable) that align with the Corporation’s risk appetite. Executive management is responsible for tracking and reporting performance measurements as well as any exceptions to guidelines or limits. The Board, and its committees when appropriate, oversees financial performance, execution of the strategic and financial operating plans, adherence
to risk appetite limits and the adequacy of internal controls.
For a more detailed discussion of our risk management activities, see the discussion below and pages 43 through 77.
Risk Management Governance
The Risk Framework describes delegations of authority whereby the Board and its committees may delegate authority to management-level committees or executive officers. Such delegations may authorize certain decision-making and approval functions, which may be evidenced in, for example, committee charters, job descriptions, meeting minutes and resolutions.
Bank
of America 2018 40
The chart below illustrates the inter-relationship among the Board, Board committees and management committees that have the majority of risk oversight responsibilities for the Corporation.
(1) This presentation does not include committees for other legal entities.
(2) Reports to the CEO and CFO with oversight by the Audit Committee.
Board of Directors and Board Committees
The
Board is composed of 16 directors, all but one of whom are independent. The Board authorizes management to maintain an effective Risk Framework, and oversees compliance with safe and sound banking practices. In addition, the Board or its committees conduct inquiries of, and receive reports from management on risk-related matters to assess scope or resource limitations that could impede the ability of Independent Risk Management (IRM) and/or Corporate Audit to execute its responsibilities. The Board committees discussed below have the principal responsibility for enterprise-wide oversight of our risk management activities. Through these activities, the Board and applicable committees are provided with information on our risk profile and oversee executive management addressing key risks we face. Other Board committees, as described below, provide additional oversight of specific risks.
Each of the committees shown on the above
chart regularly reports to the Board on risk-related matters within the committee’s responsibilities, which is intended to collectively provide the Board with integrated insight about our management of enterprise-wide risks.
Audit Committee
The Audit Committee oversees the qualifications, performance and independence of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm, the performance of our corporate audit function, the integrity of our consolidated financial statements, our compliance with legal and regulatory requirements, and makes inquiries of management or the Corporate General Auditor (CGA) to determine whether there are scope or resource limitations that impede the ability of Corporate Audit to execute its responsibilities. The Audit Committee is also responsible for overseeing compliance risk pursuant to the New York Stock Exchange listing standards.
Enterprise
Risk Committee
The ERC has primary responsibility for oversight of the Risk Framework and key risks we face and of the Corporation’s overall risk appetite. It approves the Risk Framework and the Risk Appetite Statement and further recommends these documents to the Board for approval. The ERC oversees senior management’s
responsibilities for the identification, measurement, monitoring and control of key risks we face. The ERC may consult with other Board committees on risk-related matters.
Other Board Committees
Our Corporate Governance Committee oversees our Board’s governance processes, identifies and reviews the qualifications of potential Board members, recommends nominees for election to our Board, recommends committee appointments for Board
approval and reviews our Environmental, Social and Governance and stockholder engagement activities.
Our Compensation and Benefits Committee oversees establishing, maintaining and administering our compensation programs and employee benefit plans, including approving and recommending our Chief Executive Officer’s (CEO) compensation to our Board for further approval by all independent directors, and reviewing and approving all of our executive officers’ compensation, as well as compensation for non-management directors.
Management Committees
Management committees may receive their authority from the Board, a Board committee, another management committee or from one or more executive officers. Our primary management-level risk committee is the Management Risk Committee (MRC). Subject to Board oversight, the MRC is responsible for management
oversight of key risks facing the Corporation. This includes providing management oversight of our compliance and operational risk programs, balance sheet and capital management, funding activities and other liquidity activities, stress testing, trading activities, recovery and resolution planning, model risk, subsidiary governance and activities between member banks and their nonbank affiliates pursuant to Federal Reserve rules and regulations, among other things.
Lines of Defense
We have clear ownership and accountability across three lines of defense: Front Line Units (FLUs), IRM and Corporate Audit. We also have control functions outside of FLUs and IRM (e.g., Legal and Global Human Resources). The three lines of defense are
41Bank
of America 2018
integrated into our management-level governance structure. Each of these functional roles is described in more detail below.
Executive Officers
Executive officers lead various functions representing the functional roles. Authority for functional roles may be delegated to executive officers from the Board, Board committees or management-level committees. Executive officers, in turn, may further
delegate responsibilities, as appropriate, to management-level committees, management routines or individuals. Executive officers review our activities for consistency with our Risk Framework, Risk Appetite Statement and applicable strategic, capital and financial operating plans, as well as applicable policies, standards, procedures and processes. Executive officers and other employees make decisions individually on a day-to-day basis, consistent with the authority they have been delegated. Executive officers and other employees may also serve on committees and participate in committee decisions.
Front Line Units
FLUs, which include the lines of business as well as the Global Technology and Operations Group, are responsible for appropriately assessing and effectively managing all of the risks associated with their activities.
Three
organizational units that include FLU activities and control function activities, but are not part of IRM are the Chief Financial Officer (CFO) Group, Global Marketing and Corporate Affairs (GM&CA) and the Chief Administrative Officer (CAO) Group.
Independent Risk Management
IRM is part of our control functions and includes Global Risk Management and Global Compliance and Operational Risk. We have other control functions that are not part of IRM (other control functions may also provide oversight to FLU activities), including Legal, Global Human Resources and certain activities within the CAO Group, CFO Group and GM&CA. IRM, led by the Chief Risk Officer (CRO), is responsible for independently assessing and overseeing risks within FLUs and other control functions. IRM establishes written enterprise policies and procedures that include concentration risk limits, where appropriate.
Such policies and procedures outline how aggregate risks are identified, measured, monitored and controlled.
The CRO has the stature, authority and independence to develop and implement a meaningful risk management framework. The CRO has unrestricted access to the Board and reports directly to both the ERC and to the CEO. Global Risk Management is organized into horizontal risk teams, front line unit risk teams and control function risk teams that work collaboratively in executing their respective duties.
Corporate Audit
Corporate Audit and the CGA maintain their independence from the FLUs, IRM and other control functions by reporting directly to the Audit Committee or the Board. The CGA administratively reports to the CEO. Corporate Audit provides independent assessment and validation through testing of key processes and controls across
the Corporation. Corporate Audit includes Credit Review which periodically tests and examines credit portfolios and processes.
Risk Management Processes
The Risk Framework requires that strong risk management practices are integrated in key strategic, capital and financial planning processes and in day-to-day business processes across
the Corporation, with a goal of ensuring risks are appropriately considered, evaluated and responded to in a timely manner.
We employ our risk management process, referred to as Identify, Measure, Monitor and Control, as part of our daily activities.
Identify – To be effectively managed, risks must be clearly defined and proactively identified. Proper
risk identification focuses on recognizing and understanding key risks inherent in our business activities or key risks that may arise from external factors. Each employee is expected to identify and escalate risks promptly. Risk identification is an ongoing process, incorporating input from FLUs and control functions, designed to be forward looking and capture relevant risk factors across all of our lines of business.
Measure –Once a risk is identified, it must be prioritized and accurately measured through a systematic risk quantification process including quantitative and qualitative components. Risk is measured at various levels including, but not limited to, risk type, FLU, legal entity and on an aggregate basis. This risk quantification process helps to capture changes in our risk profile due to changes in strategic direction, concentrations, portfolio quality and the
overall economic environment. Senior management considers how risk exposures might evolve under a variety of stress scenarios.
Monitor –We monitor risk levels regularly to track adherence to risk appetite, policies, standards, procedures and processes. We also regularly update risk assessments and review risk exposures. Through our monitoring, we can determine our level of risk relative to limits and can take action in a timely manner. We also can determine when risk limits are breached and have processes to appropriately report and escalate exceptions. This includes requests for approval to managers and alerts to executive management, management-level committees or the Board (directly or through an appropriate committee).
Control –We establish and communicate risk limits and controls
through policies, standards, procedures and processes that define the responsibilities and authority for risk-taking. The limits and controls can be adjusted by the Board or management when conditions or risk tolerances warrant. These limits may be absolute (e.g., loan amount, trading volume) or relative (e.g., percentage of loan book in higher-risk categories). Our lines of business are held accountable to perform within the established limits.
The formal processes used to manage risk represent a part of our overall risk management process. We instill a strong and comprehensive culture of managing risk well through communications, training, policies, procedures and organizational roles and responsibilities. Establishing a culture reflective of our purpose to help make our customers’ financial lives better and delivering our responsible growth strategy are also critical to effective risk management. We understand that improper
actions, behaviors or practices that are illegal, unethical or contrary to our core values could result in harm to the Corporation, our shareholders or our customers, damage the integrity of the financial markets, or negatively impact our reputation, and have established protocols and structures so that such conduct risk is governed and reported across the Corporation. Specifically, our Code of Conduct provides a framework for all of our employees to conduct themselves with the highest integrity. Additionally, we continue to strengthen the link between the employee performance management process and individual compensation to encourage employees to work toward enterprise-wide risk goals.
Bank
of America 2018 42
Corporation-wide Stress Testing
Integral to our Capital Planning, Financial Planning and Strategic Planning processes, we conduct capital scenario management and stress forecasting on a periodic basis to better understand balance sheet, earnings and capital sensitivities to certain economic and business scenarios, including economic and market conditions that are more severe than anticipated. These stress forecasts provide an understanding of the potential impacts from our risk profile on the balance sheet, earnings and capital, and serve as a key component of our capital and risk management practices. The intent of stress testing is to develop a comprehensive understanding of potential impacts of on- and off-balance
sheet risks at the Corporation and how they impact financial resiliency, which provides confidence to management, regulators and our investors.
Contingency Planning
We have developed and maintain contingency plans that are designed to prepare us in advance to respond in the event of potential adverse economic, financial or market stress. These contingency plans include our Capital Contingency Plan and Financial Contingency and Recovery Plan, which provide monitoring, escalation, actions and routines designed to enable us to increase capital, access funding sources and reduce risk through consideration of potential options that include asset sales, business sales, capital or debt issuances, or other de-risking strategies. We also maintain a Resolution Plan to limit adverse systemic impacts that could be associated with a potential resolution of Bank of America.
Strategic
Risk Management
Strategic risk is embedded in every business and is one of the major risk categories along with credit, market, liquidity, compliance, operational and reputational risks. This risk results from incorrect assumptions about external or internal factors, inappropriate business plans, ineffective business strategy execution, or failure to respond in a timely manner to changes in the regulatory, macroeconomic or competitive environments, in the geographic locations in which we operate, such as competitor actions, changing customer preferences, product obsolescence and technology developments. Our strategic plan is consistent with our risk appetite, capital plan and liquidity requirements, and specifically addresses strategic risks.
On an annual basis, the Board reviews and approves the strategic plan, capital plan, financial operating plan and Risk Appetite Statement.
With oversight by the Board, executive management directs the lines of business to execute our strategic plan consistent with our core operating principles and risk appetite. The executive management team monitors business performance throughout the year and provides the Board with regular progress reports on whether strategic objectives and timelines are being met, including reports on strategic risks and if additional or alternative actions need to be considered or implemented. The regular executive reviews focus on assessing forecasted earnings and returns on capital, the current risk profile, current capital and liquidity requirements, staffing levels and changes required to support the strategic plan, stress testing results, and other qualitative factors such as market growth rates and peer analysis.
Significant strategic actions, such as capital actions, material acquisitions or divestitures, and resolution plans are
reviewed and approved by the Board. At the business level, processes are in place to discuss the strategic risk implications of new, expanded or modified businesses, products or services and other strategic initiatives, and to provide formal review and approval where
required. With oversight by the Board and the ERC, executive management performs similar analyses throughout the year, and evaluates changes to the financial forecast or the risk, capital or liquidity positions as deemed appropriate to balance and optimize achieving the targeted risk appetite, shareholder returns and maintaining the targeted financial strength. Proprietary models are used to measure the capital requirements for credit, country, market, operational and strategic risks. The allocated capital assigned to each business is based on its unique risk profile. With oversight by the Board, executive management
assesses the risk-adjusted returns of each business in approving strategic and financial operating plans. The businesses use allocated capital to define business strategies, and price products and transactions.
Capital Management
The Corporation manages its capital position so that its capital is more than adequate to support its business activities and aligns with risk, risk appetite and strategic planning. Additionally, we seek to maintain safety and soundness at all times, even under adverse scenarios, take advantage of organic growth opportunities, meet obligations to creditors and counterparties, maintain ready access to financial markets, continue to serve as a credit intermediary, remain a source of strength for our subsidiaries,
and satisfy current and future regulatory capital requirements. Capital management is integrated into our risk and governance processes, as capital is a key consideration in the development of our strategic plan, risk appetite and risk limits.
We conduct an Internal Capital Adequacy Assessment Process (ICAAP) on a periodic basis. The ICAAP is a forward-looking assessment of our projected capital needs and resources, incorporating earnings, balance sheet and risk forecasts under baseline and adverse economic and market conditions. We utilize periodic stress tests to assess the potential impacts to our balance sheet, earnings, regulatory capital and liquidity under a variety of stress scenarios. We perform qualitative risk assessments to identify and assess material risks not fully captured in our forecasts or stress tests. We assess the potential capital impacts of proposed changes to regulatory capital requirements. Management
assesses ICAAP results and provides documented quarterly assessments of the adequacy of our capital guidelines and capital position to the Board or its committees.
We periodically review capital allocated to our businesses and allocate capital annually during the strategic and capital planning processes. For additional information, see Business Segment Operations on page 30.
CCAR and Capital Planning
The Federal Reserve requires BHCs to submit a capital plan and requests for capital actions on an annual basis, consistent with the rules governing the CCAR capital plan.
On June 28, 2018, following the Federal Reserve’s non-objection to our 2018 CCAR
capital plan, the Board authorized the repurchase of approximately $20.6 billion in common stock from July 1, 2018 through June 30, 2019, which includes approximately $600 million in repurchases to offset shares awarded under equity-based compensation plans during the same period. In addition to the previously announced repurchases associated with the 2018 CCAR capital plan, on February 7, 2019, we announced a plan to repurchase an additional $2.5 billion of common stock through June 30, 2019, which was approved by the Federal Reserve.
During 2018, pursuant to the Board’s authorizations, including those related to our 2017 CCAR capital
plan that expired June 30, 2018, we repurchased $20.1 billion of common stock, which includes common stock repurchases to offset equity-based
43Bank of America 2018
compensation
awards. At December 31, 2018, our remaining stock repurchase authorization was $10.3 billion.
Our stock repurchases are subject to various factors, including the Corporation’s capital position, liquidity, financial performance and alternative uses of capital, stock trading price and general market conditions, and may be suspended at any time. The repurchases may be effected through open market purchases or privately negotiated transactions, including repurchase plans that satisfy the conditions of Rule 10b5-1 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. As a “well-capitalized” BHC, we may notify the Federal Reserve of our intention to make additional capital distributions not to exceed 0.25 percent of Tier 1 capital, and which were not contemplated in our capital plan, subject to the Federal Reserve’s non-objection.
Regulatory
Capital
As a financial services holding company, we are subject to regulatory capital rules, including Basel 3, issued by U.S. banking regulators. Basel 3 established minimum capital ratios and buffer requirements and outlined two methods of calculating risk-weighted assets, the Standardized approach and the Advanced approaches. The Standardized approach relies primarily on supervisory risk weights based on exposure type, and the Advanced approaches determine risk weights based on internal models.
The Corporation and its primary affiliated banking entity, BANA, are Advanced approaches institutions under Basel 3 and are required to report regulatory risk-based capital ratios and risk-weighted assets under both the Standardized and Advanced approaches. The approach that yields the lower ratio is used to assess capital adequacy including under the Prompt Corrective Action (PCA) framework.
As of December 31, 2018, Common equity tier 1 (CET1) and Tier 1 capital ratios for the Corporation were lower under the Standardized approach whereas the Advanced approaches yielded a lower Total capital ratio.
Minimum Capital Requirements
Minimum capital requirements and related buffers were fully phased in as of January 1, 2019. The PCA framework established categories of capitalization, including well capitalized, based on the Basel 3 regulatory ratio requirements. U.S. banking regulators are required to take certain mandatory actions depending on the category of capitalization, with no mandatory actions required for well-capitalized banking organizations.
In
order to avoid restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments, the Corporation must meet risk-based capital ratio requirements that include a capital conservation buffer greater than 2.5 percent, plus any applicable countercyclical capital buffer and a global systemically important bank (G-SIB) surcharge. The buffers and surcharge must be comprised solely of CET1 capital and were phased in over a three-year period that ended January 1, 2019.
The Corporation is also required to maintain a minimum supplementary leverage ratio (SLR) of 3.0 percent plus a leverage buffer of 2.0 percent in order to avoid certain restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments. Our insured depository institution subsidiaries are required to maintain a minimum 6.0
percent SLR to be considered well capitalized under the PCA framework. The numerator of the SLR is quarter-end Basel 3 Tier 1 capital. The denominator is total leverage exposure based on the daily average of the sum of on-balance sheet exposures less permitted Tier 1 deductions, as well as the simple average of certain off-balance sheet exposures, as of the end of each month in a quarter.
Capital Composition and Ratios
Table 13 presents Bank of America Corporation’s capital ratios and related information in accordance with Basel 3Standardized and Advanced approaches as measured at December 31, 2018 and 2017. As of the periods presented, the Corporation met the definition
of well capitalized under current regulatory requirements.
Bank of America 2018 44
Table
13
Bank of America Corporation Regulatory Capital under Basel 3 (1)
Adjusted quarterly average assets (in billions) (5)
$
2,223
$
2,223
Tier
1 leverage ratio
8.6
%
8.6
%
4.0
4.0
(1)
Basel
3 transition provisions for regulatory capital adjustments and deductions were fully phased in as of January 1, 2018. Prior periods are presented on a fully phased-in basis.
(2)
The December 31, 2018 and 2017 amounts include a transition capital conservation buffer of 1.875 percent and 1.25 percent and a transition G-SIB surcharge of 1.875 percent and 1.5 percent.
The countercyclical capital buffer for both periods is zero.
(3)
The 2019 regulatory minimums include a capital conservation buffer of 2.5 percent and G-SIB surcharge of 2.5 percent. The countercyclical capital buffer is zero. We became subject to these regulatory minimums on January 1, 2019. The SLR minimum includes a leverage buffer of 2.0 percent and was applicable beginning on January 1, 2018.
(4)
Total
capital under the Advanced approaches differs from the Standardized approach due to differences in the amount permitted in Tier 2 capital related to the qualifying allowance for credit losses.
(5)
Reflects adjusted average total assets for the three months ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.
CET1 capital was $167.3 billion at December 31, 2018,
a decrease of $1.2 billion from December 31, 2017, driven by common stock repurchases, dividends and market value declines on AFS debt securities included in accumulated OCI, partially offset by earnings. During 2018, Total capital under the Advanced approaches decreased $2.4 billion driven by the same factors as CET1 capital and a decrease in subordinated debt included in Tier
2 capital. Standardized risk-weighted assets, which yielded the lower CET1 capital ratio for December 31, 2018, decreased $5.5 billion
during 2018 to $1,437 billion primarily due to sales of non-core mortgage loans and a decrease in market risk, partially offset by an increase in commercial loans.
Deferred
tax assets arising from net operating loss and tax credit carryforwards
(5,981
)
(6,555
)
Intangibles, other than mortgage servicing rights and goodwill, net of related deferred tax liabilities
(1,294
)
(1,743
)
Other
120
512
Common
equity tier 1 capital
167,272
168,461
Qualifying preferred stock, net of issuance cost
22,326
22,323
Other
(560
)
(595
)
Tier 1
capital
189,038
190,189
Tier 2 capital instruments
21,887
22,938
Eligible credit reserves included
in Tier 2 capital
1,972
2,272
Other
(19
)
(88
)
Total capital under the Advanced approaches
$
212,878
$
215,311
(1)
Basel
3 transition provisions for regulatory capital adjustments and deductions were fully phased in as of January 1, 2018. Prior periods are presented on a fully phased-in basis.
45Bank of America 2018
Table
15 shows the components of risk-weighted assets as measured under Basel 3 at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Table
15
Risk-weighted Assets under Basel 3 (1)
Standardized
Approach
Advanced Approaches
Standardized Approach
Advanced Approaches
December 31
(Dollars in billions)
2018
2017
Credit
risk
$
1,384
$
827
$
1,384
$
867
Market
risk
53
52
59
58
Operational risk
n/a
500
n/a
500
Risks
related to credit valuation adjustments
n/a
30
n/a
34
Total risk-weighted assets
$
1,437
$
1,409
$
1,443
$
1,459
(1)
Basel
3 transition provisions for regulatory capital adjustments and deductions were fully phased in as of January 1, 2018. Prior periods are presented on a fully phased-in basis.
n/a = not applicable
Bank of America, N.A. Regulatory Capital
Table 16 presents regulatory capital information for BANA in accordance with Basel 3 Standardized and Advanced approaches as measured at December 31, 2018 and 2017. BANA met the definition of well capitalized under the PCA framework for both periods.
Table
16
Bank of America, N.A. Regulatory Capital under Basel 3
Percent
required to meet guidelines to be considered well capitalized under the PCA framework.
Regulatory Developments
Minimum Total Loss-Absorbing Capacity
The Federal Reserve’s final rule, which was effective January 1, 2019, includes minimum external total loss-absorbing capacity (TLAC) and long-term debt requirements to improve the resolvability and resiliency of large, interconnected BHCs. As of December 31, 2018, the Corporation’s TLAC and long-term debt exceeded our estimated 2019 minimum requirements.
Stress Buffer Requirements
On April
10, 2018, the Federal Reserve announced a proposal to integrate the annual quantitative assessment of the CCAR program with the buffer requirements in the Basel 3 capital rule by introducing stress buffer requirements as a replacement of the CCAR quantitative objection. Under the Standardized approach, the proposal replaces the existing static 2.5 percent capital conservation buffer with a stress capital buffer, calculated as the decrease in the CET1 capital ratio in the supervisory severely adverse scenario of the modified CCAR stress test plus four quarters of planned common stock dividend payments, floored at 2.5 percent. The static 2.5 percent capital conservation buffer would be retained under the Advanced approaches. The proposal also introduces a stress leverage buffer requirement which would be calculated as the decrease in the Tier 1 leverage ratio in the supervisory severely adverse scenario of the modified CCAR stress test plus four quarters of planned
common stock dividends, with
no floor. The SLR would not incorporate a stress buffer requirement. The proposal also updates the capital distribution assumptions used in the CCAR stress test to better align with a firm’s expected actions in stress, notably removing the assumption that a BHC will carry out all of its planned capital actions under stress.
Enhanced Supplementary Leverage Ratio and TLAC Requirements
On April 11, 2018, the Federal Reserve and Office of the Comptroller of the Currency announced a proposal to modify the enhanced SLR standards applicable to U.S. G-SIBs and their insured depository institution subsidiaries. The proposal replaces
the existing 2.0 percent leverage buffer with a leverage buffer tailored to each G-SIB, set at 50 percent of the applicable G-SIB surcharge. This proposal also replaces the current 6.0 percent threshold at which a G-SIB’s insured depository institution subsidiaries are considered well capitalized under the PCA framework with a threshold set at 3.0 percent plus 50 percent of the G-SIB surcharge applicable to the subsidiary’s G-SIB holding company. Correspondingly, the proposal updates the external TLAC leverage buffer for each G-SIB to 50 percent of the applicable G-SIB surcharge and revises the leverage component of the minimum external long-term debt requirement from 4.5 percent to 2.5 percent plus 50 percent of the applicable G-SIB surcharge.
Bank
of America 2018 46
Revisions to Basel 3 to Address Current Expected Credit Loss Accounting
On December 18, 2018, the U.S. banking regulators issued a final rule to address the regulatory capital impact of using the current expected credit loss methodology to measure credit reserves under a new accounting standard that is effective on January 1, 2020. For more information on this standard, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principlesto the Consolidated Financial Statements. The final rule provides an option to phase in the
impact to regulatory capital over a three-year period on a straight-line basis. It also updates the existing regulatory capital framework by creating a new defined term, adjusted allowance for credit losses, which would include credit losses on all financial instruments measured at amortized cost with the exception of purchased credit-deteriorated assets. The final rule continues to allow a limited amount of credit losses to be recognized in Tier 2 capital and maintains the existing limits under the Standardized and Advanced approaches.
Single-Counterparty Credit Limits
On June 14, 2018, the Federal Reserve published a final rule establishing single-counterparty credit limits (SCCL) for BHCs with total consolidated assets of $250 billion or more. The SCCL rule is designed to ensure that the maximum possible loss that a BHC could
incur due to the default of a single counterparty or a group of connected counterparties would not endanger the BHC’s survival, thereby reducing the probability of future financial crises. Beginning January 1, 2020, G-SIBs must calculate SCCL on a daily basis by dividing the aggregate net credit exposure to a given counterparty by the G-SIB’s Tier 1 capital, ensuring that exposures to other G-SIBs and nonbank financial institutions regulated by the Federal Reserve do not breach 15 percent of Tier 1 capital and exposures to most other counterparties do not breach 25 percent of Tier 1 capital. Certain exposures, including exposures to the U.S. government, U.S. government-sponsored entities and qualifying central counterparties, are exempt from the credit limits.
Broker-dealer Regulatory Capital and Securities Regulation
The Corporation’s
principal U.S. broker-dealer subsidiaries are Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated (MLPF&S) and Merrill Lynch Professional Clearing Corp (MLPCC). MLPCC is a fully-guaranteed subsidiary of MLPF&S and provides clearing and settlement services. Both entities are subject to the net capital requirements of Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) Rule 15c3-1. Both entities are also registered as futures commission merchants and are subject to the Commodity Futures Trading Commission Regulation 1.17.
MLPF&S has elected to compute the minimum capital requirement in accordance with the Alternative Net Capital Requirement as permitted by SEC Rule 15c3-1. At December 31, 2018, MLPF&S’ regulatory net capital as defined
by Rule 15c3-1 was $13.4 billion and exceeded the minimum requirement of $2.0 billion by $11.4 billion. MLPCC’s net capital of $4.4 billion exceeded the minimum requirement of $617 million by $3.8 billion.
In accordance with the Alternative Net Capital Requirements, MLPF&S is required to maintain tentative net capital in excess of $1.0 billion, net capital in excess of $500 million and notify the SEC in the event its tentative net capital is less than $5.0 billion. At December 31, 2018, MLPF&S had tentative net capital and net capital in excess of the minimum and notification requirements.
As a result of resolution planning, the current business of MLPF&S is expected to be reorganized into two affiliated broker-
dealers:
MLPF&S and BofA Securities, Inc., a newly formed broker-dealer. Under the contemplated reorganization, which is expected to occur during 2019, BofA Securities, Inc. would become the legal entity for the institutional services that are now provided by MLPF&S. MLPF&S’ retail services would remain with MLPF&S. The contemplated reorganization is subject to regulatory approval. For more information on resolution planning, see Item 1. Business. – .Resolution Planning.
Merrill Lynch International (MLI), a U.K. investment firm, is regulated by the Prudential Regulation Authority and the FCA, and is subject to certain regulatory capital requirements. At December 31, 2018, MLI’s
capital resources were $35.0 billion, which exceeded the minimum Pillar 1 requirement of $12.7 billion.
Liquidity Risk
Funding and Liquidity Risk Management
Our primary liquidity risk management objective is to meet expected or unexpected cash flow and collateral needs while continuing to support our businesses and customers under a range of economic conditions. To achieve that objective, we analyze and monitor our liquidity risk under expected and stressed conditions, maintain liquidity and access to diverse funding sources, including our stable deposit base, and seek to align liquidity-related incentives and risks.
We define liquidity as readily available assets, limited
to cash and high-quality, liquid, unencumbered securities that we can use to meet our contractual and contingent financial obligations as those obligations arise. We manage our liquidity position through line of business and ALM activities, as well as through our legal entity funding strategy, on both a forward and current (including intraday) basis under both expected and stressed conditions. We believe that a centralized approach to funding and liquidity management enhances our ability to monitor liquidity requirements, maximizes access to funding sources, minimizes borrowing costs and facilitates timely responses to liquidity events.
The Board approves our liquidity risk policy and the Financial Contingency and Recovery Plan. The ERC establishes our liquidity risk tolerance levels. The MRC is responsible for overseeing liquidity risks and directing management to maintain exposures within the established tolerance levels.
The MRC reviews and monitors our liquidity position and stress testing results, approves certain liquidity risk limits and reviews the impact of strategic decisions on our liquidity. For more information, see Managing Risk on page 40. Under this governance framework, we have developed certain funding and liquidity risk management practices which include: maintaining liquidity at the parent company and selected subsidiaries, including our bank subsidiaries and other regulated entities; determining what amounts of liquidity are appropriate for these entities based on analysis of debt maturities and other potential cash outflows, including those that we may experience during stressed market conditions;
diversifying funding sources, considering our asset profile and legal entity structure; and performing contingency planning.
NB Holdings Corporation
We have intercompany arrangements with certain key subsidiaries under which we transferred certain assets of Bank of America Corporation, as the parent company, which is a separate and distinct legal entity from our banking and nonbank subsidiaries, and agreed to transfer certain additional parent company assets not needed to satisfy anticipated near-term expenditures, to NB Holdings Corporation, a wholly-owned holding company subsidiary
47Bank
of America 2018
(NB Holdings). The parent company is expected to continue to have access to the same flow of dividends, interest and other amounts of cash necessary to service its debt, pay dividends and perform other obligations as it would have had if it had not entered into these arrangements and transferred any assets.
In consideration for the transfer of assets, NB Holdings issued a subordinated note to the parent company in a principal amount equal
to the value of the transferred assets. The aggregate principal amount of the note will increase by the amount of any future asset transfers. NB Holdings also provided the parent company with a committed line of credit that allows the parent company to draw funds necessary to service near-term cash needs. These arrangements support our preferred single point of entry resolution strategy, under which only the parent company would be resolved under the U.S. Bankruptcy Code. These arrangements include provisions to terminate the line of credit, forgive the subordinated note and require the parent company to transfer its remaining financial assets to NB Holdings if our projected liquidity resources deteriorate so severely that resolution of the parent company becomes imminent.
Global Liquidity Sources and Other Unencumbered Assets
We maintain liquidity available to the Corporation,
including the parent company and selected subsidiaries, in the form of cash and high-quality, liquid, unencumbered securities. Our liquidity buffer, referred to as Global Liquidity Sources (GLS), is comprised of assets that are readily available to the parent company and selected subsidiaries, including holding company, bank and broker-dealer subsidiaries, even during stressed market conditions. Our cash is primarily on deposit with the Federal Reserve Bank and, to a lesser extent, central banks outside of the U.S. We limit the composition of high-quality, liquid, unencumbered securities to U.S. government securities, U.S. agency securities, U.S. agency MBS and a select group of non-U.S. government securities.
We can quickly obtain cash for these securities, even in stressed conditions, through repurchase agreements or outright sales. We hold our GLS in legal entities that allow us to meet the liquidity requirements of our global businesses, and we consider the impact of potential regulatory, tax, legal and other restrictions that could limit the transferability of funds among entities.
Table 17 presents average GLS for the three months ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Typically,
parent company and NB Holdings liquidity is in the form of cash deposited with BANA.
Our bank subsidiaries’ liquidity is primarily driven by deposit and lending activity, as well as securities valuation and net debt activity. Liquidity at bank subsidiaries excludes the cash deposited by the parent company and NB Holdings. Our bank subsidiaries can also generate incremental liquidity by pledging a range of unencumbered loans and securities to certain FHLBs and the Federal Reserve Discount Window. The cash we could have obtained by borrowing against this pool of specifically-identified eligible assets was $344 billion
and $308 billion at December 31,
2018 and 2017. We have established operational procedures to enable us to borrow against these assets, including regularly monitoring our total pool of eligible loans and securities collateral. Eligibility is defined in guidelines from the FHLBs and the Federal Reserve and is subject to change at their discretion. Due to regulatory restrictions, liquidity generated by the bank subsidiaries can generally be used only to fund obligations within the bank subsidiaries,
and transfers to the parent company or nonbank subsidiaries may be subject to prior regulatory approval.
Liquidity held in other regulated entities, comprised primarily of broker-dealer subsidiaries, is primarily available to meet the obligations of that entity and transfers to the parent company or to any other subsidiary may be subject to prior regulatory approval due to regulatory restrictions and minimum requirements. Our other regulated entities also hold unencumbered investment-grade securities and equities that we believe could be used to generate additional liquidity.
Table 18 presents the composition of average GLS for the three months ended December
31, 2018 and 2017.
Table 18
Average Global Liquidity Sources Composition
Three
Months Ended December 31
(Dollars in billions)
2018
2017
Cash on deposit
$
113
$
118
U.S.
Treasury securities
81
62
U.S. agency securities and mortgage-backed securities
340
330
Non-U.S. government
securities
10
12
Total Average Global Liquidity Sources
$
544
$
522
Our
GLS are substantially the same in composition to what qualifies as High Quality Liquid Assets (HQLA) under the final U.S. Liquidity Coverage Ratio (LCR) rules. However, HQLA for purposes of calculating LCR is not reported at market value, but at a lower value that incorporates regulatory deductions and the exclusion of excess liquidity held at certain subsidiaries. The LCR is calculated as the amount of a financial institution’s unencumbered HQLA relative to the estimated net cash outflows the institution could encounter over a 30-day period of significant liquidity stress, expressed as a percentage. Our average consolidated HQLA, on a net basis, was $446 billion and $439 billion for the three months ended December
31, 2018 and 2017. For the same periods, the average consolidated LCR was 118 percent and 125 percent. Our LCR will fluctuate due to normal business flows from customer activity.
Liquidity Stress Analysis
We utilize liquidity stress analysis to assist us in determining the appropriate amounts of liquidity to maintain at the parent company and our subsidiaries to meet contractual and contingent cash outflows under a range of scenarios. The scenarios we consider and utilize incorporate market-wide and Corporation-specific events, including potential credit rating downgrades
for the parent company and our subsidiaries, and more severe events including potential resolution scenarios. The scenarios are based on our historical experience, experience of distressed and failed financial institutions, regulatory guidance, and both expected and unexpected future events.
The types of potential contractual and contingent cash outflows we consider in our scenarios may include, but are not limited to, upcoming contractual maturities of unsecured debt and reductions in new debt issuance; diminished access to secured financing markets; potential deposit withdrawals; increased draws on loan
Bank
of America 2018 48
commitments, liquidity facilities and letters of credit; additional collateral that counterparties could call if our credit ratings were downgraded; collateral and margin requirements arising from market value changes; and potential liquidity required to maintain businesses and finance customer activities. Changes in certain market factors, including, but not limited to, credit rating downgrades, could negatively impact potential contractual and contingent outflows and the related financial instruments, and in some cases these impacts could be material to our financial results.
We consider all sources of funds that we could access during each stress scenario and focus particularly on matching available sources
with corresponding liquidity requirements by legal entity. We also use the stress modeling results to manage our asset and liability profile and establish limits and guidelines on certain funding sources and businesses.
Net Stable Funding Ratio
U.S. banking regulators issued a proposal for a Net Stable Funding Ratio (NSFR) requirement applicable to U.S. financial institutions following the Basel Committee’s final standard. The proposed U.S. NSFR would apply to the Corporation on a consolidated basis and to our insured depository institutions. While the final requirement remains pending and is subject to change, if finalized as proposed, we expect to be in compliance within the regulatory timeline. The standard is intended to reduce funding risk over a longer time horizon. The NSFR is designed to provide an appropriate amount of stable funding, generally capital and liabilities maturing
beyond one year, given the mix of assets and off-balance sheet items.
Diversified Funding Sources
We fund our assets primarily with a mix of deposits, and secured and unsecured liabilities through a centralized, globally coordinated funding approach diversified across products, programs, markets, currencies and investor groups.
The primary benefits of our centralized funding approach include greater control, reduced funding costs, wider name recognition by investors and greater flexibility to meet the variable funding requirements of subsidiaries. Where regulations, time zone differences or other business considerations make parent company funding impractical, certain other subsidiaries
may issue their own debt.
We fund a substantial portion of our lending activities through our deposits, which were $1.38 trillion and $1.31 trillion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Deposits are primarily generated by our Consumer Banking, GWIM and Global Banking segments. These deposits are diversified by clients, product type and geography, and the majority of our U.S. deposits are insured by the FDIC. We consider a substantial portion of our deposits to be a stable, low-cost and consistent source
of funding. We believe this deposit funding is generally less sensitive to interest rate changes, market volatility or changes in our credit ratings than wholesale funding sources. Our lending activities may also be financed through secured borrowings, including credit card securitizations and securitizations with government-sponsored enterprises (GSE), the Federal Housing Administration (FHA) and private-label investors, as well as FHLB loans.
Our trading activities in other regulated entities are primarily funded on a secured basis through securities lending and repurchase agreements, and these amounts will vary based on customer activity and market conditions. We believe funding these activities in the secured financing markets is more cost-efficient and less sensitive to changes in our credit ratings than unsecured financing. Repurchase agreements are generally short-term and
often
overnight. Disruptions in secured financing markets for financial institutions have occurred in prior market cycles which resulted in adverse changes in terms or significant reductions in the availability of such financing. We manage the liquidity risks arising from secured funding by sourcing funding globally from a diverse group of counterparties, providing a range of securities collateral and pursuing longer durations, when appropriate. For more information on secured financing agreements, see Note 10 – Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and Restricted Cashto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
We issue long-term unsecured debt in a variety of maturities and currencies to achieve cost-efficient funding and to maintain an appropriate maturity profile. While the cost and
availability of unsecured funding may be negatively impacted by general market conditions or by matters specific to the financial services industry or the Corporation, we seek to mitigate refinancing risk by actively managing the amount of our borrowings that we anticipate will mature within any month or quarter.
Table 19 presents our long-term debt by major currency at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Table
19
Long-term Debt by Major Currency
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
U.S. dollar
$
180,709
$
175,623
Euro
34,296
35,481
British
pound
5,450
7,016
Japanese yen
3,036
2,993
Canadian dollar
2,935
1,966
Australian
dollar
1,722
3,046
Other
1,192
1,277
Total long-term debt
$
229,340
$
227,402
Total
long-term debt increased$1.9 billion during 2018, primarily due to issuances outpacing maturities and redemptions. We may, from time to time, purchase outstanding debt instruments in various transactions, depending on market conditions, liquidity and other factors. Our other regulated entities may also make markets in our debt instruments to provide liquidity for investors. For more information on long-term debt funding, see Note 11 – Long-term Debtto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
During 2018, we issued $64.4 billion of long-term debt consisting of $30.7 billion
for Bank of America Corporation, substantially all of which was TLAC compliant, $18.7 billion for Bank of America, N.A. and $15.0 billion of other debt. During 2017, we issued $53.3 billion of long-term debt consisting of $37.7 billion for Bank of America Corporation, substantially all of which was TLAC compliant, $8.2 billion for Bank of America, N.A. and $7.4 billion of other debt.
During 2018, we had total long-term debt maturities and redemptions in the aggregate of $53.3 billion consisting of $29.8
billion for Bank of America Corporation, $11.2 billion for Bank of America, N.A. and $12.3 billion of other debt. During 2017, we had total long-term debt maturities and redemptions in the aggregate of $48.8 billion consisting of $29.1 billion for Bank of America Corporation, $13.3 billion for Bank of America, N.A. and $6.4 billion of other debt.
During 2018, we redeemed trust preferred securities of 11 trusts with a carrying value of $3.1 billion
and recorded a charge of $729 million in other income. We also collapsed two trusts, with no financial statement impact, that held fixed-rate junior subordinated notes with a carrying value of $741 million that were
We use derivative transactions to manage the duration, interest rate and currency risks of our borrowings, considering the characteristics of the assets they are funding. For more information on our ALM activities, see Interest Rate Risk Management for the Banking Book on page 74.
We may also issue unsecured debt in the form of structured notes for client purposes, certain of which qualify as TLAC eligible debt. During 2018,
we issued $6.9 billion of structured notes, which are debt obligations that pay investors returns linked to other debt or equity securities, indices, currencies or commodities. We typically hedge the returns we are obligated to pay on these liabilities with derivatives and/or investments in the underlying instruments, so that from a funding perspective, the cost is similar to our other unsecured long-term debt. We could be required to settle certain structured note obligations for cash or other securities prior to maturity under certain circumstances, which we consider for liquidity planning purposes. We believe, however, that a portion of such borrowings will remain outstanding beyond the earliest put or redemption date.
Substantially all of our senior and subordinated debt obligations contain no provisions that could trigger a requirement for an early repayment, require additional
collateral support, result in changes to terms, accelerate maturity or create additional financial obligations upon an adverse change in our credit ratings, financial ratios, earnings, cash flows or stock price.
Contingency Planning
We maintain contingency funding plans that outline our potential responses to liquidity stress events at various levels of severity. These policies and plans are based on stress scenarios and include potential funding strategies and communication and notification procedures that we would implement in the event we experienced stressed liquidity conditions. We periodically review and test the contingency funding plans to validate efficacy and assess readiness.
Our U.S. bank subsidiaries can access contingency funding through
the Federal Reserve Discount Window. Certain non-U.S. subsidiaries have access to central bank facilities in the jurisdictions in which they operate. While we do not rely on these sources in our liquidity modeling, we maintain the policies, procedures and governance processes that would enable us to access these sources if necessary.
Credit Ratings
Our borrowing costs and ability to raise funds are impacted by our credit ratings. In addition, credit ratings may be important to customers or counterparties when we compete in certain markets and when we seek to engage in certain transactions, including over-the-counter (OTC) derivatives. Thus, it is our objective to maintain high-quality credit ratings, and management maintains an active dialogue with the major rating agencies.
Credit
ratings and outlooks are opinions expressed by rating agencies on our creditworthiness and that of our obligations
or securities, including long-term debt, short-term borrowings, preferred stock and other securities, including asset securitizations. Our credit ratings are subject to ongoing review by the rating agencies, and they consider a number of factors, including our own financial strength, performance, prospects and operations as well as factors not under our control. The rating agencies could make adjustments to our ratings at any time, and they provide no assurances that they will maintain our ratings at current levels.
Other factors that influence our credit ratings include changes to the rating agencies’ methodologies for our industry or certain security types; the rating agencies’ assessment of the general operating
environment for financial services companies; our relative positions in the markets in which we compete; our various risk exposures and risk management policies and activities; pending litigation and other contingencies or potential tail risks; our reputation; our liquidity position, diversity of funding sources and funding costs; the current and expected level and volatility of our earnings; our capital position and capital management practices; our corporate governance; the sovereign credit ratings of the U.S. government; current or future regulatory and legislative initiatives; and the agencies’ views on whether the U.S. government would provide meaningful support to the Corporation or its subsidiaries in a crisis.
On December 5, 2018, Moody’s Investors Service (Moody’s) placed the
long-term and short-term ratings of the Corporation as well as the long-term ratings of its rated subsidiaries, including BANA, on review for upgrade. The agency cited the Corporation’s strengthening profitability, continued adherence to a conservative risk profile, and stable capital ratios as drivers of the review. A rating review indicates that those ratings are under consideration for a change in the near term, which typically concludes within 90 days. Moody’s concurrently affirmed the short-term ratings of the Corporation’s rated subsidiaries, including BANA.
The ratings from Standard & Poor’s Global Ratings (S&P) for the Corporation and its subsidiaries
did not change during 2018. The last change to the ratings from S&P was a one-notch upgrade of the Corporation’s long-term ratings in November 2017.
On June 21, 2018, Fitch Ratings (Fitch) upgraded the Corporation’s long-term senior debt rating to A+ from A as part of the agency’s latest review of 12 Global Trading & Investment Banks, citing our sustained and improved risk-adjusted earnings, lower risk appetite relative to peers, overall franchise strength and solid liquidity position. The Corporation’s short-term debt rating of F1 was affirmed. Additionally, Fitch upgraded the long- and short-term debt ratings of the Corporation’s rated U.S. subsidiaries, including BANA and MLPF&S, and upgraded the long-term
debt ratings of our rated international subsidiaries, including MLI. The outlook at Fitch remains stable for all long-term debt ratings.
Table 20 presents the Corporation’s current long-term/short-term senior debt ratings and outlooks expressed by the rating agencies.
Bank of America 2018 50
Table
20
Senior Debt Ratings
Moody’s Investors Service
Standard & Poor’s Global Ratings
Fitch Ratings
Long-term
Short-term
Outlook
Long-term
Short-term
Outlook
Long-term
Short-term
Outlook
Bank
of America Corporation
A3
P-2
Review for upgrade
A-
A-2
Stable
A+
F1
Stable
Bank
of America, N.A.
Aa3
P-1
Review for upgrade (1)
A+
A-1
Stable
AA-
F1+
Stable
Merrill
Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated
NR
NR
NR
A+
A-1
Stable
AA-
F1+
Stable
Merrill
Lynch International
NR
NR
NR
A+
A-1
Stable
A+
F1
Stable
(1)
Review for upgrade only applies to BANA’s long-term rating.
NR = not rated
A reduction in certain of our credit ratings or the ratings of certain asset-backed securitizations may have a material adverse effect on our liquidity, potential loss of access to credit markets, the related cost of funds, our businesses and on certain trading revenues, particularly in those businesses where counterparty creditworthiness is critical. In addition, under the terms of certain OTC derivative contracts and other trading agreements, in the event of downgrades of our or our rated subsidiaries’ credit ratings,
the counterparties to those agreements may require us to provide additional collateral, or to terminate these contracts or agreements, which could cause us to sustain losses and/or adversely impact our liquidity. If the short-term credit ratings of our parent company, bank or broker-dealer subsidiaries were downgraded by one or more levels, the potential loss of access to short-term funding sources such as repo financing and the effect on our incremental cost of funds could be material.
While certain potential impacts are contractual and quantifiable, the full scope of the consequences of a credit rating downgrade to a financial institution is inherently uncertain, as it depends upon numerous dynamic, complex and inter-related factors and assumptions,
including whether any downgrade of a company’s long-term credit ratings precipitates downgrades to its short-term credit ratings, and assumptions about the potential behaviors of various customers, investors and counterparties. For more information on potential impacts of credit rating downgrades, see Liquidity Risk – Liquidity Stress Analysis on page 48.
For more information on additional collateral and termination payments that could be required in connection with certain OTC derivative contracts and other trading agreements as a result of such a credit rating downgrade, see Note 3 – Derivativesto the Consolidated Financial Statements and Item
1A. Risk Factors.
Common Stock Dividends
For a summary of our declared quarterly cash dividends on common stock during 2018 and through February 26, 2019, see Note 13 – Shareholders’ Equityto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Credit Risk Management
Credit risk is the risk of loss arising from the inability or failure of a borrower or counterparty to meet its obligations. Credit risk can also arise from operational
failures that result in an erroneous advance, commitment or investment of funds. We define the credit exposure to a borrower or counterparty as the loss potential arising from all product classifications including loans and leases, deposit overdrafts, derivatives, assets held-for-sale and unfunded lending commitments which include loan commitments, letters of credit and financial guarantees. Derivative positions are recorded at fair value and assets held-for-sale are recorded at either fair value or the lower of cost or fair value. Certain loans and unfunded commitments are accounted for under the fair value option. Credit
risk for categories of assets carried at fair value is not accounted for as part of the allowance for credit losses but as part of the fair value adjustments recorded in earnings. For derivative positions, our credit risk is measured as the net cost in the event
the counterparties with contracts in which we are in a gain position fail to perform under the terms of those contracts. We use the current fair value to represent credit exposure without giving consideration to future mark-to-market changes. The credit risk amounts take into consideration the effects of legally enforceable master netting agreements and cash collateral. Our consumer and commercial credit extension and review procedures encompass funded and unfunded credit exposures. For more information on derivatives and credit extension commitments, see Note 3 – Derivatives and Note 12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
We
manage credit risk based on the risk profile of the borrower or counterparty, repayment sources, the nature of underlying collateral, and other support given current events, conditions and expectations. We classify our portfolios as either consumer or commercial and monitor credit risk in each as discussed below.
We refine our underwriting and credit risk management practices as well as credit standards to meet the changing economic environment. To mitigate losses and enhance customer support in our consumer businesses, we have in place collection programs and loan modification and customer assistance infrastructures. We utilize a number of actions to mitigate losses in the commercial businesses including increasing the frequency and intensity of portfolio monitoring, hedging activity and our practice of transferring management of deteriorating commercial exposures to independent special asset officers as credits enter criticized
categories.
For more information on our credit risk management activities, see Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management below, Commercial Portfolio Credit Risk Management on page 59, Non-U.S. Portfolio on page 65, Provision for Credit Losses on page 67, Allowance for Credit Losses on page 67, and Note 5 – Outstanding Loans and Leases and Note 6 – Allowance for Credit Lossesto the
Consolidated Financial Statements.
Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management
Credit risk management for the consumer portfolio begins with initial underwriting and continues throughout a borrower’s credit cycle. Statistical techniques in conjunction with experiential judgment are used in all aspects of portfolio management including underwriting, product pricing, risk appetite, setting credit limits, and establishing operating processes and metrics to quantify and balance risks and returns. Statistical models are built using detailed behavioral information from external sources such as credit bureaus and/or internal historical experience and are a component of our consumer credit risk management process. These models are used in part to
assist in making both new and
51Bank of America 2018
ongoing credit decisions, as well as portfolio management strategies, including authorizations and line management, collection
practices and strategies, and determination of the allowance for loan and lease losses and allocated capital for credit risk.
Consumer Credit Portfolio
Improvement in home prices continued during 2018 resulting in improved credit quality and lower credit losses in the home equity portfolio, partially offset by seasoning and loan growth in the U.S. credit card portfolio compared to 2017.
Improved credit quality, continued loan balance runoff and sales primarily in the non-core consumer real estate portfolio, partially offset by seasoning within the U.S. credit card portfolio, drove a $581 milliondecrease in the consumer allowance for loan and lease
losses in 2018 to $4.8 billion at December 31, 2018. For additional information, see Allowance for Credit Losses on page 67.
For more information on our accounting policies regarding delinquencies, nonperforming status, charge-offs, troubled debt restructurings (TDRs) for the consumer portfolio and PCI loans, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles and
Note 5 – Outstanding Loans and Leasesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Table 21 presents our outstanding consumer loans and leases, consumer nonperforming loans and accruing consumer loans past due 90 days or more. Nonperforming loans do not include past due consumer credit card loans, other unsecured loans and in general, consumer loans not secured by real estate (bankruptcy loans are included) as these loans are typically charged off no later than the end of the month in which the loan becomes 180 days past due. Real estate-secured past due consumer loans that are insured by the FHA or individually insured under long-term standby agreements with Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac (collectively, the fully-insured loan portfolio) are reported as accruing as opposed to nonperforming since the principal repayment is insured. Fully-insured loans included in accruing past due 90 days or more are primarily from our repurchases of delinquent FHA loans pursuant to our servicing agreements
with the Government National Mortgage Association (GNMA). Additionally, nonperforming loans and accruing balances past due 90 days or more do not include the PCI loan portfolio or loans accounted for under the fair value option even though the customer may be contractually past due.
Table
21
Consumer Credit Quality
Outstandings
Nonperforming
Accruing
Past Due
90 Days or More
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
Residential
mortgage (1)
$
208,557
$
203,811
$
1,893
$
2,476
$
1,884
$
3,230
Home
equity
48,286
57,744
1,893
2,644
—
—
U.S.
credit card
98,338
96,285
n/a
n/a
994
900
Direct/Indirect
consumer (2)
91,166
96,342
56
46
38
40
Other
consumer (3)
202
166
—
—
—
—
Consumer
loans excluding loans accounted for under the fair value option
$
446,549
$
454,348
$
3,842
$
5,166
$
2,916
$
4,170
Loans
accounted for under the fair value option (4)
682
928
Total
consumer loans and leases
$
447,231
$
455,276
Percentage
of outstanding consumer loans and leases (5)
n/a
n/a
0.86
%
1.14
%
0.65
%
0.92
%
Percentage
of outstanding consumer loans and leases, excluding PCI and fully-insured loan portfolios (5)
n/a
n/a
0.91
1.23
0.24
0.22
(1)
Residential
mortgage loans accruing past due 90 days or more are fully-insured loans. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, residential mortgage includes $1.4 billion and $2.2 billion of loans on which interest had been curtailed by the FHA, and therefore were no longer accruing interest, although principal was still insured, and $498 million and $1.0 billion of loans on which interest was still accruing.
(2)
Outstandings
include auto and specialty lending loans and leases of $50.1 billion and $52.4 billion, unsecured consumer lending loans of $383 million and $469 million, U.S. securities-based lending loans of $37.0 billion and $39.8 billion, non-U.S. consumer loans of $2.9 billion and $3.0 billion and other consumer loans of $746 million and $684 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(3)
Substantially
all of other consumer at December 31, 2018 and 2017 is consumer overdrafts.
(4)
Consumer loans accounted for under the fair value option include residential mortgage loans of $336 million and $567 million and home equity loans of $346 million and $361 million at December
31, 2018 and 2017. For more information on the fair value option, see Note 21 – Fair Value Optionto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
(5)
Excludes consumer loans accounted for under the fair value option. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, $12 million and $26
million of loans accounted for under the fair value option were past due 90 days or more and not accruing interest.
n/a = not applicable
Table 22 presents net charge-offs and related ratios for consumer loans and leases.
Table
22
Consumer Net Charge-offs and Related Ratios
Net
Charge-offs (1)
Net Charge-off Ratios (1, 2)
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
Residential
mortgage
$
28
$
(100
)
0.01
%
(0.05
)%
Home equity
(2
)
213
—
0.34
U.S.
credit card
2,837
2,513
3.00
2.76
Non-U.S. credit card (3)
—
75
—
1.91
Direct/Indirect
consumer
195
214
0.21
0.22
Other consumer
182
163
n/m
n/m
Total
$
3,240
$
3,078
0.72
0.68
(1)
Net
charge-offs exclude write-offs in the PCI loan portfolio. For more information, see Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Purchased Credit-impaired Loan Portfolio on page 57.
(2)
Net charge-off ratios are calculated as net charge-offs divided by average outstanding loans and leases excluding loans accounted for under the fair value option.
(3)
Represents net charge-offs
related to the non-U.S. credit card loan portfolio, which was sold during the second quarter of 2017.
n/m = not meaningful
Bank of America 2018 52
Net charge-offs, as shown in Tables 22 and 23, exclude write-offs in the PCI loan portfolio
of $154 million and $131 million in residential mortgage and $119 million and $76 million in home equity for 2018 and 2017. Net charge-off ratios including the PCI write-offs were 0.09 percent and 0.02 percent for residential mortgage and 0.22 percent and 0.47 percent for home equity in 2018 and 2017.
Table 23 presents outstandings, nonperforming balances, net charge-offs, allowance for loan and lease losses and provision for loan and lease losses for the core and non-core portfolios within the consumer real estate portfolio.
We categorize consumer real estate loans as core and non-core based on loan and customer characteristics such as origination date, product type, loan-to-value (LTV), Fair Isaac Corporation (FICO) score and delinquency status consistent with our current consumer and mortgage servicing strategy. Generally, loans that were originated after January 1,
2010, qualified under GSE underwriting guidelines, or otherwise met our underwriting guidelines in place in 2015 are characterized as core loans. All other loans are generally characterized as non-core loans and represent runoff portfolios. Core loans as reported in Table 23 include loans held in the Consumer Banking and GWIM segments, as well
as loans held for ALM activities in All Other.
As shown in Table 23, outstanding core consumer real estate loans increased$12.8 billion during 2018 driven by an increase of $17.1 billion in residential mortgage, partially offset by a $4.2 billiondecrease in home equity.
During 2018, we sold $11.6 billion of consumer real estate loans compared to $4.0
billion in 2017. In addition to recurring loan sales, the 2018 amount includes sales of loans, primarily non-core, with a carrying value of $9.6 billion and related gains of $731 million recorded in other income in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
Table
23
Consumer Real Estate Portfolio (1)
Outstandings
Nonperforming
December
31
Net Charge-offs (2)
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
Core
portfolio
Residential
mortgage
$
193,695
$
176,618
$
1,010
$
1,087
$
11
$
(45
)
Home
equity
40,010
44,245
955
1,079
78
100
Total
core portfolio
233,705
220,863
1,965
2,166
89
55
Non-core
portfolio
Residential
mortgage
14,862
27,193
883
1,389
17
(55
)
Home
equity
8,276
13,499
938
1,565
(80
)
113
Total
non-core portfolio
23,138
40,692
1,821
2,954
(63
)
58
Consumer
real estate portfolio
Residential
mortgage
208,557
203,811
1,893
2,476
28
(100
)
Home
equity
48,286
57,744
1,893
2,644
(2
)
213
Total
consumer real estate portfolio
$
256,843
$
261,555
$
3,786
$
5,120
$
26
$
113
Allowance
for Loan
and Lease Losses
Provision for Loan and Lease Losses
December 31
2018
2017
2018
2017
Core
portfolio
Residential mortgage
$
214
$
218
$
7
$
(79
)
Home
equity
228
367
(60
)
(91
)
Total
core portfolio
442
585
(53
)
(170
)
Non-core
portfolio
Residential
mortgage
208
483
(104
)
(201
)
Home
equity
278
652
(335
)
(339
)
Total
non-core portfolio
486
1,135
(439
)
(540
)
Consumer
real estate portfolio
Residential
mortgage
422
701
(97
)
(280
)
Home
equity
506
1,019
(395
)
(430
)
Total
consumer real estate portfolio
$
928
$
1,720
$
(492
)
$
(710
)
(1)
Outstandings
and nonperforming loans exclude loans accounted for under the fair value option. Consumer loans accounted for under the fair value option included residential mortgage loans of $336 million and $567 million and home equity loans of $346 million and $361 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017. For additional information, see Note 21 – Fair Value Optionto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
(2)
Net
charge-offs exclude write-offs in the PCI loan portfolio. For more information, see Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Purchased Credit-impaired Loan Portfolio on page 57.
We believe that the presentation of information adjusted to exclude the impact of the PCI loan portfolio, the fully-insured loan portfolio and loans accounted for under the fair value option is more representative of the ongoing operations and credit quality of the business. As a result, in the following tables and discussions of the residential mortgage and home equity portfolios, we exclude loans accounted for under the fair value option and provide information that excludes the impact of the PCI loan portfolio and the fully-insured loan portfolio in certain credit quality statistics. We separately disclose
information on the PCI loan portfolio on page 57.
Residential Mortgage
The residential mortgage portfolio made up the largest percentage of our consumer loan portfolio at 47 percent of consumer loans and leases at December 31, 2018. Approximately 44 percent of the residential mortgage portfolio was in Consumer Banking and 37 percent was in GWIM. The remaining portion was in All Other and was comprised of originated loans, purchased loans used in our overall ALM activities, delinquent FHA loans repurchased
pursuant to our servicing agreements with GNMA as well as loans repurchased related to our representations and warranties.
53Bank of America 2018
Outstanding balances in the residential
mortgage portfolio increased$4.7 billion in 2018 as retention of new originations was partially offset by loan sales of $8.9 billion and runoff.
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the residential mortgage portfolio included $20.1 billion and $23.7 billion of outstanding fully-insured loans, of which $14.0 billion and $17.4 billion had FHA insurance with the remainder protected by long-term standby agreements. At December 31, 2018
and 2017, $3.5 billion and $5.2 billion of the FHA-insured loan population were repurchases of delinquent FHA loans pursuant to our servicing agreements with GNMA.
Table 24 presents certain residential mortgage key credit statistics on both a reported basis and excluding the PCI loan portfolio and the fully-insured loan portfolio. Additionally, in the “Reported Basis” columns in the following table, accruing balances past due and nonperforming loans do not include the PCI loan portfolio, in accordance with our accounting policies, even though the customer may be contractually past due. As such, the following discussion presents the residential mortgage portfolio excluding the PCI loan portfolio and the fully-insured loan portfolio.
Table
24
Residential Mortgage – Key Credit Statistics
Reported
Basis (1)
Excluding Purchased Credit-impaired and Fully-insured Loans (1)
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
Outstandings
$
208,557
$
203,811
$
184,627
$
172,069
Accruing
past due 30 days or more
3,945
5,987
1,155
1,521
Accruing past
due 90 days or more
1,884
3,230
—
—
Nonperforming loans
1,893
2,476
1,893
2,476
Percent
of portfolio
Refreshed LTV greater than 90 but less than
or equal to 100
2
%
3
%
1
%
2
%
Refreshed LTV greater than 100
1
2
1
1
Refreshed
FICO below 620
4
6
2
3
2006 and 2007 vintages (2)
6
10
5
8
2018
2017
2018
2017
Net
charge-off ratio (3)
0.01
%
(0.05
)%
0.02
%
(0.06
)%
(1)
Outstandings,
accruing past due, nonperforming loans and percentages of portfolio exclude loans accounted for under the fair value option.
(2)
These vintages of loans accounted for $536 million, or 28 percent, and $825 million, or 33 percent, of nonperforming residential mortgage loans at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(3)
Net
charge-off ratios are calculated as net charge-offs divided by average outstanding loans excluding loans accounted for under the fair value option.
Nonperforming residential mortgage loans decreased$583 million in 2018 primarily driven by sales. Of the nonperforming residential mortgage loans at December 31, 2018, $716 million, or 38 percent, were current on contractual payments. Loans accruing past due 30 days or more decreased$366 million due to continued improvement in credit quality as well as loan sales in the non-core portfolio.
Net
charge-offs increased$128 million to $28 million in 2018 compared to $100 million of net recoveries in 2017 primarily due to net recoveries related to loan sales in 2017.
Loans with a refreshed LTV greater than 100 percent represented one percent of the residential mortgage loan portfolio at both December 31, 2018 and 2017. Of the loans with a refreshed LTV greater than 100 percent, 99 percent and 98 percent were performing at December
31, 2018 and 2017. Loans with a refreshed LTV greater than 100 percent reflect loans where the outstanding carrying value of the loan is greater than the most recent valuation of the property securing the loan.
Of the $184.6 billion in total residential mortgage loans outstanding at December 31, 2018, as shown in Table 24, 30 percent were originated as interest-only loans. The outstanding balance of interest-only residential mortgage loans that have
entered the amortization period was $8.6 billion, or 16 percent, at December
31, 2018. Residential mortgage loans that have entered the amortization period generally have experienced a higher rate of early stage delinquencies and nonperforming status compared to the residential mortgage portfolio as a whole. At December 31, 2018, $177 million, or two percent, of outstanding interest-only residential mortgages that had entered the amortization period were accruing past due 30 days or more compared to $1.2 billion, or one percent, for the entire residential mortgage portfolio. In addition, at December 31, 2018, $365 million, or four percent, of outstanding interest-only residential mortgage loans that had entered the amortization
period were nonperforming, of which $128 million were contractually current, compared to $1.9 billion, or one percent, for the entire residential mortgage portfolio. Loans that have yet to enter the amortization period in our interest-only residential mortgage portfolio are primarily well-collateralized loans to our wealth management clients and have an interest-only period of three to ten years. Approximately 90 percent of these loans that have yet to enter the amortization period will not be required to make a fully-amortizing payment until 2022 or later.
Bank
of America 2018 54
Table 25 presents outstandings, nonperforming loans and net charge-offs by certain state concentrations for the residential mortgage portfolio. The Los Angeles-Long Beach-Santa Ana Metropolitan Statistical Area (MSA) within California represented 16 percent of outstandings at both December 31, 2018 and 2017. In the New York area, the New York-Northern New Jersey-Long Island MSA made up 13 percent of outstandings at both December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Outstandings
and nonperforming loans exclude loans accounted for under the fair value option.
(2)
Net charge-offs exclude $154 million and $131 million of write-offs in the residential mortgage PCI loan portfolio in 2018 and 2017. For more information on PCI write-offs, see Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Purchased Credit-impaired Loan Portfolio on page 57.
(3)
In
these states, foreclosure requires a court order following a legal proceeding (judicial states).
(4)
Amounts exclude the PCI residential mortgage and fully-insured loan portfolios.
(5)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, 49 percent and 47 percent of PCI residential mortgage loans were
in California. There were no other significant single state concentrations.
Home Equity
At December 31, 2018, the home equity portfolio made up 11 percent of the consumer portfolio and was comprised of home equity lines of credit (HELOCs), home equity loans and reverse mortgages.
At December 31, 2018, our HELOC portfolio had an outstanding balance of $44.3 billion, or 92 percent of the total home equity portfolio, compared to $51.2
billion, or 89 percent, at December 31, 2017. HELOCs generally have an initial draw period of 10 years, and after the initial draw period ends, the loans generally convert to 15-year amortizing loans.
At December 31, 2018, our home equity loan portfolio had an outstanding balance of $1.8 billion, or four percent of the total home equity portfolio, compared to $4.4 billion, or seven percent, at December 31, 2017. Home equity loans are almost all fixed-rate loans with amortizing payment terms of 10 to 30 years, and of the $1.8 billion at December 31, 2018,
68 percent have 25- to 30-year terms. At December 31, 2018, our reverse mortgage portfolio had an outstanding balance of $2.2 billion, or four percent of the total home equity portfolio, compared to $2.1 billion, or four percent, at December 31, 2017. We no longer originate reverse mortgages.
At December 31, 2018, 75 percent of the home equity portfolio was in Consumer Banking, 17 percent was in All Other and the remainder of the portfolio was primarily in GWIM. Outstanding
balances
in the home equity portfolio decreased$9.5 billion in 2018 primarily due to paydowns and loan sales of $2.7 billion outpacing new originations and draws on existing lines. Of the total home equity portfolio at December 31, 2018 and 2017, $17.3 billion and $18.7 billion, or 36 percent and 32 percent, were in first-lien positions. At December 31, 2018, outstanding balances in the home equity portfolio that were in a second-lien or more junior-lien position and where we also held the first-lien loan totaled $7.9 billion, or 17 percent of our
total home equity portfolio excluding the PCI loan portfolio.
Unused HELOCs totaled $43.1 billion and $44.2 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. The decrease was primarily due to accounts reaching the end of their draw period, which automatically eliminates open line exposure, and customers choosing to close accounts. Both of these more than offset the impact of new production. The HELOC utilization rate was 51 percent and 54 percent at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Table
26 presents certain home equity portfolio key credit statistics on both a reported basis and excluding the PCI loan portfolio. Additionally, in the “Reported Basis” columns in the following table, accruing balances past due 30 days or more and nonperforming loans do not include the PCI loan portfolio, in accordance with our accounting policies, even though the customer may be contractually past due. As such, the following discussion presents the home equity portfolio excluding the PCI loan portfolio.
55Bank of America 2018
Table
26
Home Equity – Key Credit Statistics
Reported
Basis (1)
Excluding Purchased Credit-impaired Loans (1)
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
Outstandings
$
48,286
$
57,744
$
47,441
$
55,028
Accruing
past due 30 days or more (2)
363
502
363
502
Nonperforming
loans (2)
1,893
2,644
1,893
2,644
Percent
of portfolio
Refreshed CLTV greater than 90 but less than or equal to 100
2
%
3
%
2
%
3
%
Refreshed
CLTV greater than 100
3
5
3
4
Refreshed FICO below 620
5
6
5
6
2006
and 2007 vintages (3)
22
29
21
27
2018
2017
2018
2017
Net
charge-off ratio (4)
—
%
0.34
%
—
%
0.36
%
(1)
Outstandings,
accruing past due, nonperforming loans and percentages of the portfolio exclude loans accounted for under the fair value option.
(2)
Accruing past due 30 days or more include $48 million and $67 million and nonperforming loans include $218 million and $344 million of loans where we serviced the underlying first lien at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(3)
These
vintages of loans have higher refreshed combined loan-to-value (CLTV) ratios and accounted for 49 percent and 52 percent of nonperforming home equity loans at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and $11 million and $193 million of net charge-offs in 2018 and 2017.
(4)
Net
charge-off ratios are calculated as net charge-offs divided by average outstanding loans excluding loans accounted for under the fair value option.
Nonperforming outstanding balances in the home equity portfolio decreased$751 million in 2018 as outflows, including sales, outpaced new inflows. Of the nonperforming home equity loans at December 31, 2018, $1.1 billion, or 59 percent, were current on contractual payments. Nonperforming loans that are contractually current primarily consist of collateral-dependent TDRs, including those that have been discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy, junior-lien loans where the underlying first lien is 90
days or more past due, as well as loans that have not yet demonstrated a sustained period of payment performance following a TDR. In addition, $463 million, or 24 percent, of nonperforming home equity loans were 180 days or more past due and had been written down to the estimated fair value of the collateral, less costs to sell. Accruing loans that were 30 days or more past due decreased$139 million in 2018.
In some cases, the junior-lien home equity outstanding balance that we hold is performing, but the underlying first lien is not. For outstanding balances in the home equity portfolio on which we service the first-lien loan, we are able to track whether the first-lien loan is in default. For loans where the first lien is serviced by a third party, we utilize credit bureau data
to estimate the delinquency status of the first lien. At December 31, 2018, we estimate that $610 million of current and $83 million of 30 to 89 days past due junior-lien loans were behind a delinquent first-lien loan. We service the first-lien loans on $114 million of these combined amounts, with the remaining $579 million serviced by third parties. Of the $693 million of current to 89 days past due junior-lien loans, based on available credit bureau data and our own internal servicing data, we estimate that approximately $221 million had first-lien loans that were 90 days or more past due.
Net charge-offs decreased$215 million to a net recovery of $2 million in 2018
compared to net charge-offs of $213 million in 2017 driven by favorable portfolio trends due in part to improvement in home prices and the U.S. economy.
Outstanding balances with a refreshed CLTV greater than 100 percent comprised three percent and four percent of the home equity portfolio at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Outstanding balances with a refreshed CLTV greater than 100 percent reflect loans where our loan and available line of credit combined with any outstanding senior liens against the property are equal to or greater than the most recent valuation of the property securing the
loan. Depending on the value of the property, there may be collateral in excess of the first lien that is available to reduce the
severity of loss on the second lien. Of those outstanding balances with a refreshed CLTV greater than 100 percent, 96 percent of the customers were current on their home equity loan and 91 percent of second-lien loans with a refreshed CLTV greater than 100 percent were current on both their second-lien and underlying first-lien loans at December 31, 2018.
Of the $47.4 billion in total home equity portfolio outstandings at December 31, 2018, as shown in Table
26, 20 percent require interest-only payments. The outstanding balance of HELOCs that have reached the end of their draw period and have entered the amortization period was $15.8 billion at December 31, 2018. The HELOCs that have entered the amortization period have experienced a higher percentage of early stage delinquencies and nonperforming status when compared to the HELOC portfolio as a whole. At December 31, 2018, $267 million, or two percent, of outstanding HELOCs that had entered the amortization period were accruing past due 30 days or more. In addition, at December 31, 2018, $1.7 billion, or 11 percent, of outstanding HELOCs that had entered the
amortization period were nonperforming. Loans that have yet to enter the amortization period in our interest-only portfolio are primarily post-2008 vintages and generally have better credit quality than the previous vintages that had entered the amortization period. We communicate to contractually current customers more than a year prior to the end of their draw period to inform them of the potential change to the payment structure before entering the amortization period, and provide payment options to customers prior to the end of the draw period.
Although we do not actively track how many of our home equity customers pay only the minimum amount due on their home equity loans and lines, we can infer some of this information through a review of our HELOC portfolio that we service and that is still in its revolving period. During 2018, 14 percent of these customers with an outstanding
balance did not pay any principal on their HELOCs.
Table 27 presents outstandings, nonperforming balances and net charge-offs by certain state concentrations for the home equity portfolio. In the New York area, the New York-Northern New Jersey-Long Island MSA made up 13 percent of the outstanding home equity portfolio at both December 31, 2018 and 2017. Loans within this MSA contributed $35 million and $58 million of net charge-offs in 2018 and 2017 within the home equity portfolio. The Los Angeles-Long Beach-Santa Ana MSA within California made up 11 percent of the outstanding home equity portfolio
Bank
of America 2018 56
at both December 31, 2018 and 2017. Loans within this MSA contributed net recoveries of $23 million and $20 million within the home equity portfolio in 2018 and 2017.
Table
27
Home Equity State Concentrations
Outstandings
(1)
Nonperforming (1)
December 31
Net Charge-offs (2)
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
California
$
13,228
$
15,145
$
536
$
766
$
(54
)
$
(37
)
Florida
(3)
5,363
6,308
315
411
1
38
New
Jersey (3)
3,833
4,546
150
191
25
44
New
York (3)
3,549
4,195
194
252
23
35
Massachusetts
2,376
2,751
65
92
5
9
Other
19,092
22,083
633
932
(2
)
124
Home
equity loans (4)
$
47,441
$
55,028
$
1,893
$
2,644
$
(2
)
$
213
Purchased
credit-impaired home equity portfolio (5)
845
2,716
Total
home equity loan portfolio
$
48,286
$
57,744
(1)
Outstandings
and nonperforming loans exclude loans accounted for under the fair value option.
(2)
Net charge-offs exclude $119 million and $76 million of write-offs in the home equity PCI loan portfolio in 2018 and 2017. For more information on PCI write-offs, see Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Purchased Credit-impaired Loan Portfolio.
(3)
In
these states, foreclosure requires a court order following a legal proceeding (judicial states).
(4)
Amount excludes the PCI home equity portfolio.
(5)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, 34 percent and 28 percent of PCI home equity loans were in California. There were no other significant
single state concentrations.
Purchased Credit-impaired Loan Portfolio
Loans acquired with evidence of credit quality deterioration since origination and for which it is probable at purchase that we will be unable to collect all contractually required payments are accounted for under the accounting standards for PCI loans.
Table 28 presents the unpaid principal balance, carrying value, related valuation allowance and the net carrying value as a percentage of the unpaid principal balance for the PCI loan portfolio.
At
December 31, 2018 and 2017, pay option loans had an unpaid principal balance of $757 million and $1.4 billion and a carrying value of $744 million and $1.4 billion. This includes $645 million and $1.2 billion of loans that were credit-impaired upon acquisition and $67 million and $141 million of loans that were 90 days or more past due. The total unpaid principal balance of pay option loans with accumulated negative amortization was $73 million and $160 million, including $4 million and $9 million of negative amortization at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
The
total PCI unpaid principal balance decreased$6.1 billion, or 56 percent, in 2018 primarily driven by loan sales with a carrying value of $4.4 billion compared to sales of $803 million in 2017.
Of the unpaid principal balance of $4.8 billion at December 31, 2018, $4.3 billion, or 90 percent, was current based on the contractual terms, $208 million, or four percent, was in early stage delinquency and $205 million was 180 days or more past due, including
$172 million of first-lien mortgages and $33 million of home equity loans.
The PCI residential mortgage loan and home equity portfolios represented 82 percent and 18 percent of the total PCI loan portfolio at December 31, 2018. Those loans to borrowers with a refreshed FICO score below 620 represented 19 percent and 21 percent of the PCI residential mortgage loan and home equity portfolios at December 31, 2018. Residential mortgage and home equity loans with a refreshed LTV or CLTV greater than 90 percent, after consideration of purchase accounting adjustments and the related valuation allowance, represented 10 percent and 28 percent of
their respective PCI loan portfolios and 11 percent and
32 percent based on the unpaid principal balance at December 31, 2018.
U.S. Credit Card
At December 31, 2018, 97 percent of the U.S. credit card portfolio was managed in Consumer Banking with the remainder in GWIM. Outstandings in the U.S. credit card portfolio increased$2.1
billion in 2018 to $98.3 billion due to higher retail volume partially offset by payments as well as the sale of a small portfolio. In 2018, net charge-offs increased$324 million to $2.8 billion, and U.S. credit card loans 30 days or more past due and still accruing interest increased $142 million and loans 90 days or more past due and still accruing interest increased$94 million, each driven by portfolio seasoning and loan growth.
Unused lines of credit for U.S. credit card totaled $334.8 billion and $326.3 billion at December
31, 2018 and 2017. The increase was driven by account growth and lines of credit increases.
Table 29 presents certain state concentrations for the U.S. credit card portfolio.
57Bank of America 2018
Table
29
U.S. Credit Card State Concentrations
Outstandings
Accruing
Past Due
90 Days or More
December 31
Net Charge-offs
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
California
$
16,062
$
15,254
$
163
$
136
$
479
$
412
Florida
8,840
8,359
119
94
332
259
Texas
7,730
7,451
84
76
224
194
New
York
6,066
5,977
81
91
268
218
Washington
4,558
4,350
24
20
63
56
Other
55,082
54,894
523
483
1,471
1,374
Total
U.S. credit card portfolio
$
98,338
$
96,285
$
994
$
900
$
2,837
$
2,513
Direct/Indirect
Consumer
At December 31, 2018, 55 percent of the direct/indirect portfolio was included in Consumer Banking (consumer auto and specialty lending – automotive, marine, aircraft, recreational vehicle loans and consumer personal loans) and 45 percent was included in GWIM (principally securities-based lending loans).
Outstandings in the direct/indirect portfolio decreased$5.2 billion in 2018 to $91.2 billion primarily due to declines in
securities-based
lending due to higher paydowns, and in our auto portfolio as paydowns outpaced originations. Net charge-offs decreased$19 million to $195 million in 2018 due largely to clarifying regulatory guidance related to bankruptcy and repossession issued during 2017.
Table 30 presents certain state concentrations for the direct/indirect consumer loan portfolio.
Table
30
Direct/Indirect State Concentrations
Outstandings
Accruing
Past Due 90 Days or More
December 31
Net Charge-offs
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
California
$
11,734
$
12,897
$
4
$
3
$
21
$
21
Florida
10,240
11,184
4
5
36
43
Texas
9,876
10,676
6
5
30
38
New
York
6,296
6,557
2
2
9
7
New
Jersey
3,308
3,449
1
1
2
6
Other
49,712
51,579
21
24
97
99
Total
direct/indirect loan portfolio
$
91,166
$
96,342
$
38
$
40
$
195
$
214
Nonperforming
Consumer Loans, Leases and Foreclosed Properties Activity
Table 31 presents nonperforming consumer loans, leases and foreclosed properties activity during 2018 and 2017. During 2018, nonperforming consumer loans declined$1.3 billion to $3.8 billion primarily driven by loan sales of $969 million.
At December 31, 2018, $1.1 billion, or 29 percent, of nonperforming loans were 180 days or more past due and had been written down to their
estimated property value less costs to sell. In addition, at December 31, 2018, $1.9 billion, or 49 percent, of nonperforming consumer loans were modified and are now current after successful trial periods, or are current loans classified as nonperforming loans in accordance with applicable policies.
Foreclosed properties increased$8 million in 2018 to $244 million as additions outpaced liquidations. PCI loans are excluded from nonperforming loans as these loans were written down to fair value at the acquisition date; however, once we acquire the underlying real estate upon foreclosure of the delinquent PCI loan,
it
is included in foreclosed properties. Certain delinquent government-guaranteed loans (principally FHA-insured loans) are excluded from our nonperforming loans and foreclosed properties activity as we expect we will be reimbursed once the property is conveyed to the guarantor for principal and, up to certain limits, costs incurred during the foreclosure process and interest accrued during the holding period.
We classify junior-lien home equity loans as nonperforming when the first-lien loan becomes 90 days past due even if the junior-lien loan is performing. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, $221 million and $330 million of such junior-lien home equity loans were included in nonperforming
loans and leases.
Nonperforming loans also include certain loans that have been modified in TDRs where economic concessions have been granted to borrowers experiencing financial difficulties. Nonperforming TDRs, excluding those modified loans in the PCI loan portfolio, are included in Table 31.
Bank of America 2018 58
Table
31
Nonperforming Consumer Loans, Leases and Foreclosed Properties Activity
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Nonperforming
loans and leases, January 1
$
5,166
$
6,004
Additions
2,440
3,254
Reductions:
Paydowns
and payoffs
(958
)
(1,052
)
Sales
(969
)
(511
)
Returns to performing status (1)
(1,283
)
(1,438
)
Charge-offs
(401
)
(676
)
Transfers
to foreclosed properties
(151
)
(217
)
Transfers to loans held-for-sale
(2
)
(198
)
Total net reductions to nonperforming
loans and leases
(1,324
)
(838
)
Total nonperforming loans and leases, December 31
3,842
5,166
Foreclosed
properties, December 31 (2)
244
236
Nonperforming consumer loans, leases and foreclosed properties, December 31
$
4,086
$
5,402
Nonperforming
consumer loans and leases as a percentage of outstanding consumer loans and leases (3)
0.86
%
1.14
%
Nonperforming consumer loans, leases and foreclosed properties as a percentage of outstanding consumer loans, leases and foreclosed properties (3)
0.92
1.19
(1)
Consumer
loans may be returned to performing status when all principal and interest is current and full repayment of the remaining contractual principal and interest is expected, or when the loan otherwise becomes well-secured and is in the process of collection.
(2)
Foreclosed property balances do not include properties insured by certain government-guaranteed loans, principally FHA-insured, of $488 million and $801 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(3)
Outstanding
consumer loans and leases exclude loans accounted for under the fair value option.
Table 32 presents TDRs for the consumer real estate portfolio. Performing TDR balances are excluded from nonperforming loans and leases in Table 31.
Total
consumer real estate troubled debt restructurings
$
2,316
$
6,240
$
8,556
$
2,992
$
9,562
$
12,554
(1)
At
December 31, 2018 and 2017, residential mortgage TDRs deemed collateral dependent totaled $1.6 billion and $2.8 billion, and included $960 million and $1.2 billion of loans classified as nonperforming and $605 million and $1.6 billion of loans classified as performing.
(2)
Residential
mortgage performing TDRs included $2.8 billion and $3.7 billion of loans that were fully-insured at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(3)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, home equity TDRs deemed collateral dependent totaled $1.3
billion and $1.6 billion, and included $961 million and $1.2 billion of loans classified as nonperforming and $322 million and $388 million of loans classified as performing.
In addition to modifying consumer real estate loans, we work with customers who are experiencing financial difficulty by modifying credit card and other consumer loans. Credit card and other consumer loan modifications generally involve a reduction in the customer’s interest rate on the account and placing the customer on a fixed payment plan not exceeding 60 months, all of which are considered TDRs (the renegotiated TDR portfolio).
Modifications
of credit card and other consumer loans are made through renegotiation programs utilizing direct customer contact, but may also utilize external renegotiation programs. The renegotiated TDR portfolio is excluded in large part from Table 31 as substantially all of the loans remain on accrual status until either charged off or paid in full. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, our renegotiated TDR portfolio was $566 million and $490 million, of which $481 million and $426 million were current or less than 30 days past due under the modified terms. The increase
in the renegotiated TDR portfolio was primarily driven by new renegotiated enrollments outpacing runoff of existing portfolios.
Commercial Portfolio Credit Risk Management
Credit risk management for the commercial portfolio begins with an assessment of the credit risk profile of the borrower or counterparty based on an analysis of its financial position. As part of the overall credit risk assessment, our commercial credit exposures are assigned a risk rating and are subject to approval based on defined credit approval standards. Subsequent to loan origination, risk ratings are monitored on an ongoing basis, and if necessary, adjusted to reflect changes in the financial condition,
cash
flow, risk profile or outlook of a borrower or counterparty. In making credit decisions, we consider risk rating, collateral, country, industry and single-name concentration limits while also balancing these considerations with the total borrower or counterparty relationship. We use a variety of tools to continuously monitor the ability of a borrower or counterparty to perform under its obligations. We use risk rating aggregations to measure and evaluate concentrations within portfolios. In addition, risk ratings are a factor in determining the level of allocated capital and the allowance for credit losses.
As part of our ongoing risk mitigation initiatives, we attempt to work with clients experiencing financial difficulty to modify their loans to terms that better align with their current ability to pay. In situations where an economic concession has been granted to a borrower experiencing financial difficulty, we identify
these loans as TDRs. For more information on our accounting policies regarding delinquencies, nonperforming status and net charge-offs for the commercial portfolio, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principlesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Management of Commercial Credit Risk Concentrations
Commercial credit risk is evaluated and managed with the goal that concentrations of credit exposure continue to be aligned with our risk appetite. We review, measure and manage concentrations of credit exposure by industry, product, geography, customer relationship and loan size. We also review, measure and manage commercial real estate loans by geographic location and property
59Bank
of America 2018
type. In addition, within our non-U.S. portfolio, we evaluate exposures by region and by country. Tables 37, 40, 43 and 44 summarize our concentrations. We also utilize syndications of exposure to third parties, loan sales, hedging and other risk mitigation techniques to manage the size and
risk profile of the commercial credit portfolio. For more information on our industry concentrations, see Commercial Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Industry Concentrations on page 63 and Table 40.
We account for certain large corporate loans and loan commitments, including issued but unfunded letters of credit which are considered utilized for credit risk management purposes, that exceed our single-name credit risk concentration guidelines under the fair value option. Lending commitments, both funded and unfunded, are actively managed and monitored, and as appropriate, credit risk for these lending relationships may be mitigated through the use of credit derivatives, with our credit view and market perspectives determining the size and timing of the hedging activity. In addition,
we purchase credit protection to cover the funded portion as well as the unfunded portion of certain other credit exposures. To lessen the cost of obtaining our desired credit protection levels, credit exposure may be added within an industry, borrower or counterparty group by selling protection. These credit derivatives do not meet the requirements for treatment as accounting hedges. They are carried at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in other income.
In addition, we are a member of various securities and derivative exchanges and clearinghouses, both in the U.S. and
other countries. As a member, we may be required to pay a pro-rata share of the losses incurred by some of these organizations as a result of another member default and under other loss scenarios. For additional information, see Note
12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Commercial Credit Portfolio
During 2018, credit quality among large corporate borrowers was strong, and there was continued improvement in the energy portfolio. Credit quality of commercial real estate borrowers in most sectors remained stable with conservative LTV ratios. However, some of the commercial real estate markets experienced slowing tenant demand and decelerating rental income.
Total commercial utilized credit exposure increased$20.2 billion in 2018 to $621.0 billion
primarily driven by commercial loan growth. The utilization rate for loans and leases, SBLCs and financial guarantees, and commercial letters of credit, in the aggregate, was 59 percent at both December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Table 33 presents commercial credit exposure by type for utilized, unfunded and total binding committed credit exposure. Commercial utilized credit exposure includes SBLCs and financial guarantees and commercial letters of credit that have been issued and for which we are legally bound to advance funds under prescribed conditions during a specified time period, and excludes exposure related to trading account assets. Although funds have not yet been advanced, these exposure types are considered
utilized for credit risk management purposes.
Table
33
Commercial Credit Exposure by Type
Commercial
Utilized (1)
Commercial Unfunded (2, 3, 4)
Total Commercial Committed
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
Loans
and leases (5)
$
505,724
$
487,748
$
369,282
$
364,743
$
875,006
$
852,491
Derivative
assets (6)
43,725
37,762
—
—
43,725
37,762
Standby
letters of credit and financial guarantees
34,941
34,517
491
863
35,432
35,380
Debt
securities and other investments
25,425
28,161
4,250
4,864
29,675
33,025
Loans
held-for-sale
9,090
10,257
14,812
9,742
23,902
19,999
Commercial
letters of credit
1,210
1,467
168
155
1,378
1,622
Other
898
888
—
—
898
888
Total
$
621,013
$
600,800
$
389,003
$
380,367
$
1,010,016
$
981,167
(1)
Commercial
utilized exposure includes loans of $3.7 billion and $4.8 billion and issued letters of credit with a notional amount of $100 million and $232 million accounted for under the fair value option at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(2)
Commercial unfunded exposure includes commitments accounted for under the fair value option with a notional amount of $3.0 billion
and $4.6 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(3)
Excludes unused business card lines, which are not legally binding.
(4)
Includes the notional amount of unfunded legally binding lending commitments net of amounts distributed (i.e., syndicated or participated) to other financial
institutions. The distributed amounts were $10.7 billion and $11.0 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(5)
Includes credit risk exposure associated with assets under operating lease arrangements of $6.1 billion and $6.3 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(6)
Derivative
assets are carried at fair value, reflect the effects of legally enforceable master netting agreements and have been reduced by cash collateral of $32.4 billion and $34.6 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Not reflected in utilized and committed exposure is additional non-cash derivative collateral held of $33.0 billion and $26.2 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017, which consists primarily of other marketable securities.
Outstanding
commercial loans and leases increased$18.2 billion during 2018 primarily in the U.S. commercial portfolio. The allowance for loan and lease losses for the commercial portfolio decreased$211 million to $4.8 billion at December 31, 2018. For additional information, see Allowance for Credit Losses on page 67. Table 34 presents our commercial loans and leases portfolio and related credit quality information at December
31, 2018 and 2017.
Bank of America 2018 60
Table
34
Commercial Credit Quality
Outstandings
Nonperforming
Accruing Past Due
90 Days or More
December
31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
Commercial
and industrial:
U.S. commercial
$
299,277
$
284,836
$
794
$
814
$
197
$
144
Non-U.S.
commercial
98,776
97,792
80
299
—
3
Total
commercial and industrial
398,053
382,628
874
1,113
197
147
Commercial
real estate (1)
60,845
58,298
156
112
4
4
Commercial
lease financing
22,534
22,116
18
24
29
19
481,432
463,042
1,048
1,249
230
170
U.S.
small business commercial (2)
14,565
13,649
54
55
84
75
Commercial
loans excluding loans accounted for under the fair value option
495,997
476,691
1,102
1,304
314
245
Loans
accounted for under the fair value option (3)
3,667
4,782
—
43
—
—
Total
commercial loans and leases
$
499,664
$
481,473
$
1,102
$
1,347
$
314
$
245
(1)
Includes
U.S. commercial real estate of $56.6 billion and $54.8 billion and non-U.S. commercial real estate of $4.2 billion and $3.5 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(2)
Includes card-related products.
(3)
Commercial
loans accounted for under the fair value option include U.S. commercial of $2.5 billion and $2.6 billion and non-U.S. commercial of $1.1 billion and $2.2 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. For more information on the fair value option, see Note 21 – Fair Value Optionto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Table 35 presents net charge-offs and related ratios for our commercial loans and leases for 2018
and 2017. The decrease in net charge-offs of $378 million for 2018 was primarily driven by a single-name non-U.S. commercial charge-off of $292 million in 2017.
Table
35
Commercial Net Charge-offs and Related Ratios
Net Charge-offs
Net
Charge-off Ratios (1)
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
Commercial and industrial:
U.S.
commercial
$
215
$
232
0.07
%
0.08
%
Non-U.S.
commercial
68
440
0.07
0.48
Total commercial and industrial
283
672
0.07
0.18
Commercial
real estate
1
9
—
0.02
Commercial lease financing
(1
)
5
(0.01
)
0.02
283
686
0.06
0.15
U.S.
small business commercial
240
215
1.70
1.60
Total commercial
$
523
$
901
0.11
0.20
(1)
Net
charge-off ratios are calculated as net charge-offs divided by average outstanding loans and leases excluding loans accounted for under the fair value option.
Table 36 presents commercial reservable criticized utilized exposure by loan type. Criticized exposure corresponds to the Special Mention, Substandard and Doubtful asset categories as defined by regulatory authorities. Total commercial reservable criticized utilized exposure decreased$2.5 billion, or 18 percent, during 2018 driven by broad-based improvements including the energy sector. At December 31, 2018 and 2017,
91 percent and 84 percent of commercial reservable criticized utilized exposure was secured.
Total commercial reservable criticized utilized exposure (1)
$
11,061
2.08
$
13,563
2.65
(1)
Total
commercial reservable criticized utilized exposure includes loans and leases of $10.3 billion and $12.5 billion and commercial letters of credit of $781 million and $1.1 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(2)
Percentages are calculated as commercial reservable criticized utilized exposure divided by total commercial reservable utilized exposure for each exposure category.
61Bank
of America 2018
Commercial and Industrial
Commercial and industrial loans include U.S. commercial and non-U.S. commercial portfolios.
U.S. Commercial
At December 31, 2018, 70 percent of the U.S. commercial loan portfolio, excluding small business, was managed in Global
Banking, 16 percent in Global Markets, 12 percent in GWIM (generally business-purpose loans for high net worth clients) and the remainder primarily in Consumer Banking. U.S. commercial loans increased $14.4 billion in 2018 primarily in Global Banking. Reservable criticized utilized exposure decreased$1.9 billion, or 19 percent, driven by broad-based improvements including the energy sector.
Non-U.S. Commercial
At December 31, 2018,
81 percent of the non-U.S. commercial loan portfolio was managed in Global Banking and 19 percent in Global Markets. Reservable criticized utilized exposure decreased$753 million, or 43 percent, and nonperforming loans and leases decreased$219 million, or 73 percent, due primarily to paydowns, sales and charge-offs. Net charge-offs decreased$372 million in 2018 primarily due to a single-name non-U.S. commercial charge-off of $292 million in 2017.
For more information on the non-U.S. commercial portfolio, see Non-U.S. Portfolio on page 65.
Commercial Real Estate
Commercial real estate primarily includes commercial loans and leases secured by non-owner-occupied real estate and is
dependent on the sale or lease of the real estate as the primary source of repayment. The portfolio remains diversified across property types and geographic regions. California represented the largest state concentration at 23 percent of the commercial real estate loans and leases portfolio at both December 31, 2018 and 2017.
The commercial real estate portfolio is predominantly managed in Global Banking and consists of loans made primarily to public and private developers, and commercial real estate firms. Outstanding loans increased$2.5 billion, or four percent, during 2018 to $60.8 billion due to new originations, including higher hold levels on syndicated loans, outpacing paydowns.
During 2018, we continued to see low default rates and solid credit quality in both the residential and non-residential portfolios. We use a number of proactive risk mitigation initiatives to reduce adversely rated exposure in the commercial
real estate portfolio, including transfers of deteriorating exposures to management by independent special asset officers and the pursuit of loan restructurings or asset sales to achieve the best results for our customers and the Corporation.
Nonperforming commercial real estate loans and foreclosed properties increased$48 million, or 29 percent, during 2018 to $212 million, primarily due to a single-name downgrade.
Table 37 presents outstanding commercial real estate loans by geographic region, based on the geographic location of the collateral, and by property type.
Table
37
Outstanding Commercial Real Estate Loans
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
By
Geographic Region
California
$
14,002
$
13,607
Northeast
10,895
10,072
Southwest
7,339
6,970
Southeast
5,726
5,487
Midwest
3,772
3,769
Florida
3,680
3,170
Illinois
2,989
3,263
Midsouth
2,919
2,962
Northwest
2,178
2,657
Non-U.S.
4,240
3,538
Other (1)
3,105
2,803
Total
outstanding commercial real estate loans
$
60,845
$
58,298
By Property Type
Non-residential
Office
$
17,246
$
16,718
Shopping
centers / Retail
8,798
8,825
Multi-family rental
7,762
8,280
Hotels / Motels
7,248
6,344
Industrial
/ Warehouse
5,379
6,070
Unsecured
2,956
2,187
Multi-use
2,848
2,771
Other
7,029
5,645
Total
non-residential
59,266
56,840
Residential
1,579
1,458
Total outstanding commercial real estate loans
$
60,845
$
58,298
(1)
Includes
unsecured loans to real estate investment trusts and national home builders whose portfolios of properties span multiple geographic regions and properties in the states of Colorado, Utah, Hawaii, Wyoming and Montana.
U.S. Small Business Commercial
The U.S. small business commercial loan portfolio is comprised of small business card loans and small business loans managed in Consumer Banking. Credit card-related products were 51 percent and 50 percent of the U.S. small business commercial portfolio at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Of the U.S. small business commercial net charge-offs, 95 percent and 90 percent were credit card-related
products in 2018 and 2017.
Bank of America 2018 62
Nonperforming Commercial Loans, Leases and Foreclosed Properties Activity
Table 38 presents the nonperforming commercial loans, leases and foreclosed properties activity during 2018
and 2017. Nonperforming loans do not include loans accounted for under the fair value option. During 2018, nonperforming commercial loans and leases decreased$202 million to $1.1 billion. At December
31, 2018, 93 percent of commercial nonperforming loans, leases and foreclosed properties were secured and 55 percent were contractually current. Commercial nonperforming loans were carried at 89 percent of their unpaid principal balance before consideration of the allowance for loan and lease losses as the carrying value of these loans has been reduced
to the estimated collateral value less costs to sell.
Table 38
Nonperforming Commercial Loans, Leases and Foreclosed Properties Activity (1, 2)
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
Nonperforming loans and leases, January 1
$
1,304
$
1,703
Additions
1,415
1,616
Reductions:
Paydowns
(771
)
(930
)
Sales
(210
)
(136
)
Returns
to performing status (3)
(246
)
(280
)
Charge-offs
(361
)
(455
)
Transfers to
foreclosed properties
(12
)
(40
)
Transfers to loans held-for-sale
(17
)
(174
)
Total net reductions to nonperforming loans
and leases
(202
)
(399
)
Total nonperforming loans and leases, December 31
1,102
1,304
Foreclosed properties, December
31
56
52
Nonperforming commercial loans, leases and foreclosed properties, December 31
$
1,158
$
1,356
Nonperforming
commercial loans and leases as a percentage of outstanding commercial loans and leases (4)
0.22
%
0.27
%
Nonperforming commercial loans, leases and foreclosed properties as a percentage of outstanding commercial loans, leases and foreclosed properties (4)
0.23
0.28
(1)
Balances
do not include nonperforming loans held-for-sale of $292 million and $339 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(2)
Includes U.S. small business commercial activity. Small business card loans are excluded as they are not classified as nonperforming.
(3)
Commercial loans and leases may be returned to performing status when
all principal and interest is current and full repayment of the remaining contractual principal and interest is expected, or when the loan otherwise becomes well-secured and is in the process of collection. TDRs are generally classified as performing after a sustained period of demonstrated payment performance.
(4)
Outstanding commercial loans exclude loans accounted for under the fair value option.
Table 39 presents our commercial TDRs by product type and performing status. U.S. small business commercial TDRs are comprised of renegotiated small business card loans and small business loans. The renegotiated small business card loans
are not classified as nonperforming as they are charged off no later than the end of the month in which the loan becomes 180 days past due. For more information on TDRs, see Note 5 – Outstanding Loans and Leasesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Table 40 presents commercial committed and utilized credit exposure by industry and the total net credit default protection purchased to cover the funded and unfunded portions of certain credit exposures. Our commercial credit exposure is diversified across a broad range of industries. Total commercial committed exposure increased$28.8 billion, or three percent, during 2018 to $1.0 trillion. The increase in commercial committed exposure was concentrated in the Asset Managers and Funds, Pharmaceuticals and Biotechnology, and Capital Goods industry sectors. Increases were partially offset by reduced exposure to the Media, Food and Staples Retailing,
and Energy industry sectors.
Industry limits are used internally to manage industry concentrations and are based on committed exposure that is
allocated on an industry-by-industry basis. A risk management framework is in place to set and approve industry limits as well as to provide ongoing monitoring. The MRC oversees industry limit governance.
Asset Managers and Funds, our largest industry concentration with committed exposure of $107.9 billion, increased$16.8 billion, or 18 percent, during 2018. The change reflects an increase
in exposure to several counterparties.
Real Estate, our second largest industry concentration with committed exposure of $86.5 billion, increased$2.7 billion, or three percent, during 2018. For more information on the commercial real estate and related portfolios, see Commercial Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Commercial Real Estate on page 62.
63Bank
of America 2018
Capital Goods, our third largest industry concentration with committed exposure of $75.1 billion, increased$4.7 billion, or seven percent, during 2018. The increase in committed exposure occurred
primarily as a result of increases in large conglomerates, as well as trading companies, distributors and electrical equipment companies, partially offset by a decrease in machinery companies.
Our energy-related committed exposure decreased$4.5 billion, or 12 percent, during 2018 to $32.3 billion. Energy sector net
charge-offs were $31 million in 2018 compared to $156 million in 2017. Energy sector reservable criticized exposure decreased $833 million during 2018
to $787 million due to improvement in credit quality coupled with exposure reductions. The energy allowance for credit losses decreased $225 million during 2018 to $335 million.
Table
40
Commercial Credit Exposure by Industry (1)
Commercial
Utilized
Total Commercial
Committed (2)
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
Asset
managers and funds
$
71,756
$
59,190
$
107,888
$
91,092
Real
estate (3)
65,328
61,940
86,514
83,773
Capital goods
39,192
36,705
75,080
70,417
Finance
companies
36,662
34,050
56,659
53,107
Healthcare equipment and services
35,763
37,780
56,489
57,256
Government
and public education
43,675
48,684
54,749
58,067
Materials
27,347
24,001
51,865
47,386
Retailing
25,333
26,117
47,507
48,796
Consumer
services
25,702
27,191
43,298
43,605
Food, beverage and tobacco
23,586
23,252
42,745
42,815
Commercial
services and supplies
22,623
22,100
39,349
35,496
Energy
13,727
16,345
32,279
36,765
Transportation
22,814
21,704
31,523
29,946
Global
commercial banks
26,269
29,491
28,321
31,764
Utilities
12,035
11,342
27,623
27,935
Technology
hardware and equipment
13,014
10,728
26,228
22,071
Individuals and trusts
18,643
18,549
25,019
25,097
Media
12,132
19,155
24,502
33,955
Pharmaceuticals
and biotechnology
7,430
5,653
23,634
18,623
Vehicle dealers
17,603
16,896
20,446
20,361
Consumer
durables and apparel
9,904
8,859
20,199
17,296
Software and services
8,809
8,562
19,172
18,202
Insurance
8,674
6,411
15,807
12,990
Telecommunication
services
8,686
6,389
14,166
13,108
Automobiles and components
7,131
5,988
13,893
13,318
Food
and staples retailing
4,787
4,955
9,093
15,589
Religious and social organizations
3,757
4,454
5,620
6,318
Financial
markets infrastructure (clearinghouses)
2,382
688
4,107
2,403
Other
6,249
3,621
6,241
3,616
Total
commercial credit exposure by industry
$
621,013
$
600,800
$
1,010,016
$
981,167
Net
credit default protection purchased on total commitments (4)
$
(2,663
)
$
(2,129
)
(1)
Includes
U.S. small business commercial exposure.
(2)
Includes the notional amount of unfunded legally binding lending commitments net of amounts distributed (i.e., syndicated or participated) to other financial institutions. The distributed amounts were $10.7 billion and $11.0 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(3)
Industries
are viewed from a variety of perspectives to best isolate the perceived risks. For purposes of this table, the real estate industry is defined based on the primary business activity of the borrowers or counterparties using operating cash flows and primary source of repayment as key factors.
(4)
Represents net notional credit protection purchased. For additional information, see Commercial Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Risk Mitigation.
Risk Mitigation
We purchase credit protection to cover the funded portion as well as the unfunded
portion of certain credit exposures. To lower the cost of obtaining our desired credit protection levels, we may add credit exposure within an industry, borrower or counterparty group by selling protection.
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, net notional credit default protection purchased in our credit derivatives portfolio to hedge our funded and unfunded exposures for which we elected the fair
value option, as well as certain other credit exposures, was $2.7 billion and $2.1 billion. We recorded net losses of $2 million for 2018 compared to net losses
of $66 million in 2017 on these positions. The gains and losses on these instruments were offset by gains and losses on the related exposures. The Value-at-Risk (VaR) results for these exposures are included in the fair value option portfolio information in Table 47. For additional information, see Trading Risk Management on page 71.
Bank of America 2018 64
Tables
41 and 42 present the maturity profiles and the credit exposure debt ratings of the net credit default protection portfolio at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Table
41
Net Credit Default Protection by Maturity
December 31
2018
2017
Less
than or equal to one year
20
%
42
%
Greater than one year and less than or equal to five years
78
58
Greater than five years
2
—
Total
net credit default protection
100
%
100
%
Table
42
Net Credit Default Protection by Credit Exposure Debt Rating
Net Notional
(1)
Percent of Total
Net Notional (1)
Percent of Total
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Ratings (2,
3)
A
$
(700
)
26.3
%
$
(280
)
13.2
%
BBB
(501
)
18.8
(459
)
21.6
BB
(804
)
30.2
(893
)
41.9
B
(422
)
15.8
(403
)
18.9
CCC
and below
(205
)
7.7
(84
)
3.9
NR (4)
(31
)
1.2
(10
)
0.5
Total
net credit
default protection
$
(2,663
)
100.0
%
$
(2,129
)
100.0
%
(1)
Represents
net credit default protection purchased.
(2)
Ratings are refreshed on a quarterly basis.
(3)
Ratings of BBB- or higher are considered to meet the definition of investment grade.
(4)
NR is comprised of index positions held
and any names that have not been rated.
In addition to our net notional credit default protection purchased to cover the funded and unfunded portion of certain credit exposures, credit derivatives are used for market-making activities for clients and establishing positions intended to profit from directional or relative value changes. We execute the majority of our credit derivative trades in the OTC market with large, multinational financial institutions, including broker-dealers and, to a lesser degree, with a variety of other investors. Because these transactions are executed in the OTC market, we are subject to settlement risk. We are also subject to credit risk in the event that these counterparties fail to perform under the terms of these contracts. In order to properly reflect counterparty credit risk, we record
counterparty credit risk valuation adjustments on certain derivative assets, including our purchased credit default protection.
In most cases, credit derivative transactions are executed on a daily margin basis. Therefore, events such as a credit downgrade, depending on the ultimate rating level, or a breach of credit covenants would typically require an increase in the amount of collateral required by the counterparty, where applicable, and/or allow us to take additional protective measures such as early termination of all trades. For more information on credit derivatives and counterparty credit risk valuation adjustments, see Note 3 – Derivativesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Non-U.S.
Portfolio
Our non-U.S. credit and trading portfolios are subject to country risk. We define country risk as the risk of loss from unfavorable economic and political conditions, currency fluctuations, social instability and changes in government policies. A risk management framework is in place to measure, monitor and manage non-U.S. risk and exposures. In addition to the direct risk of doing business in a country, we also are exposed to indirect country risks (e.g., related to the collateral received on secured financing transactions or related to client clearing activities). These indirect exposures are managed in the normal course of business through credit, market and operational risk governance, rather than through country risk governance.
Table 43 presents our 20 largest non-U.S. country exposures at December
31, 2018. These exposures accounted for 89 percent and 86 percent of our total non-U.S. exposure at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Net country exposure for these 20 countries increased$44.1 billion in 2018, primarily driven by increased placements with central banks in the U.K., Japan and Germany.
Non-U.S. exposure is presented on an internal risk management basis and includes sovereign and non-sovereign credit exposure, securities and other investments issued by or domiciled
in countries other than the U.S.
Funded loans and loan equivalents include loans, leases, and other extensions of credit and funds, including letters of credit and due from placements. Unfunded commitments are the undrawn portion of legally binding commitments related to loans and loan equivalents. Net counterparty exposure includes the fair value of derivatives, including the counterparty risk associated with credit default swaps (CDS), and secured financing transactions. Securities and other investments are carried at fair value and long securities exposures are netted against short exposures with the same underlying issuer to, but not below, zero. Net country exposure represents country exposure less hedges and credit default protection purchased, net of credit default protection sold.
65Bank
of America 2018
Table
43
Top 20 Non-U.S. Countries Exposure
(Dollars
in millions)
Funded Loans and Loan Equivalents
Unfunded Loan Commitments
Net Counterparty Exposure
Securities/ Other
Investments
Country Exposure at December 31 2018
Hedges
and Credit Default Protection
Net Country Exposure at December 31 2018
Increase (Decrease) from December 31 2017
United Kingdom
$
28,833
$
20,410
$
6,419
$
2,639
$
58,301
$
(3,447
)
$
54,854
$
17,259
Germany
24,856
6,823
1,835
443
33,957
(5,300
)
28,657
7,154
Japan
17,762
1,316
1,023
1,341
21,442
(1,419
)
20,023
10,933
Canada
7,388
7,234
1,641
3,773
20,036
(521
)
19,515
792
China
12,774
681
975
495
14,925
(284
)
14,641
(1,284
)
France
7,137
5,849
1,331
1,214
15,531
(2,880
)
12,651
2,108
Netherlands
8,405
2,992
389
973
12,759
(1,182
)
11,577
3,110
India
7,147
451
312
3,379
11,289
(177
)
11,112
615
Brazil
6,651
544
209
3,172
10,576
(327
)
10,249
(467
)
Australia
5,173
3,132
571
1,507
10,383
(453
)
9,930
(659
)
South
Korea
5,634
463
897
2,456
9,450
(280
)
9,170
1,269
Switzerland
5,494
2,580
335
201
8,610
(846
)
7,764
1,967
Hong
Kong
5,287
442
321
1,224
7,274
(38
)
7,236
(1,442
)
Mexico
3,506
1,275
140
1,444
6,365
(129
)
6,236
749
Belgium
4,684
1,016
103
147
5,950
(372
)
5,578
1,613
Singapore
3,330
125
362
1,770
5,587
(70
)
5,517
(746
)
Spain
3,769
1,138
290
792
5,989
(1,339
)
4,650
1,542
United
Arab Emirates
3,371
135
138
55
3,699
(50
)
3,649
262
Taiwan
2,311
13
288
623
3,235
—
3,235
523
Italy
2,372
1,065
491
597
4,525
(1,444
)
3,081
(1,165
)
Total
top 20 non-U.S. countries exposure
$
165,884
$
57,684
$
18,070
$
28,245
$
269,883
$
(20,558
)
$
249,325
$
44,133
A
number of economic conditions and geopolitical events have given rise to risk aversion in certain emerging markets. Our largest emerging market country exposure at December 31, 2018 was China, with net exposure of $14.6 billion, concentrated in large state-owned companies, subsidiaries of multinational corporations and commercial banks.
The outlook for policy direction and therefore economic performance in the EU remains uncertain as a consequence of reduced political cohesion among EU countries. Additionally, we believe that the uncertainty in the U.K.’s ability to negotiate a favorable exit from the EU will further weigh on economic performance. Our largest EU country exposure at December
31, 2018 was the U.K. with net exposure of $54.9 billion, a $17.3 billion increase from December 31, 2017. The increase was driven by corporate loan growth and increased placements with the central bank as part of liquidity management.
Markets have reacted negatively to the escalating tensions between the U.S. and several key trading partners. We are closely
monitoring our exposures to tariff-sensitive industries and our international exposure, particularly to countries that account for a large percentage of U.S. trade.
Table 44 presents countries
where total cross-border exposure exceeded one percent of our total assets. At December 31, 2018, the U.K. and France were the only countries where total cross-border exposure exceeded one percent of our total assets. At December 31, 2018, Germany and China had total cross-border exposure of $20.4 billion and $19.5 billion representing 0.87 percent and 0.83 percent of our total assets. No other countries had total cross-border exposure that exceeded 0.75 percent of our total assets at December 31, 2018.
Cross-border
exposure includes the components of Country Risk Exposure as detailed in Table 43 as well as the notional amount of cash loaned under secured financing agreements. Local exposure, defined as exposure booked in local offices of a respective country with clients in the same country, is excluded.
Table
44
Total Cross-border Exposure Exceeding One Percent of Total Assets
(Dollars
in millions)
December 31
Public Sector
Banks
Private Sector
Cross-border Exposure
Exposure as a Percent of Total Assets
United
Kingdom
2018
$
1,505
$
3,458
$
46,191
$
51,154
2.17
%
2017
923
2,984
47,205
51,112
2.24
2016
2,975
4,557
42,105
49,637
2.27
France
2018
633
2,385
29,847
32,865
1.40
2017
2,964
1,521
27,903
32,388
1.42
2016
4,956
1,205
23,193
29,354
1.34
Bank
of America 2018 66
Provision for Credit Losses
The provision for credit losses decreased$114 million to $3.3 billion in 2018 compared to 2017 primarily due to improvement in the commercial portfolio, partially offset by an increase in the consumer portfolio. The provision for credit losses was $481 millionlower
than net charge-offs for 2018, resulting in a reduction in the allowance for credit losses. This compared to a reduction of $583 million in the allowance for credit losses in 2017.
The provision for credit losses for the consumer portfolio increased$222 million to $2.9 billion in 2018 compared to 2017. The increase was primarily driven by a slower pace of improvement in the consumer real estate portfolio, and portfolio seasoning and loan growth in the
U.S. credit card portfolio, partially offset by the impact of the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business in 2017.
The provision for credit losses for the commercial portfolio, including unfunded lending commitments, decreased$336 million to $333 million in 2018 compared to 2017. The decrease was primarily driven by a 2017 single-name non-U.S. commercial charge-off and improvement in the commercial portfolio.
Allowance for Credit Losses
Allowance for Loan and Lease Losses
The
allowance for loan and lease losses is comprised of two components. The first component covers nonperforming commercial loans and TDRs. The second component covers loans and leases on which there are incurred losses that are not yet individually identifiable, as well as incurred losses that may not be represented in the loss forecast models. We evaluate the adequacy of the allowance for loan and lease losses based on the total of these two components, each of which is described in more detail below. The allowance for loan and lease losses excludes loans held-for-sale (LHFS) and loans accounted for under the fair value option as the fair value reflects a credit risk component.
The first component of the allowance for loan and lease losses covers both nonperforming commercial loans and all TDRs within the consumer and commercial portfolios. These loans are subject to impairment measurement based on the present value of projected
future cash flows discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate, or in certain circumstances, impairment may also be based upon the collateral value or the loan’s observable market price if available. Impairment measurement for the renegotiated consumer credit card, small business credit card and unsecured consumer TDR portfolios is based on the present value of projected cash flows discounted using the average portfolio contractual interest rate, excluding promotionally priced loans, in effect prior to restructuring. For purposes of computing this specific loss component of the allowance, larger impaired loans are evaluated individually and smaller impaired loans are evaluated as a pool using historical experience for the respective product types and risk ratings of the loans.
The second component of the allowance for loan and lease losses covers the remaining consumer and commercial loans and leases that have
incurred losses that are not yet individually identifiable. The allowance for consumer (including credit card and other consumer loans) and certain homogeneous commercial loan and lease products is based on aggregated portfolio evaluations, which include both quantitative and qualitative components, generally by product type. Loss forecast models are utilized that consider a variety of factors including, but not limited to, historical loss experience, estimated defaults or foreclosures based on portfolio trends, delinquencies, economic trends and credit scores. Our consumer real estate loss forecast model estimates
the portion of loans that will default based on individual loan attributes, the most significant of which are refreshed LTV or CLTV, and borrower credit score as well as vintage and geography, all of which are further broken down into current delinquency status. Additionally,
we incorporate the delinquency status of underlying first-lien loans on our junior-lien home equity portfolio in our allowance process. Incorporating refreshed LTV and CLTV into our probability of default allows us to factor the impact of changes in home prices into our allowance for loan and lease losses. These loss forecast models are updated on a quarterly basis to incorporate information reflecting the current economic environment. As of December 31, 2018, the loss forecast process resulted in reductions in the allowance related to the residential mortgage and home equity portfolios compared to December 31, 2017.
The allowance for commercial loan and lease losses is established by product type after analyzing historical loss experience,
internal risk rating, current economic conditions, industry performance trends, geographic and obligor concentrations within each portfolio and any other pertinent information. The statistical models for commercial loans are generally updated annually and utilize our historical database of actual defaults and other data, including external default data. The loan risk ratings and composition of the commercial portfolios used to calculate the allowance are updated quarterly to incorporate the most recent data reflecting the current economic environment. For risk-rated commercial loans, we estimate the probability of default and the loss given default (LGD) based on our historical experience of defaults and credit losses. Factors considered when assessing the internal risk rating include the value of the underlying collateral, if applicable, the industry in which the obligor operates, the obligor’s liquidity and other financial indicators, and other quantitative and qualitative
factors relevant to the obligor’s credit risk. As of December 31, 2018, the allowance for the U.S. commercial and non-U.S. commercial portfolios decreased compared to December 31, 2017.
Also included within the second component of the allowance for loan and lease losses are reserves to cover losses that are incurred but, in our assessment, may not be adequately represented in the historical loss data used in the loss forecast models. For example, factors that we consider include, among others, changes in lending policies and procedures, changes in economic and business conditions, changes in the nature and size of the portfolio, changes in portfolio concentrations, changes in the volume and severity of past due loans and nonaccrual
loans, the effect of external factors such as competition, and legal and regulatory requirements. Further, we consider the inherent uncertainty in mathematical models that are built upon historical data.
During 2018, the factors that impacted the allowance for loan and lease losses included improvement in the credit quality of the consumer real estate portfolios driven by continuing improvements in the U.S. economy and strong labor markets, proactive credit risk management initiatives and the impact of high credit quality originations. Evidencing the improvements in the U.S. economy and strong labor markets are low levels of unemployment and increases in home prices. In addition to these improvements, in the consumer portfolio, nonperforming consumer loans decreased$1.3 billion in
2018 as returns to performing status, loan sales, paydowns and charge-offs continued to outpace new nonaccrual loans. During 2018, the allowance for loan and lease losses in the commercial portfolio reflected decreased energy reserves primarily driven by improvement in energy exposures including reservable criticized utilized exposures.
67Bank of America 2018
We
monitor differences between estimated and actual incurred loan and lease losses. This monitoring process includes periodic assessments by senior management of loan and lease portfolios and the models used to estimate incurred losses in those portfolios.
The allowance for loan and lease losses for the consumer portfolio, as presented in Table 45, was $4.8 billion at December 31, 2018, a decrease of $581 million from December 31, 2017. The decrease was primarily in the consumer real estate portfolio,
partially offset by an increase in the U.S. credit card portfolio. The reduction in the allowance for the consumer real estate portfolio was due to improved home prices, lower nonperforming loans and a decrease in loan balances in our non-core portfolio. The increase in the allowance for the U.S. credit card portfolio was driven by portfolio seasoning and loan growth.
The allowance for loan and lease losses for the commercial portfolio, as presented in Table 45, was $4.8 billion at December 31, 2018, a decrease of $211 million from December 31, 2017
primarily driven by improvement in energy exposures. Commercial reservable criticized utilized exposure decreased to $11.1 billion at December 31, 2018 from $13.6 billion (to 2.08 percent from 2.65 percent of total commercial reservable utilized exposure) at December 31, 2017, driven by broad-based improvements including the energy sector. Nonperforming commercial loans decreased to $1.1 billion at December
31, 2018 from $1.3 billion (to 0.22 percent from 0.27 percent of outstanding commercial loans excluding loans accounted for under the fair value option)
at December 31, 2017. See Tables 34, 35 and 36 for more details on key commercial credit statistics.
The allowance for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total loans and leases outstanding was 1.02 percent at December
31, 2018 compared to 1.12 percent at December 31, 2017.
Reserve for Unfunded Lending Commitments
In addition to the allowance for loan and lease losses, we also estimate probable losses related to unfunded lending commitments such as letters of credit, financial guarantees, unfunded bankers’ acceptances and binding loan commitments, excluding commitments accounted for under the fair value option. Unfunded lending commitments are subject to the same assessment as funded loans, including estimates of probability of default and LGD. Due to the nature of unfunded commitments, the estimate of probable losses must also consider utilization. To estimate the portion of these undrawn commitments that is likely to be
drawn by a borrower at the time of estimated default, analyses of our historical experience are applied to the unfunded commitments to estimate the funded exposure at default (EAD). The expected loss for unfunded lending commitments is the product of the probability of default, the LGD and the EAD, adjusted for any qualitative factors including economic uncertainty and inherent imprecision in models.
Ratios
are calculated as allowance for loan and lease losses as a percentage of loans and leases outstanding excluding loans accounted for under the fair value option. Consumer loans accounted for under the fair value option include residential mortgage loans of $336 million and $567 million and home equity loans of $346 million and $361 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Commercial loans accounted for under the fair value option include U.S. commercial loans of $2.5 billion and $2.6 billion and
non-U.S. commercial loans of $1.1 billion and $2.2 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(2)
Includes allowance for loan and lease losses for U.S. small business commercial loans of $474 million and $439 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(3)
Includes
$91 million and $289 million of valuation allowance presented with the allowance for loan and lease losses related to PCI loans at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
n/m = not meaningful
Bank of America 2018 68
Table
46 presents a rollforward of the allowance for credit losses, which includes the allowance for loan and lease losses and the reserve for unfunded lending commitments, for 2018 and 2017.
Table
46
Allowance for Credit Losses
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Allowance
for loan and lease losses, January 1
$
10,393
$
11,237
Loans and leases charged off
Residential mortgage
(207
)
(188
)
Home
equity
(483
)
(582
)
U.S. credit card
(3,345
)
(2,968
)
Non-U.S. credit card (1)
—
(103
)
Direct/Indirect
consumer
(495
)
(491
)
Other consumer
(197
)
(212
)
Total consumer charge-offs
(4,727
)
(4,544
)
U.S.
commercial (2)
(575
)
(589
)
Non-U.S. commercial
(82
)
(446
)
Commercial real
estate
(10
)
(24
)
Commercial lease financing
(8
)
(16
)
Total commercial charge-offs
(675
)
(1,075
)
Total
loans and leases charged off
(5,402
)
(5,619
)
Recoveries of loans and leases previously charged off
Residential mortgage
179
288
Home
equity
485
369
U.S. credit card
508
455
Non-U.S. credit card (1)
—
28
Direct/Indirect
consumer
300
277
Other consumer
15
49
Total consumer recoveries
1,487
1,466
U.S.
commercial (3)
120
142
Non-U.S. commercial
14
6
Commercial real
estate
9
15
Commercial lease financing
9
11
Total commercial recoveries
152
174
Total
recoveries of loans and leases previously charged off
1,639
1,640
Net charge-offs
(3,763
)
(3,979
)
Write-offs of
PCI loans
(273
)
(207
)
Provision for loan and lease losses
3,262
3,381
Other (4)
(18
)
(39
)
Allowance
for loan and lease losses, December 31
9,601
10,393
Reserve for unfunded lending commitments, January 1
777
762
Provision
for unfunded lending commitments
20
15
Reserve for unfunded lending commitments, December 31
797
777
Allowance
for credit losses, December 31
$
10,398
$
11,170
Loan and allowance ratios:
Loans
and leases outstanding at December 31 (5)
$
942,546
$
931,039
Allowance for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total loans and leases outstanding at December 31 (5)
1.02
%
1.12
%
Consumer
allowance for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total consumer loans and leases outstanding at December 31 (6)
1.08
1.18
Commercial allowance for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total commercial loans and leases outstanding at December 31 (7)
0.97
1.05
Average
loans and leases outstanding (5)
$
927,531
$
911,988
Net charge-offs as a percentage of average loans and leases outstanding (5, 8)
0.41
%
0.44
%
Net
charge-offs and PCI write-offs as a percentage of average loans and leases outstanding (5)
0.44
0.46
Allowance for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total nonperforming loans and leases at December 31 (5)
194
161
Ratio
of the allowance for loan and lease losses at December 31 to net charge-offs (8)
2.55
2.61
Ratio of the allowance for loan and lease losses at December 31 to net charge-offs and PCI write-offs
2.38
2.48
Amounts
included in allowance for loan and lease losses for loans and leases that are excluded from nonperforming loans and leases at December 31 (9)
$
4,031
$
3,971
Allowance for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total nonperforming loans and leases, excluding the allowance for loan and lease losses for loans and leases that are excluded from nonperforming loans and leases at December
31 (5, 9)
113
%
99
%
(1)
Represents net charge-offs related to the non-U.S. credit card loan portfolio, which was sold in 2017.
(2)
Includes
U.S. small business commercial charge-offs of $287 million and $258 million in 2018 and 2017.
(3)
Includes U.S. small business commercial recoveries of $47 million and $43 million in 2018 and 2017.
(4)
Primarily
represents the net impact of portfolio sales, consolidations and deconsolidations, foreign currency translation adjustments, transfers to held for sale and certain other reclassifications.
(5)
Outstanding loan and lease balances and ratios do not include loans accounted for under the fair value option of $4.3 billion and $5.7 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Average loans accounted for under the fair value option were $5.5 billion
and $6.7 billion in 2018 and 2017.
(6)
Excludes consumer loans accounted for under the fair value option of $682 million and $928 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(7)
Excludes
commercial loans accounted for under the fair value option of $3.7 billion and $4.8 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(8)
Net charge-offs exclude $273 million and $207 million of write-offs in the PCI loan portfolio in 2018 and 2017. For more information on PCI write-offs, see Consumer
Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Purchased Credit-impaired Loan Portfolio on page 57.
(9)
Primarily includes amounts allocated to U.S. credit card and unsecured consumer lending portfolios in Consumer Banking and PCI loans in All Other.
69Bank
of America 2018
Market Risk Management
Market risk is the risk that changes in market conditions may adversely impact the value of assets or liabilities, or otherwise negatively impact earnings. This risk is inherent in the financial instruments associated with our operations, primarily within our Global Markets
segment. We are also exposed to these risks in other areas of the Corporation (e.g., our ALM activities). In the event of market stress, these risks could have a material impact on our results. For more information, see Interest Rate Risk Management for the Banking Book on page 74.
Our traditional banking loan and deposit products are non-trading positions and are generally reported at amortized cost for assets or the amount owed for liabilities (historical cost). However, these positions are still subject to changes in economic value based on varying market conditions, with one of the primary risks being changes in the levels of interest rates. The risk of adverse changes in the economic value of our non-trading positions arising from changes in interest rates is managed through our ALM activities. We have elected to account for
certain assets and liabilities under the fair value option.
Our trading positions are reported at fair value with changes reflected in income. Trading positions are subject to various changes in market-based risk factors. The majority of this risk is generated by our activities in the interest rate, foreign exchange, credit, equity and commodities markets. In addition, the values of assets and liabilities could change due to market liquidity, correlations across markets and expectations of market volatility. We seek to manage these risk exposures by using a variety of techniques that encompass a broad range of financial instruments. The key risk management techniques are discussed in more detail in the Trading Risk Management section.
Global Risk Management is responsible for providing senior management with a clear and comprehensive understanding of the trading risks to which we
are exposed. These responsibilities include ownership of market risk policy, developing and maintaining quantitative risk models, calculating aggregated risk measures, establishing and monitoring position limits consistent with risk appetite, conducting daily reviews and analysis of trading inventory, approving material risk exposures and fulfilling regulatory requirements. Market risks that impact businesses outside of Global Markets are monitored and governed by their respective governance functions.
Quantitative risk models, such as VaR, are an essential component in evaluating the market risks within a portfolio. The Enterprise Model Risk Committee (EMRC), a subcommittee of the MRC, is responsible for providing management oversight and approval of model risk management and governance. The EMRC defines model risk standards, consistent with our risk framework and risk appetite,
prevailing regulatory guidance and industry best practice. Models must meet certain validation criteria, including effective challenge of the model development process and a sufficient demonstration of developmental evidence incorporating a comparison of alternative theories and approaches. The EMRC oversees that model standards are consistent with model risk requirements and monitors the effective challenge in the model validation process across the Corporation. In addition, the relevant stakeholders must agree on any required actions or restrictions to the models and maintain a stringent monitoring process for continued compliance.
Interest Rate Risk
Interest rate risk represents exposures to instruments whose values vary with the level or volatility of interest rates. These instruments include, but are not limited to, loans, debt securities,
certain
trading-related assets and liabilities, deposits, borrowings and derivatives. Hedging instruments used to mitigate these risks include derivatives such as options, futures, forwards and swaps.
Foreign Exchange Risk
Foreign exchange risk represents exposures to changes in the values of current holdings and future cash flows denominated in currencies other than the U.S. dollar. The types of instruments exposed to this risk include investments in non-U.S. subsidiaries, foreign currency-denominated loans and securities, future cash flows in foreign currencies arising from foreign exchange transactions, foreign currency-denominated debt and various foreign exchange derivatives whose values fluctuate with changes in the level or volatility of currency exchange rates or non-U.S. interest rates. Hedging
instruments used to mitigate this risk include foreign exchange options, currency swaps, futures, forwards, and foreign currency-denominated debt and deposits.
Mortgage Risk
Mortgage risk represents exposures to changes in the values of mortgage-related instruments. The values of these instruments are sensitive to prepayment rates, mortgage rates, agency debt ratings, default, market liquidity, government participation and interest rate volatility. Our exposure to these instruments takes several forms. For example, we trade and engage in market-making activities in a variety of mortgage securities including whole loans, pass-through certificates, commercial mortgages and collateralized mortgage obligations including collateralized debt obligations using mortgages as underlying collateral. In addition, we originate a variety of MBS, which involves the accumulation of mortgage-related
loans in anticipation of eventual securitization, and we may hold positions in mortgage securities and residential mortgage loans as part of the ALM portfolio. We also record MSRs as part of our mortgage origination activities. Hedging instruments used to mitigate this risk include derivatives such as options, swaps, futures and forwards as well as securities including MBS and U.S. Treasury securities. For more information, see Mortgage Banking Risk Management on page 76.
Equity Market Risk
Equity market risk represents exposures to securities that represent an ownership interest in a corporation in the form of domestic and foreign common stock or other equity-linked instruments. Instruments that would lead to this exposure include, but are not limited to, the following: common stock,
exchange-traded funds, American Depositary Receipts, convertible bonds, listed equity options (puts and calls), OTC equity options, equity total return swaps, equity index futures and other equity derivative products. Hedging instruments used to mitigate this risk include options, futures, swaps, convertible bonds and cash positions.
Commodity Risk
Commodity risk represents exposures to instruments traded in the petroleum, natural gas, power and metals markets. These instruments consist primarily of futures, forwards, swaps and options. Hedging instruments used to mitigate this risk include options, futures and swaps in the same or similar commodity product, as well as cash positions.
Issuer Credit Risk
Issuer credit risk represents exposures to changes in the creditworthiness of individual issuers
or groups of issuers. Our portfolio is exposed to issuer credit risk where the value of an asset may be adversely impacted by changes in the levels of credit spreads, by credit migration or by defaults. Hedging instruments
Bank of America 2018 70
used to mitigate this risk include bonds, CDS and other credit fixed-income instruments.
Market
Liquidity Risk
Market liquidity risk represents the risk that the level of expected market activity changes dramatically and, in certain cases, may even cease. This exposes us to the risk that we will not be able to transact business and execute trades in an orderly manner which may impact our results. This impact could be further exacerbated if expected hedging or pricing correlations are compromised by disproportionate demand or lack of demand for certain instruments. We utilize various risk mitigating techniques as discussed in more detail in Trading Risk Management.
Trading Risk Management
To evaluate risk in our trading activities, we focus on the actual and potential volatility of revenues generated by individual
positions as well as portfolios of positions. Various techniques and procedures are utilized to enable the most complete understanding of these risks. Quantitative measures of market risk are evaluated on a daily basis from a single position to the portfolio of the Corporation. These measures include sensitivities of positions to various market risk factors, such as the potential impact on revenue from a one basis point change in interest rates, and statistical measures utilizing both actual and hypothetical market moves, such as VaR and stress testing. Periods of extreme market stress influence the reliability of these techniques to varying degrees. Qualitative evaluations of market risk utilize the suite of quantitative risk measures while understanding each of their respective limitations. Additionally, risk managers independently evaluate the risk of the portfolios under the current market environment and potential future environments.
VaR
is a common statistic used to measure market risk as it allows the aggregation of market risk factors, including the effects of portfolio diversification. A VaR model simulates the value of a portfolio under a range of scenarios in order to generate a distribution of potential gains and losses. VaR represents the loss a portfolio is not expected to exceed more than a certain number of times per period, based on a specified holding period, confidence level and window of historical data. We use one VaR model consistently across the trading portfolios and it uses a historical simulation approach based on a three-year window of historical data. Our primary VaR statistic is equivalent to a 99 percent confidence level. This means that for a VaR with a one-day holding period, there should not be losses in excess of VaR, on average, 99 out of 100 trading days.
Within any VaR model, there are significant and numerous assumptions that
will differ from company to company. The accuracy of a VaR model depends on the availability and quality of historical data for each of the risk factors in the portfolio. A VaR model may require additional modeling assumptions for new products that do not have the necessary historical market data or for less liquid positions for which accurate daily prices are not consistently available. For positions with insufficient historical data for the VaR calculation, the process for establishing an appropriate proxy is based on fundamental and statistical analysis of the new product or less liquid position. This analysis identifies reasonable alternatives that replicate both the expected volatility and correlation to other market risk factors that the missing data would be expected to experience.
VaR may not be indicative of realized revenue volatility as changes in market conditions or in the composition of the portfolio can have
a material impact on the results. In particular, the historical data used for the VaR calculation might indicate higher
or lower levels of portfolio diversification than will be experienced. In order for the VaR model to reflect current market conditions, we update the historical data underlying our VaR model on a weekly basis, or more frequently during periods of market stress, and regularly review the assumptions underlying the model. A minor portion of risks related to our trading positions is not included in VaR. These risks are reviewed as part of our ICAAP. For more information regarding ICAAP, see Capital Management on page 43.
Global Risk Management continually reviews, evaluates and enhances our VaR model so that it reflects the material
risks in our trading portfolio. Changes to the VaR model are reviewed and approved prior to implementation and any material changes are reported to management through the appropriate management committees.
Trading limits on quantitative risk measures, including VaR, are independently set by Global Markets Risk Management and reviewed on a regular basis so that trading limits remain relevant and within our overall risk appetite for market risks. Trading limits are reviewed in the context of market liquidity, volatility and strategic business priorities. Trading limits are set at both a granular level to allow for extensive coverage of risks as well as at aggregated portfolios to account for correlations among risk factors. All trading limits are approved at least annually. Approved trading limits are stored and tracked in a centralized limits management system. Trading limit excesses are communicated to management for review.
Certain quantitative market risk measures and corresponding limits have been identified as critical in the Corporation’s Risk Appetite Statement. These risk appetite limits are reported on a daily basis and are approved at least annually by the ERC and the Board.
In periods of market stress, Global Markets senior leadership communicates daily to discuss losses, key risk positions and any limit excesses. As a result of this process, the businesses may selectively reduce risk.
Table 47 presents the total market-based portfolio VaR which is the combination of the total covered positions (and less liquid trading positions) portfolio and the fair value option portfolio. Covered positions are defined by regulatory standards as trading assets and liabilities, both on- and off-balance sheet, that meet a defined set
of specifications. These specifications identify the most liquid trading positions which are intended to be held for a short-term horizon and where we are able to hedge the material risk elements in a two-way market. Positions in less liquid markets, or where there are restrictions on the ability to trade the positions, typically do not qualify as covered positions. Foreign exchange and commodity positions are always considered covered positions, except for structural foreign currency positions that are excluded with prior regulatory approval. In addition, Table 47 presents our fair value option portfolio, which includes substantially all of the funded and unfunded exposures for which we elect the fair value option, and their corresponding hedges. Additionally, market risk VaR for trading activities as presented in Table 47 differs from VaR used for regulatory capital calculations
due to the holding period being used. The holding period for VaR used for regulatory capital calculations is 10 days, while for the market risk VaR presented below, it is one day. Both measures utilize the same process and methodology.
The total market-based portfolio VaR results in Table 47 include market risk to which we are exposed from all business segments, excluding credit valuation adjustment (CVA), DVA and related hedges. The majority of this portfolio is within the Global Markets segment.
71Bank of America
2018
Table 47 presents year-end, average, high and low daily trading VaR for 2018 and 2017 using a 99 percent confidence level. The amounts disclosed in Table 47 and Table 48 align to the view of covered positions used in the Basel 3 capital calculations. Foreign exchange and commodity
positions are always considered covered positions, regardless of trading or banking treatment for the trade,
except for structural foreign currency positions that are excluded with prior regulatory approval.
The average total covered positions and less liquid trading positions portfolio VaR decreased during 2018 primarily due to a decrease in credit risk along with an increase in portfolio diversification.
Table
47
Market Risk VaR for Trading Activities
2018
2017
(Dollars
in millions)
Year End
Average
High (1)
Low (1)
Year End
Average
High (1)
Low (1)
Foreign
exchange
$
9
$
8
$
15
$
2
$
7
$
11
$
25
$
3
Interest
rate
36
25
45
15
22
21
41
11
Credit
26
25
31
20
29
26
33
21
Equity
20
20
40
11
19
18
33
12
Commodities
13
8
15
3
5
5
9
3
Portfolio
diversification
(59
)
(55
)
—
—
(49
)
(47
)
—
—
Total
covered positions portfolio
45
31
45
20
33
34
53
23
Impact
from less liquid exposures
5
3
—
—
5
6
—
—
Total
covered positions and less liquid trading positions portfolio
50
34
51
23
38
40
63
26
Fair
value option loans
8
11
18
8
9
10
14
7
Fair
value option hedges
5
9
17
4
7
7
11
4
Fair
value option portfolio diversification
(7
)
(11
)
—
—
(7
)
(8
)
—
—
Total
fair value option portfolio
6
9
16
5
9
9
11
6
Portfolio
diversification
(3
)
(5
)
—
—
(4
)
(4
)
—
—
Total
market-based portfolio
$
53
$
38
57
26
$
43
$
45
69
29
(1)
The
high and low for each portfolio may have occurred on different trading days than the high and low for the components. Therefore the impact from less liquid exposures and the amount of portfolio diversification, which is the difference between the total portfolio and the sum of the individual components, is not relevant.
The graph below presents the daily covered positions and less liquid trading positions portfolio VaR for 2018, corresponding to the data in Table 47.
Bank
of America 2018 72
Additional VaR statistics produced within our single VaR model are provided in Table 48 at the same level of detail as in Table 47. Evaluating VaR with additional statistics allows for an increased understanding of the risks in the portfolio as the historical market data used in the VaR calculation does not necessarily follow a predefined statistical distribution. Table 48 presents average trading VaR statistics at 99 percent and 95 percent confidence levels for 2018 and 2017.
Table
48
Average Market Risk VaR for Trading Activities – 99 percent and 95 percent VaR Statistics
2018
2017
(Dollars
in millions)
99 percent
95 percent
99 percent
95 percent
Foreign exchange
$
8
$
5
$
11
$
6
Interest
rate
25
16
21
14
Credit
25
15
26
15
Equity
20
11
18
10
Commodities
8
4
5
3
Portfolio
diversification
(55
)
(33
)
(47
)
(30
)
Total covered positions portfolio
31
18
34
18
Impact
from less liquid exposures
3
1
6
2
Total covered positions and
less liquid trading positions portfolio
34
19
40
20
Fair value
option loans
11
6
10
6
Fair value option hedges
9
6
7
5
Fair
value option portfolio diversification
(11
)
(7
)
(8
)
(6
)
Total fair value
option portfolio
9
5
9
5
Portfolio diversification
(5
)
(3
)
(4
)
(3
)
Total
market-based portfolio
$
38
$
21
$
45
$
22
Backtesting
The accuracy of the VaR methodology is evaluated by backtesting, which compares the daily VaR results, utilizing a one-day holding period, against a comparable subset of trading revenue. A backtesting excess occurs when a trading loss exceeds the VaR for the corresponding day. These excesses are evaluated to understand the positions and market moves that produced the trading loss with a goal to ensure that the VaR methodology accurately represents those losses. We expect the frequency of trading losses in excess of VaR to be in line with the confidence level of the VaR statistic being tested. For example, with a 99 percent confidence level, we expect one trading loss in excess of VaR every 100 days or between two to three trading losses in excess of VaR over the course of a year. The number of backtesting excesses observed can differ from the statistically expected number of excesses if the current level of market volatility
is materially different than the level of market volatility that existed during the three years of historical data used in the VaR calculation.
The trading revenue used for backtesting is defined by regulatory agencies in order to most closely align with the VaR component of the regulatory capital calculation. This revenue differs from total trading-related revenue in that it excludes revenue from trading activities that either do not generate market risk or the market risk cannot be included in VaR. Some examples of the types of revenue excluded for backtesting are fees, commissions, reserves, net interest income and intraday trading revenues.
We conduct daily backtesting on the VaR results used for regulatory capital calculations as well as the VaR results for key legal entities, regions and risk factors. These results are reported to senior market risk management. Senior management
regularly reviews and evaluates the results of these tests.
During 2018, there were three days in which there was a backtesting excess for our total covered portfolio VaR, utilizing a one-day holding period.
Total Trading-related Revenue
Total trading-related revenue, excluding brokerage fees, and CVA, DVA and funding valuation adjustment gains (losses), represents the total amount earned from trading positions, including market-based net interest income, which are taken in a diverse range of financial instruments and markets. Trading account assets and liabilities are reported at fair value. For more information on fair value, see Note 20 – Fair Value Measurementsto the Consolidated
Financial Statements. Trading-related revenue can be volatile and is largely driven by general market conditions and customer demand. Also, trading-related revenue is dependent on the volume and type of transactions, the level of risk assumed, and the volatility of price and rate movements at any given time within the ever-changing market environment. Significant daily revenue by business is monitored and the primary drivers of these are reviewed.
The following histogram is a graphic depiction of trading volatility and illustrates the daily level of trading-related revenue for 2018 and 2017. During 2018, positive trading-related revenue was recorded for 98 percent of the trading days, of which 79 percent were daily trading gains of over $25 million. This compares
to 2017 where positive trading-related revenue was recorded for 100 percent of the trading days, of which 77 percent were daily trading gains of over $25 million.
73Bank of America 2018
Trading
Portfolio Stress Testing
Because the very nature of a VaR model suggests results can exceed our estimates and it is dependent on a limited historical window, we also stress test our portfolio using scenario analysis. This analysis estimates the change in the value of our trading portfolio that may result from abnormal market movements.
A set of scenarios, categorized as either historical or hypothetical, are computed daily for the overall trading portfolio and individual businesses. These scenarios include shocks to underlying market risk factors that may be well beyond the shocks found in the historical data used to calculate VaR. Historical scenarios simulate the impact of the market moves that occurred during a period of extended historical market stress. Generally, a multi-week period representing the most severe point during a crisis is selected for each historical scenario.
Hypothetical scenarios provide estimated portfolio impacts from potential future market stress events. Scenarios are reviewed and updated in response to changing positions and new economic or political information. In addition, new or ad hoc scenarios are developed to address specific potential market events or particular vulnerabilities in the portfolio. The stress tests are reviewed on a regular basis and the results are presented to senior management.
Stress testing for the trading portfolio is integrated with enterprise-wide stress testing and incorporated into the limits framework. The macroeconomic scenarios used for enterprise-wide stress testing purposes differ from the typical trading portfolio scenarios in that they have a longer time horizon and the results are forecasted over multiple periods for use in consolidated capital and liquidity planning. For more information, see Managing Risk
on page 40.
Interest Rate Risk Management for the Banking Book
The following discussion presents net interest income for banking book activities.
Interest rate risk represents the most significant market risk exposure to our banking book balance sheet. Interest rate risk is measured as the potential change in net interest income caused
by movements in market interest rates. Client-facing activities, primarily lending and deposit-taking, create interest rate sensitive positions on our balance sheet.
We prepare forward-looking forecasts of net interest income. The baseline forecast
takes into consideration expected future business growth, ALM positioning and the direction of interest rate movements as implied by the market-based forward curve. We then measure and evaluate the impact that alternative interest rate scenarios have on the baseline forecast in order to assess interest rate sensitivity under varied conditions. The net interest income forecast is frequently updated for changing assumptions and differing outlooks based on economic trends, market conditions and business strategies. Thus, we continually monitor our balance sheet position in order to maintain an acceptable level of exposure to interest rate changes.
The interest rate scenarios that we analyze incorporate balance sheet assumptions such as loan and deposit growth and pricing, changes in funding mix, product repricing, maturity characteristics and investment securities premium amortization. Our overall goal is to manage interest rate
risk so that movements in interest rates do not significantly adversely affect earnings and capital.
Table 49 presents the spot and 12-month forward rates used in our baseline forecasts at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Table
50 shows the pretax impact to forecasted net interest income over the next 12 months from December 31, 2018 and 2017, resulting from instantaneous parallel and non-parallel shocks to the market-based forward curve. Periodically we evaluate the scenarios presented so that they are meaningful in the context of the current rate environment.
During 2018, the asset sensitivity of our balance sheet to rising rates declined primarily due to increases in long-end rates. We continue to be asset sensitive to a parallel move in interest rates with the majority of that impact coming from the short end of the yield curve. Additionally, higher interest rates impact the fair value of debt securities and, accordingly, for
debt securities classified as AFS, may adversely affect accumulated OCI and thus capital levels under the Basel 3 capital rules. Under instantaneous upward parallel shifts, the near-term adverse impact to Basel 3 capital is reduced over time by offsetting positive impacts to net interest income. For more information on Basel 3, see Capital Management – Regulatory Capital on page 44.
Table
50
Estimated Banking Book Net Interest Income Sensitivity to Curve Changes
Short
Rate (bps)
Long
Rate (bps)
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Parallel
Shifts
+100 bps
instantaneous shift
+100
+100
$
2,651
$
3,317
-100 bps
instantaneous shift
-100
-100
(4,109
)
(5,183
)
Flatteners
Short-end
instantaneous change
+100
—
1,977
2,182
Long-end
instantaneous change
—
-100
(1,616
)
(2,765
)
Steepeners
Short-end
instantaneous change
-100
—
(2,478
)
(2,394
)
Long-end
instantaneous
change
—
+100
673
1,135
The sensitivity analysis in Table 50 assumes that we take no action in response to these rate shocks and does not assume any change in other
macroeconomic variables normally correlated with changes in interest rates. As part of our ALM activities, we use securities, certain residential mortgages, and interest rate and foreign exchange derivatives in managing interest rate sensitivity.
The behavior of our deposit portfolio in the baseline forecast and in alternate interest rate scenarios is a key assumption in our projected estimates of net interest income. The sensitivity analysis in Table 50 assumes no change in deposit portfolio size or mix from the baseline forecast in alternate rate environments. In higher rate scenarios, any customer activity resulting in the replacement of low-cost or noninterest-bearing deposits with higher yielding
Bank
of America 2018 74
deposits or market-based funding would reduce our benefit in those scenarios.
Interest Rate and Foreign Exchange Derivative Contracts
Interest rate and foreign exchange derivative contracts are utilized in our ALM activities and serve as an efficient tool to manage our interest rate and foreign exchange risk. We use derivatives to hedge the variability in cash flows or changes in fair value on our balance sheet due to interest rate and foreign exchange components. For more information on
our hedging activities, see Note 3 – Derivativesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Our interest rate contracts are generally non-leveraged generic interest rate and foreign exchange basis swaps, options, futures and forwards. In addition, we use foreign exchange contracts, including cross-currency interest rate swaps, foreign currency futures contracts, foreign currency forward contracts and options to mitigate the foreign exchange risk associated with foreign currency-denominated
assets and liabilities.
Changes to the composition of our derivatives portfolio during 2018 reflect actions taken for interest rate and foreign exchange rate risk management. The decisions to reposition our derivatives portfolio are based on the current assessment of economic and financial conditions including the interest rate and foreign currency environments, balance sheet composition and trends, and the relative mix of our cash and derivative positions.
We use interest rate derivative instruments to hedge the variability in the cash flows of our assets and liabilities and other forecasted transactions (collectively referred to as cash flow
hedges). The net losses on both open and terminated cash flow hedge derivative instruments recorded
in accumulated OCI were $1.3 billion, on a pretax basis, at both December 31, 2018 and 2017. These net losses are expected to be reclassified into earnings in the same period as the hedged cash flows affect earnings and will decrease income or increase expense on the respective hedged cash flows. Assuming no change in open cash flow derivative hedge positions and no changes in prices or interest rates beyond what is implied in forward yield curves at December 31, 2018, the pretax net losses are expected to be reclassified into earnings as follows: 25 percent within the next year, 56 percent in years two through five and 11 percent in years six through 10, with the remaining eight
percent thereafter. For more information on derivatives designated as cash flow hedges, see Note 3 – Derivativesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
We hedge our net investment in non-U.S. operations determined to have functional currencies other than the U.S. dollar using forward foreign exchange contracts that typically settle in less than 180 days, cross-currency basis swaps and foreign exchange options. We recorded net after-tax losses on derivatives in accumulated OCI associated with net investment hedges which were offset by gains on our net investments in consolidated non-U.S. entities at December 31, 2018.
Table
51 presents derivatives utilized in our ALM activities and shows the notional amount, fair value, weighted-average receive-fixed and pay-fixed rates, expected maturity and average estimated durations of our open ALM derivatives at December 31, 2018 and 2017. These amounts do not include derivative hedges on our MSRs.
Table
51
Asset and Liability Management Interest Rate and Foreign Exchange Contracts
Does
not include basis adjustments on either fixed-rate debt issued by the Corporation or AFS debt securities, which are hedged using derivatives designated as fair value hedging instruments, that substantially offset the fair values of these derivatives.
(2)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the notional amount of same-currency basis swaps included $101.2 billion and $38.6 billion in both foreign currency and U.S. dollar-denominated basis swaps in which both sides of the swap are in the
same currency.
(3)
Foreign exchange basis swaps consisted of cross-currency variable interest rate swaps used separately or in conjunction with receive-fixed interest rate swaps.
(4)
Does not include foreign currency translation adjustments on certain non-U.S. debt issued by the Corporation that substantially offset the fair values of these derivatives.
(5)
The
notional amount of foreign exchange contracts of $(8.4) billion at December 31, 2018 was comprised of $25.2 billion in foreign currency-denominated and cross-currency receive-fixed swaps, $(32.7) billion in net foreign currency forward rate contracts, $(1.8) billion in foreign currency-denominated pay-fixed swaps and $814 million in net foreign currency futures contracts. Foreign exchange contracts
of $(11.8) billion at December 31, 2017 were comprised of $29.1 billion in foreign currency-denominated and cross-currency receive-fixed swaps, $(35.6) billion in net foreign currency forward rate contracts, $(6.2) billion in foreign currency-denominated pay-fixed swaps and $940 million in foreign currency futures contracts.
(6)
Reflects
the net of long and short positions. Amounts shown as negative reflect a net short position.
Mortgage Banking Risk Management
We originate, fund and service mortgage loans, which subject us to credit, liquidity and interest rate risks, among others. We determine whether loans will be held for investment or held for sale at the time of commitment and manage credit and liquidity risks by selling or securitizing a portion of the loans we originate.
Interest rate risk and market risk can be substantial in the mortgage business. Changes in interest rates and other market factors impact the volume of mortgage originations. Changes in interest rates also impact the value of
interest rate lock commitments (IRLCs) and the related residential first mortgage LHFS between the date of the IRLC and the date the loans are sold to the secondary market. An increase in mortgage interest rates typically leads to a decrease in the value of these instruments. Conversely, when there is an increase in interest rates, the value of the MSRs will increase driven by lower prepayment expectations. Because the interest rate risks of these two hedged items offset, we combine them into one overall hedged item with one combined economic hedge portfolio consisting of derivative contracts and securities.
During 2018 and 2017, we recorded gains of $244 million and $118 million related to the change in fair value of the MSRs, IRLCs and LHFS,
net of gains and losses on the hedge portfolio. For more information on MSRs, see Note 20 – Fair Value Measurementsto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Compliance and Operational Risk Management
Compliance risk is the risk of legal or regulatory sanctions, material financial loss or damage to the reputation of the Corporation arising from the failure of the Corporation to comply with the requirements of applicable laws, rules, regulations and our internal policies and procedures (collectively, applicable laws, rules and regulations).
Operational risk is the risk of loss resulting
from inadequate or failed processes, people and systems or from external events. Operational risk may occur anywhere in the Corporation, including third-party business processes, and is not limited to operations functions. Effects may extend beyond financial losses and may result in reputational risk impacts. Operational risk includes legal risk. Additionally, operational risk is a component in the calculation of total risk-weighted assets used in the Basel 3 capital calculation. For more information on Basel 3 calculations, see Capital Management on page 43.
FLUs and control functions are first and foremost responsible for managing all aspects of their businesses, including their compliance and operational risk. FLUs and control functions are required to understand their business processes and related risks and controls, including
the related regulatory requirements, and monitor and report on the effectiveness of the control environment. In order to actively monitor and assess the performance of their processes and controls, they must conduct comprehensive quality assurance activities and identify issues and risks to remediate control gaps and weaknesses. FLUs and control functions must also adhere to compliance and operational risk appetite limits to meet strategic, capital and financial planning objectives. Finally, FLUs and control functions are responsible for the proactive identification, management and escalation of compliance and operational risks across the Corporation.
Global Compliance and Operational Risk teams independently assess compliance and operational risk, monitor business activities and processes, evaluate FLUs and control functions for adherence to applicable laws, rules and regulations, including identifying issues and risks, determining
and developing tests to be conducted by the Enterprise Independent Testing unit, and reporting on the state of the control environment. Enterprise Independent Testing, an independent testing function within IRM, works with Global Compliance and Operational Risk, the FLUs and
Bank of America 2018 76
control functions in the identification of testing needs and test design, and is accountable
for test execution, reporting and analysis of results.
The Corporation’s approach to the management of compliance risk is described in the Global Compliance - Enterprise Policy, which outlines the requirements of the Corporation’s compliance risk management program, and defines roles and responsibilities of FLUs, IRM and Corporate Audit, the three lines of defense in managing compliance risk. The requirements work together to drive a comprehensive risk-based approach for the proactive identification, management and escalation of compliance risks throughout the Corporation. For more information on FLUs and control functions, see Managing Risk on page 40.
The Corporation’s approach to operational risk management is outlined in the Operational Risk Management - Enterprise Policy which establishes
the requirements of the Corporation’s operational risk management program and specifies the responsibilities and accountabilities of the first and second lines of defense for managing operational risk so that our business processes are designed and executed effectively.
The Global Compliance Enterprise Policy and Operational Risk Management - Enterprise Policy also set the requirements for reporting compliance and operational risk information to executive management as well as the Board or appropriate Board-level committees in support of Global Compliance and Operational Risk’s responsibilities for conducting independent oversight of our compliance and operational risk management activities. The Board provides oversight of compliance risk through its Audit Committee and the ERC, and operational risk through the ERC.
A key operational risk facing the Corporation is information security,
which includes cybersecurity. Cybersecurity risk represents, among other things, exposure to failures or interruptions of service or breaches of security, resulting from malicious technological attacks or otherwise, that impact the confidentiality, availability or integrity of our operations, systems or data, including sensitive corporate and customer information. The Corporation manages information security risk in accordance withinternal policies which govern our comprehensive information security program designed to protect the Corporation by enabling preventative and detective measures to combat information and cybersecurity risks. The Board and the ERC provide cybersecurity and information security risk oversight for the Corporation and our Global Information Security Team manages the day-to-day implementation of our information security program.
Reputational
Risk Management
Reputational risk is the risk that negative perceptions of the Corporation’s conduct or business practices may adversely impact its profitability or operations. Reputational risk may result from many of the Corporation’s activities, including those related to the management of our strategic, operational, compliance and credit risks.
The Corporation manages reputational risk through established policies and controls in its businesses and risk management processes to mitigate reputational risks in a timely manner and through proactive monitoring and identification of potential reputational risk events. If reputational risk events occur, we focus on remediating the underlying issue and taking action to minimize damage to the Corporation’s reputation. The Corporation has processes and procedures in place to respond to events that give rise to reputational risk, including
educating individuals and organizations that influence public opinion, implementing external communication strategies to mitigate the risk, and informing key stakeholders of potential reputational risks.
The Corporation’s organization and governance structure provides oversight of reputational risks, and reputational risk reporting is provided regularly and directly to management and the ERC, which provides primary oversight of reputational risk. In addition, each FLU has a committee, which includes representatives from Compliance, Legal and Risk, that is responsible for the oversight of reputational risk. Such committees’ oversight includes providing approval for business activities that present elevated levels of reputational risks.
Complex
Accounting Estimates
Our significant accounting principles, as described in Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principlesto the Consolidated Financial Statements, are essential in understanding the Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations (MD&A). Many of our significant accounting principles require complex judgments to estimate the values of assets and liabilities. We have procedures and processes in place to facilitate making these judgments.
The more judgmental estimates are summarized in the following discussion. We have identified and described the development of the variables most important in the estimation
processes that involve mathematical models to derive the estimates. In many cases, there are numerous alternative judgments that could be used in the process of determining the inputs to the models. Where alternatives exist, we have used the factors that we believe represent the most reasonable value in developing the inputs. Actual performance that differs from our estimates of the key variables could materially impact our results of operations. Separate from the possible future impact to our results of operations from input and model variables, the value of our lending portfolio and market-sensitive assets and liabilities may change subsequent to the balance sheet date, often significantly, due to the nature and magnitude of future credit and market conditions. Such credit and market conditions may change quickly and in unforeseen ways and the resulting volatility could have a significant, negative effect on future operating results. These fluctuations would not be
indicative of deficiencies in our models or inputs.
Allowance for Credit Losses
The allowance for credit losses, which includes the allowance for loan and lease losses and the reserve for unfunded lending commitments, represents management’s estimate of probable incurred credit losses in the Corporation’s loan and lease portfolio excluding those loans accounted for under the fair value option. The allowance for credit losses includes both quantitative and qualitative components. The qualitative component has a higher degree of management subjectivity, and includes factors such as concentrations, economic conditions and other considerations. Our process for determining the allowance for credit losses is discussed in Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principlesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Our estimate for the allowance for loan and lease losses is sensitive to the loss rates and expected cash flows from our Consumer Real Estate and Credit Card and Other Consumer portfolio segments, as well as our U.S. small business commercial card portfolio within the Commercial portfolio segment. For each one-percent increase in the loss rates on loans collectively evaluated for impairment in our Consumer Real Estate portfolio segment, excluding PCI loans, coupled with a one-percent decrease in the discounted cash flows on those loans individually evaluated for impairment within this portfolio segment, the allowance for loan and lease losses at December 31, 2018 would have increased $24 million. We subject our PCI portfolio to stress
77Bank
of America 2018
scenarios to evaluate the potential impact given certain events. A one-percent decrease in the expected cash flows would result in a $41 million impairment of the portfolio. Within our Credit Card and Other Consumer portfolio segment and U.S. small business commercial card portfolio, for each one-percent increase in the loss rates on loans collectively evaluated for impairment coupled with a one-percent decrease in the expected cash flows on those loans individually evaluated for
impairment, the allowance for loan and lease losses at December 31, 2018 would have increased $44 million.
Our allowance for loan and lease losses is sensitive to the risk ratings assigned to loans and leases within the Commercial portfolio segment (excluding the U.S. small business commercial card portfolio). Assuming a downgrade of one level in the internal risk ratings for commercial loans and leases, except loans and leases already classified as Substandard and Doubtful as defined by regulatory authorities, the allowance for loan and lease losses would have increased $2.5 billion at December 31, 2018.
The allowance for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total loans and leases
at December 31, 2018 was 1.02 percent and these hypothetical increases in the allowance would raise the ratio to 1.30 percent.
These sensitivity analyses do not represent management’s expectations of the deterioration in risk ratings or the increases in loss rates but are provided as hypothetical scenarios to assess the sensitivity of the allowance for loan and lease losses to changes in key inputs. We believe the risk ratings and loss severities currently in use are appropriate and that the probability of the alternative scenarios outlined above occurring within a short period of time is remote.
The process of determining the level of the allowance for credit losses requires a high degree of judgment. It is possible that others, given
the same information, may at any point in time reach different reasonable conclusions.
Fair Value of Financial Instruments
Under applicable accounting standards, we are required to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs in measuring fair value. We classify fair value measurements of financial instruments and MSRs based on the three-level fair value hierarchy in the accounting standards.
The fair values of assets and liabilities may include adjustments, such as market liquidity and credit quality, where appropriate. Valuations of products using models or other techniques are sensitive to assumptions used for the significant inputs. Where market data is available, the inputs used for valuation reflect that information as of our valuation date. Inputs to valuation models are considered unobservable
if they are supported by little or no market activity. In periods of extreme volatility, lessened liquidity or in illiquid markets, there may be more variability in market pricing or a lack of market data to use in the valuation process. In keeping with the prudent application of estimates and management judgment in determining the fair value of assets and liabilities, we have in place various processes and controls that include: a model validation policy that requires review and approval of quantitative models used for deal pricing, financial statement fair value determination and risk quantification; a trading product valuation policy that requires verification of all traded product valuations; and a periodic review and substantiation of daily profit and loss reporting for all traded products. Primarily through validation controls, we utilize both broker and pricing service inputs which can and do include both market-observable and internally-modeled values and/or
valuation inputs. Our reliance on this information is affected by our understanding of how the broker and/or pricing service develops
its data with a higher degree of reliance applied to those that are more directly observable and lesser reliance applied to those developed through their own internal modeling. For example, broker quotes in less active markets may only be indicative and therefore less reliable. These processes and controls are performed independently of the business. For additional information, see Note 20 – Fair Value Measurements and Note 21 – Fair Value Optionto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Level 3 Assets and Liabilities
Financial
assets and liabilities, and MSRs, where values are based on valuation techniques that require inputs that are both unobservable and are significant to the overall fair value measurement are classified as Level 3 under the fair value hierarchy established in applicable accounting standards. The fair value of these Level 3 financial assets and liabilities and MSRs is determined using pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies or similar techniques for which the determination of fair value requires significant management judgment or estimation.
Level 3 financial instruments may be hedged with derivatives classified as Level 1 or 2; therefore, gains or losses associated with Level 3 financial instruments may be offset by gains or losses associated with financial instruments classified in other levels of the fair value hierarchy. The Level 3 gains and losses recorded in earnings did not have a significant impact on our
liquidity or capital. We conduct a review of our fair value hierarchy classifications on a quarterly basis. Transfers into or out of Level 3 are made if the significant inputs used in the financial models measuring the fair values of the assets and liabilities became unobservable or observable, respectively, in the current marketplace. For more information on transfers into and out of Level 3 during 2018, 2017 and 2016, see Note 20 – Fair Value Measurementsto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Accrued Income Taxes and Deferred Tax Assets
Accrued income taxes, reported as a component of either other assets or accrued expenses and other liabilities
on the Consolidated Balance Sheet, represent the net amount of current income taxes we expect to pay to or receive from various taxing jurisdictions attributable to our operations to date. We currently file income tax returns in more than 100 jurisdictions and consider many factors, including statutory, judicial and regulatory guidance, in estimating the appropriate accrued income taxes for each jurisdiction.
Net deferred tax assets, reported as a component of other assets on the Consolidated Balance Sheet, represent the net decrease in taxes expected to be paid in the future because of net operating loss (NOL) and tax credit carryforwards and because of future reversals of temporary differences in the bases of assets and liabilities as measured by tax laws and their bases as reported in the financial statements. NOL and tax credit
carryforwards result in reductions to future tax liabilities, and many of these attributes can expire if not utilized within certain periods. We consider the need for valuation allowances to reduce net deferred tax assets to the amounts that we estimate are more likely than not to be realized.
Consistent with the applicable accounting guidance, we monitor relevant tax authorities and change our estimates of accrued income taxes and/or net deferred tax assets due to changes in income tax laws and their interpretation by the courts and regulatory authorities. These revisions of our estimates, which also may result from our income tax planning and from the resolution of income tax audit matters, may be material to our operating results for any given period.
Bank
of America 2018 78
See Note 19 – Income Taxesto the Consolidated Financial Statements for a table of significant tax attributes and additional information. For more information, see page 13 under Item 1A. Risk Factors – Regulatory, Compliance and Legal.
Goodwill and Intangible Assets
The nature of and accounting for goodwill and intangible assets are discussed in Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles, and Note
8 – Goodwill and Intangible Assets. Beginning with our annual goodwill impairment test as of June 30, 2018, we conducted a qualitative assessment, rather than a quantitative assessment as previously performed, that is more fully described in Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principlesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
We completed our annual goodwill impairment test as of June 30, 2018 for all of our reporting units that had goodwill. We performed that test by assessing qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of each reporting unit is less than its
respective carrying value. Factors considered in the qualitative assessments include, among other things, macroeconomic conditions, industry and market considerations, financial performance of the respective reporting unit and other relevant entity- and reporting-unit specific considerations. If based on the results of the qualitative assessment, it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying value, a quantitative assessment is performed.
Based on our qualitative assessments, we determined that for each reporting unit with goodwill, it was more likely than not that its respective fair value exceeded its carrying value, indicating there was no impairment. For more information regarding goodwill balances at June 30, 2018, see Note 8 – Goodwill and Intangible Assetsto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
Representations and Warranties Liability
The methodology used to estimate the liability for obligations under representations and warranties related to transfers of residential mortgage loans is a function of the type of representations and warranties provided in the sales contracts and considers a variety of factors. These factors, which incorporate judgment, are subject to change based on our specific experience. Our experience in negotiating settlements with trustees and other counterparties is an important input in determining our estimate of the liability. We also consider actual defaults, estimated future defaults, historical loss experience, estimated home prices and other economic conditions. Changes
to any one of these factors could impact the estimate of our liability.
The representations and warranties provision may vary significantly each period as the methodology used to estimate the expense continues to be refined. The estimate of the liability for representations and warranties is sensitive to future defaults, loss severity and the net repurchase rate. An assumed simultaneous increase or decrease of 10 percent in estimated future defaults, loss severity and the net repurchase rate would result in an increase or decrease of approximately $200 million in the representations and warranties liability as of December 31, 2018. These sensitivities are hypothetical and are intended to provide an indication of the impact of a significant
change in these key assumptions on the representations and warranties liability. In reality, changes in one assumption may result in changes in other assumptions, which may or may not counteract the sensitivity.
For more information on representations and warranties exposure, see Note 12 – Commitments and Contingenciesto the Consolidated Financial Statements.
2017 Compared to 2016
The following discussion and analysis provide a comparison of our results of operations for 2017 and
2016. This discussion should be read in conjunction with the Consolidated Financial Statements and related Notes.
Overview
Net Income
Net income was $18.2 billion, or $1.56 per diluted share in 2017 compared to $17.8 billion, or $1.49 per diluted share in 2016. The results for 2017 included a charge of $2.9 billion related to the Tax Act. The pretax results for 2017
compared to 2016 were driven by higher revenue, largely the result of an increase in net interest income, lower provision for credit losses and a decline in noninterest expense.
Net Interest Income
Net interest income increased $3.6 billion to $44.7 billion in 2017 compared to 2016. Net interest yield on an FTE basis increased 12 bps to 2.37 percent for 2017. These increases were primarily driven by the benefits from higher interest rates and loan and deposit growth, partially offset by the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business in the second quarter of 2017.
Noninterest Income
Noninterest income increased $80 million to $42.7 billion in 2017 compared to 2016. The following highlights the significant changes.
●
Service charges increased $180 million primarily driven by the impact of pricing strategies and higher treasury services related revenue.
●
Investment
and brokerage services income increased $487 million primarily driven by the impact of AUM flows and higher market valuations, partially offset by the impact of changing market dynamics on transactional revenue and AUM pricing.
●
Investment banking income increased $770 million primarily due to higher advisory fees and higher debt and equity issuance fees.
●
Trading account profits increased $375
million primarily due to increased client financing activity in equities, partially offset by weaker performance across most fixed-income products.
●
Other income decreased $1.8 billion primarily due to lower mortgage banking income, with declines in both MSR results and production. Included in 2017 was a $793 million pretax gain recognized in connection with the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business and a downward valuation adjustment of $946 million on tax-advantaged energy investments in connection with the Tax Act.
Provision for Credit Losses
The provision for credit losses decreased $201
million to $3.4 billion for 2017 compared to 2016 primarily due to reductions in energy exposures in the commercial portfolio and credit quality improvements in the consumer real estate portfolio. This was partially offset by portfolio seasoning and loan growth in the U.S. credit card portfolio and a single-name non-U.S. commercial charge-off.
Noninterest Expense
Noninterest expense decreased $340 million to $54.7 billion for 2017 compared to 2016. The decrease was primarily due to lower operating costs, a reduction from the
sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business and lower litigation expense, partially offset by a $316 million impairment charge related to certain data centers that were in the process of being sold and
79Bank of America 2018
$145
million for the shared success discretionary year-end bonus awarded to certain employees.
Income Tax Expense
Tax expense for 2017 included a charge of $1.9 billion reflecting the impact of the Tax Act. Other than the impact of the Tax Act, the effective tax rate for 2017 was driven by our recurring tax preference benefits as well as an expense recognized in connection with the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business, largely offset by benefits related to the adoption of the new accounting standard for the tax impact associated with share-based compensation, and the restructuring of certain subsidiaries. The effective tax rate for 2016
was driven by our recurring tax preferences and net tax benefits related to various tax audit matters, partially offset by a charge for the impact of U.K. tax law changes enacted in 2016.
Business Segment Operations
Consumer Banking
Net income for Consumer Banking increased $1.0 billion to $8.2 billion in 2017 compared to 2016 primarily driven by higher net interest income, partially offset by higher provision for credit losses and lower mortgage banking income which is included in other noninterest income. Net interest income increased $3.0 billion to $24.3 billion
primarily due to the beneficial impact of an increase in investable assets as a result of higher deposits, as well as pricing discipline and loan growth. Noninterest income decreased $227 million to $10.2 billion driven by lower mortgage banking income, partially offset by higher card income and service charges. The provision for credit losses increased $810 million to $3.5 billion due to portfolio seasoning and loan growth in the U.S. credit card portfolio. Noninterest expense increased $131 million to $17.8 billion driven by higher personnel expense, including the shared success discretionary year-end bonus, and increased FDIC expense, as well as investments in digital capabilities and business growth. These increases were partially offset by improved operating efficiencies.
Global
Wealth & Investment Management
Net income for GWIM increased$312 million to $3.1 billion in 2017 compared to 2016 due to higher revenue, partially offset by an increase in noninterest expense. Net interest income increased $414 million to $6.2 billion driven by higher short-term interest rates. Noninterest income, which primarily includes investment and brokerage services income, increased $526 million to $12.4 billion. The increase in noninterest income was driven by the impact of AUM flows and higher market valuations, partially offset by the impact of changing market dynamics on transactional
revenue and AUM pricing. Noninterest expense increased $390 million to $13.6 billion primarily driven by higher revenue-related incentive costs.
Global Banking
Net income for Global Banking increased $1.2 billion to $7.0 billion in2017 compared to2016driven by higher revenue and lower
provision for credit losses. Revenue increased $1.6 billion to $20.0 billion driven by higher net interest income and noninterest income. Net interest income increased $1.0 billion to $10.5 billion due to loan and deposit-related growth, higher short-term rates on an increased deposit base and the impact of the allocation of ALM activities, partially offset by credit spread compression. Noninterest income increased $521 million to $9.5 billion largely due to higher investment banking fees. The provision for credit lossesdecreased$671millionto$212 millionin2017primarily driven by reductions in energy exposures and continued portfolio improvement, partially offset by Global Banking’s portion of a 2017 single-name non-U.S. commercial charge-off. Noninterest expense increased $110 million to $8.6 billion in 2017 primarily driven by higher investments in technology and higher deposit insurance, partially offset by lower litigation costs.
Global Markets
Net income for Global Markets decreased $524 million to $3.3
billion in 2017 compared to 2016. Net DVA losses were $428 million compared to losses of $238 million in 2016. Excluding net DVA, net income decreased $405 million to $3.6 billion primarily driven by higher noninterest expense, lower sales and trading revenue and an increase in the provision for credit losses, partially offset by higher investment banking fees. Sales and trading revenue, excluding net DVA, decreased $423 million primarily due to weaker performance in rates products and emerging markets. The provision for credit losses increased $133 million to $164 million in 2017, reflecting Global
Markets’ portion of a single-name non-U.S. commercial charge-off. Noninterest expense increased $560 million to $10.7 billion primarily due to higher litigation expense and continued investments in technology.
All Other
The net loss for All Other increased $1.6 billion to a net loss of $3.3 billion, driven by a charge of $2.9 billion due to enactment of the Tax Act. The pretax loss for 2017 compared to 2016 decreased $523 million reflecting lower noninterest expense and a larger benefit in the provision for credit losses, partially offset by a decline in revenue. Revenue declined
$1.5 billion primarily due to lower mortgage banking income. All other noninterest loss decreased marginally and included a pretax gain of $793 million on the sale of the non-U.S. credit card business and a downward valuation adjustment of $946 million on tax-advantaged energy investments in connection with the Tax Act.
The benefit in the provision for credit losses increased $461 million to a benefit of $561 million primarily driven by continued runoff of the non-core portfolio, loan sale recoveries and the sale of the non-U.S. consumer credit card business.
Noninterest expense decreased $1.5 billion to $4.1 billion driven by lower litigation expense, lower personnel expense and a decline in non-core mortgage servicing costs.
The
income tax benefit was $1.0 billion in 2017 compared to a benefit of $3.1 billion in 2016. The decrease in the tax benefit was driven by the impacts of the Tax Act. Both periods include income tax benefit adjustments to eliminate the FTE treatment of certain tax credits recorded in Global Banking.
Total
consumer loans excluding loans accounted for under the fair value option
446,549
454,348
456,320
454,298
486,493
Consumer
loans accounted for under the fair value option (3)
682
928
1,051
1,871
2,077
Total
consumer
447,231
455,276
457,371
456,169
488,570
Commercial
U.S.
commercial
299,277
284,836
270,372
252,771
220,293
Non-U.S.
commercial
98,776
97,792
89,397
91,549
80,083
Commercial
real estate (4)
60,845
58,298
57,355
57,199
47,682
Commercial
lease financing
22,534
22,116
22,375
21,352
19,579
481,432
463,042
439,499
422,871
367,637
U.S.
small business commercial (5)
14,565
13,649
12,993
12,876
13,293
Total
commercial loans excluding loans accounted for under the fair value option
495,997
476,691
452,492
435,747
380,930
Commercial
loans accounted for under the fair value option (3)
3,667
4,782
6,034
5,067
6,604
Total
commercial
499,664
481,473
458,526
440,814
387,534
Less:
Loans of business held for sale (6)
—
—
(9,214
)
—
—
Total
loans and leases
$
946,895
$
936,749
$
906,683
$
896,983
$
876,104
(1)
Includes
auto and specialty lending loans and leases of $50.1 billion, $52.4 billion, $50.7 billion, $43.9 billion and $38.7 billion, unsecured consumer lending loans of $383 million, $469 million, $585 million, $886 million and $1.5 billion, U.S. securities-based lending loans of $37.0 billion, $39.8 billion, $40.1 billion, $39.8 billion
and $35.8 billion, non-U.S. consumer loans of $2.9 billion, $3.0 billion, $3.0 billion, $3.9 billion and $4.0 billion, student loans of $0, $0, $497 million, $564 million and $632 million, and other consumer loans of $746 million, $684 million, $1.1 billion, $1.0 billion
and $761 million at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
(2)
Substantially all of other consumer at December 31, 2018 and 2017 is consumer overdrafts. Other consumer at December
31, 2016, 2015 and 2014 also includes consumer finance loans of $465 million, $564 million and $676 million, respectively.
(3)
Consumer loans accounted for under the fair value option were residential mortgage loans of $336 million, $567 million, $710 million, $1.6 billion
and $1.9 billion, and home equity loans of $346 million, $361 million, $341 million, $250 million and $196 million at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Commercial loans accounted for under the fair value option were U.S. commercial loans of $2.5 billion, $2.6 billion, $2.9
billion, $2.3 billion and $1.9 billion, and non-U.S. commercial loans of $1.1 billion, $2.2 billion, $3.1 billion, $2.8 billion and $4.7 billion at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
(4)
Includes
U.S. commercial real estate loans of $56.6 billion, $54.8 billion, $54.3 billion, $53.6 billion and $45.2 billion, and non-U.S. commercial real estate loans of $4.2 billion, $3.5 billion, $3.1 billion, $3.5 billion and $2.5 billion at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015
and 2014, respectively.
(5)
Includes card-related products.
(6)
Represents non-U.S. credit card loans, which were included in assets of business held for sale on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
81Bank
of America 2018
Table
II
Nonperforming Loans, Leases and Foreclosed Properties (1)
December 31
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
2016
2015
2014
Consumer
Residential
mortgage
$
1,893
$
2,476
$
3,056
$
4,803
$
6,889
Home
equity
1,893
2,644
2,918
3,337
3,901
Direct/Indirect
consumer
56
46
28
24
28
Other
consumer
—
—
2
1
1
Total
consumer (2)
3,842
5,166
6,004
8,165
10,819
Commercial
U.S.
commercial
794
814
1,256
867
701
Non-U.S.
commercial
80
299
279
158
1
Commercial
real estate
156
112
72
93
321
Commercial
lease financing
18
24
36
12
3
1,048
1,249
1,643
1,130
1,026
U.S.
small business commercial
54
55
60
82
87
Total
commercial (3)
1,102
1,304
1,703
1,212
1,113
Total
nonperforming loans and leases
4,944
6,470
7,707
9,377
11,932
Foreclosed
properties
300
288
377
459
697
Total
nonperforming loans, leases and foreclosed properties
$
5,244
$
6,758
$
8,084
$
9,836
$
12,629
(1)
Balances
do not include PCI loans even though the customer may be contractually past due. PCI loans were recorded at fair value upon acquisition and accrete interest income over the remaining life of the loan. In addition, balances do not include foreclosed properties insured by certain government-guaranteed loans, principally FHA-insured loans, that entered foreclosure of $488 million, $801 million, $1.2 billion, $1.4 billion and $1.1 billion at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014,
respectively.
(2)
In 2018, $625 million in interest income was estimated to be contractually due on $3.8 billion of consumer loans and leases classified as nonperforming at December 31, 2018, as presented in the table above, plus $6.8 billion of TDRs classified as performing at December 31, 2018. Approximately $388
million of the estimated $625 million in contractual interest was received and included in interest income for 2018.
(3)
In 2018, $119 million in interest income was estimated to be contractually due on $1.1 billion of commercial loans and leases classified as nonperforming at December 31, 2018, as presented in the table above, plus $1.3
billion of TDRs classified as performing at December 31, 2018. Approximately $84 million of the estimated $119 million in contractual interest was received and included in interest income for 2018.
Table
III
Accruing Loans and Leases Past Due 90 Days or More (1)
December 31
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
2016
2015
2014
Consumer
Residential
mortgage (2)
$
1,884
$
3,230
$
4,793
$
7,150
$
11,407
U.S.
credit card
994
900
782
789
866
Non-U.S.
credit card
—
—
66
76
95
Direct/Indirect
consumer
38
40
34
39
64
Other
consumer
—
—
4
3
1
Total
consumer
2,916
4,170
5,679
8,057
12,433
Commercial
U.S.
commercial
197
144
106
113
110
Non-U.S.
commercial
—
3
5
1
—
Commercial
real estate
4
4
7
3
3
Commercial
lease financing
29
19
19
15
40
230
170
137
132
153
U.S.
small business commercial
84
75
71
61
67
Total
commercial
314
245
208
193
220
Total
accruing loans and leases past due 90 days or more
$
3,230
$
4,415
$
5,887
$
8,250
$
12,653
(1)
Our
policy is to classify consumer real estate-secured loans as nonperforming at 90 days past due, except the PCI loan portfolio, the fully-insured loan portfolio and loans accounted for under the fair value option.
Sensitivity of selected loans to changes in interest rates for loans due after one year:
Fixed
interest rates
$
17,109
$
27,664
Floating
or adjustable interest rates
272,760
31,393
Total
$
289,869
$
59,057
(1)
Loan
maturities are based on the remaining maturities under contractual terms.
(2)
Includes loans accounted for under the fair value option.
(3)
Loan maturities include non-U.S. commercial and commercial real estate loans.
Table
V
Allowance for Credit Losses
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
2016
2015
2014
Allowance for loan and lease losses, January 1
$
10,393
$
11,237
$
12,234
$
14,419
$
17,428
Loans
and leases charged off
Residential mortgage
(207
)
(188
)
(403
)
(866
)
(855
)
Home
equity
(483
)
(582
)
(752
)
(975
)
(1,364
)
U.S.
credit card
(3,345
)
(2,968
)
(2,691
)
(2,738
)
(3,068
)
Non-U.S.
credit card (1)
—
(103
)
(238
)
(275
)
(357
)
Direct/Indirect
consumer
(495
)
(491
)
(392
)
(383
)
(456
)
Other
consumer
(197
)
(212
)
(232
)
(224
)
(268
)
Total
consumer charge-offs
(4,727
)
(4,544
)
(4,708
)
(5,461
)
(6,368
)
U.S.
commercial (2)
(575
)
(589
)
(567
)
(536
)
(584
)
Non-U.S.
commercial
(82
)
(446
)
(133
)
(59
)
(35
)
Commercial
real estate
(10
)
(24
)
(10
)
(30
)
(29
)
Commercial
lease financing
(8
)
(16
)
(30
)
(19
)
(10
)
Total
commercial charge-offs
(675
)
(1,075
)
(740
)
(644
)
(658
)
Total
loans and leases charged off
(5,402
)
(5,619
)
(5,448
)
(6,105
)
(7,026
)
Recoveries
of loans and leases previously charged off
Residential
mortgage
179
288
272
393
969
Home
equity
485
369
347
339
457
U.S.
credit card
508
455
422
424
430
Non-U.S.
credit card (1)
—
28
63
87
115
Direct/Indirect
consumer
300
277
258
271
287
Other
consumer
15
49
27
31
39
Total
consumer recoveries
1,487
1,466
1,389
1,545
2,297
U.S.
commercial (3)
120
142
175
172
214
Non-U.S.
commercial
14
6
13
5
1
Commercial
real estate
9
15
41
35
112
Commercial
lease financing
9
11
9
10
19
Total
commercial recoveries
152
174
238
222
346
Total
recoveries of loans and leases previously charged off
1,639
1,640
1,627
1,767
2,643
Net
charge-offs
(3,763
)
(3,979
)
(3,821
)
(4,338
)
(4,383
)
Write-offs
of PCI loans
(273
)
(207
)
(340
)
(808
)
(810
)
Provision
for loan and lease losses
3,262
3,381
3,581
3,043
2,231
Other (4)
(18
)
(39
)
(174
)
(82
)
(47
)
Total
allowance for loan and lease losses, December 31
9,601
10,393
11,480
12,234
14,419
Less:
Allowance included in assets of business held for sale (5)
—
—
(243
)
—
—
Allowance
for loan and lease losses, December 31
9,601
10,393
11,237
12,234
14,419
Reserve
for unfunded lending commitments, January 1
777
762
646
528
484
Provision
for unfunded lending commitments
20
15
16
118
44
Other
(4)
—
—
100
—
—
Reserve
for unfunded lending commitments, December 31
797
777
762
646
528
Allowance
for credit losses, December 31
$
10,398
$
11,170
$
11,999
$
12,880
$
14,947
(1)
Represents
net charge-offs related to the non-U.S. credit card loan portfolio, which was sold in 2017.
(2)
Includes U.S. small business commercial charge-offs of $287 million, $258 million, $253 million, $282 million and $345 million in 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014,
respectively.
(3)
Includes U.S. small business commercial recoveries of $47 million, $43 million, $45 million, $57 million and $63 million in 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
(4)
Primarily
represents the net impact of portfolio sales, consolidations and deconsolidations, foreign currency translation adjustments, transfers to held for sale and certain other reclassifications.
(5)
Represents allowance related to the non-U.S. credit card loan portfolio, which was sold in 2017.
83Bank of America 2018
Table
V
Allowance for Credit Losses (continued)
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
2016
2015
2014
Loan and allowance ratios (6):
Loans
and leases outstanding at December 31 (7)
$
942,546
$
931,039
$
908,812
$
890,045
$
867,422
Allowance
for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total loans and leases outstanding at December 31 (7)
1.02
%
1.12
%
1.26
%
1.37
%
1.66
%
Consumer
allowance for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total consumer loans and leases outstanding at December 31 (8)
1.08
1.18
1.36
1.63
2.05
Commercial
allowance for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total commercial loans and leases outstanding at December 31 (9)
0.97
1.05
1.16
1.11
1.16
Average
loans and leases outstanding (7)
$
927,531
$
911,988
$
892,255
$
869,065
$
888,804
Net
charge-offs as a percentage of average loans and leases outstanding (7, 10)
0.41
%
0.44
%
0.43
%
0.50
%
0.49
%
Net
charge-offs and PCI write-offs as a percentage of average loans and leases outstanding (7)
0.44
0.46
0.47
0.59
0.58
Allowance
for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total nonperforming loans and leases at December 31 (7)
194
161
149
130
121
Ratio
of the allowance for loan and lease losses at December 31 to net charge-offs (10)
2.55
2.61
3.00
2.82
3.29
Ratio
of the allowance for loan and lease losses at December 31 to net charge-offs and PCI write-offs
2.38
2.48
2.76
2.38
2.78
Amounts
included in allowance for loan and lease losses for loans and leases that are excluded from nonperforming loans and leases at December 31 (11)
$
4,031
$
3,971
$
3,951
$
4,518
$
5,944
Allowance
for loan and lease losses as a percentage of total nonperforming loans and leases, excluding the allowance for loan and lease losses for loans and leases that are excluded from nonperforming loans and leases at December 31 (7, 11)
113
%
99
%
98
%
82
%
71
%
(6)
Loan
and allowance ratios for 2016 include $243 million of non-U.S. credit card allowance for loan and lease losses and $9.2 billion of ending non-U.S. credit card loans, which were sold in 2017.
(7)
Outstanding loan and lease balances and ratios do not include loans accounted for under the fair value option of $4.3 billion, $5.7 billion, $7.1 billion, $6.9 billion and $8.7 billion at December 31, 2018, 2017,
2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Average loans accounted for under the fair value option were $5.5 billion, $6.7 billion, $8.2 billion, $7.7 billion and $9.9 billion in 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
(8)
Excludes consumer loans accounted
for under the fair value option of $682 million, $928 million, $1.1 billion, $1.9 billion and $2.1 billion at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
(9)
Excludes commercial loans accounted for under the fair value option of $3.7 billion, $4.8 billion,
$6.0 billion, $5.1 billion and $6.6 billion at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
(10)
Net charge-offs exclude $273 million, $207 million, $340 million, $808 million and $810 million of write-offs in the PCI loan portfolio in 2018, 2017,
2016, 2015 and 2014 respectively. For more information on PCI write-offs, see Consumer Portfolio Credit Risk Management – Purchased Credit-impaired Loan Portfolio on page 57.
(11)
Primarily includes amounts allocated to U.S. credit card and unsecured consumer lending portfolios in Consumer Banking and PCI loans and the non-U.S. credit card portfolio in All Other.
Table
VI
Allocation of the Allowance for Credit Losses by Product Type
December 31
2018
2017
2016
2015
2014
(Dollars
in millions)
Amount
Percent of Total
Amount
Percent of Total
Amount
Percent of Total
Amount
Percent of
Total
Amount
Percent of Total
Allowance for loan and lease losses
Residential
mortgage
$
422
4.40
%
$
701
6.74
%
$
1,012
8.82
%
$
1,500
12.26
%
$
2,900
20.11
%
Home
equity
506
5.27
1,019
9.80
1,738
15.14
2,414
19.73
3,035
21.05
U.S.
credit card
3,597
37.47
3,368
32.41
2,934
25.56
2,927
23.93
3,320
23.03
Non-U.S.
credit card
—
—
—
—
243
2.12
274
2.24
369
2.56
Direct/Indirect
consumer
248
2.58
264
2.54
244
2.13
223
1.82
299
2.07
Other
consumer
29
0.30
31
0.30
51
0.44
47
0.38
59
0.41
Total
consumer
4,802
50.02
5,383
51.79
6,222
54.21
7,385
60.36
9,982
69.23
U.S.
commercial (1)
3,010
31.35
3,113
29.95
3,326
28.97
2,964
24.23
2,619
18.16
Non-U.S.
commercial
677
7.05
803
7.73
874
7.61
754
6.17
649
4.50
Commercial
real estate
958
9.98
935
9.00
920
8.01
967
7.90
1,016
7.05
Commercial
lease financing
154
1.60
159
1.53
138
1.20
164
1.34
153
1.06
Total
commercial
4,799
49.98
5,010
48.21
5,258
45.79
4,849
39.64
4,437
30.77
Total
allowance for loan and lease losses (2)
9,601
100.00
%
10,393
100.00
%
11,480
100.00
%
12,234
100.00
%
14,419
100.00
%
Less:
Allowance included in assets of business held for sale (3)
—
—
(243
)
—
—
Allowance
for loan and lease losses
9,601
10,393
11,237
12,234
14,419
Reserve
for unfunded lending commitments
797
777
762
646
528
Allowance
for credit losses
$
10,398
$
11,170
$
11,999
$
12,880
$
14,947
(1)
Includes
allowance for loan and lease losses for U.S. small business commercial loans of $474 million, $439 million, $416 million, $507 million and $536 million at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
(2)
Includes
$91 million, $289 million, $419 million, $804 million and $1.7 billion of valuation allowance presented with the allowance for loan and lease losses related to PCI loans at December 31, 2018, 2017, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
(3)
Represents
allowance for loan and lease losses related to the non-U.S. credit card loan portfolio, which was sold in 2017.
Bank of America 2018 84
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk
See Market Risk Management on page 70
in the MD&A and the sections referenced therein for Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk.
Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
Report of Management on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
The management of Bank of America Corporation is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting.
The Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting is
a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. The Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Corporation; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, and that receipts and expenditures of the Corporation are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Corporation; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection
of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the Corporation’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Management assessed the effectiveness of the Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 based on the framework set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in Internal
Control – Integrated Framework (2013). Based on that assessment, management concluded that, as of December 31, 2018, the Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting is effective.
The Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018 has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers, LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their accompanying report which expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting as of December
31, 2018.
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of Bank of America Corporation:
Opinions on the Financial Statements and Internal Control over Financial Reporting
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Bank of America Corporation and its subsidiaries as of December 31, 2018and December 31, 2017,and the related consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, changes in shareholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018, including the related notes (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). We also have audited the Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework(2013)issued
by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Corporation as of December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2017, and the results of itsoperations and itscash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2018in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also
in our opinion, the Corporation maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2018, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework(2013)issued by the COSO.
Basis for Opinions
The Corporation’s management is responsible for these consolidated financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Report of Management on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express opinions on the Corporation’s consolidated
financial statements and on the Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB) and are required to be independent with respect to the Corporation in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud, and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.
Our audits of the consolidated financial statements included performing
procedures to assess the risks of material
misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as
we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.
Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary
to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that
controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Interest-bearing
deposits with the Federal Reserve, non-U.S. central banks and other banks
i148,341
i127,954
Cash
and cash equivalents
i177,404
i157,434
Time
deposits placed and other short-term investments
i7,494
i11,153
Federal
funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell
(includes $56,399 and $52,906measured at fair value)
i261,131
i212,747
Trading
account assets (includes $119,363 and $106,274pledged as collateral)
i214,348
i209,358
Derivative
assets
i43,725
i37,762
Debt
securities:
Carried at fair value
i238,101
i315,117
Held-to-maturity,
at cost (fair value – $200,435 and $123,299)
i203,652
i125,013
Total
debt securities
i441,753
i440,130
Loans
and leases (includes $4,349 and $5,710 measured at fair value)
i946,895
i936,749
Allowance
for loan and lease losses
(i9,601
)
(i10,393
)
Loans
and leases, net of allowance
i937,294
i926,356
Premises
and equipment, net
i9,906
i9,247
Goodwill
i68,951
i68,951
Loans
held-for-sale (includes $2,942 and $2,156measured at fair value)
i10,367
i11,430
Customer
and other receivables
i65,814
i61,623
Other
assets (includes $19,739 and $22,581measured at fair value)
i116,320
i135,043
Total
assets
$
i2,354,507
$
i2,281,234
Liabilities
Deposits
in U.S. offices:
Noninterest-bearing
$
i412,587
$
i430,650
Interest-bearing
(includes $492 and $449measured at fair value)
i891,636
i796,576
Deposits
in non-U.S. offices:
Noninterest-bearing
i14,060
i14,024
Interest-bearing
i63,193
i68,295
Total
deposits
i1,381,476
i1,309,545
Federal
funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase
(includes $28,875 and $36,182measured at fair value)
i186,988
i176,865
Trading
account liabilities
i68,220
i81,187
Derivative
liabilities
i37,891
i34,300
Short-term
borrowings (includes $1,648 and $1,494measured at fair value)
i20,189
i32,666
Accrued
expenses and other liabilities (includes $20,075 and $22,840measured at fair value
and $797 and $777 of reserve for unfunded lending commitments)
i165,078
i152,123
Long-term
debt (includes $27,637 and $31,786measured at fair value)
i229,340
i227,402
Total
liabilities
i2,089,182
i2,014,088
Commitments
and contingencies (Note 7 – Securitizations and Other Variable Interest Entities
and Note 12 – Commitments and Contingencies)
Shareholders’ equity
Preferred
stock, $0.01 par value; authorized – 100,000,000shares; issued and outstanding – 3,843,140 and 3,837,683 shares
i22,326
i22,323
Common
stock and additional paid-in capital, $0.01 par value; authorized – 12,800,000,000shares;
issued and outstanding – 9,669,286,370and 10,287,302,431 shares
i118,896
i138,089
Retained
earnings
i136,314
i113,816
Accumulated
other comprehensive income (loss)
(i12,211
)
(i7,082
)
Total
shareholders’ equity
i265,325
i267,146
Total
liabilities and shareholders’ equity
$
i2,354,507
$
i2,281,234
Assets
of consolidated variable interest entities included in total assets above (isolated to settle the liabilities of the variable interest entities)
Trading account assets
$
i5,798
$
i6,521
Loans
and leases
i43,850
i48,929
Allowance
for loan and lease losses
(i912
)
(i1,016
)
Loans
and leases, net of allowance
i42,938
i47,913
All
other assets
i337
i1,721
Total
assets of consolidated variable interest entities
$
i49,073
$
i56,155
Liabilities
of consolidated variable interest entities included in total liabilities above
Short-term borrowings
$
i742
$
i312
Long-term
debt (includes $10,943and $9,872 of non-recourse debt)
i10,944
i9,873
All
other liabilities (includes $27 and $34 of non-recourse liabilities)
i30
i37
Total
liabilities of consolidated variable interest entities
$
i11,716
$
i10,222
See
accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
NOTE 1iSummary of Significant Accounting Principles
Bank of America Corporation, a bank holding company and a financial
holding company, provides a diverse range of financial services and products throughout the U.S. and in certain international markets. The term “the Corporation” as used herein may refer to Bank of America Corporation, individually, Bank of America Corporation and its subsidiaries, or certain of Bank of America Corporation’s subsidiaries or affiliates.
Principles of Consolidation and Basis of Presentation
iThe Consolidated
Financial Statements include the accounts of the Corporation and its majority-owned subsidiaries and those variable interest entities (VIEs) where the Corporation is the primary beneficiary. Intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated. Results of operations of acquired companies are included from the dates of acquisition and for VIEs, from the dates that the Corporation became the primary beneficiary. Assets held in an agency or fiduciary capacity are not included in the Consolidated Financial Statements. The Corporation accounts for investments in companies for which it owns a voting interest and for which it has the ability to exercise significant influence over operating and financing decisions using the equity method of accounting. These investments are included in other assets. Equity method investments are subject to impairment testing, and the Corporation’s
proportionate share of income or loss is included in other income.
iThe preparation of the Consolidated Financial Statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (GAAP) requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect reported amounts and disclosures. Realized results could materially differ from those estimates and assumptions. Certain prior-period amounts have been reclassified to conform to current-period presentation.
iNew
Accounting Standards
Effective January 1, 2018, the Corporation adopted the following new accounting standards on a prospective basis.
●
Revenue Recognition– The new accounting standard addresses the recognition of revenue from contracts with customers. For additional information, see Revenue Recognition Accounting Policies in this Note, and.
●
Hedge
Accounting– The new accounting standard simplifies and expands the ability to apply hedge accounting to certain risk management activities. For additional information,see .
●
Recognition and Measurement of Financial Assets and Liabilities– The new accounting standard relates to the recognition and measurement of financial instruments, including equity investments. For additional information, see and .
●
Tax
Effects in Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income –The new accounting standard addresses certain tax effects stranded in accumulated other comprehensive income (OCI) related to the 2017 Tax Cuts and Job Act (the Tax Act).For additional information, see .
Effective January 1, 2018, the Corporation adopted the following new accounting standards on a retrospective basis, resulting in restatement of all prior periods presented in the Consolidated Statement of Income and the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows. The changes in presentation are not material to the individual line items affected.
●
Presentation
of Pension Costs–The new accounting standard requires separate presentation of the service cost component of pension expense from all other components of net pension benefit/cost in the Consolidated Statement of Income. As a result, the service cost component continues to be presented in personnel expense while other components of net pension benefit/cost (e.g., interest cost, actual return on plan assets, amortization of prior service cost) are now presented in other general operating expense. For additional information, see .
●
Classification of Cash Flows and Restricted Cash–The new accounting standards address the classification of certain cash receipts and cash payments in the statement of cash flows as well as the presentation and disclosure of restricted cash. For more information on restricted cash, see .
Lease Accounting
On January 1, 2019, the Corporation adopted the new accounting standards that require lessees to recognize operating leases on the Consolidated Balance Sheet as right-of-use assets and lease liabilities based on the value of the discounted future lease payments. Lessor accounting is largely unchanged. Expanded disclosures about the nature and terms of lease agreements will be required prospectively. The Corporation elected to apply certain transition elections which allow for the continued application of the previous
determination of whether a contract that existed at transition is or contains a lease, the associated lease classification, and the recognition of leases on January 1, 2019 through a cumulative-effect adjustment to retained earnings, with no adjustment to comparative prior periods presented. Upon adoption, the Corporation recognized right-of-use assets and lease liabilities of $i9.7
billion. Adoption of the standard did not have a significant effect on the Corporation’s regulatory capital measures.
Accounting Standards Issued and Not Yet Adopted
Accounting for Financial Instruments -- Credit Losses
The Financial Accounting Standards Board issued a new accounting standard that will be effective for the Corporation on January 1, 2020. The standard replaces the existing measurement of the allowance for credit losses that is based on management’s best estimate of probable credit losses inherent in the Corporation’s lending activities with management’s best estimate of lifetime expected credit losses inherent in the Corporation’s financial assets that are recognized at amortized cost. The standard will also expand credit quality disclosures.
While the standard changes the measurement of the allowance for credit losses, it does not change the Corporation’s credit risk of its lending portfolios. The credit loss estimation models and processes to be used in implementing the new standard have largely been designed and developed. The validation of the models and testing of controls are in process and expected to be completed during 2019. Currently, the impact of this new accounting standard may be an increase in the Corporation’s allowance for credit losses at the date of adoption which would have a resulting negative adjustment to retained earnings. The ultimate impact will be dependent on the characteristics of the
Bank
of America 2018 92
Corporation’s portfolio at adoption date as well as the macroeconomic conditions and forecasts as of that date.
Significant Accounting Principles
Cash and Cash Equivalents
iCash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, cash items in the process of collection, cash segregated under federal and other brokerage regulations,
and amounts due from correspondent banks, the Federal Reserve Bank and certain non-U.S. central banks. Certain cash balances are restricted as to withdrawal or usage by legal binding contractual agreements or regulatory requirements.
Securities Financing Agreements
iSecurities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase (securities financing agreements) are treated as collateralized financing transactions except in instances where the transaction
is required to be accounted for as individual sale and purchase transactions. Generally, these agreements are recorded at acquisition or sale price plus accrued interest, except for certain securities financing agreements that the Corporation accounts for under the fair value option. Changes in the fair value of securities financing agreements that are accounted for under the fair value option are recorded in trading account profits in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
The Corporation’s policy is to monitor the market value of the principal amount loaned under resale agreements and obtain collateral from or return collateral pledged to counterparties when appropriate. Securities financing agreements do not create material credit risk due to these collateral provisions; therefore, an allowance for loan losses is not necessary.
In transactions where the Corporation acts
as the lender in a securities lending agreement and receives securities that can be pledged or sold as collateral, it recognizes an asset on the Consolidated Balance Sheet at fair value, representing the securities received, and a liability, representing the obligation to return those securities.
Collateral
iThe Corporation accepts securities and loans as collateral that it is permitted by contract or practice to sell or
repledge. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the fair value of this collateral was $i599.0 billion and $i561.9
billion, of which $i508.6 billion and $i476.1
billion were sold or repledged. The primary source of this collateral is securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell.
The Corporation also pledges company-owned securities and loans as collateral in transactions that include repurchase agreements, securities loaned, public and trust deposits, U.S. Treasury tax and loan notes, and short-term borrowings. This collateral, which in some cases can be sold or repledged by the counterparties to the transactions, is parenthetically disclosed on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
In certain cases, the Corporation has transferred assets to consolidated VIEs where those restricted assets serve as collateral for the interests issued by the VIEs. These assets are included on the Consolidated Balance Sheet in Assets of Consolidated VIEs.
In addition, the
Corporation obtains collateral in connection with its derivative contracts. Required collateral levels vary depending on the credit risk rating and the type of counterparty. Generally, the Corporation accepts collateral in the form of cash, U.S. Treasury securities and other marketable securities. Based on provisions contained in master netting agreements, the
Corporation nets cash collateral received against derivative assets. The Corporation also pledges collateral on its own derivative positions which can be applied against derivative liabilities.
Trading Instruments
iFinancial
instruments utilized in trading activities are carried at fair value. Fair value is generally based on quoted market prices for the same or similar assets and liabilities. If these market prices are not available, fair values are estimated based on dealer quotes, pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies, or similar techniques where the determination of fair value may require significant management judgment or estimation. Realized gains and losses are recorded on a trade-date basis. Realized and unrealized gains and losses are recognized in trading account profits.
iDerivatives
and Hedging Activities
Derivatives are entered into on behalf of customers, for trading or to support risk management activities. Derivatives used in risk management activities include derivatives that are both designated in qualifying accounting hedge relationships and derivatives used to hedge market risks in relationships that are not designated in qualifying accounting hedge relationships (referred to as other risk management activities). The Corporation manages interest rate and foreign currency exchange rate sensitivity predominantly through the use of derivatives. Derivatives utilized by the Corporation include swaps, futures and forward settlement contracts, and option contracts.
All derivatives
are recorded on the Consolidated Balance Sheet at fair value, taking into consideration the effects of legally enforceable master netting agreements that allow the Corporation to settle positive and negative positions and offset cash collateral held with the same counterparty on a net basis. For exchange-traded contracts, fair value is based on quoted market prices in active or inactive markets or is derived from observable market- based pricing parameters, similar to those applied to over-the-counter (OTC) derivatives. For non-exchange traded contracts, fair value is based on dealer quotes, pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies or similar techniques for which the determination of fair value may require significant management judgment or estimation.
Valuations
of derivative assets and liabilities reflect the value of the instrument including counterparty credit risk. These values also take into account the Corporation’s own credit standing.
Trading Derivatives and Other Risk Management Activities
Derivatives held for trading purposes are included in derivative assets or derivative liabilities on the Consolidated Balance Sheet with changes in fair value included in trading account profits.
Derivatives used for other risk management activities are included in derivative assets or derivative liabilities. Derivatives used in other risk management activities have not been designated in qualifying accounting hedge relationships because they did not qualify or the risk that is being mitigated pertains to an item that is reported at fair value through earnings so that the effect of measuring the derivative
instrument and the asset or liability to which the risk exposure pertains will offset in the Consolidated Statement of Income to the extent effective. The changes in the fair value of derivatives that serve to mitigate certain risks associated with mortgage servicing rights (MSRs), interest rate lock commitments (IRLCs) and first-lien mortgage loans held-for-sale (LHFS) that are originated by the Corporation are recorded in other income. Changes in the fair value of derivatives that serve to mitigate interest rate risk and foreign currency risk are included
93Bank of America 2018
in
other income. Credit derivatives are also used by the Corporation to mitigate the risk associated with various credit exposures. The changes in the fair value of these derivatives are included in other income.
Derivatives Used For Hedge Accounting Purposes (Accounting Hedges)
For accounting hedges, the Corporation formally documents at inception all relationships between hedging instruments and hedged items, as well as the risk management objectives and strategies for undertaking various accounting hedges. Additionally, the Corporation primarily uses regression analysis at the inception of a hedge and for each reporting period thereafter to assess whether the derivative used in an accounting hedge transaction is expected to be and has been highly effective in offsetting changes in the fair value or cash flows of a hedged item or forecasted transaction. The Corporation discontinues
hedge accounting when it is determined that a derivative is not expected to be or has ceased to be highly effective as a hedge, and then reflects changes in fair value of the derivative in earnings after termination of the hedge relationship.
Fair value hedges are used to protect against changes in the fair value of the Corporation’s assets and liabilities that are attributable to interest rate or foreign exchange volatility. Changes in the fair value of derivatives designated as fair value hedges are recorded in earnings, together and in the same income statement line item with changes in the fair value of the related hedged item. If a derivative instrument in a fair value hedge is terminated or the hedge designation removed, the previous adjustments to the carrying value of the hedged asset or liability are subsequently accounted for in the same manner as other components of the carrying value of that asset or liability.
For interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, such adjustments are amortized to earnings over the remaining life of the respective asset or liability.
Cash flow hedges are used primarily to minimize the variability in cash flows of assets and liabilities or forecasted transactions caused by interest rate or foreign exchange rate fluctuations. Changes in the fair value of derivatives used in cash flow hedges are recorded in accumulated OCI and are reclassified into the line item in the income statement in which the hedged item is recorded in the same period the hedged item affects earnings. Components of a derivative that are excluded in assessing hedge effectiveness are recorded in the same income statement line item as the hedged item.
Net investment hedges are used to manage the foreign exchange rate sensitivity arising from a net investment in a foreign operation.
Changes in the spot prices of derivatives that are designated as net investment hedges of foreign operations are recorded as a component of accumulated OCI. The remaining components of these derivatives are excluded in assessing hedge effectiveness and are recorded in other income.
Securities
iDebt securities are reported on the Consolidated Balance Sheet at their trade date. Their classification is dependent on the purpose for which the securities were acquired. Debt securities purchased for use in the Corporation’s trading activities
are reported in trading account assets at fair value with unrealized gains and losses included in trading account profits. Substantially all other debt securities purchased are used in the Corporation’s asset and liability management (ALM) activities and are reported on the Consolidated Balance Sheet as either debt securities carried at fair value or as held-to-maturity (HTM) debt securities. Debt securities carried at fair value are either available-for-sale (AFS)
securities with unrealized gains and losses net-of-tax included in accumulated OCI or carried at fair value with unrealized gains and losses reported in other income. HTM debt securities, which are certain debt securities that management has the intent and ability to hold to maturity, are reported at amortized cost.
The Corporation regularly evaluates each AFS and HTM
debt security where the value has declined below amortized cost to assess whether the decline in fair value is other than temporary. In determining whether an impairment is other than temporary, the Corporation considers the severity and duration of the decline in fair value, the length of time expected for recovery, the financial condition of the issuer, and other qualitative factors, as well as whether the Corporation either plans to sell the security or it is more likely than not that it will be required to sell the security before recovery of the amortized cost. For AFS debt securities the Corporation intends to hold, an analysis is performed to determine how much of the decline in fair value is related to the issuer’s credit and how much is related to market factors (e.g., interest rates). If any of the decline in fair value is due to credit, an other-than-temporary impairment (OTTI) loss is recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Income for that amount. If
any of the decline in fair value is related to market factors, that amount is recognized in accumulated OCI. In certain instances, the credit loss may exceed the total decline in fair value, in which case, the difference is due to market factors and is recognized as an unrealized gain in accumulated OCI. If the Corporation intends to sell or believes it is more likely than not that it will be required to sell the debt security, it is written down to fair value as an OTTI loss.
Interest on debt securities, including amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts, is included in interest income. Premiums and discounts are amortized or accreted to interest income at a constant effective yield over the contractual lives of the securities. Realized gains and losses from the sales of debt securities are determined using the specific identification method.
Equity securities with readily
determinable fair values that are not held for trading purposes are carried at fair value with unrealized gains and losses included in other income. Equity securities that do not have readily determinable fair values are held at cost and evaluated for impairment. These securities are reported in other assets or time deposits placed and other short-term investments.
Loans and Leases
iLoans, with the exception of loans accounted for under the fair value option, are measured at historical cost and reported at their
outstanding principal balances net of any unearned income, charge-offs, unamortized deferred fees and costs on originated loans, and for purchased loans, net of any unamortized premiums or discounts. Loan origination fees and certain direct origination costs are deferred and recognized as adjustments to interest income over the lives of the related loans. Unearned income, discounts and premiums are amortized to interest income using a level yield methodology. The Corporation elects to account for certain consumer and commercial loans under the fair value option with changes in fair value reported in other income.
Under applicable accounting guidance, for reporting purposes, the loan and lease portfolio is categorized by portfolio segment and, within each portfolio segment, by class of financing receivables. A portfolio segment is defined as the level at which an entity develops and documents a systematic methodology
to determine the allowance for credit losses, and a class of financing receivables is defined as the level of disaggregation of portfolio segments based on the initial measurement attribute, risk
Bank of America 2018 94
characteristics and methods for assessing risk. The Corporation’s ithree
portfolio segments are Consumer Real Estate, Credit Card and Other Consumer, and Commercial. The classes within the Consumer Real Estate portfolio segment are residential mortgage and home equity. The classes within the Credit Card and Other Consumer portfolio segment are U.S. credit card, direct/indirect consumer and other consumer. The classes within the Commercial portfolio segment are U.S. commercial, non-U.S. commercial, commercial real estate, commercial lease financing and U.S. small business commercial.
Purchased Credit-impaired Loans
At acquisition, purchased credit-impaired (PCI) loans are recorded at fair value with no allowance for credit losses, and accounted for individually or aggregated in pools based on similar risk characteristics. The expected cash flows in excess of the amount paid for the loans is referred to as
the accretable yield and is recorded as interest income over the remaining estimated life of the loan or pool of loans. The excess of the contractual principal and interest over the expected cash flows of the PCI loans is referred to as the nonaccretable difference. If, upon subsequent valuation, the Corporation determines it is probable that the present value of the expected cash flows has decreased, a charge to the provision for credit losses is recorded. If it is probable that there is a significant increase in the present value of expected cash flows, the allowance for credit losses is reduced or, if there is no remaining allowance for credit losses related to these PCI loans, the accretable yield is increased through a reclassification from nonaccretable difference, resulting in a prospective increase in interest income. Reclassifications to or from nonaccretable difference can also occur for changes in the estimated lives of the PCI loans. If a loan within a PCI
pool is sold, foreclosed, forgiven or the expectation of any future proceeds is remote, the loan is removed from the pool at its proportional carrying value. If the loan’s recovery value is less than its carrying value, the difference is first applied against the PCI pool’s nonaccretable difference and then against the allowance for credit losses.
Leases
The Corporation provides equipment financing to its customers through a variety of lease arrangements. Direct financing leases are carried at the aggregate of lease payments receivable plus estimated residual value of the leased property less unearned income. Leveraged leases, which are a form of financing leases, are reported net of non-recourse debt. Unearned income on leveraged and direct financing leases is accreted to interest income over the lease terms using methods that approximate the interest method.
Allowance
for Credit Losses
iThe allowance for credit losses, which includes the allowance for loan and lease losses and the reserve for unfunded lending commitments, represents management’s estimate of probable incurred credit losses in the Corporation’s loan and lease portfolio excluding loans and unfunded lending commitments accounted for under the fair value option. The allowance for credit losses includes both quantitative and qualitative components. The qualitative component has a higher degree of management subjectivity,
and includes factors such as concentrations, economic conditions and other considerations. The allowance for loan and lease losses represents the estimated probable credit losses on funded consumer and commercial loans and leases while the reserve for unfunded lending commitments, including standby letters of credit (SBLCs) and binding unfunded loan commitments, represents estimated probable credit losses o
n these unfunded credit instruments based on utilization assumptions. Lending-related credit exposures deemed to be uncollectible, excluding loans carried at fair value, are charged off against these accounts.
The Corporation performs periodic and systematic detailed reviews of its lending portfolios to identify credit risks and to assess the overall collectability of those portfolios. The allowance on certain homogeneous consumer
loan portfolios, which generally consist of consumer real estate loans within the Consumer Real Estate portfolio segment and credit card loans within the Credit Card and Other Consumer portfolio segment, is based on aggregated portfolio segment evaluations generally by product type. Loss forecast models are utilized for these portfolios which consider a variety of factors including, but not limited to, historical loss experience, estimated defaults or foreclosures based on portfolio trends, delinquencies, bankruptcies, economic conditions, credit scores and the amount of loss in the event of default.
For consumer loans secured by residential real estate, using statistical modeling methodologies, the Corporation estimates the number of loans that will default based on the individual loan attributes aggregated into pools of homogeneous loans with similar attributes. The attributes that are most significant to the probability
of default and are used to estimate defaults include refreshed loan-to-value (LTV) or, in the case of a subordinated lien, refreshed combined LTV (CLTV), borrower credit score, months since origination (referred to as vintage) and geography, all of which are further broken down by present collection status (whether the loan is current, delinquent, in default or in bankruptcy). The severity or loss given default is estimated based on the refreshed LTV for first-lien mortgages or CLTV for subordinated liens. The estimates are based on the Corporation’s historical experience with the loan portfolio, adjusted to reflect an assessment of environmental factors not yet reflected in the historical data underlying the loss estimates, such as changes in real estate values, local and national economies, underwriting standards and the regulatory environment. The probability of default models also incorporate recent experience with modification programs including re-defaults subsequent
to modification, a loan’s default history prior to modification and the change in borrower payments post-modification. On home equity loans where the Corporation holds only a second-lien position and foreclosure is not the best alternative, the loss severity is estimated at i100
percent.
The allowance on certain commercial loans (except business card and certain small business loans) is calculated using loss rates delineated by risk rating and product type. Factors considered when assessing loss rates include the value of the underlying collateral, if applicable, the industry of the obligor, and the obligor’s liquidity and other financial indicators along with certain qualitative factors. These statistical models are updated regularly for changes in economic and business conditions. Included in the analysis of consumer and commercial loan portfolios are qualitative estimates which are maintained to cover uncertainties that affect the Corporation’s estimate of probable losses including domestic and global economic uncertainty and large single-name defaults.
For individually impaired loans, which include nonperforming commercial
loans as well as consumer and commercial loans and leases modified in a troubled debt restructuring (TDR), management measures impairment primarily based on the present value of payments expected to be received, discounted at the loans’ original effective contractual interest rates. Credit card loans are discounted at the portfolio average contractual annual percentage rate, excluding promotionally priced loans, in effect prior to restructuring. Impaired loans and TDRs may also be
95Bank of America 2018
measured
based on observable market prices, or for loans that are solely dependent on the collateral for repayment, the estimated fair value of the collateral less costs to sell. If the recorded investment in impaired loans exceeds this amount, a specific allowance is established as part of the allowance for loan and lease losses unless these are secured consumer loans that are solely dependent on collateral for repayment, in which case the amount that exceeds the fair value of the collateral is charged off.
Generally, the Corporation initially estimates the fair value of the collateral securing these consumer real estate-secured loans using an automated valuation model (AVM). An AVM is a tool that estimates the value of a property by reference to market data including sales of comparable properties and price trends specific to the Metropolitan Statistical Area in which the property being valued is located. In the event that an AVM
value is not available, the Corporation utilizes publicized indices or if these methods provide less reliable valuations, the Corporation uses appraisals or broker price opinions to estimate the fair value of the collateral. While there is inherent imprecision in these valuations, the Corporation believes that they are representative of the portfolio in the aggregate.
In addition to the allowance for loan and lease losses, the Corporation also estimates probable losses related to unfunded lending commitments, such as letters of credit, financial guarantees and binding unfunded loan commitments. Unfunded lending commitments are subject to individual reviews and are analyzed and segregated by risk according to the Corporation’s internal risk rating scale. These risk classifications, in conjunction with an analysis of historical loss experience, utilization assumptions, current economic conditions, performance trends within the
portfolio and any other pertinent information, result in the estimation of the reserve for unfunded lending commitments.
The allowance for credit losses related to the loan and lease portfolio is reported separately on the Consolidated Balance Sheet whereas the reserve for unfunded lending commitments is reported on the Consolidated Balance Sheet in accrued expenses and other liabilities. The provision for credit losses related to the loan and lease portfolio and unfunded lending commitments is reported in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
Nonperforming Loans and Leases, Charge-offs and Delinquencies
iNonperforming
loans and leases generally include loans and leases that have been placed on nonaccrual status. Loans accounted for under the fair value option, PCI loans and LHFS are not reported as nonperforming.
In accordance with the Corporation’s policies, consumer real estate-secured loans, including residential mortgages and home equity loans, are generally placed on nonaccrual status and classified as nonperforming at i90
days past due unless repayment of the loan is insured by the Federal Housing Administration (FHA) or through individually insured long-term standby agreements with Fannie Mae (FNMA) or Freddie Mac (FHLMC) (the fully-insured portfolio). Residential mortgage loans in the fully-insured portfolio are not placed on nonaccrual status and, therefore, are not reported as nonperforming. Junior-lien home equity loans are placed on nonaccrual status and classified as nonperforming when the underlying first-lien mortgage loan becomes i90
days past due even if the junior-lien loan is current. The outstanding balance of real estate-secured loans that is in excess of the estimated property value less costs to sell is charged off no later than the end of the month in which the loan becomes i180 days past due unless the loan is fully insured, or for loans in bankruptcy, within
i60
days of receipt of notification of filing, with the remaining balance classified as nonperforming.
Consumer loans secured by personal property, credit card loans and other unsecured consumer loans are not placed on nonaccrual status prior to charge-off and, therefore, are not reported as nonperforming loans, except for certain secured consumer loans, including those that have been modified in a TDR. Personal property-secured loans (including auto loans) are charged off to collateral value no later than the end of the month in which the account becomes i120
days past due, or upon repossession of an auto or, for loans in bankruptcy, within i60 days of receipt of notification of filing. Credit card and other unsecured customer loans are charged off no later than the end of the month in which the
account becomes i180 days past due, within i60
days after receipt of notification of death or bankruptcy, or upon confirmation of fraud.
Commercial loans and leases, excluding business card loans, that are past due i90 days or more as to principal or interest, or where reasonable doubt exists as to timely collection, including loans that are individually identified as being impaired, are generally placed on nonaccrual
status and classified as nonperforming unless well-secured and in the process of collection.
Business card loans are charged off in the same manner as consumer credit card loans. These loans are not placed on nonaccrual status prior to charge-off and, therefore, are not reported as nonperforming loans. Other commercial loans and leases are generally charged off when all or a portion of the principal amount is determined to be uncollectible.
The entire balance of a consumer loan or commercial loan or lease is contractually delinquent if the minimum payment is not received by the specified due date on the customer’s billing statement. Interest and fees continue to accrue on past due loans and leases until the date the loan is placed on nonaccrual status, if applicable. Accrued interest receivable is reversed when loans and leases are placed on nonaccrual status. Interest collections
on nonaccruing loans and leases for which the ultimate collectability of principal is uncertain are applied as principal reductions; otherwise, such collections are credited to income when received. Loans and leases may be restored to accrual status when all principal and interest is current and full repayment of the remaining contractual principal and interest is expected.
PCI loans are recorded at fair value at the acquisition date. Although the PCI loans may be contractually delinquent, the Corporation does not classify these loans as nonperforming as the loans were written down to fair value at the acquisition date and the accretable yield is recognized in interest income over the remaining life of the loan. In addition, reported net charge-offs exclude write-offs on PCI loans as the fair value already considers the estimated credit losses.
Troubled Debt Restructurings
iConsumer
and commercial loans and leases whose contractual terms have been restructured in a manner that grants a concession to a borrower experiencing financial difficulties are classified as TDRs. Concessions could include a reduction in the interest rate to a rate that is below market on the loan, payment extensions, forgiveness of principal, forbearance or other actions designed to maximize collections. Loans that are carried at fair value, LHFS and PCI loans are not classified as TDRs.
Loans and leases whose contractual terms have been modified in a TDR and are current at the time of restructuring may remain on accrual status if there is demonstrated performance prior to the restructuring and payment in full under the restructured terms
Bank
of America 2018 96
is expected. Otherwise, the loans are placed on nonaccrual status and reported as nonperforming, except for fully-insured consumer real estate loans, until there is sustained repayment performance for a reasonable period, generally six months. If accruing TDRs cease to perform in accordance with their modified contractual terms, they are placed on nonaccrual status and reported as nonperforming TDRs.
Secured consumer loans that have been discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy and have not been reaffirmed by the borrower are classified as TDRs at the time of discharge. Such loans are placed on nonaccrual status and written down to the estimated collateral value less costs to sell no later than at the time of discharge.
If these loans are contractually current, interest collections are generally recorded in interest income on a cash basis. Consumer real estate-secured loans for which a binding offer to restructure has been extended are also classified as TDRs. Credit card and other unsecured consumer loans that have been renegotiated in a TDR generally remain on accrual status until the loan is either paid in full or charged off, which occurs no later than the end of the month in which the loan becomes i180
days past due or, for loans that have been placed on a fixed payment plan, i120 days past due.
A loan that had previously been modified in a TDR and is subsequently refinanced
under current underwriting standards at a market rate with no concessionary terms is accounted for as a new loan and is no longer reported as a TDR.
Loans Held-for-sale
iLoans that are intended to be sold in the foreseeable future, including residential mortgages, loan syndications, and to a lesser degree, commercial real estate, consumer finance and other loans, are reported as LHFS and are carried at the lower of aggregate cost or fair value. The Corporation accounts for certain LHFS, including residential mortgage LHFS, under the fair value option. Loan
origination costs related to LHFS that the Corporation accounts for under the fair value option are recognized in noninterest expense when incurred. Loan origination costs for LHFS carried at the lower of cost or fair value are capitalized as part of the carrying value of the loans and recognized as a reduction of noninterest income upon the sale of such loans. LHFS that are on nonaccrual status and are reported as nonperforming, as defined in the policy herein, are reported separately from nonperforming loans and leases.
Premises and Equipment
iPremises
and equipment are carried at cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation and amortization are recognized using the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Estimated lives range up to i40 years for buildings, up to i12
years for furniture and equipment, and the shorter of lease term or estimated useful life for leasehold improvements.
Goodwill and Intangible Assets
iGoodwill is the purchase premium after adjusting for the fair value of net assets acquired. Goodwill is not amortized but is reviewed for potential impairment on an annual basis, or when events or circumstances indicate a potential impairment, at the reporting unit level. A reporting unit is a business segment or one level below a business segment.
The Corporation assesses the fair value of each reporting unit against its carrying value, including goodwill, as measured by allocated equity. For purposes of goodwill impairment testing, the Corporation utilizes allocated equity as a proxy for the carrying value of its reporting units. Allocated equity in the reporting units
is comprised of allocated capital plus capital for the portion of goodwill and intangibles specifically assigned to the reporting unit.
In performing its goodwill impairment testing, the Corporation first assesses qualitative factors to determine whether it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying value. Qualitative factors include, among other things, macroeconomic conditions, industry and market considerations,
financial performance of the respective reporting unit and other relevant entity- and reporting-unit specific considerations.
If the Corporation concludes it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying value, a quantitative assessment is performed. If the fair value of the reporting unit exceeds its carrying value, goodwill of the reporting unit is considered not impaired; however, if the carrying value of the reporting unit exceeds its fair value, an additional step is performed to measure potential impairment.
This step involves calculating an implied fair value of goodwill which is the excess of the fair value of the reporting unit, as determined in the first step, over the aggregate fair values of the assets, liabilities and identifiable intangibles as if the reporting unit was being acquired in a business combination. If the implied
fair value of goodwill exceeds the goodwill assigned to the reporting unit, there is no impairment. If the goodwill assigned to a reporting unit exceeds the implied fair value of goodwill, an impairment charge is recorded for the excess. An impairment loss recognized cannot exceed the amount of goodwill assigned to a reporting unit. An impairment loss establishes a new basis in the goodwill, and subsequent reversals of goodwill impairment losses are not permitted under applicable accounting guidance.
For intangible assets subject to amortization, an impairment loss is recognized if the carrying value of the intangible asset is not recoverable and exceeds fair value. The carrying value of the intangible asset is considered not recoverable if it exceeds the sum of the undiscounted cash flows expected to result from the use of the asset. Intangible assets deemed to have indefinite useful lives are not subject to amortization.
An impairment loss is recognized if the carrying value of the intangible asset with an indefinite life exceeds its fair value.
Variable Interest Entities
iA VIE is an entity that lacks equity investors or whose equity investors do not have a controlling financial interest in the entity through their equity investments. The Corporation consolidates a VIE if it has both the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance and an obligation to absorb
losses or the right to receive benefits that could potentially be significant to the VIE. On a quarterly basis, the Corporation reassesses its involvement with the VIE and evaluates the impact of changes in governing documents and its financial interests in the VIE. The consolidation status of the VIEs with which the Corporation is involved may change as a result of such reassessments.
The Corporation primarily uses VIEs for its securitization activities, in which the Corporation transfers whole loans or debt securities into a trust or other vehicle. When the Corporation is the servicer of whole loans held in a securitization trust, including non-agency residential mortgages, home equity loans, credit cards, and other loans, the Corporation has the power to direct the most significant activities of the trust. The Corporation generally does not have the power to direct the most significant activities of a residential
mortgage agency trust except in certain circumstances in which the Corporation holds substantially all of the issued securities and has the unilateral right to liquidate the trust. The power to direct the most significant activities of a commercial
97Bank of America 2018
mortgage
securitization trust is typically held by the special servicer or by the party holding specific subordinate securities which embody certain controlling rights. The Corporation consolidates a whole-loan securitization trust if it has the power to direct the most significant activities and also holds securities issued by the trust or has other contractual arrangements, other than standard representations and warranties, that could potentially be significant to the trust.
The Corporation may also transfer trading account securities and AFS securities into municipal bond or resecuritization trusts. The Corporation consolidates a municipal bond or resecuritization trust if it has control over the ongoing activities of the trust such as the remarketing of the trust’s liabilities or, if there are no ongoing activities, sole discretion over the design of the trust, including the identification of securities to be transferred in and
the structure of securities to be issued, and also retains securities or has liquidity or other commitments that could potentially be significant to the trust. The Corporation does not consolidate a municipal bond or resecuritization trust if one or a limited number of third-party investors share responsibility for the design of the trust or have control over the significant activities of the trust through liquidation or other substantive rights.
Other VIEs used by the Corporation include collateralized debt obligations (CDOs), investment vehicles created on behalf of customers and other investment vehicles. The Corporation does not routinely serve as collateral manager for CDOs and, therefore, does not typically have the power to direct the activities that most significantly impact the economic performance of a CDO. However, following an event of default, if the Corporation is a majority holder of senior securities issued
by a CDO and acquires the power to manage its assets, the Corporation consolidates the CDO.
The Corporation consolidates a customer or other investment vehicle if it has control over the initial design of the vehicle or manages the assets in the vehicle and also absorbs potentially significant gains or losses through an investment in the vehicle, derivative contracts or other arrangements. The Corporation does not consolidate an investment vehicle if a single investor controlled the initial design of the vehicle or manages the assets in the vehicles or if the Corporation does not have a variable interest that could potentially be significant to the vehicle.
Retained interests in securitized assets are initially recorded at fair value. In addition, the Corporation may invest in debt securities
issued by unconsolidated VIEs. Fair values of these debt securities, which are classified as trading account assets, debt securities carried at fair value or HTM securities, are based primarily on quoted market prices in active or inactive markets. Generally, quoted market prices for retained residual interests are not available; therefore, the Corporation estimates fair values based on the present value of the associated expected future cash flows.
Fair Value
iThe Corporation measures the fair
values of its assets and liabilities, where applicable, in accordance with accounting guidance that requires an entity to base fair value on exit price. Under this guidance, an entity is required to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs in measuring fair value. A hierarchy is established which categorizes fair value measurements into three levels based on the inputs to the valuation technique with the highest priority given to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets and the lowest priority given to unobservable inputs. The Corporation categorizes its fair value measurements of financial instruments based on this three-level hierarchy.
Level 1
Unadjusted quoted
prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities. Level 1 assets and liabilities include debt and equity securities and derivative contracts that are traded in an active exchange market, as well as certain U.S. Treasury securities that are highly liquid and are actively traded in OTC markets.
Level 2
Observable inputs other than Level 1 prices, such as quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities, quoted prices in markets that are not active, or other inputs that are observable or can be corroborated by observable market data for substantially the full term of the assets or liabilities. Level 2 assets and liabilities include debt securities
with quoted prices that are traded less frequently than exchange-traded instruments and derivative contracts where fair value is determined using a pricing model with inputs that are observable in the market or can be derived principally from or corroborated by observable market data. This category generally includes U.S. government and agency mortgage-backed (MBS) and asset-backed securities (ABS), corporate debt securities, derivative contracts, certain loans and LHFS.
Level 3
Unobservable inputs that are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant
to the overall fair value of the assets or liabilities. Level 3 assets and liabilities include financial instruments for which the determination of fair value requires significant management judgment or estimation. The fair value for such assets and liabilities is generally determined using pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies or similar techniques that incorporate the assumptions a market participant would use in pricing the asset or liability. This category generally includes retained residual interests in securitizations, consumer MSRs, certain ABS, highly structured, complex or long-dated derivative contracts, certain loans and LHFS, IRLCs and certain CDOs where independent pricing information cannot be obtained for a significant portion of the underlying assets.
Income Taxes
iThere
are two components of income tax expense: current and deferred. Current income tax expense reflects taxes to be paid or refunded for the current period. Deferred income tax expense results from changes in deferred tax assets and liabilities between periods. These gross deferred tax assets and liabilities represent decreases or increases in taxes expected to be paid in the future because of future reversals of temporary differences in the bases of assets and liabilities as measured by tax laws and their bases as reported in the financial statements. Deferred tax assets are also recognized for tax attributes such as net operating loss carryforwards and tax credit carryforwards. Valuation allowances are recorded to reduce deferred tax assets to the amounts management concludes are more likely than not to be realized.
Income tax benefits are recognized and measured based upon a two-step model: first, a tax position must
be more likely than not to be sustained based solely on its technical merits in order to be recognized, and second, the benefit is measured as the largest dollar amount of that position that is more likely than not to be sustained upon settlement. The difference between the benefit recognized and the tax benefit claimed on a tax return is referred to as an unrecognized tax benefit. The Corporation records income tax-related interest and penalties, if applicable, within income tax expense.
Bank of America 2018 98
Revenue
Recognition
iThe following summarizes the Corporation’s revenue recognition accounting policies for certain noninterest income activities.
Card Income
Card income includes annual, late and over-limit fees as well as fees earned from interchange, cash advances and other miscellaneous transactions and is presented net of direct costs. Interchange fees are recognized upon settlement of the credit and debit card payment transactions and
are generally determined on a percentage basis for credit cards and fixed rates for debit cards based on the corresponding payment network’s rates. Substantially all card fees are recognized at the transaction date, except for certain time-based fees such as annual fees, which are recognized over 12 months. Fees charged to cardholders that are estimated to be uncollectible are reserved in the allowance for loan and lease losses. Included in direct cost are rewards and credit card partner payments. Rewards paid to cardholders are related to points earned by the cardholder that can be redeemed for a broad range of rewards including cash, travel and gift cards. The points to be redeemed are estimated based on past redemption behavior, card product type, account transaction activity and other historical card performance. The liability is reduced as the points are redeemed. The Corporation also makes payments to credit card
partners. The payments are based on revenue-sharing agreements that are generally driven by cardholder transactions and partner sales volumes. As part of the revenue-sharing agreements, the credit card partner provides the Corporation exclusive rights to market to the credit card partner’s members or customers on behalf of the Corporation.
Service Charges
Service charges include deposit and lending-related fees. Deposit-related fees consist of fees earned on consumer and commercial
deposit activities and are generally recognized when the transactions occur or as the service is performed. Consumer fees are earned on consumer deposit accounts for account maintenance and various transaction-based services, such as ATM transactions, wire transfer activities, check and money order processing and insufficient funds/overdraft transactions.
Commercial deposit-related fees are from the Corporation’s Global Transaction Services business and consist of commercial deposit and treasury management services, including account maintenance and other services, such as payroll, sweep account and other cash management services. Lending-related fees generally represent transactional fees earned from certain loan commitments, financial guarantees and SBLCs.
Investment and Brokerage Services
Investment and brokerage services consist of asset management and brokerage fees. Asset management fees are earned from the management of client assets under advisory agreements or the full discretion of the Corporation’s financial advisors (collectively referred to as assets under management (AUM)). Asset management fees are earned as a percentage of the client’s AUM and generally range from 50
basis points (bps) to 150 bps of the AUM. In cases where a third party is used to obtain a client’s investment allocation, the fee remitted to the third party is recorded net and is not reflected in the transaction price, as the Corporation is an agent for those services.
Brokerage fees include income earned from transaction-based services that are performed as part of investment management services and are based on a fixed price per unit or as a percentage of the total transaction amount. Brokerage fees also include distribution fees and sales commissions that are primarily in the
Global Wealth & Investment Management (GWIM) segment and are earned over time. In addition, primarily in the Global
Markets segment, brokerage fees are earned when the Corporation fills customer orders to buy or sell various financial products or when it acknowledges, affirms, settles and clears transactions and/or submits trade information to the appropriate clearing broker. Certain customers pay brokerage, clearing and/or exchange fees imposed by relevant regulatory bodies or exchanges in order to execute or clear trades. These fees are recorded net and are not reflected in the transaction price, as the Corporation is an agent for those services.
Investment Banking Income
Investment banking income includes underwriting income and financial advisory services income. Underwriting consists of fees earned for the placement of a customer’s debt or equity securities. The revenue is generally earned based on a percentage of the fixed number of shares or principal placed. Once
the number of shares or notes is determined and the service is completed, the underwriting fees are recognized. The Corporation incurs certain out-of-pocket expenses, such as legal costs, in performing these services. These expenses are recovered through the revenue the Corporation earns from the customer and are included in operating expenses. Syndication fees represent fees earned as the agent or lead lender responsible for structuring, arranging and administering a loan syndication.
Financial advisory services consist of fees earned for assisting customers with transactions related to mergers and acquisitions and financial restructurings. Revenue varies depending on the size and number of services performed for each contract and is generally contingent on successful execution of the transaction. Revenue is typically recognized once
the transaction is completed and all services have been rendered. Additionally, the Corporation may earn a fixed fee in merger and acquisition transactions to provide a fairness opinion, with the fees recognized when the opinion is delivered to the customer.
Other Revenue Measurement and Recognition Policies
The Corporation did not disclose the value of any open performance obligations at December 31, 2018, as its contracts with customers generally have a fixed term that is less than one year, an open term with a cancellation period that is less than one year, or provisions that allow the Corporation
to recognize revenue at the amount it has the right to invoice.
Earnings Per Common Share
iEarnings per common share (EPS) is computed by dividing net income allocated to common shareholders by the weighted-average common shares outstanding, excluding unvested common shares subject to repurchase or cancellation. Net income allocated to common shareholders is net income adjusted for preferred stock dividends including dividends declared, accretion of discounts on preferred stock including accelerated accretion when preferred stock is repaid early, and cumulative dividends related to the current
dividend period that have not been declared as of period end, less income allocated to participating securities. Diluted EPS is computed by dividing income allocated to common shareholders plus dividends on dilutive convertible preferred stock and preferred stock that can be tendered to exercise warrants, by the weighted-average common shares outstanding plus amounts representing the dilutive effect of stock options outstanding, restricted stock, restricted stock units (RSUs), outstanding warrants and the dilution resulting from the conversion of convertible preferred stock, if applicable.
99Bank of America 2018
Foreign
Currency Translation
iAssets, liabilities and operations of foreign branches and subsidiaries are recorded based on the functional currency of each entity. When the functional currency of a foreign operation is the local currency, the assets, liabilities and operations are translated, for consolidation purposes, from the local currency to the U.S. dollar reporting currency at period-end rates for assets and
liabilities and generally at average rates for results of operations. The resulting unrealized gains and losses are reported as a component of accumulated OCI, net-of-tax. When the foreign entity’s functional currency is the U.S. dollar, the resulting remeasurement gains or losses on foreign currency-denominated assets or liabilities are included in earnings.
NOTE 2iNoninterest
Income
iThe table below presents the Corporation’s noninterest income disaggregated by revenue source for 2018, 2017 and 2016. For more information, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles. For a disaggregation of noninterest income by business segment and All Other,
see Note 23 – Business Segment Information.
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Card
income
Interchange fees (1)
$
i4,093
$
i3,942
$
i3,960
Other
card income
i1,958
i1,960
i1,891
Total
card income
i6,051
i5,902
i5,851
Service
charges
Deposit-related fees
i6,667
i6,708
i6,545
Lending-related
fees
i1,100
i1,110
i1,093
Total
service charges
i7,767
i7,818
i7,638
Investment
and brokerage services
Asset management fees
i10,189
i9,310
i8,328
Brokerage
fees
i3,971
i4,526
i5,021
Total
investment and brokerage services
i14,160
i13,836
i13,349
Investment
banking income
Underwriting income
i2,722
i2,821
i2,585
Syndication
fees
i1,347
i1,499
i1,388
Financial
advisory services
i1,258
i1,691
i1,268
Total
investment banking income
i5,327
i6,011
i5,241
Trading
account profits
i8,540
i7,277
i6,902
Other
income
i1,970
i1,841
i3,624
Total
noninterest income
$
i43,815
$
i42,685
$
i42,605
(1)
During
2018, 2017 and 2016, gross interchange fees were $i9.5 billion, $i8.8
billion and $i8.2 billion and are presented net of $i5.4
billion, $i4.8 billion and $i4.2 billion,
respectively, of expenses for rewards and partner payments.
Bank of America 2018 100
NOTE 3iDerivatives
Derivative
Balances
Derivatives are entered into on behalf of customers, for trading or to support risk management activities. Derivatives used in risk management activities include derivatives that may or may not be designated in qualifying hedge accounting relationships. Derivatives that are not designated in qualifying hedge accounting relationships are referred to as other risk management derivatives. For more information on the Corporation’s derivatives and hedging
activities, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles. iThe
following tables present derivative instruments included on the Consolidated Balance Sheet in derivative assets and liabilities at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Balances are presented on a gross basis, prior to the application of counterparty and cash collateral netting. Total derivative assets and liabilities are adjusted on an aggregate basis to take into consideration the effects of legally enforceable master netting agreements and have been reduced by cash collateral received or paid.
Represents
the total contract/notional amount of derivative assets and liabilities outstanding.
(2)
The net derivative liability and notional amount of written credit derivatives for which the Corporation held purchased credit derivatives with identical underlying referenced names were $i185
million and $i342.8 billion at December 31, 2018.
(3)
Derivative
assets and liabilities for credit default swaps (CDS) reflect a central clearing counterparty’s amendments to legally re-characterize daily cash variation margin from collateral, which secures an outstanding exposure, to settlement, which discharges an outstanding exposure, effective in 2018.
Represents
the total contract/notional amount of derivative assets and liabilities outstanding.
(2)
The net derivative asset and notional amount of written credit derivatives for which the Corporation held purchased credit derivatives with identical underlying referenced names were $i6.4
billion and $i435.1 billion at December 31, 2017.
Offsetting of
Derivatives
The Corporation enters into International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. (ISDA) master netting agreements or similar agreements with substantially all of the Corporation’s derivative counterparties. Where legally enforceable, these master netting agreements give the Corporation, in the event of default by the counterparty, the right to liquidate securities held as collateral and to offset receivables and payables with the same counterparty. For purposes of the Consolidated Balance Sheet, the Corporation offsets derivative assets and liabilities and cash collateral held with the same counterparty where it has such a legally enforceable master netting agreement.
iiThe
following table presents derivative instruments included in derivative assets and liabilities on the Consolidated Ba/
lance Sheet at December 31, 2018 and 2017 by primary risk (e.g., interest rate risk) and the platform, where applicable, on which these derivatives are transacted. Balances are presented on a gross basis, prior to the application of counterparty and cash collateral netting. Total gross derivative assets and liabilities are adjusted on an aggregate basis to take into consideration the effects of legally enforceable master netting agreements which include reducing the balance
for counterparty netting and cash collateral received or paid.
For more information on offsetting of securities financing agreements, see Note 10 – Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and Restricted Cash.
Total
gross derivative assets/liabilities, before netting
Over-the-counter
i292.5
i283.0
i320.7
i317.0
Exchange-traded
i17.1
i16.0
i9.8
i9.3
Over-the-counter
cleared
i8.2
i7.2
i8.9
i8.5
Less:
Legally enforceable master netting agreements and cash collateral received/paid
Over-the-counter
(i264.4
)
(i259.2
)
(i296.9
)
(i294.6
)
Exchange-traded
(i13.5
)
(i13.5
)
(i8.6
)
(i8.6
)
Over-the-counter
cleared
(i7.2
)
(i7.2
)
(i8.3
)
(i8.5
)
Derivative
assets/liabilities, after netting
i32.7
i26.3
i25.6
i23.1
Other
gross derivative assets/liabilities (2)
i11.0
i11.6
i12.2
i11.2
Total
derivative assets/liabilities
i43.7
i37.9
i37.8
i34.3
Less:
Financial instruments collateral (3)
(i16.3
)
(i8.6
)
(i11.2
)
(i10.4
)
Total
net derivative assets/liabilities
$
i27.4
$
i29.3
$
i26.6
$
i23.9
(1)
OTC
derivatives include bilateral transactions between the Corporation and a particular counterparty. OTC-cleared derivatives include bilateral transactions between the Corporation and a counterparty where the transaction is cleared through a clearinghouse. Exchange-traded derivatives include listed options transacted on an exchange.
(2)
Consists of derivatives entered into under master netting agreements where the enforceability of these agreements is uncertain under bankruptcy laws in some countries or industries.
(3)
Amounts
are limited to the derivative asset/liability balance and, accordingly, do not include excess collateral received/pledged. Financial instruments collateral includes securities collateral received or pledged and cash securities held and posted at third-party custodians that are not offset on the Consolidated Balance Sheet but shown as a reduction to derive net derivative assets and liabilities.
ALM and Risk Management Derivatives
The Corporation’s ALM and risk management activities include the use of derivatives to mitigate risk to the Corporation including derivatives designated in qualifying hedge accounting relationships and derivatives used in other risk management activities. Interest rate, foreign exchange, equity, commodity and credit contracts
are utilized in the Corporation’s ALM and risk management activities.
TheCorporation maintains an overall interest rate risk management strategy that incorporates the use of interest rate contracts, which are generally non-leveraged generic interest rate and basis swaps, options, futures and forwards, to minimize significant fluctuations in earnings caused by interest rate volatility. The Corporation’s goal is to manage interest rate sensitivity and volatility so that movements in interest rates do not significantly adversely affect earnings or capital. As a result of interest rate fluctuations, hedged fixed-rate assets and liabilities appreciate or depreciate in fair value. Gains or losses on the derivative instruments that are linked to the hedged fixed-rate assets and liabilities are
expected to substantially offset this unrealized appreciation or depreciation.
Market risk, including interest rate risk, can be substantial in the mortgage business. Market risk in the mortgage business is the risk that values of mortgage assets or revenues will be adversely affected by changes in market conditions such as interest rate movements. To mitigate the interest rate risk in mortgage banking production income, the Corporation utilizes forward loan sale commitments and other derivative instruments, including purchased options, and certain debt securities. The
Corporation also utilizes derivatives such as interest rate options, interest rate swaps, forward settlement contracts and eurodollar futures to hedge certain market risks of MSRs.
For more information on MSRs, see Note 20 – Fair Value Measurements.
The Corporation uses foreign exchange contracts to manage the foreign exchange risk associated with certain foreign currency-denominated assets and liabilities, as well as the Corporation’s investments in non-U.S. subsidiaries. Foreign exchange contracts, which include spot and forward contracts, represent agreements to exchange the currency of one country for the currency of another country at an agreed-upon price on an agreed-upon settlement date. Exposure
to loss on these contracts will increase or decrease over their respective lives as currency exchange and interest rates fluctuate.
The Corporation purchases credit derivatives to manage credit risk related to certain funded and unfunded credit exposures. Credit derivatives include CDS, total return swaps and swaptions. These derivatives are recorded on the Consolidated Balance Sheet at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in other income.
Derivatives Designated as Accounting Hedges
The Corporation uses various types of interest rate and foreign exchange derivative contracts to protect against changes in the fair value of its assets and liabilities
due to fluctuations in interest rates and exchange rates (fair value hedges). The Corporation also uses these types of contracts to protect against changes in the cash flows of its assets and liabilities, and other forecasted transactions (cash flow hedges). The Corporation hedges its net investment in consolidated non-U.S. operations determined to have functional currencies other than the U.S. dollar using forward
103Bank of America 2018
exchange
contracts and cross-currency basis swaps, and by issuing foreign currency-denominated debt (net investment hedges).
Fair Value Hedges
iThe table below summarizes information related to fair value hedges for 2018, 2017
and 2016.
Gains
and Losses on Derivatives Designated as Fair Value Hedges
Derivative
Hedged
Item
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Interest
rate risk on long-term debt (1)
$
(i1,538
)
$
(i1,537
)
$
(i1,488
)
$
i1,429
$
i1,045
$
i646
Interest
rate and foreign currency risk on long-term debt (2)
(i1,187
)
i1,811
(i941
)
i1,079
(i1,767
)
i944
Interest
rate risk on available-for-sale securities (3)
(i52
)
(i67
)
i227
i50
i35
(i286
)
Total
$
(i2,777
)
$
i207
$
(i2,202
)
$
i2,558
$
(i687
)
$
i1,304
(1)
Amounts
are recorded in interest expense in the Consolidated Statement of Income. In 2017 and 2016, amounts representing hedge ineffectiveness were losses of $i492 million and $i842
million.
(2)
In 2018, 2017 and 2016, the derivative amount includes losses of $i992
million, gains of $i2.2 billion and losses of $i910
million, respectively, in other income and losses of $i116 million, $i365
million and $i30 million, respectively, in interest expense. Line item totals are in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
(3)
Amounts
are recorded in interest income in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
iThe table below summarizes the carrying value of hedged assets and liabilities that are designated and qualifying in fair value hedging relationships along with the cumulative amount of fair value hedging adjustments included in the carrying value that have been recorded in the current hedging relationships.
These fair value hedging adjustments are open basis adjustments that are not subject to amortization as long as the hedging relationship remains designated.
For
assets, increase (decrease) to carrying value and for liabilities, (increase) decrease to carrying value.
At December 31, 2018, the cumulative fair value adjustments remaining on long-term debt and AFS debt securities from discontinued hedging relationships were a decrease to the related liability and related asset of $i1.6
billionand $i29 million, which are being amortized over the remaining contractual life of the de-designated hedged items.
Cash Flow and Net Investment Hedges
iThe
following table summarizes certain information related to cash flow hedges and net investment hedges for 2018, 2017 and 2016.
Of the $i1.0 billion after-tax net loss ($i1.3
billion pretax) on derivatives in accumulated OCI at December 31, 2018, $i253 million after-tax ($i332
million pretax) is expected to be reclassified into earnings in the next 12 months. These net losses reclassified into earnings are expected to primarily reduce net interest income related to the respective hedged items. For terminated cash flow hedges, the time period over which the majority of the forecasted transactions are hedged is approximately i4 years, with a maximum length of time for certain forecasted transactions of i17
years.
Gains
and Losses on Derivatives Designated as Cash Flow and Net Investment Hedges
Gains
(Losses) Recognized in Accumulated OCI on Derivatives
Gains (Losses) in Income Reclassified from Accumulated OCI
(Dollars in millions, amounts pretax)
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Cash
flow hedges
Interest rate risk on variable-rate assets (1)
$
(i159
)
$
(i109
)
$
(i340
)
$
(i165
)
$
(i327
)
$
(i553
)
Price
risk on certain restricted stock awards (2)
i4
i59
i41
i27
i148
(i32
)
Total
$
(i155
)
$
(i50
)
$
(i299
)
$
(i138
)
$
(i179
)
$
(i585
)
Net
investment hedges
Foreign
exchange risk (3)
$
i989
$
(i1,588
)
$
i1,636
$
i411
$
i1,782
$
i3
(1)
Amounts
reclassified from accumulated OCI are recorded in interest income in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
(2)
Amounts reclassified from accumulated OCI are recorded in personnel expense in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
(3)
Amounts reclassified from accumulated OCI are recorded in other income in the Consolidated Statement of Income. Amounts excluded from effectiveness testing and recognized in other income were gains of $i47
million, $i120 million and $i325
million in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
Bank of America 2018 104
Other Risk Management Derivatives
Other risk management derivatives are used by the Corporation
to reduce certain risk exposures by economically hedging various assets and liabilities. The gains and losses on these derivatives are recognized in other income. iThe table below presents gains (losses) on these derivatives for 2018, 2017 and 2016.
These gains (losses) are largely offset by the income or expense that is recorded on the hedged item.
Gains and Losses
on Other Risk Management Derivatives
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Interest
rate risk on mortgage activities (1)
$
(i107
)
$
i8
$
i461
Credit
risk on loans
i9
(i6
)
(i107
)
Interest
rate and foreign currency risk on ALM activities (2)
i1,010
(i36
)
(i754
)
(1)
Primarily
related to hedges of interest rate risk on MSRs and IRLCs to originate mortgage loans that will be held for sale. The net gains on IRLCs, which are not included in the table but are considered derivative instruments, were $i47 million, $i220
million and $i533 million for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
(2)
Primarily
related to hedges of debt securities carried at fair value and hedges of foreign currency-denominated debt.
Transfers of Financial Assets with Risk Retained through Derivatives
The Corporation enters into certain transactions involving the transfer of financial assets that are accounted for as sales where substantially all of the economic exposure to the transferred financial assets is retained through derivatives (e.g., interest rate and/or credit), but the Corporation does not retain control over the assets transferred. As of December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation had transferred $i5.8
billion and $i6.0 billion of non-U.S. government-guaranteed MBS to a third-party trust and retained economic exposure to the transferred assets through derivative contracts. In connection with these transfers, the Corporation received gross cash proceeds
of $i5.8 billion and $i6.0
billion at the transfer dates. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the fair value of the transferred securities was $i5.5 billion and $i6.1
billion.
Sales and Trading Revenue
The Corporation enters into trading derivatives to facilitate client transactions and to manage risk exposures arising from trading account assets and liabilities. It is the Corporation’s policy to include these derivative instruments in its trading activities which include derivatives and non-derivative cash instruments. The resulting risk from these derivatives is managed on a portfolio basis as part of the Corporation’s Global Markets business segment. The related sales and trading revenue generated within Global Markets is recorded in various income statement line items including trading account profits and net interest income as well as other revenue categories.
Sales and
trading revenue includes changes in the fair value and realized gains and losses on the sales of trading and other assets, net interest income, and fees primarily from commissions on equity securities. Revenue is generated by the difference in the client price for an instrument and the price at which the trading desk can execute the trade in the dealer market. For equity securities, commissions related to purchases and sales are recorded in the “Other” column in the Sales and Trading Revenue table. Changes in the fair value of these securities are included in trading account profits. For debt securities, revenue, with the exception of interest associated with the debt securities, is typically included in trading account profits. Unlike commissions for equity securities, the initial revenue related to broker-dealer services for debt securities is typically included in the pricing of
the
instrument rather than being charged through separate fee arrangements. Therefore, this revenue is recorded in trading account profits as part of the initial mark to fair value. For derivatives, the majority of revenue is included in trading account profits. In transactions where the Corporation acts as agent, which include exchange-traded futures and options, fees are recorded in other income.
iThe table below, which includes both derivatives and non-derivative cash instruments, identifies
the amounts in the respective income statement line items attributable to the Corporation’s sales and trading revenue in Global Markets, categorized by primary risk, for 2018, 2017 and 2016. The difference between total trading account profits in the following table and in the Consolidated Statement of Income represents trading activities in business segments other than Global Markets. This table includes debit valuation adjustment (DVA) and funding valuation adjustment (FVA) gains (losses). Global Markets results inNote 23 – Business Segment Information are presented on a fully taxable-equivalent (FTE) basis.
The table below is not presented on an FTE basis.
Sales
and Trading Revenue
Trading Account Profits
Net Interest
Income
Other
(1)
Total
(Dollars in millions)
2018
Interest rate risk
$
i1,180
$
i1,292
$
i220
$
i2,692
Foreign
exchange risk
i1,503
(i7
)
i6
i1,502
Equity
risk
i3,994
(i781
)
i1,619
i4,832
Credit
risk
i1,063
i1,853
i552
i3,468
Other
risk
i189
i64
i66
i319
Total
sales and trading revenue
$
i7,929
$
i2,421
$
i2,463
$
i12,813
2017
Interest
rate risk
$
i712
$
i1,560
$
i249
$
i2,521
Foreign
exchange risk
i1,417
(i1
)
i7
i1,423
Equity
risk
i2,689
(i517
)
i1,903
i4,075
Credit
risk
i1,685
i1,937
i576
i4,198
Other
risk
i203
i45
i76
i324
Total
sales and trading revenue
$
i6,706
$
i3,024
$
i2,811
$
i12,541
2016
Interest
rate risk
$
i1,189
$
i2,002
$
i145
$
i3,336
Foreign
exchange risk
i1,360
(i10
)
i5
i1,355
Equity
risk
i1,917
i28
i2,074
i4,019
Credit
risk
i1,674
i1,956
i424
i4,054
Other
risk
i407
(i7
)
i39
i439
Total
sales and trading revenue
$
i6,547
$
i3,969
$
i2,687
$
i13,203
(1)
Represents
amounts in investment and brokerage services and other income that are recorded in Global Markets and included in the definition of sales and trading revenue. Includes investment and brokerage services revenue of $i1.7 billion, $i2.0
billion and $i2.1 billion for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
Credit Derivatives
The Corporation enters into credit derivatives
primarily to facilitate client transactions and to manage credit risk exposures. Credit derivatives derive value based on an underlying third-party referenced obligation or a portfolio of referenced obligations and generally require the Corporation, as the seller of credit protection, to make payments to a buyer upon the occurrence of a predefined credit event. Such credit events generally include bankruptcy of the referenced credit entity and failure to pay under the obligation, as well as acceleration of indebtedness and payment repudiation or moratorium. For credit derivatives based on a portfolio of referenced credits or credit indices, the Corporation may not be required to make payment until a specified amount of loss has occurred and/or may only be required to make payment up to a specified amount.
105Bank
of America 2018
Credit derivatives are classified as investment and non-investment grade based on the credit quality of the underlying referenced obligation. The Corporation considers ratings of BBB- or higher as investment grade. Non-investment grade includes non-rated credit derivative instruments. The Corporation discloses
internal categorizations of investment grade and non-investment grade consistent
with how risk is managed for these instruments.
iCredit derivative instruments where the Corporation is the seller of credit protection and their expiration at December 31, 2018 and 2017 are summarized in the following table.
The
notional amount represents the maximum amount payable by the Corporation for most credit derivatives. However, the Corporation does not monitor its exposure to credit derivatives based solely on the notional amount because this measure does not take into consideration the probability of occurrence. As such, the notional amount is not a reliable indicator of the Corporation’s exposure to these contracts. Instead, a risk framework is used to define risk tolerances and establish limits so that certain credit risk-related losses occur within acceptable, predefined limits.
Credit-related notes in the table above include investments in securities issued by CDO, collateralized loan obligation (CLO) and credit-linked note vehicles. These instruments are primarily classified as trading securities. The carrying value of these instruments equals
the Corporation’s maximum exposure to loss. The Corporation is not obligated to make any payments to the entities under the terms of the securities owned.
Credit-related Contingent Features and Collateral
TheCorporation executes the majority of its derivative contracts in the OTC market with large, international financial institutions, including broker-dealers and, to a lesser degree, with a variety of non-financial companies. A significant majority of the derivative transactions are executed on a daily margin basis. Therefore, events such as a credit rating downgrade (depending on the ultimate rating level) or a breach of credit covenants would typically require an increase in the amount of collateral
required of the counterparty, where applicable, and/or allow the Corporation to take additional protective measures such as early termination of all trades. Further, as previously discussed on page 102, the Corporation enters into legally enforceable master netting agreements which reduce risk by permitting closeout and netting of transactions with the same counterparty upon the occurrence of certain events.
Bank of America 2018 106
A
majority of the Corporation’s derivative contracts contain credit risk-related contingent features, primarily in the form of ISDA master netting agreements and credit support documentation that enhance the creditworthiness of these instruments compared to other obligations of the respective counterparty with whom the Corporation has transacted. These contingent features may be for the benefit of the Corporation as well as its counterparties with respect to changes in the Corporation’s creditworthiness and the mark-to-market exposure under the derivative transactions. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation held cash and securities collateral of $i81.6
billion and $i77.2 billion, and posted cash and securities collateral of $i56.5
billion and $i59.2 billion in the normal course of business under derivative agreements, excluding cross-product margining agreements where clients are permitted to margin on a net basis for both derivative and secured financing arrangements.
In connection with certain OTC derivative contracts
and other trading agreements, the Corporation can be required to provide additional collateral or to terminate transactions with certain counterparties in the event of a downgrade of the senior debt ratings of the Corporation or certain subsidiaries. The amount of
additional collateral required depends on the contract and is usually a fixed incremental amount and/or the market value of the exposure.
At December 31, 2018, the amount of collateral, calculated based on the terms of the contracts, that the Corporation and
certain subsidiaries could be required to post to counterparties but had not yet posted to counterparties was $i1.8 billion, including $i1.0
billion for Bank of America, National Association (Bank of America, N.A. or BANA).
Some counterparties are currently able to unilaterally terminate certain contracts, or the Corporation or certain subsidiaries may be required to take other action such as find a suitable replacement or obtain a guarantee. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the liability recorded for these derivative contracts was not significant.
iThe
table below presents the amount of additional collateral that would have been contractually required by derivative contracts and other trading agreements at December 31, 2018 if the rating agencies had downgraded their long-term senior debt ratings for the Corporation or certain subsidiaries by one incremental notch and by an additional second incremental notch.
Additional
Collateral Required to be Posted Upon Downgrade at December 31, 2018
Included
in Bank of America Corporation collateral requirements in this table.
iThe following table presents the derivative liabilities that would be subject to unilateral termination by counterparties and the amounts of collateral that would have been contractually required atDecember 31, 2018if the long-term senior debt ratings for the Corporation or certain subsidiaries had been lower by one incremental notch and by an additional second incremental notch.
Derivative Liabilities
Subject to Unilateral Termination Upon Downgrade at December 31, 2018
(Dollars in millions)
One
incremental notch
Second
incremental notch
Derivative liabilities
$
i13
$
i581
Collateral
posted
i1
i305
Valuation
Adjustments on Derivatives
TheCorporation records credit risk valuation adjustments on derivatives in order to properly reflect the credit quality of the counterparties and its own credit quality. The Corporation calculates valuation adjustments on derivatives based on a modeled expected exposure that incorporates current market risk factors. The exposure also takes into consideration credit mitigants such as enforceable master netting agreements and collateral. CDS spread data is used to estimate the default probabilities and severities that are applied to the exposures. Where no observable credit default data is available for counterparties, the Corporation uses proxies and other market data to estimate default probabilities and severity.
Valuation adjustments on derivatives are affected by changes in market spreads, non-credit
related market factors such as interest rate and currency changes that affect the expected exposure, and other factors like changes in collateral arrangements and partial payments. Credit spreads and non-credit factors can move independently. For example, for an interest rate swap, changes in interest rates may increase the expected exposure, which would increase the counterparty credit valuation adjustment (CVA). Independently, counterparty credit spreads may tighten, which would result in an offsetting decrease to CVA.
The Corporation enters into risk management activities to offset market driven exposures. The Corporation often hedges the counterparty spread risk in CVA with CDS. The Corporation hedges other market risks in both CVA and DVA primarily with currency and interest rate swaps. In certain instances, the net-of-hedge amounts in the table below move in the same direction as the gross amount or may move in the
opposite direction. This movement is a consequence of the complex interaction of the risks being hedged, resulting in limitations in the ability to perfectly hedge all of the market exposures at all times.
iThe table below presents CVA, DVA and FVA gains (losses) on derivatives, which are recorded in trading account profits, on a gross and net of hedge basis for 2018, 2017 and 2016. CVA
gains reduce the cumulative CVA thereby increasing the derivative assets balance. DVA gains increase the cumulative DVA thereby decreasing the derivative liabilities balance. CVA and DVA losses have the opposite impact. FVA gains related to derivative assets reduce the cumulative FVA thereby increasing the derivative assets balance. FVA gains related to derivative liabilities increase the cumulative FVA thereby decreasing the derivative liabilities balance. FVA losses have the opposite impact.
Valuation
Adjustments on Derivatives (1)
Gains
(Losses)
Gross
Net
Gross
Net
Gross
Net
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Derivative
assets (CVA)
$
i77
$
i187
$
i330
$
i98
$
i374
$
i214
Derivative
assets/liabilities (FVA)
(i15
)
i14
i160
i178
i186
i102
Derivative
liabilities (DVA)
(i19
)
(i55
)
(i324
)
(i281
)
i24
(i141
)
(1)
At
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, cumulative CVA reduced the derivative assets balance by $i600 million, $i677
million and $i1.0 billion, cumulative FVA reduced the net derivatives balance by $i151
million, $i136 million and $i296
million, and cumulative DVA reduced the derivative liabilities balance by $i432 million, $i450
million and $i774 million, respectively.
107Bank of America
2018
NOTE 4iSecurities
iThe
table below presents the amortized cost, gross unrealized gains and losses, and fair value of AFS debt securities, other debt securities carried at fair value and HTM debt securities at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
At
December 31, 2018 and 2017, the underlying collateral type included approximately i68 percent and i62
percent prime, i4 percent and i13
percent Alt-A, and i28 percent and i25
percent subprime.
(2)
During 2018, the Corporation transferred AFS debt securities with an amortized cost of $i64.5 billion to held to maturity.
(3)
Includes
securities pledged as collateral of $i40.6 billion and $i35.8 billion at December
31, 2018 and 2017.
(4)
The Corporation had debt securities from FNMA and FHLMC that each exceeded 10 percent of shareholders’ equity, with an amortized cost of $i161.2
billion and $i52.2 billion, and a fair value of $i158.5
billion and $i51.4 billion at December 31, 2018, and an amortized cost of $i163.6
billion and $i50.3 billion, and a fair value of $i162.1
billion and $i50.0 billion at December 31, 2017.
(5)
Classified
in other assets on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
At December 31, 2018, the accumulated net unrealized loss on AFS debt securities included in accumulated OCI was $i3.7
billion, net of the related income tax benefit of $i1.2 billion. The Corporation had nonperforming AFS debt securities of $i11
million and $i99 million at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Effective January 1, 2018, the Corporation adopted
an accounting standard applicable to equity securities. For additional information, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles. At December 31, 2018, the Corporation held equity securities at an aggregate fair value of $i893 million and other equity securities, as valued under the measurement alternative,
at
cost of $i219 million, both of which are included in other assets. At December 31, 2018, the Corporation also held equity securities at fair value of $i1.2
billion included in time deposits placed and other short-term investments.
iThe following table presents the components of other debt securities carried at fair value where the changes in fair value are reported in other income. In 2018, the Corporation recorded unrealized mark-to-market net losses of $i73
million and realized net gains of $i140 million, and unrealized mark-to-market net gains of $i243
million and realized net losses of $i49 million in 2017. These amounts exclude hedge results.
Bank
of America 2018 108
Other Debt Securities Carried at Fair Value
December 31
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
Mortgage-backed securities
$
i1,606
$
i2,769
U.S.
Treasury and agency securities
i1,282
i—
Non-U.S.
securities (1)
i5,844
i9,488
Other
taxable securities, substantially all asset-backed securities
i3
i229
Total
$
i8,735
$
i12,486
(1)
These
securities are primarily used to satisfy certain international regulatory liquidity requirements.
iThe gross realized gains and losses on sales of AFS debt securities for 2018, 2017 and 2016 are presented in the table below.
Gains
and Losses on Sales of AFS Debt Securities
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Gross gains
$
i169
$
i352
$
i520
Gross
losses
(i15
)
(i97
)
(i30
)
Net
gains on sales of AFS debt securities
$
i154
$
i255
$
i490
Income
tax expense attributable to realized net gains on sales of AFS debt securities
$
i37
$
i97
$
i186
iThe table below presents the fair value and the associated gross unrealized losses on AFS debt securities and whether these securities have had gross unrealized losses for less than 12 months or for 12 months or longer at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Temporarily
Impaired and Other-than-temporarily Impaired AFS Debt Securities
Total
temporarily impaired and other-than-temporarily impaired
AFS debt securities
$
i111,645
$
(i693
)
$
i110,109
$
(i2,425
)
$
i221,754
$
(i3,118
)
(1)
Includes
other than temporarily impaired AFS debt securities on which an OTTI loss, primarily related to changes in interest rates, remains in accumulated OCI.
109Bank of America 2018
In
2018, 2017 and 2016, the Corporation had $i33 million, $i41
million and $i19 million, respectively, of credit-related OTTI losses on AFS debt securities which were recognized in other income. The amount of noncredit-related OTTI losses recognized in OCI was not significant for all periods presented.
The cumulative OTTI credit losses recognized in income on AFS debt securities that the Corporation does
not intend to sell were $i120 million, $i274
million and $i253 million at December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
The Corporation estimates the portion of a loss on
a security that is attributable to credit using a discounted cash flow model and estimates the expected cash flows of the underlying collateral using internal credit, interest rate and prepayment risk models that incorporate management’s best estimate of current key assumptions such as default rates, loss severity and prepayment rates. Assumptions used for the underlying loans that support the MBS can vary widely from loan to loan and are influenced by such factors as loan interest rate, geographic location of the borrower, borrower characteristics and collateral type. Based on these assumptions, the Corporation then determines how the underlying collateral cash flows will be distributed to each MBS issued from the applicable special purpose entity. Expected principal and interest cash flows on an impaired AFS debt security are discounted using the effective yield of each individual impaired AFS debt security.
iSignificant
assumptions used in estimating the expected cash flows for measuring credit losses on non-agency residential mortgage-backed securities (RMBS) were as follows at December 31, 2018.
Significant
Assumptions
Range (1)
Weighted average
10th
Percentile
(2)
90th
Percentile (2)
Prepayment speed
i12.9
%
i3.3
%
i21.5
%
Loss
severity
i19.8
i8.5
i36.4
Life
default rate
i16.9
i1.4
i64.4
(1)
Represents
the range of inputs/assumptions based upon the underlying collateral.
(2)
The value of a variable below which the indicated percentile of observations will fall.
Annual constant prepayment speed and loss severity rates are projected considering collateral characteristics such as LTV, creditworthiness of borrowers as measured using Fair Isaac Corporation (FICO) scores, and geographic concentrations. The weighted-average severity by collateral type was i16.0
percent for prime, i16.6 percent for Alt-A and i25.6
percent for subprime at December 31, 2018. Default rates are projected by considering collateral characteristics including, but not limited to, LTV, FICO and geographic concentration. Weighted-average life default rates by collateral type were i14.7
percent for prime, i16.6 percent for Alt-A and i19.1
percent for subprime at December 31, 2018.
iThe remaining contractual maturity distribution and yields of the Corporation’s debt securities carried at fair value and HTM debt securities at December 31, 2018 are summarized in the table below. Actual duration and yields
may differ as prepayments on the loans underlying the mortgages or other ABS are passed through to the Corporation.
Maturities
of Debt Securities Carried at Fair Value and Held-to-maturity Debt Securities
Due
in One
Year or Less
Due after One Year
through Five Years
Due after Five Years
through Ten Years
Due after
Ten Years
Total
(Dollars in millions)
Amount
Yield (1)
Amount
Yield (1)
Amount
Yield (1)
Amount
Yield (1)
Amount
Yield (1)
Amortized
cost of debt securities carried at fair value
Mortgage-backed
securities:
Agency
$
i—
i—
%
$
i114
i2.42
%
$
i1,245
i2.39
%
$
i123,757
i3.34
%
$
i125,116
i3.33
%
Agency-collateralized
mortgage obligations
i—
i—
i—
i—
i30
i2.50
i5,591
i3.17
i5,621
i3.17
Commercial
i198
i1.78
i2,467
i2.36
i10,976
i2.53
i828
i2.96
i14,469
i2.52
Non-agency
residential
i—
i—
i—
i—
i14
i—
i3,268
i9.88
i3,282
i9.84
Total
mortgage-backed securities
i198
i1.78
i2,581
i2.36
i12,265
i2.51
i133,444
i3.49
i148,488
i3.39
U.S.
Treasury and agency securities
i670
i0.78
i33,659
i1.48
i23,159
i2.36
i21
i2.57
i57,509
i1.83
Non-U.S.
securities
i14,318
i1.30
i682
i1.88
i21
i4.43
i121
i6.57
i15,142
i1.37
Other
taxable securities, substantially all asset-backed securities
i1,591
i3.34
i2,022
i3.54
i688
i3.48
i86
i5.59
i4,387
i3.49
Total
taxable securities
i16,777
i1.48
i38,944
i1.66
i36,133
i2.43
i133,672
i3.49
i225,526
i2.85
Tax-exempt
securities
i938
i2.59
i7,526
i2.59
i6,162
i2.44
i2,723
i2.55
i17,349
i2.53
Total
amortized cost of debt securities carried at fair value
$
i17,715
i1.54
$
i46,470
i1.81
$
i42,295
i2.43
$
i136,395
i3.47
$
i242,875
i2.83
Amortized
cost of HTM debt securities (2)
$
i657
i5.78
$
i18
i3.93
$
i1,475
i2.89
$
i201,502
i3.23
$
i203,652
i3.24
Debt
securities carried at fair value
Mortgage-backed
securities:
Agency
$
i—
$
i114
$
i1,219
$
i120,493
$
i121,826
Agency-collateralized
mortgage obligations
i—
i—
i29
i5,501
i5,530
Commercial
i198
i2,425
i10,656
i799
i14,078
Non-agency
residential
i—
i—
i24
i3,499
i3,523
Total
mortgage-backed securities
i198
i2,539
i11,928
i130,292
i144,957
U.S.
Treasury and agency securities
i669
i32,694
i22,821
i21
i56,205
Non-U.S.
securities
i14,315
i692
i19
i124
i15,150
Other
taxable securities, substantially all asset-backed securities
i1,585
i2,043
i698
i87
i4,413
Total
taxable securities
i16,767
i37,968
i35,466
i130,524
i220,725
Tax-exempt
securities
i936
i7,537
i6,184
i2,719
i17,376
Total
debt securities carried at fair value
$
i17,703
$
i45,505
$
i41,650
$
i133,243
$
i238,101
Fair
value of HTM debt securities (2)
$
i657
$
i18
$
i1,429
$
i198,331
$
i200,435
(1)
The
weighted average yield is computed based on a constant effective interest rate over the contractual life of each security. The average yield considers the contractual coupon and the amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts, excluding the effect of related hedging derivatives.
(2)
Substantially all U.S. agency MBS.
Bank
of America 2018 110
NOTE 5iOutstanding Loans and Leases
iThe
following tables present total outstanding loans and leases and an aging analysis for the Consumer Real Estate, Credit Card and Other Consumer, and Commercial portfolio segments, by class of financing receivables, at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Consumer
loans accounted for under the fair value option (7)
$
i682
i682
Total
consumer loans and leases
i3,025
i1,170
i4,513
i8,708
i433,196
i4,645
i682
i447,231
Commercial
U.S.
commercial
i594
i232
i573
i1,399
i297,878
i299,277
Non-U.S.
commercial
i1
i49
i—
i50
i98,726
i98,776
Commercial
real estate (8)
i29
i16
i14
i59
i60,786
i60,845
Commercial
lease financing
i124
i114
i37
i275
i22,259
i22,534
U.S.
small business commercial
i83
i54
i96
i233
i14,332
i14,565
Total
commercial
i831
i465
i720
i2,016
i493,981
i495,997
Commercial
loans accounted for under the fair value option (7)
i3,667
i3,667
Total
commercial loans and leases
i831
i465
i720
i2,016
i493,981
i3,667
i499,664
Total
loans and leases (9)
$
i3,856
$
i1,635
$
i5,233
$
i10,724
$
i927,177
$
i4,645
$
i4,349
$
i946,895
Percentage
of outstandings
i0.41
%
i0.17
%
i0.55
%
i1.13
%
i97.92
%
i0.49
%
i0.46
%
i100.00
%
(1)
Consumer
real estate loans 30-59 days past due includes fully-insured loans of $i637 million and nonperforming loans of $i217
million. Consumer real estate loans 60-89 days past due includes fully-insured loans of $i269 million and nonperforming loans of $i146
million.
(2)
Consumer real estate includes fully-insured loans of $i1.9
billion.
(3)
Consumer real estate includes $i1.8
billion and direct/indirect consumer includes $i53 million of nonperforming loans.
(4)
PCI
loan amounts are shown gross of the valuation allowance.
(5)
Total outstandings includes auto and specialty lending loans and leases of $i50.1
billion, unsecured consumer lending loans of $i383 million, U.S. securities-based lending loans of $i37.0
billion, non-U.S. consumer loans of $i2.9 billion and other consumer loans of $i746
million.
(6)
Substantially all of other consumer is consumer overdrafts.
(7)
Consumer loans accounted for under the fair value option includes residential mortgage loans of $i336
million and home equity loans of $i346 million. Commercial loans accounted for under the fair value option includes U.S. commercial loans of $i2.5
billion and non-U.S. commercial loans of $i1.1 billion. For additional information, see Note 20 – Fair Value Measurements and Note 21 – Fair Value Option.
(8)
Total
outstandings includes U.S. commercial real estate loans of $i56.6 billion and non-U.S. commercial real estate loans of $i4.2
billion.
(9)
Total outstandings includes loans and leases pledged as collateral of $i36.7 billion. The Corporation also pledged $i166.1
billion of loans with no related outstanding borrowings to secure potential borrowing capacity with the Federal Reserve Bank and Federal Home Loan Bank (FHLB).
Consumer
loans accounted for under the fair value option (7)
$
i928
i928
Total
consumer loans and leases
i3,581
i1,527
i6,564
i11,672
i431,959
i10,717
i928
i455,276
Commercial
U.S.
commercial
i547
i244
i425
i1,216
i283,620
i284,836
Non-U.S.
commercial
i52
i1
i3
i56
i97,736
i97,792
Commercial
real estate (8)
i48
i10
i29
i87
i58,211
i58,298
Commercial
lease financing
i110
i68
i26
i204
i21,912
i22,116
U.S.
small business commercial
i95
i45
i88
i228
i13,421
i13,649
Total
commercial
i852
i368
i571
i1,791
i474,900
i476,691
Commercial
loans accounted for under the fair value option (7)
i4,782
i4,782
Total
commercial loans and leases
i852
i368
i571
i1,791
i474,900
i4,782
i481,473
Total
loans and leases (9)
$
i4,433
$
i1,895
$
i7,135
$
i13,463
$
i906,859
$
i10,717
$
i5,710
$
i936,749
Percentage
of outstandings
i0.48
%
i0.20
%
i0.76
%
i1.44
%
i96.81
%
i1.14
%
i0.61
%
i100.00
%
(1)
Consumer
real estate loans 30-59 days past due includes fully-insured loans of $i850 million and nonperforming loans of $i253
million. Consumer real estate loans 60-89 days past due includes fully-insured loans of $i386 million and nonperforming loans of $i195
million.
(2)
Consumer real estate includes fully-insured loans of $i3.2
billion.
(3)
Consumer real estate includes $i2.3
billion and direct/indirect consumer includes $i43 million of nonperforming loans.
(4)
PCI
loan amounts are shown gross of the valuation allowance.
(5)
Total outstandings includes auto and specialty lending loans and leases of $i52.4
billion, unsecured consumer lending loans of $i469 million, U.S. securities-based lending loans of $i39.8
billion, non-U.S. consumer loans of $i3.0 billion and other consumer loans of $i684
million.
(6)
Substantially all of other consumer is consumer overdrafts.
(7)
Consumer loans accounted for under the fair value option includes residential mortgage loans of $i567
million and home equity loans of $i361 million. Commercial loans accounted for under the fair value option includes U.S. commercial loans of $i2.6
billion and non-U.S. commercial loans of $i2.2 billion. For additional information, see Note 20 – Fair Value Measurements and Note 21 – Fair Value Option.
(8)
Total
outstandings includes U.S. commercial real estate loans of $i54.8 billion and non-U.S. commercial real estate loans of $i3.5
billion.
(9)
Total outstandings includes loans and leases pledged as collateral of $i40.1 billion. The Corporation also pledged $i160.3
billion of loans with no related outstanding borrowings to secure potential borrowing capacity with the Federal Reserve Bank and FHLB.
The Corporation categorizes consumer real estate loans as core and non-core based on loan and customer characteristics such as origination date, product type, LTV, FICO score and delinquency status consistent with its current consumer and mortgage servicing strategy. Generally, loans that were originated after January 1, 2010, qualified under government-sponsored enterprise (GSE) underwriting guidelines, or otherwise met the Corporation’s underwriting guidelines in place in 2015 are characterized as core loans. All other loans are generally characterized as non-core loans and represent runoff portfolios.
The Corporation
has entered into long-term credit protection agreements with FNMA and FHLMC on loans totaling $i6.1 billion and $i6.3
billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017, providing full credit protection on residential mortgage loans that become severely delinquent. All of these loans are individually insured and therefore the Corporation does not record an allowance for credit losses related to these loans.
During 2018, the Corporation sold $i11.6
billion of consumer real estate loans compared to $i4.0 billion in 2017. In addition to recurring loan sales, the 2018 amount includes sales of loans, primarily non-core, with a carrying value of $i9.6
billion and related gains of $i731 million recorded in other income in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
Nonperforming Loans and Leases
The Corporation classifies junior-lien home equity loans
as nonperforming when the first-lien loan becomes i90 days past due even if the junior-lien loan is performing. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, $i221
million and $i330 million of such junior-lien home equity loans were included in nonperforming loans.
The Corporation classifies consumer real estate loans that have been discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy and not reaffirmed
by the borrower as TDRs, irrespective of payment history or delinquency status, even if the repayment terms for the loan have not been otherwise modified. The Corporation continues to have a lien on the underlying collateral. At December 31, 2018, nonperforming loans discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy with no change in repayment terms were $i185
million of which $i98 million were current on their contractual payments, while $i70
million were i90 days or more past due. Of the contractually current nonperforming loans, i63
percent were discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy over 12 months ago, and i55 percent were discharged 24 months or more ago.
Bank
of America 2018 112
During 2018, the Corporation sold nonperforming and PCI consumer real estate loans with a carrying value of $i5.3
billion, including $i4.4 billion of PCI loans, compared to $i1.3
billion, including $i803 million of PCI loans, in 2017.
iThe
table below presents the Corporation’s nonperforming loans and leases including nonperforming TDRs,
and loans accruing past due i90 days or more at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Nonperforming LHFS are excluded from nonperforming loans and leases as they are recorded at either fair value or the
lower of cost or fair value. For more information on the criteria for classification as nonperforming, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles.
Credit
Quality
Nonperforming Loans
and Leases
Accruing
Past Due
90 Days or More
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
Consumer real estate
Core
portfolio
Residential mortgage (1)
$
i1,010
$
i1,087
$
i274
$
i417
Home
equity
i955
i1,079
i—
i—
Non-core
portfolio
Residential mortgage (1)
i883
i1,389
i1,610
i2,813
Home
equity
i938
i1,565
i—
i—
Credit
card and other consumer
U.S. credit card
n/a
n/a
i994
i900
Direct/Indirect
consumer
i56
i46
i38
i40
Total
consumer
i3,842
i5,166
i2,916
i4,170
Commercial
U.S.
commercial
i794
i814
i197
i144
Non-U.S.
commercial
i80
i299
i—
i3
Commercial
real estate
i156
i112
i4
i4
Commercial
lease financing
i18
i24
i29
i19
U.S.
small business commercial
i54
i55
i84
i75
Total
commercial
i1,102
i1,304
i314
i245
Total
loans and leases
$
i4,944
$
i6,470
$
i3,230
$
i4,415
(1)
Residential
mortgage loans in the core and non-core portfolios accruing past due i90 days or more are fully-insured loans. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, residential mortgage includes $i1.4
billion and $i2.2 billion of loans on which interest has been curtailed by the FHA and therefore are no longer accruing interest, although principal is still insured, and $i498
million and $i1.0 billion of loans on which interest is still accruing.
n/a = not applicable
Credit
Quality Indicators
The Corporation monitors credit quality within its Consumer Real Estate, Credit Card and Other Consumer, and Commercial portfolio segments based on primary credit quality indicators. For more information on the portfolio segments, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles. Within the Consumer Real Estate portfolio segment, the primary credit quality indicators are refreshed LTV and refreshed FICO score. Refreshed LTV measures the carrying value of the loan as a percentage of the value of the property securing the loan, refreshed quarterly. Home equity loans are evaluated using CLTV which measures the carrying value of the Corporation’s loan and available line of credit combined with any outstanding senior liens against the property as a percentage of the value of the property securing the loan, refreshed quarterly. FICO score measures the creditworthiness
of the borrower based on the financial obligations of the borrower and the borrower’s credit history. FICO scores are typically refreshed quarterly or more
frequently. Certain borrowers (e.g., borrowers that have had debts discharged in a bankruptcy proceeding) may not have their FICO scores updated. FICO scores are also a primary credit quality indicator for the Credit Card and Other Consumer portfolio segment and the business card portfolio within U.S. small business commercial. Within the Commercial portfolio segment, loans are evaluated using the internal classifications of pass rated or reservable criticized as the primary credit quality indicators. The term reservable criticized refers to those commercial loans that are internally classified or listed by the Corporation as Special Mention, Substandard or Doubtful, which are asset quality categories defined by regulatory authorities.
These assets have an elevated level of risk and may have a high probability of default or total loss. Pass rated refers to all loans not considered reservable criticized. In addition to these primary credit quality indicators, the Corporation uses other credit quality indicators for certain types of loans.
113Bank of America 2018
iThe
following tables present certain credit quality indicators for the Corporation’s Consumer Real Estate, Credit Card and Other Consumer, and Commercial portfolio segments, by class of financing receivables, at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Consumer
Real Estate – Credit Quality Indicators (1)
Excludes
$i3.7 billion of loans accounted for under the fair value option.
(2)
U.S. small
business commercial includes $i731 million of criticized business card and
small business loans which are evaluated using refreshed FICO scores or internal credit metrics, including delinquency status, rather than risk ratings. At December 31, 2018, i99
percent of the balances where internal credit metrics are used was current or less than 30 days past due.
(3)
Refreshed FICO score and other internal credit metrics are applicable only to the U.S. small business commercial portfolio.
(4)
Other internal credit metrics may include delinquency status, application scores, geography or other factors.
Bank
of America 2018 114
Consumer
Real Estate – Credit Quality Indicators (1)
Excludes
$i4.8 billion of loans accounted for under the fair value option.
(2)
U.S. small
business commercial includes $i709 million of criticized business card and
small business loans which are evaluated using refreshed FICO scores or internal credit metrics, including delinquency status, rather than risk ratings. At December 31, 2017, i98
percent of the balances where internal credit metrics are used was current or less than 30 days past due.
(3)
Refreshed FICO score and other internal credit metrics are applicable only to the U.S. small business commercial portfolio.
(4)
Other internal credit metrics may include delinquency status, application scores, geography or other factors.
115Bank
of America 2018
Impaired Loans and Troubled Debt Restructurings
A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information, it is probable that the Corporation will be unable to collect all amounts due from the borrower in accordance with the contractual terms of the loan. For more information, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles.
Consumer
Real Estate
Impaired consumer real estate loans within the Consumer Real Estate portfolio segment consist entirely of TDRs. Excluding PCI loans, most modifications of consumer real estate loans meet the definition of TDRs when a binding offer is extended to a borrower. Modifications of consumer real estate loans are done in accordance with government programs or the Corporation’s proprietary programs. These modifications are considered to be TDRs if concessions have been granted to borrowers experiencing financial difficulties. Concessions may include reductions in interest rates, capitalization of past due amounts, principal and/or interest forbearance, payment extensions, principal and/or interest forgiveness, or combinations thereof.
Prior to permanently modifying a loan, the Corporation may enter into trial modifications with certain borrowers under both government and proprietary
programs. Trial modifications generally represent a three- to four-month period during which the borrower makes monthly payments under the anticipated modified payment terms. Upon successful completion of the trial period, the Corporation and the borrower enter into a permanent modification. Binding trial modifications are classified as TDRs when the trial offer is made and continue to be classified as TDRs regardless of whether the borrower enters into a permanent modification.
Consumer real estate loans that have been discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy with no change in repayment terms and not reaffirmed by the borrower of $i858
million were included in TDRs at December 31, 2018, of which $i185 million were classified as nonperforming and $i344
million were loans fully insured by the FHA. For more information on loans discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy, see Nonperforming Loans and Leases in this Note.
Consumer real estate TDRs are measured primarily based on the net present value of the estimated cash flows discounted at the loan’s original effective interest rate. If the carrying value of a TDR exceeds this amount, a specific allowance is recorded as a component of the allowance for loan and lease losses.
Alternatively, consumer real estate TDRs that are considered to be dependent solely on the collateral for repayment (e.g., due to the lack of income verification) are measured based on the estimated fair value of the collateral and a charge-off is recorded if the carrying value exceeds the fair value of the collateral. Consumer real estate loans
that reached 180 days past due prior to modification had been charged off to their net realizable value, less costs to sell, before they were modified as TDRs in accordance with established policy. Therefore, modifications of consumer real estate loans that are 180 or more days past due as TDRs do not have an impact on the allowance for loan and lease losses nor are additional charge-offs required at the time of modification. Subsequent declines in the fair value of the collateral after a loan has reached 180 days past due are recorded as charge-offs. Fully-insured loans are protected against principal loss, and therefore, the Corporation does not record an allowance for loan and lease losses on the outstanding principal balance, even after they have been modified in a TDR.
At December 31, 2018 and 2017,
remaining commitments to lend additional funds to debtors whose terms have been modified in a consumer real estate TDR were not significant. Consumer real estate foreclosed properties totaled $i244 million and $i236
million at December 31, 2018 and 2017. The carrying value of consumer real estate loans, including fully-insured and PCI loans, for which formal foreclosure proceedings were in process at December 31, 2018 was $i2.5
billion. During 2018 and 2017, the Corporation reclassified $i670 million and $i815
million of consumer real estate loans to foreclosed properties or, for properties acquired upon foreclosure of certain government-guaranteed loans (principally FHA-insured loans), to other assets. The reclassifications represent non-cash investing activities and, accordingly, are not reflected in the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows.
iThe following table provides the unpaid principal balance, carrying value and related
allowance at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the average carrying value and interest income recognized in 2018, 2017 and 2016 for impaired loans in the Corporation’s Consumer Real Estate portfolio segment. Certain impaired consumer real estate loans do not have a related allowance as the current valuation of these impaired loans exceeded the carrying value, which is net of previously recorded charge-offs.
During
2018, previously impaired consumer real estate loans with a carrying value of $i2.3 billion were sold.
(2)
Interest income recognized includes
interest accrued and collected on the outstanding balances of accruing impaired loans as well as interest cash collections on nonaccruing impaired loans for which the principal is considered collectible.
iThe table below presents the December 31, 2018, 2017
and 2016 unpaid principal balance, carrying value, and average pre- and post-modification interest rates on consumer real estate loans that were modified in TDRs during 2018, 2017 and 2016. The following Consumer Real Estate portfolio segment tables include loans that were initially classified as TDRs during the period and also loans that had previously been classified as TDRs and were modified again during the period.
Consumer
Real Estate – TDRs Entered into During 2018, 2017 and 2016
The
post-modification interest rate reflects the interest rate applicable only to permanently completed modifications, which exclude loans that are in a trial modification period.
117Bank of America 2018
The
table below presents the December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016 carrying value for consumer real estate loans that were modified in a TDR during 2018, 2017 and 2016, by type of modification.
Consumer
Real Estate – Modification Programs
TDRs Entered
into During
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Modifications under government programs
Contractual
interest rate reduction
$
i19
$
i59
$
i151
Principal
and/or interest forbearance
i—
i4
i13
Other
modifications (1)
i42
i22
i23
Total
modifications under government programs
i61
i85
i187
Modifications
under proprietary programs
Contractual interest rate reduction
i209
i281
i235
Capitalization
of past due amounts
i96
i63
i40
Principal
and/or interest forbearance
i51
i38
i72
Other
modifications (1)
i167
i55
i75
Total
modifications under proprietary programs
i523
i437
i422
Trial
modifications
i285
i569
i831
Loans
discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy (2)
i130
i211
i226
Total
modifications
$
i999
$
i1,302
$
i1,666
(1)
Includes
other modifications such as term or payment extensions and repayment plans. During 2018, this included $i198 million of modifications that met the definition
of a TDR related to the 2017 hurricanes. These modifications had been written down to their net realizable value less costs to sell or were fully insured as of December 31, 2018.
(2)
Includes loans discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy with no change in repayment terms that are classified as TDRs.
The table below presents the carrying value of consumer real estate loans that entered into payment default during 2018, 2017 and 2016
that were modified in a TDR during the 12 months preceding payment default. A payment default for consumer real estate TDRs is recognized when a borrower has missed ithree monthly payments (not necessarily consecutively) since modification.
Consumer
Real Estate – TDRs Entering Payment Default that were Modified During the Preceding 12 Months
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Modifications
under government programs
$
i39
$
i81
$
i262
Modifications
under proprietary programs
i158
i138
i196
Loans
discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy (1)
i64
i116
i158
Trial
modifications (2)
i107
i391
i824
Total
modifications
$
i368
$
i726
$
i1,440
(1)
Includes
loans discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy with no change in repayment terms that are classified as TDRs.
(2)
Includes trial modification offers to which the customer did not respond.
Credit Card and Other Consumer
Impaired loans within the Credit Card and Other Consumer portfolio segment consist entirely of loans that have been modified in TDRs. The Corporation seeks to assist customers that are experiencing financial
difficulty by modifying loans while ensuring compliance with federal and local laws and guidelines. Credit card and other consumer loan modifications generally involve reducing the interest rate on the account, placing the customer on a fixed payment plan not exceeding i60 months and canceling the customer’s available line of credit, all of which are considered TDRs. The Corporation makes loan modifications directly with borrowers for debt held only
by the Corporation (internal programs). Additionally, the Corporation makes loan modifications for
borrowers working with third-party renegotiation agencies that provide solutions to customers’ entire unsecured debt structures (external programs). The Corporation classifies other secured consumer loans that have been discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy as TDRs which are written down to collateral value and placed on nonaccrual status no later than the time of discharge. For more information on the regulatory guidance on loans discharged in Chapter 7 bankruptcy, see Nonperforming Loans and Leases in this Note.
iThe
table below provides the unpaid principal balance, carrying value and related allowance at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the average carrying value for 2018, 2017 and 2016 on TDRs within the Credit Card and Other Consumer portfolio segment.
The related interest income recognized, which included interest accrued and collected on the outstanding balances of accruing impaired loans as well as interest cash collections on nonaccruing impaired loans for which the principal was considered collectible, was not significant in 2018, 2017 and 2016.
(3)
In
2017, the Corporation sold its non-U.S. consumer credit card business.
n/a = not applicable
iThe table below provides information on the Corporation’s primary modification programs for the Credit Card and Other Consumer TDR portfolio at December 31, 2018
and 2017.
Credit
Card and Other Consumer – TDRs by Program Type at December 31
U.S. Credit Card
Direct/Indirect Consumer
Total TDRs by Program
Type
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
Internal
programs
$
i259
$
i203
$
i—
$
i1
$
i259
$
i204
External
programs
i273
i257
i—
i—
i273
i257
Other
i1
i1
i33
i28
i34
i29
Total
$
i533
$
i461
$
i33
$
i29
$
i566
$
i490
Percent
of balances current or less than 30 days past due
i85
%
i87
%
i81
%
i88
%
i85
%
i87
%
The
table below provides information on the Corporation’s Credit Card and Other Consumer TDR portfolio including the December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016 unpaid principal balance, carrying value, and average pre- and post-modification interest rates of loans that were modified in TDRs during 2018, 2017 and 2016.
Credit
Card and Other Consumer – TDRs Entered into During 2018, 2017 and 2016
Credit card and other consumer loans are deemed to be in payment default during the quarter in which a borrower misses the
second of itwo consecutive payments. Payment defaults are one of the factors considered when projecting future cash flows in the calculation of the allowance for loan and lease losses for impaired credit card and other consumer loans. Based on historical experience, the Corporation estimates that i13
percent of new U.S. credit card TDRs and i14 percent of new direct/indirect consumer TDRs may be in payment default within i12
months after modification.
Commercial Loans
Impaired commercial loans include nonperforming loans and TDRs (both performing and nonperforming). Modifications of loans to commercial borrowers that are experiencing financial difficulty are designed to reduce the Corporation’s loss exposure while providing the borrower with an opportunity to work through financial difficulties, often to avoid foreclosure or bankruptcy. Each modification is unique and reflects the individual circumstances of the borrower. Modifications that result in a TDR may include extensions of maturity at a concessionary (below market) rate of interest, payment forbearances or other actions designed to benefit the customer while mitigating the Corporation’s risk exposure. Reductions in interest
rates are rare. Instead, the interest rates are typically increased, although the increased rate may not represent a market rate of interest. Infrequently,
concessions may also include principal forgiveness in connection with foreclosure, short sale or other settlement agreements leading to termination or sale of the loan.
At the time of restructuring, the loans are remeasured to reflect the impact, if any, on projected cash flows resulting from the modified terms. If there was no forgiveness of principal and the interest rate was not decreased, the modification may have little or no impact on the allowance established for the loan. If a portion of the loan is deemed to be uncollectible, a charge-off may be recorded at the time of restructuring. Alternatively, a charge-off may have already been recorded in a previous period such
that no charge-off is required at the time of modification. For more information on modifications for the U.S. small business commercial portfolio, see Credit Card and Other Consumer in this Note.
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, remaining commitments to lend additional funds to debtors whose terms have been modified in a commercial loan TDR were $i297
million and $i205 million.
iThe
table below provides information on impaired loans in the Commercial loan portfolio segment including the unpaid principal balance, carrying value and related allowance at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the average carrying value for 2018, 2017 and 2016. Certain impaired commercial loans do not have a related allowance because the valuation of these impaired loans exceeded the carrying value, which is net of previously recorded charge-offs.
The
related interest income recognized, which included interest accrued and collected on the outstanding balances of accruing impaired loans as well as interest cash collections on nonaccruing impaired loans for which the principal was considered collectible, was not significant in 2018, 2017 and 2016.
(2)
Includes U.S. small business commercial renegotiated TDR loans and related allowance.
Bank
of America 2018 120
iThe table below presents the December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016
unpaid principal balance and carrying value of commercial loans that were modified as TDRs during 2018, 2017 and 2016. The table below includes loans that were initially classified as TDRs during the period and also loans that had previously been classified as TDRs and were modified again during the period.
Commercial
– TDRs Entered into During 2018, 2017 and 2016
U.S.
small business commercial TDRs are comprised of renegotiated small business card loans.
A commercial TDR is generally deemed to be in payment default when the loan is i90 days or more past due, including delinquencies that were not resolved as part of the modification. U.S. small business commercial TDRs are deemed to be in payment default during the quarter in which a borrower misses
the second of two consecutive payments. Payment defaults are one of the factors considered when projecting future cash flows, along with observable market prices or fair value of collateral when measuring the allowance for loan and lease losses. TDRs that were in payment default had a carrying value of $i150 million,
$i64 million and $i140
million for U.S. commercial and $i3 million, $i19
million and $i34 million for commercial real estate at December 31, 2018, 2017 and
2016, respectively.
Purchased Credit-impaired Loans
iThe table below shows activity for the accretable yield on PCI loans, which includes the Countrywide Financial Corporation (Countrywide) portfolio and loans repurchased in connection with the 2013 settlement with FNMA. The amount of accretable yield is affected by changes in credit outlooks, including
metrics such as default rates and loss severities, prepayment speeds, which can change the amount and period of time over which interest payments are expected to be received, and the interest rates on variable rate loans. The reclassifications from nonaccretable difference during 2018 and 2017 were primarily due to an increase in the expected principal and interest cash flows due to lower default estimates and the rising interest rate environment.
During2018 and 2017, the Corporation sold PCI loans with a carrying value of $i4.4 billion and $i803
million. For more information on PCI loans, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles and for the carrying value and valuation allowance for PCI loans, see Note 6 – Allowance for Credit Losses.
Loans Held-for-sale
The Corporation had LHFS of $i10.4 billion
and $i11.4 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Cash and non-cash proceeds from sales and paydowns of loans originally classified as LHFS were $i29.2
billion, $i41.3 billion and $i32.6
billion for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Cash used for originations and purchases of LHFS totaled $i28.1 billion, $i43.5
billion and $i33.1 billion for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
121Bank
of America 2018
NOTE 6iAllowance
for Credit Losses
iThe table below summarizes the changes in the allowance for credit losses by portfolio segment for 2018, 2017 and 2016.
Consumer
Real Estate (1)
Credit Card and Other Consumer
Commercial
Total
(Dollars in millions)
2018
Allowance for loan and lease losses, January 1
$
i1,720
$
i3,663
$
i5,010
$
i10,393
Loans
and leases charged off
(i690
)
(i4,037
)
(i675
)
(i5,402
)
Recoveries
of loans and leases previously charged off
i664
i823
i152
i1,639
Net
charge-offs
(i26
)
(i3,214
)
(i523
)
(i3,763
)
Write-offs
of PCI loans (2)
(i273
)
i—
i—
(i273
)
Provision
for loan and lease losses
(i492
)
i3,441
i313
i3,262
Other
(3)
(i1
)
(i16
)
(i1
)
(i18
)
Allowance
for loan and lease losses, December 31
i928
i3,874
i4,799
i9,601
Reserve
for unfunded lending commitments, January 1
i—
i—
i777
i777
Provision
for unfunded lending commitments
i—
i—
i20
i20
Reserve
for unfunded lending commitments, December 31
i—
i—
i797
i797
Allowance
for credit losses, December 31
$
i928
$
i3,874
$
i5,596
$
i10,398
2017
Allowance
for loan and lease losses, January 1
$
i2,750
$
i3,229
$
i5,258
$
i11,237
Loans
and leases charged off
(i770
)
(i3,774
)
(i1,075
)
(i5,619
)
Recoveries
of loans and leases previously charged off
i657
i809
i174
i1,640
Net
charge-offs
(i113
)
(i2,965
)
(i901
)
(i3,979
)
Write-offs
of PCI loans (2)
(i207
)
i—
i—
(i207
)
Provision
for loan and lease losses
(i710
)
i3,437
i654
i3,381
Other
(3)
i—
(i38
)
(i1
)
(i39
)
Allowance
for loan and lease losses, December 31
i1,720
i3,663
i5,010
i10,393
Reserve
for unfunded lending commitments, January 1
i—
i—
i762
i762
Provision
for unfunded lending commitments
i—
i—
i15
i15
Reserve
for unfunded lending commitments, December 31
i—
i—
i777
i777
Allowance
for credit losses, December 31
$
i1,720
$
i3,663
$
i5,787
$
i11,170
2016
Allowance
for loan and lease losses, January 1
$
i3,914
$
i3,471
$
i4,849
$
i12,234
Loans
and leases charged off
(i1,155
)
(i3,553
)
(i740
)
(i5,448
)
Recoveries
of loans and leases previously charged off
i619
i770
i238
i1,627
Net
charge-offs
(i536
)
(i2,783
)
(i502
)
(i3,821
)
Write-offs
of PCI loans (2)
(i340
)
i—
i—
(i340
)
Provision
for loan and lease losses
(i258
)
i2,826
i1,013
i3,581
Other
(3)
(i30
)
(i42
)
(i102
)
(i174
)
Total
allowance for loan and lease losses, December 31
i2,750
i3,472
i5,258
i11,480
Less:
Allowance included in assets of business held for sale (4)
—
(i243
)
—
(i243
)
Allowance
for loan and lease losses, December 31
i2,750
i3,229
i5,258
i11,237
Reserve
for unfunded lending commitments, January 1
i—
i—
i646
i646
Provision
for unfunded lending commitments
i—
i—
i16
i16
Other
(3)
i—
i—
i100
i100
Reserve
for unfunded lending commitments, December 31
i—
i—
i762
i762
Allowance
for credit losses, December 31
$
i2,750
$
i3,229
$
i6,020
$
i11,999
(1)
Includes
valuation allowance associated with the PCI loan portfolio.
(2)
Includes write-offs associated with the sale of PCI loans of $i167 million, $i87
million and $i60 million in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
(3)
Primarily
represents the net impact of portfolio sales, consolidations and deconsolidations, foreign currency translation adjustments, transfers to held for sale and certain other reclassifications.
(4)
Represents allowance for loan and lease losses related to the non-U.S. consumer credit card loan portfolio, which was sold in 2017.
Bank
of America 2018 122
The table below presents the allowance and the carrying value of outstanding loans and leases by portfolio segment at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Impaired loans and troubled debt restructurings (1)
Allowance
for loan and lease losses
$
i348
$
i125
$
i190
$
i663
Carrying
value (2)
i12,554
i490
i2,407
i15,451
Allowance
as a percentage of carrying value
i2.77
%
i25.51
%
i7.89
%
i4.29
%
Loans
collectively evaluated for impairment
Allowance for loan and lease losses
$
i1,083
$
i3,538
$
i4,820
$
i9,441
Carrying
value (2, 3)
i238,284
i192,303
i474,284
i904,871
Allowance
as a percentage of carrying value (3)
i0.45
%
i1.84
%
i1.02
%
i1.04
%
Purchased
credit-impaired loans
Valuation allowance
$
i289
n/a
n/a
$
i289
Carrying
value gross of valuation allowance
i10,717
n/a
n/a
i10,717
Valuation
allowance as a percentage of carrying value
i2.70
%
n/a
n/a
i2.70
%
Total
Allowance
for loan and lease losses
$
i1,720
$
i3,663
$
i5,010
$
i10,393
Carrying
value (2, 3)
i261,555
i192,793
i476,691
i931,039
Allowance
as a percentage of carrying value (3)
i0.66
%
i1.90
%
i1.05
%
i1.12
%
(1)
Impaired
loans include nonperforming commercial loans and all TDRs, including both commercial and consumer TDRs. Impaired loans exclude nonperforming consumer loans unless they are TDRs, and all consumer and commercial loans accounted for under the fair value option.
(2)
Amounts are presented gross of the allowance for loan and lease losses.
(3)
Outstanding loan and lease balances and ratios do not include loans accounted for under the fair value option of $i4.3
billion and $i5.7 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
n/a = not applicable
NOTE
7iSecuritizations and Other Variable Interest Entities
The Corporation utilizes VIEs in the ordinary course of business to support its own and its customers’ financing and investing needs. The Corporation routinely securitizes loans and debt securities using VIEs as a source of funding for the Corporation and as a means of transferring the economic risk of the loans or debt securities to third parties. The assets are transferred into a trust or other securitization vehicle such that the
assets are legally isolated from the creditors of the Corporation and are not available to satisfy its obligations. These assets can only be used to settle obligations of the trust or other securitization vehicle. The Corporation also administers, structures or invests in other VIEs including CDOs, investment vehicles and other entities. For more information on the Corporation’s use of VIEs, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles.
The tables in this Note present the assets and liabilities of consolidated and unconsolidated VIEs at December 31, 2018 and 2017 in situations where the Corporation has continuing involvement with transferred assets or if the Corporation otherwise
has a variable interest in the VIE. The tables also present the Corporation’s maximum loss exposure at December 31, 2018 and 2017 resulting from its involvement with consolidated VIEs and unconsolidated VIEs in which the Corporation holds a variable interest. The Corporation’s maximum loss exposure is based on the unlikely event that all of the assets in the VIEs become worthless and incorporates not only potential losses associated with assets recorded on the Consolidated Balance Sheet but also potential losses associated with off-balance sheet commitments, such as unfunded liquidity commitments and other contractual arrangements. The Corporation’s maximum loss exposure does not include losses previously recognized through write-downs of assets.
123Bank
of America 2018
The Corporation invests in ABS issued by third-party VIEs with which it has no other form of involvement and enters into certain commercial lending arrangements that may also incorporate the use of VIEs, for example to hold collateral. These securities and loans are included in Note 4 – Securities or Note 5 – Outstanding Loans and Leases. In addition, the Corporation
has used VIEs such as trust preferred securities trusts in connection with its funding activities. In 2018, the Corporation redeemed trust preferred securities with a total carrying value of $i3.1 billion resulting in the extinguishment of the related junior subordinated notes issued by the Corporation. In connection therewith, the Corporation recorded a charge to other income of $i729
million primarily due to the difference between the carrying and redemption values of the trust preferred securities, the majority of which relates to the discount on the junior subordinated notes resulting from prior acquisitions. For more information on trust preferred securities, see Note 11 – Long-term Debt. These VIEs, which are generally not consolidated by the Corporation, as applicable, are not included in the tables herein.
The Corporation did not provide financial support to consolidated or unconsolidated VIEs during 2018, 2017 and 2016 that it was not previously contractually required to provide, nor does it intend to do so.
The
Corporation had liquidity commitments, including written put options and collateral value guarantees, with certain
unconsolidated VIEs of $i218 million and $i442
million at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
First-lien Mortgage Securitizations
As part of its mortgage banking activities, the Corporation securitizes a portion of the first-lien residential mortgage loans it originates or purchases from third parties, generally in the form of RMBS guaranteed by government-sponsored enterprises, FNMA and FHLMC (collectively the GSEs), or the Government National Mortgage Association (GNMA) primarily in the case of FHA-insured and U.S. Department of Veterans Affairs (VA)-guaranteed mortgage loans. Securitization usually occurs in conjunction with or shortly after origination or purchase, and the Corporation may also securitize loans
held in its residential mortgage portfolio. In addition, the Corporation may, from time to time, securitize commercial mortgages it originates or purchases from other entities. The Corporation typically services the loans it securitizes. Further, the Corporation may retain beneficial interests in the securitization trusts including senior and subordinate securities and equity tranches issued by the trusts. Except as described in Note 12 – Commitments and Contingencies, the Corporation does not provide guarantees or recourse to the securitization trusts other than standard representations and warranties.
iThe
table below summarizes select information related to first-lien mortgage securitizations for 2018, 2017 and 2016.
First-lien
Mortgage Securitizations
Residential
Mortgage - Agency
Commercial Mortgage
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Cash
proceeds from new securitizations (1)
$
i5,369
$
i14,467
$
i24,201
$
i6,713
$
i5,641
$
i3,887
Gains
on securitizations (2)
i62
i158
i370
i101
i91
i38
Repurchases
from securitization trusts (3)
i1,485
i2,713
i3,611
i—
i—
i—
(1)
The
Corporation transfers residential mortgage loans to securitizations sponsored by the GSEs or GNMA in the normal course of business and receives RMBS in exchange which may then be sold into the market to third-party investors for cash proceeds.
(2)
A majority of the first-lien residential mortgage loans securitized are initially classified as LHFS and accounted for under the fair value option. Gains recognized on these LHFS prior to securitization, which totaled $i71
million, $i243 million and $i487
million, net of hedges, during 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively, are not included in the table above.
(3)
The Corporation may have the option to repurchase delinquent loans out of securitization trusts, which reduces the amount of servicing advances it is required to make. The Corporation may also repurchase loans from securitization trusts to perform modifications. Repurchased loans include FHA-insured mortgages collateralizing GNMA securities.
In addition
to cash proceeds as reported in the table above, the Corporation received securities with an initial fair value of $i711 million, $i1.9
billion and $i4.2 billion in connection with first-lien mortgage securitizations in 2018, 2017and2016, respectively. Substantially all of these securities are classified as Level 2 assets within the fair value hierarchy.
The Corporation recognizes consumer MSRs from the sale or securitization of consumer real estate loans. The unpaid principal balance of loans serviced for investors, including residential mortgage and home equity loans, totaled $i226.6 billion and $i277.6
billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Servicing fee and ancillary fee income on serviced loans was $i710 million, $i893
million and $i1.2 billion in 2018, 2017and2016, respectively. Servicing advances on serviced
loans, including loans serviced for others and loans held for investment, were $i3.3 billion and $i4.5
billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. For more information on MSRs, see Note 20 – Fair Value Measurements.
There were no significant deconsolidations of agency residential mortgage securitizations in 2018 or 2017. During 2016, the Corporation deconsolidated agency residential mortgage securitization vehicles with total assets of $i3.8
billion and total liabilities of $i628 million following the sale of retained interests to third parties, after which the Corporation no longer had the unilateral ability to liquidate the vehicles. Of the balances deconsolidated in 2016, $i706
million of assets and $i628 million of liabilities represent non-cash investing and financing activities and, accordingly, are not reflected on the Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows. A gain on sale of $i125
million in 2016 related to the deconsolidation was recorded in other income in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
iThe following table summarizes select information related to first-lien mortgage securitization trusts in which the Corporation held a variable interest at December 31, 2018 and
2017.
Bank of America 2018 124
First-lien
Mortgage VIEs
Residential
Mortgage
Non-agency
Agency
Prime
Subprime
Alt-A
Commercial
Mortgage
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
Unconsolidated
VIEs
Maximum
loss exposure (1)
$
i16,011
$
i19,110
$
i448
$
i689
$
i1,897
$
i2,643
$
i217
$
i403
$
i767
$
i585
On-balance
sheet assets
Senior
securities:
Trading
account assets
$
i460
$
i716
$
i30
$
i6
$
i36
$
i10
$
i90
$
i50
$
i97
$
i108
Debt
securities carried at fair value
i9,381
i15,036
i246
i477
i1,470
i2,221
i125
i351
i—
i—
Held-to-maturity
securities
i6,170
i3,348
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i528
i274
All
other assets
i—
i10
i3
i5
i37
i38
i2
i2
i40
i88
Total
retained positions
$
i16,011
$
i19,110
$
i279
$
i488
$
i1,543
$
i2,269
$
i217
$
i403
$
i665
$
i470
Principal
balance outstanding (2)
$
i187,512
$
i232,761
$
i8,954
$
i10,549
$
i8,719
$
i10,254
$
i23,467
$
i28,129
$
i43,593
$
i26,504
Consolidated
VIEs
Maximum
loss exposure (1)
$
i13,296
$
i14,502
$
i7
$
i571
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i76
$
i—
On-balance
sheet assets
Trading
account assets
$
i1,318
$
i232
$
i150
$
i571
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i76
$
i—
Loans
and leases, net
i11,858
i14,030
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
All
other assets
i143
i240
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
Total
assets
$
i13,319
$
i14,502
$
i150
$
i571
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i76
$
i—
Total
liabilities
$
i26
$
i3
$
i143
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
(1)
Maximum
loss exposure includes obligations under loss-sharing reinsurance and other arrangements for non-agency residential mortgage and commercial mortgage securitizations, but excludes the reserve for representations and warranties obligations and corporate guarantees and also excludes servicing advances and other servicing rights and obligations. For additional information, see Note 12 – Commitments and Contingencies and Note 20 – Fair Value Measurements.
(2)
Principal balance outstanding includes loans where the Corporation was the transferor to securitization VIEs with which it has continuing involvement, which may include servicing
the loans.
Other Asset-backed Securitizations
iThe table below summarizes select information related to home equity, credit card and other asset-backed VIEs in which the Corporation held a variable interest at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Home
Equity Loan, Credit Card and Other Asset-backed VIEs
Home
Equity (1)
Credit Card (2, 3)
Resecuritization Trusts
Municipal Bond Trusts
December 31 2018
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
Unconsolidated
VIEs
Maximum
loss exposure
$
i908
$
i1,522
$
i—
$
i—
$
i7,647
$
i8,204
$
i2,150
$
i1,631
On-balance
sheet assets
Senior
securities (4):
Trading
account assets
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i1,419
$
i869
$
i26
$
i33
Debt
securities carried at fair value
i27
i36
i—
i—
i1,337
i1,661
i—
i—
Held-to-maturity
securities
i—
i—
i—
i—
i4,891
i5,644
i—
i—
All
other assets (4)
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i30
i—
i—
Total
retained positions
$
i27
$
i36
$
i—
$
i—
$
i7,647
$
i8,204
$
i26
$
i33
Total
assets of VIEs (5)
$
i1,813
$
i2,432
$
i—
$
i—
$
i16,949
$
i19,281
$
i2,829
$
i2,287
Consolidated
VIEs
Maximum
loss exposure
$
i85
$
i112
$
i18,800
$
i24,337
$
i128
$
i628
$
i1,540
$
i1,453
On-balance
sheet assets
Trading
account assets
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i366
$
i1,557
$
i1,553
$
i1,452
Loans
and leases
i133
i177
i29,906
i32,554
i—
i—
i—
i—
Allowance
for loan and lease losses
(i5
)
(i9
)
(i901
)
(i988
)
i—
i—
i—
i—
All
other assets
i4
i6
i136
i1,385
i—
i—
i1
i1
Total
assets
$
i132
$
i174
$
i29,141
$
i32,951
$
i366
$
i1,557
$
i1,554
$
i1,453
On-balance
sheet liabilities
Short-term
borrowings
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i742
$
i312
Long-term
debt
i55
i76
i10,321
i8,598
i238
i929
i12
i—
All
other liabilities
i—
i—
i20
i16
i—
i—
i—
i—
Total
liabilities
$
i55
$
i76
$
i10,341
$
i8,614
$
i238
$
i929
$
i754
$
i312
(1)
For
unconsolidated home equity loan VIEs, the maximum loss exposure includes outstanding trust certificates issued by trusts in rapid amortization, net of recorded reserves. For both consolidated and unconsolidated home equity loan VIEs, the maximum loss exposure excludes the reserve for representations and warranties obligations and corporate guarantees. For additional information, see Note 12 – Commitments and Contingencies.
(2)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, loans and leases in the
consolidated credit card trust included $i11.0 billion and $i15.6
billion of seller’s interest.
(3)
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, all other assets in the consolidated credit card trust included certain short-term investments and unbilled accrued interest and fees.
(4)
All other assets includes subordinate securities.
The retained senior and subordinate securities were valued using quoted market prices or observable market inputs (Level 2 of the fair value hierarchy).
(5)
Total assets of VIEs includes loans the Corporation transferred with which it has continuing involvement, which may include servicing the loan.
125Bank of America 2018
Home
Equity Loans
The Corporation retains interests in home equity securitization trusts, primarily senior securities, to which it transferred home equity loans. In addition, the Corporation may be obligated to provide subordinate funding to the trusts during a rapid amortization event. This obligation is included in the maximum loss exposure in the table above. The charges that will ultimately be recorded as a result of the rapid amortization events depend on the undrawn portion of the home equity lines of credit (HELOCs), performance of the loans, the amount of subsequent draws and the timing of related cash flows.
Credit Card Securitizations
The Corporation securitizes originated and purchased credit card loans. The Corporation’s continuing involvement with the securitization trust includes servicing the receivables, retaining an undivided
interest (seller’s interest) in the receivables, and holding certain retained interests including subordinate interests in accrued interest and fees on the securitized receivables and cash reserve accounts.
During 2018, 2017 and 2016, new senior debt securities issued to third-party investors from the credit card securitization trust were $i4.0
billion, $i3.1 billion and $i750
million, respectively.
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation held subordinate securities issued by the credit card securitization trust with a notional principal amount of $i7.7
billion and $i7.4 billion. These securities serve as a form of credit enhancement to the senior debt securities and have a stated interest rate of izero
percent. During 2018, 2017 and 2016, the credit card securitization trust issued $i650 million, $i500
million and $i121 million, respectively, of these subordinate securities.
Resecuritization Trusts
The Corporation transfers securities, typically MBS, into resecuritization VIEs at the request of customers seeking
securities
with specific characteristics. Generally, there are no significant ongoing activities performed in a resecuritization trust, and no single investor has the unilateral ability to liquidate the trust.
The Corporation resecuritized $i22.8 billion, $i25.1
billion and $i23.4 billion of securities in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. Securities transferred into resecuritization VIEs were measured at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in trading account profits prior
to the resecuritization and no gain or loss on sale was recorded. During 2018, 2017 and 2016, resecuritization proceeds included securities with an initial fair value of $i4.1 billion,
$i3.3 billion and $i3.3
billion, respectively. Substantially all of the other securities received as resecuritization proceeds were classified as trading securities and were categorized as Level 2 within the fair value hierarchy.
Municipal Bond Trusts
The Corporation administers municipal bond trusts that hold highly-rated, long-term, fixed-rate municipal bonds. The trusts obtain financing by issuing floating-rate trust certificates that reprice on a weekly or other short-term basis to third-party investors.
The Corporation’s liquidity commitments to unconsolidated municipal bond trusts, including those for which the Corporation was transferor, totaled $i2.1
billion and $i1.6 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
The weighted-average remaining life of bonds held in the trusts at December 31, 2018 was i7.3 years. There were no material write-downs or downgrades of assets or issuers during 2018,
2017 and 2016.
Other Variable Interest Entities
iThe table below summarizes select information related to other VIEs in which the Corporation held a variable interest at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Other
VIEs
Consolidated
Unconsolidated
Total
Consolidated
Unconsolidated
Total
December
31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Maximum loss exposure
$
i4,177
$
i24,498
$
i28,675
$
i4,660
$
i19,785
$
i24,445
On-balance
sheet assets
Trading
account assets
$
i2,335
$
i860
$
i3,195
$
i2,709
$
i346
$
i3,055
Debt
securities carried at fair value
i—
i84
i84
i—
i160
i160
Loans
and leases
i1,949
i3,940
i5,889
i2,152
i3,596
i5,748
Allowance
for loan and lease losses
(i2
)
(i30
)
(i32
)
(i3
)
(i32
)
(i35
)
All
other assets
i53
i18,885
i18,938
i89
i15,216
i15,305
Total
$
i4,335
$
i23,739
$
i28,074
$
i4,947
$
i19,286
$
i24,233
On-balance
sheet liabilities
Long-term
debt
$
i152
$
i—
$
i152
$
i270
$
i—
$
i270
All
other liabilities
i7
i4,231
i4,238
i18
i3,417
i3,435
Total
$
i159
$
i4,231
$
i4,390
$
i288
$
i3,417
$
i3,705
Total
assets of VIEs
$
i4,335
$
i94,746
$
i99,081
$
i4,947
$
i69,746
$
i74,693
Customer
VIEs
Customer VIEs include credit-linked, equity-linked and commodity-linked note VIEs, repackaging VIEs and asset acquisition VIEs, which are typically created on behalf of customers who wish to obtain market or credit exposure to a specific company, index, commodity or financial instrument.
The Corporation’s maximum loss exposure to consolidated and unconsolidated customer VIEs totaled $i2.1
billion and $i2.3 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017, including the notional amount of derivatives to which the Corporation is a counterparty,
net
of losses previously recorded, and the Corporation’s investment, if any, in securities issued by the VIEs.
Collateralized Debt Obligation VIEs
The Corporation receives fees for structuring CDO VIEs, which hold diversified pools of fixed-income securities, typically corporate debt or ABS, which the CDO VIEs fund by issuing multiple tranches of debt and equity securities. CDOs are generally managed by third-party portfolio managers. The Corporation typically transfers assets to these CDOs, holds securities issued by the CDOs and may be a derivative counterparty to the CDOs. The Corporation’s maximum loss exposure to consolidated and
Bank
of America 2018 126
unconsolidated CDOs totaled $i421 million and $i358
million at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Investment VIEs
The Corporation sponsors, invests in or provides financing, which may be in connection with the sale of assets, to a variety of investment VIEs that hold loans, real estate, debt securities or other financial instruments and are designed to provide the desired investment profile to investors or the Corporation. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation’s consolidated investment VIEs had total assets of $i270
million and $i249 million. The Corporation also held investments in unconsolidated VIEs with total assets of $i37.7
billion and $i20.3 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. The Corporation’s maximum loss exposure associated with both consolidated and unconsolidated investment VIEs totaled $i7.2
billion and $i5.7 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 comprised primarily of on-balance sheet assets less non-recourse liabilities.
Leveraged Lease Trusts
The
Corporation’s net investment in consolidated leveraged lease trusts totaled $i1.8 billion and $i2.0
billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. The trusts hold long-lived equipment such as rail cars, power generation and distribution equipment, and commercial aircraft. The Corporation structures the trusts and holds a significant residual interest. The net investment represents the Corporation’s maximum loss exposure to the trusts in the unlikely event that the leveraged lease investments become worthless. Debt issued by the leveraged lease trusts is non-recourse to the Corporation.
Tax Credit VIEs
The Corporation holds investments in unconsolidated limited partnerships and similar entities that construct, own and
operate affordable housing, wind and solar projects. An unrelated third party is typically the general partner or managing member and has control over the significant activities of the VIE. The Corporation earns a return primarily through the receipt of tax credits allocated to the projects. The maximum loss exposure included in the Other VIEs table was $i17.0
billion and $i13.8 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. The Corporation’s risk of loss
is generally mitigated by policies requiring that the project qualify for the expected tax credits prior to making its investment.
The Corporation’s investments in affordable housing partnerships, which are reported in other assets on the Consolidated Balance Sheet, totaled $i8.9 billion and $i8.0
billion, including unfunded commitments to provide capital contributions of $i3.8 billion and $i3.1
billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. The unfunded commitments are expected to be paid over the next ifive years. During 2018, 2017 and 2016,
the Corporation recognized tax credits and other tax benefits from investments in affordable housing partnerships of $i981 million, $i1.0
billion and $i1.1 billion and reported pretax losses in other income of $i798
million, $i766 million and $i789
million, respectively. Tax credits are recognized as part of the Corporation’s annual effective tax rate used to determine tax expense in a given quarter. Accordingly, the portion of a year’s expected tax benefits recognized in any given quarter may differ from i25 percent. The Corporation may from time to time be asked to invest additional amounts to support a troubled affordable housing project. Such additional investments have not been
and are not expected to be significant.
NOTE 8iGoodwill and Intangible Assets
Goodwill
iThe
table below presents goodwill balances by reporting unit and All Other at December 31, 2018 and 2017. The reporting units utilized for goodwill impairment testing are the operating segments or one level below.
Goodwill
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Deposits
$
i18,414
$
i18,414
Consumer
Lending
i11,709
i11,709
Consumer
Banking
i30,123
i30,123
U.S.
Trust
i2,917
i2,917
Merrill
Lynch Global Wealth Management
i6,760
i6,760
Global
Wealth & Investment Management
i9,677
i9,677
Global
Commercial Banking
i16,146
i16,146
Global
Corporate and Investment Banking
i6,231
i6,231
Business
Banking
i1,546
i1,546
Global
Banking
i23,923
i23,923
Global
Markets
i5,182
i5,182
All
Other
i46
i46
Total
goodwill
$
i68,951
$
i68,951
During
2018, the Corporation completed its annual goodwill impairment test as of June 30, 2018 using qualitative assessments for all applicable reporting units. Based on the results of the annual goodwill impairment test, the Corporation determined there was no impairment. For more information on the use of qualitative assessments, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles.
127Bank of America 2018
Intangible
Assets
iThe table below presents the gross and net carrying values and accumulated amortization for intangible assets at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Includes $i1.6
billion at both December 31, 2018 and 2017 of intangible assets associated with trade names that have an indefinite life and, accordingly, are not amortized.
Amortization of intangibles expense was $i538 million, $i621
million and $i730 million for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. The Corporation estimates aggregate amortization expense will be $i105
million for 2019, $i55 million for 2020 and inone
for the years thereafter.
NOTE 9iDeposits
iThe
table below presents information about the Corporation’s time deposits of $100 thousand or more at December 31, 2018 and 2017. The Corporation also had aggregate time deposits of $i16.4 billion and $i17.0
billion in denominations that met or exceeded the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) insurance limit at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
U.S.
certificates of deposit and other time deposits
$
i14,441
$
i11,855
$
i3,209
$
i29,505
$
i25,192
Non-U.S.
certificates of deposit and other time deposits
i7,317
i2,655
i820
i10,792
i15,472
The
scheduled contractual maturities for total time deposits at December 31, 2018 are presented in the table below.
Contractual
Maturities of Total Time Deposits
(Dollars in millions)
U.S.
Non-U.S.
Total
Due
in 2019
$
i43,452
$
i10,030
$
i53,482
Due
in 2020
i4,580
i164
i4,744
Due
in 2021
i725
i8
i733
Due
in 2022
i560
i11
i571
Due
in 2023
i270
i632
i902
Thereafter
i570
i37
i607
Total
time deposits
$
i50,157
$
i10,882
$
i61,039
NOTE
10iFederal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and Restricted Cash
iThe
table below presents federal funds sold or purchased, securities financing agreements (which include securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase) and short-term borrowings. The Corporation elects to account for certain securities financing agreements and short-term borrowings under the fair value option. For more information on the fair value option, see Note 21 – Fair Value Option.
Amount
Rate
Amount
Rate
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
Federal funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell
Average during year
$
i251,328
i1.26
%
$
i222,818
i0.81
%
Maximum
month-end balance during year
i279,350
n/a
i237,064
n/a
Federal
funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase
Average during year
$
i193,681
i1.80
%
$
i199,501
i1.30
%
Maximum
month-end balance during year
i201,089
n/a
i218,017
n/a
Short-term
borrowings
Average during year
i36,021
i2.69
i37,337
i2.48
Maximum
month-end balance during year
i52,480
n/a
i46,202
n/a
n/a
= not applicable
Bank of America 2018 128
Bank of America, N.A. maintains a global program to offer up to a maximum of $i75
billion outstanding at any one time, of bank notes with fixed or floating rates and maturities of at least iseven days from the date of issue. Short-term bank notes outstanding under this program totaled $i12.1
billion and $i14.2 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. These short-term bank notes, along with FHLB advances, U.S.
Treasury tax and loan notes, and term federal funds purchased, are included in short-term borrowings on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
Offsetting of Securities Financing Agreements
The Corporation enters into securities financing agreements to accommodate customers (also referred to as “matched-book transactions”), obtain securities to cover short positions, and to finance inventory positions. Substantially all of the Corporation’s securities financing activities are transacted under legally enforceable master repurchase agreements or legally enforceable master securities lending agreements that give the Corporation,
in the event of default by the counterparty, the right to liquidate securities held and to offset receivables and payables with the same counterparty. The Corporation offsets
securities financing transactions with the same counterparty on the Consolidated Balance Sheet where it has such a legally enforceable master netting agreement and the transactions have the same maturity date.
iiThe
Securities Financing Agreements table presents securities financing agreements included on the Consolidated Balance Sheet in federal funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell, and in federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase at /December 31, 2018 and 2017. Balances are presented on a gross basis, prior to the application of counterparty netting. Gross assets and liabilities are adjusted on an aggregate basis to take into consideration the effects of legally enforceable master netting agreements. For more information on the offsetting of derivatives, see Note
3 – Derivatives.
Securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell (3)
$
i348,472
$
(i135,725
)
$
i212,747
$
(i165,720
)
$
i47,027
Securities
loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase
$
i312,582
$
(i135,725
)
$
i176,857
$
(i146,205
)
$
i30,652
Other
(4)
i22,711
i—
i22,711
(i22,711
)
i—
Total
$
i335,293
$
(i135,725
)
$
i199,568
$
(i168,916
)
$
i30,652
(1)
Includes
activity where uncertainty exists as to the enforceability of certain master netting agreements under bankruptcy laws in some countries or industries.
(2)
Includes securities collateral received or pledged under repurchase or securities lending agreements where there is a legally enforceable master netting agreement. These amounts are not offset on the Consolidated Balance Sheet, but are shown as a reduction to derive a net asset or liability. Securities collateral received or pledged where the legal enforceability of the master netting agreements is uncertain is excluded from the table.
(3)
Excludes
repurchase activity of $i11.5 billion and $i10.2 billion reported in loans and leases on the Consolidated Balance Sheet at December
31, 2018 and 2017.
(4)
Balance is reported in accrued expenses and other liabilities on the Consolidated Balance Sheet and relates to transactions where the Corporation acts as the lender in a securities lending agreement and receives securities that can be pledged as collateral or sold. In these transactions, the Corporation recognizes an asset at fair value, representing the securities received, and a liability, representing the obligation to return those securities.
Repurchase Agreements and Securities
Loaned Transactions Accounted for as Secured Borrowings
iThe following tables present securities sold under agreements to repurchase and securities loaned by remaining contractual term to maturity and class of collateral pledged. Included in “Other” are transactions where the Corporation acts as the lender
in a securities lending agreement and receives
securities that can be pledged as collateral or sold. Certain agreements contain a right to substitute collateral and/or terminate the agreement prior to maturity at the option of the Corporation or the counterparty. Such agreements are included in the table below based on the remaining contractual term to maturity.
Under
repurchase agreements, the Corporation is required to post collateral with a market value equal to or in excess of the principal amount borrowed. For securities loaned transactions, the Corporation receives collateral in the form of cash, letters of credit or other securities. To determine whether the market value of the underlying collateral remains sufficient, collateral is generally valued daily, and the Corporation may be required to deposit additional collateral or may receive or return collateral pledged when appropriate. Repurchase agreements and securities loaned transactions are generally either overnight, continuous (i.e., no stated term) or short-term. The Corporation manages liquidity risks related to these agreements by sourcing
funding from a diverse
group of counterparties, providing a range of securities collateral and pursuing longer durations, when appropriate.
Restricted Cash
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation held restricted cash included within cash and cash equivalents on the Consolidated Balance Sheet of $i22.6
billion and $i18.8 billion, predominantly related to cash held on deposit with the Federal Reserve Bank and non-U.S. central banks to meet reserve requirements and cash segregated in compliance with securities regulations.
Bank
of America 2018 130
NOTE 11iLong-term Debt
Long-term debt consists of borrowings having an original maturity of one year or more. iThe
table below presents the balance of long-term debt at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and the related contractual rates and maturity dates as of December 31, 2018.
Weighted-average
Rate
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
Interest Rates
Maturity Dates
2018
2017
Notes
issued by Bank of America Corporation
Senior
notes:
Fixed
i3.39
%
0.39
- 8.40
%
2019 - 2049
$
i120,548
$
i119,548
Floating
i2.09
0.06
- 7.26
2019 - 2044
i25,574
i21,048
Senior
structured notes (1)
i13,768
i15,460
Subordinated
notes:
Fixed
i4.91
2.94
- 8.57
2019 - 2045
i20,843
i22,004
Floating
i2.16
1.14
- 3.55
2019 - 2026
i1,742
i4,058
Junior
subordinated notes (2):
Fixed
i6.71
6.45
- 8.05
2027 - 2066
i732
i3,282
Floating
i3.54
3.54
2056
i1
i553
Total
notes issued by Bank of America Corporation
i183,208
i185,953
Notes
issued by Bank of America, N.A.
Senior
notes:
Fixed
i—
i4,686
Floating
i2.96
2.90
- 2.96
2020 - 2041
i1,770
i1,033
Subordinated
notes
i6.00
6.00
2036
i1,617
i1,679
Advances
from Federal Home Loan Banks:
Fixed
i5.10
0.01
- 7.72
2019 - 2034
i130
i146
Floating
i2.49
2.24
- 2.80
2019 - 2020
i14,751
i5,000
Securitizations
and other BANA VIEs (3)
i10,326
i8,641
Other
i442
i433
Total
notes issued by Bank of America, N.A.
i29,036
i21,618
Other
debt
Structured liabilities
i16,478
i18,574
Nonbank
VIEs (3)
i618
i1,232
Other
i—
i25
Total
other debt
i17,096
i19,831
Total
long-term debt
$
i229,340
$
i227,402
(1)
Includes
total loss-absorbing capacity compliant debt.
(2)
Includes amounts related to trust preferred securities. For additional information, see Trust Preferred Securities in this Note.
(3)
Represents the total long-term debt included in the liabilities of consolidated VIEs on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
Bank of America Corporation and Bank of America, N.A. maintain various U.S.
and non-U.S. debt programs to offer both senior and subordinated notes. The notes may be denominated in U.S. dollars or foreign currencies. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the amount of foreign currency-denominated debt translated into U.S. dollars included in total long-term debt was $i48.6 billion and $i51.8
billion. Foreign currency contracts may be used to convert certain foreign currency-denominated debt into U.S. dollars.
At December 31, 2018, long-term debt of consolidated VIEs in the table above included debt from credit card and all other VIEs of $i10.3
billion and $i623 million. Long-term debt of VIEs is collateralized by the assets of the VIEs. For additional information, see Note 7 – Securitizations and Other Variable Interest Entities.
The weighted-average effective interest rates for total
long-term debt (excluding senior structured notes), total fixed-rate debt and total floating-rate debt were i3.29 percent, i3.66
percent and i2.26 percent, respectively, at December 31, 2018, and i3.44
percent, i3.87 percent and i1.49
percent, respectively, at December 31, 2017. The Corporation’s ALM activities maintain an overall interest rate risk management strategy that incorporates the use of interest rate contracts to manage fluctuations in earnings that are caused by interest rate volatility. The Corporation’s goal is to manage interest rate sensitivity so that movements in interest rates do not significantly adversely affect earnings and capital. The weighted-average rates are the contractual interest rates on the debt and do not reflect the impacts of derivative transactions.
Debt outstanding of $i3.8
billion at December 31, 2018 was issued by BofA Finance LLC, a 100 percent owned finance subsidiary of Bank of America Corporation, the parent company, and is fully and unconditionally guaranteed by the parent company.
During 2018, the Corporation had total long-term debt maturities and redemptions in the aggregate of $i53.3
billion consisting of $i29.8 billion for Bank of America Corporation, $i11.2
billion for Bank of America, N.A. and $i12.3 billion of other debt. During 2017, the Corporation had total long-term debt maturities and redemptions in the aggregate of $i48.8
billion consisting of $i29.1 billion for Bank of America Corporation, $i13.3
billion for Bank of America, N.A. and $i6.4 billion of other debt.
iThe
following table shows the carrying value for aggregate annual contractual maturities of long-term debt as of December 31, 2018. Included in the table are certain structured notes issued by the Corporation that contain provisions whereby the borrowings are redeemable at the option of the holder (put options) at specified dates prior to maturity. Other structured notes have coupon or repayment terms linked to the performance of debt or equity securities, indices, currencies or commodities, and the maturity may be accelerated based on the value of a referenced index or security. In both cases, the Corporation or a subsidiary may be required to settle the obligation for cash or other securities prior to the contractual maturity date. These borrowings are reflected in the table as maturing at their contractual maturity date.
131Bank
of America 2018
Long-term
Debt by Maturity
(Dollars
in millions)
2019
2020
2021
2022
2023
Thereafter
Total
Bank
of America Corporation
Senior
notes
$
i14,831
$
i10,308
$
i15,883
$
i14,882
$
i22,570
$
i67,648
$
i146,122
Senior
structured notes
i1,337
i875
i482
i1,914
i323
i8,837
i13,768
Subordinated
notes
i1,501
i—
i346
i364
i—
i20,374
i22,585
Junior
subordinated notes
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i733
i733
Total
Bank of America Corporation
i17,669
i11,183
i16,711
i17,160
i22,893
i97,592
i183,208
Bank
of America, N.A.
Senior
notes
i—
i1,750
i—
i—
i—
i20
i1,770
Subordinated
notes
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i1,617
i1,617
Advances
from Federal Home Loan Banks
i11,762
i3,010
i2
i3
i1
i103
i14,881
Securitizations
and other Bank VIEs (1)
i3,200
i3,100
i4,022
i—
i—
i4
i10,326
Other
i224
i83
i—
i2
i133
i—
i442
Total
Bank of America, N.A.
i15,186
i7,943
i4,024
i5
i134
i1,744
i29,036
Other
debt
Structured
liabilities
i5,085
i2,712
i1,112
i558
i830
i6,181
i16,478
Nonbank
VIEs (1)
i35
i—
i—
i—
i23
i560
i618
Total
other debt
i5,120
i2,712
i1,112
i558
i853
i6,741
i17,096
Total
long-term debt
$
i37,975
$
i21,838
$
i21,847
$
i17,723
$
i23,880
$
i106,077
$
i229,340
(1)
Represents the total long-term debt included in the liabilities of consolidated VIEs on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
Trust Preferred Securities
Trust preferred securities (Trust Securities) are primarily issued by trust companies (the Trusts) that are not consolidated. These Trust Securities are mandatorily redeemable preferred security obligations of the Trusts. The sole assets of the Trusts generally are junior subordinated deferrable interest notes of the Corporation or its subsidiaries (the Notes). The Trusts generally are 100 percent owned finance subsidiaries
of the Corporation.
Periodic cash payments and payments upon liquidation or redemption with respect to Trust Securities are guaranteed by the Corporation or its subsidiaries to the extent of funds held by the Trusts (the Preferred Securities Guarantee). The Preferred Securities Guarantee, when taken together with the Corporation’s other obligations including its obligations under the Notes, generally will constitute a full and unconditional guarantee, on a subordinated basis, by the Corporation of payments due on the Trust Securities.
During 2018, the Corporation redeemed Trust Securities of i11
Trusts with a carrying value of $i3.1 billion. At December 31, 2018, the Corporation had ione
remaining floating-rate junior subordinated note held in trust.
NOTE 12iCommitments and Contingencies
In the normal course of business, the Corporation enters into a number of off-balance sheet commitments. These commitments expose the Corporation to varying degrees of credit and market risk and are subject to the same
credit and market risk limitation reviews as those instruments recorded on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
Credit Extension Commitments
The Corporation enters into commitments to extend credit such as loan commitments, SBLCs and commercial letters of credit to meet the financing needs of its customers. The following table includes the notional amount of unfunded legally binding lending commitments net of amounts distributed (i.e., syndicated or participated) to other financial institutions. The distributed amounts were $i10.7
billion and $i11.0 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017. At December 31, 2018, the carrying value of these commitments,
excluding commitments accounted for under the fair value option, was $i813 million, including deferred revenue of $i16
million and a reserve for unfunded lending commitments of $i797 million. At December 31, 2017, the comparable amounts were $i793
million, $i16 million and $i777
million, respectively. The carrying value of these commitments is classified in accrued expenses and other liabilities on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
Legally binding commitments to extend credit generally have specified rates and maturities. Certain of these commitments have adverse change clauses that help to protect the Corporation against deterioration in the borrower’s ability to pay.
iThe table below also includes the notional
amount of commitments of $i3.1 billion and $i4.8
billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017 that are accounted for under the fair value option. However, the following table excludes cumulative net fair value of $i169 millionand $i120
million at December 31, 2018 and 2017 on these commitments, which is classified in accrued expenses and other liabilities. For more information regarding the Corporation’s loan commitments accounted for under the fair value option, see Note 21 – Fair Value Option.
Standby
letters of credit and financial guarantees (1)
i19,976
i11,261
i3,420
i1,144
i35,801
Letters
of credit
i1,291
i117
i129
i87
i1,624
Legally
binding commitments
i113,243
i156,777
i152,880
i53,823
i476,723
Credit
card lines (3)
i362,030
i—
i—
i—
i362,030
Total
credit extension commitments
$
i475,273
$
i156,777
$
i152,880
$
i53,823
$
i838,753
(1)
The notional amounts of SBLCs and financial guarantees classified as investment grade and non-investment grade based on the credit quality of the underlying reference name within the instrument were $i28.3 billion and $i7.1
billion at December 31, 2018, and $i27.3 billion and $i8.1
billion at December 31, 2017. Amounts in the table include consumer SBLCs of $i372 million and $i421
million at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
(2)
At December 31, 2018, included letters of credit of $i422
million related to certain liquidity commitments of VIEs. For additional information, see .
(3)
Includes business card unused lines of credit.
Other Commitments
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation had commitments to purchase loans (e.g., residential mortgage and commercial real estate) of $i329
million and $i344 million, which upon settlement will be included in loans or LHFS, and commitments to purchase commercial loans of $i463
million and $i994 million, which upon settlement will be included in trading account assets.
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation had commitments
to purchase commodities, primarily liquefied natural gas, of $i1.3 billion and $i1.5
billion, which upon settlement will be included in trading account assets.
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation had commitments to enter into resale and forward-dated resale and securities borrowing agreements of $i59.7 billion
and $i56.8 billion, and commitments to enter into forward-dated repurchase and securities lending agreements of $i21.2
billion and $i34.3 billion. These commitments expire primarily within the next i12
months.
At both December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation had a commitment to originate or purchase up to $i3.0 billion, on a rolling 12-month basis, of auto loans and leases from a strategic partner.
This commitment extends through November 2022 and can be terminated with i12 months prior notice.
The Corporation is a party to operating leases for certain of its premises and equipment. Commitments under these leases are approximately $i2.4
billion, $i2.2 billion, $i2.0
billion, $i1.7 billion and $i1.3
billion for 2019 and the years through 2023, respectively, and $i6.2 billion in the aggregate for all years thereafter.
Other Guarantees
Bank-owned Life Insurance Book Value Protection
The Corporation sells products that offer book value
protection to insurance carriers who offer group life insurance policies to corporations, primarily banks. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the notional amount of these guarantees totaled $i9.8 billion and
$i10.4
billion. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation’s maximum exposure related to these guarantees totaled $i1.5 billion and $i1.6
billion, with estimated maturity dates between 2033 and 2039.
Indemnifications
In the ordinary course of business, the Corporation enters into various agreements that contain indemnifications, such as tax indemnifications, whereupon payment may become due if certain external events occur, such as a change in tax law. The indemnification clauses are often standard contractual terms and were entered into in the normal course of business based on an assessment that the risk of loss would be remote. These agreements typically contain an early termination clause that permits the Corporation to exit the agreement upon these events. The maximum potential future payment under indemnification agreements is difficult to assess for several reasons, including the occurrence of an external event, the inability to predict future changes in tax and other laws, the
difficulty in determining how such laws would apply to parties in contracts, the absence of exposure limits contained in standard contract language and the timing of any early termination clauses. Historically, any payments made under these guarantees have been de minimis. The Corporation has assessed the probability of making such payments in the future as remote.
Merchant Services
In accordance with credit and debit card association rules, the Corporation sponsors merchant processing servicers that process credit and debit card transactions on behalf of various merchants. If the merchant processor fails to meet its obligation to reimburse the cardholder for disputed transactions, then the Corporation,
as the sponsor, could be held liable for the disputed amount. In 2018 and 2017, the sponsored entities processed and settled $i874.3 billion and $i812.2
billion of transactions and recorded losses of $i31 million and $i28
million. A significant portion of this activity was processed by a joint venture in which the Corporation holds
133Bank of America 2018
a i49
percent ownership. The carrying value of the Corporation’s investment in the merchant services joint venture was $i2.8 billion and $i2.9
billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017, and is recorded in other assets on the Consolidated Balance Sheet and in All Other.
At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the maximum potential exposure for sponsored transactions totaled $i348.1
billion and $i346.4 billion. However, the Corporation believes that the maximum potential exposure is not representative of the actual potential loss exposure and does not expect to make material payments in connection with these guarantees.
Exchange and Clearing House Member Guarantees
The
Corporation is a member of various securities and derivative exchanges and clearinghouses, both in the U.S. and other countries. As a member, the Corporation may be required to pay a pro-rata share of the losses incurred by some of these organizations as a result of another member default and under other loss scenarios. The Corporation’s potential obligations may be limited to its membership interests in such exchanges and clearinghouses, to the amount (or multiple) of the Corporation’s contribution to the guarantee fund or, in limited instances, to the full pro-rata share of the residual losses after applying the guarantee fund. The Corporation’s maximum potential exposure under these membership agreements is difficult to estimate; however, the Corporation has assessed the probability of making any such payments as remote.
Prime Brokerage and Securities Clearing Services
In connection
with its prime brokerage and clearing businesses, the Corporation performs securities clearance and settlement services with other brokerage firms and clearinghouses on behalf of its clients. Under these arrangements, the Corporation stands ready to meet the obligations of its clients with respect to securities transactions. The Corporation’s obligations in this respect are secured by the assets in the clients’ accounts and the accounts of their customers as well as by any proceeds received from the transactions cleared and settled by the firm on behalf of clients or their customers. The Corporation’s maximum potential exposure under these arrangements is difficult to estimate; however, the potential for the Corporation to incur material losses pursuant to these arrangements is remote.
Other Guarantees
The Corporation has entered into additional guarantee agreements and commitments,
including sold risk participation swaps, liquidity facilities, lease-end obligation agreements, partial credit guarantees on certain leases, real estate joint venture guarantees, divested business commitments and sold put options that require gross settlement. The maximum potential future payment under these agreements was approximately $i5.9 billion at both December 31, 2018
and 2017. The estimated maturity dates of these obligations extend up to 2040. The Corporation has made no material payments under these guarantees. For more information on maximum potential future payments under VIE-related liquidity commitments at December 31, 2018, see Note 7 – Securitizations and Other Variable Interest Entities.
In the normal course of business, the Corporation periodically guarantees the obligations of its affiliates in a variety of transactions including ISDA-related transactions and non-ISDA related transactions such as commodities trading, repurchase agreements, prime brokerage agreements and other transactions.
Payment
Protection Insurance
On June 1, 2017, the Corporation sold its non-U.S. consumer credit card business. Included in the calculation of the gain on sale, the
Corporation recorded an obligation to indemnify the purchaser for substantially all payment protection insurance exposure above reserves assumed by the purchaser.
Representations and Warranties Obligations and Corporate Guarantees
The Corporation securitizes first-lien residential mortgage loans generally in the form of RMBS guaranteed by the GSEs or by GNMA in the case of FHA-insured, VA-guaranteed and Rural Housing Service-guaranteed mortgage loans, and sells pools of first-lien residential mortgage loans in the form of whole loans. In addition,
in prior years, legacy companies and certain subsidiaries sold pools of first-lien residential mortgage loans and home equity loans as private-label securitizations or in the form of whole loans. In connection with these transactions, the Corporation or certain of its subsidiaries or legacy companies make and have made various representations and warranties. Breaches of these representations and warranties have resulted in and may continue to result in the requirement to repurchase mortgage loans or to otherwise make whole or provide indemnification or other remedies to sponsors, investors, securitization trusts, guarantors, insurers or other parties (collectively, repurchases).
Unresolved Repurchase Claims
Unresolved
representations and warranties repurchase claims represent the notional amount of repurchase claims made by counterparties, typically the outstanding principal balance or the unpaid principal balance at the time of default. In the case of first-lien mortgages, the claim amount is often significantly greater than the expected loss amount due to the benefit of collateral and, in some cases, mortgage insurance or mortgage guarantee payments. Claims received from a counterparty remain outstanding until the underlying loan is repurchased, the claim is rescinded by the counterparty, the Corporation determines that the applicable statute of limitations has expired, or representations and warranties claims with respect to the applicable trust are settled, and fully and finally released.
The notional amount of unresolved repurchase claims at December 31, 2018
and 2017 was $i14.4 billion and $i17.6
billion. This balance included $i6.2 billion and $i6.9
billion of claims related to loans in specific private-label securitization groups or tranches where the Corporation owns substantially all of the outstanding securities or will otherwise realize the benefit of any repurchase claims paid. The balance also includes $i1.5 billion of repurchase claims related to a single monoline insurer and is the subject of litigation.
During 2018,
the Corporation received $i283 million in new repurchase claims, including $i201 million in claims
that were deemed time-barred. During 2018, $i3.5 billion in claims were resolved, including $i2.2
billion of claims that were deemed time-barred and $i1.1 billion related to settlements. Although the pace of new claims has declined, it is possible the Corporation will receive additional claims or file requests in the future.
Reserve and Related Provision
The reserve for representations and warranties obligations and corporate guarantees at December
31, 2018 and 2017 was $i2.0 billion and $i1.9
billion and is included in accrued expenses and other liabilities on the Consolidated Balance Sheet and the related provision is included in other income in the Consolidated Statement of Income. The representations and warranties reserve represents the Corporation’s best estimate of probable incurred losses. This reserve considers a number of provisional settlements with sponsors, investors and trustees, some of which
Bank of America 2018 134
are
subject to trustee approval processes, which may include court proceedings. Future representations and warranties losses may occur in excess of the amounts recorded for these exposures; however, the Corporation does not expect such amounts to be material. Future provisions for representations and warranties may be significantly impacted if actual experiences are different from the Corporation’s assumptions in predictive models. The Corporation has combined the range of reasonably possible losses that are in excess of the representations and warranties reserve with the litigation range of possible loss in excess of litigation reserves, as discussed in Litigation and Regulatory Matters in this Note. This is consistent with the reduction in outstanding representations and warranties exposure in comparison to prior periods resulting from the resolution of prior matters along with changes in the Corporation’s business model.
The
reserve for representations and warranties exposures does not consider certain losses related to servicing, including foreclosure and related costs, fraud, indemnity, or claims (including for RMBS) related to securities law or monoline insurance litigation. Losses with respect to one or more of these matters could be material to the Corporation’s results of operations or liquidity for any particular reporting period.
Litigation and Regulatory Matters
In the ordinary course of business, the Corporation and its subsidiaries are routinely defendants in or parties to many pending and threatened legal, regulatory and governmental actions and proceedings. In view of the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of such matters, particularly where the claimants seek very large or indeterminate
damages or where the matters present novel legal theories or involve a large number of parties, the Corporation generally cannot predict the eventual outcome of the pending matters, timing of the ultimate resolution of these matters, or eventual loss, fines or penalties related to each pending matter.
In accordance with applicable accounting guidance, the Corporation establishes an accrued liability when those matters present loss contingencies that are both probable and estimable. In such cases, there may be an exposure to loss in excess of any amounts accrued. As a matter develops, the Corporation, in conjunction with any outside counsel handling the matter, evaluates on an ongoing basis whether such matter presents a loss contingency that is probable and estimable. Once the loss contingency is deemed to be both probable and estimable, the Corporation will establish an accrued liability and record a corresponding amount
of litigation-related expense. The Corporation continues to monitor the matter for further developments that could affect the amount of the accrued liability that has been previously established. Excluding expenses of internal and external legal service providers, litigation-related expense of $i469 million and $i753
million was recognized in 2018 and 2017.
For a limited number of the matters disclosed in this Note for which a loss, whether in excess of a related accrued liability or where there is no accrued liability, is reasonably possible in future periods, the Corporation is able to estimate a range of possible loss. In determining whether it is possible to estimate a range of possible loss, the Corporation reviews and evaluates its matters on an ongoing basis, in conjunction with any outside counsel handling the matter, in light of potentially relevant factual and legal developments. With respect to the matters disclosed in this Note, in cases in which the Corporation possesses sufficient appropriate information to estimate a range of possible loss, that estimate is aggregated and disclosed below. There may
be other disclosed matters for which a loss is probable or reasonably possible but
such an estimate of the range of possible loss may not be possible. For such matters disclosed in this Note, where an estimate of the range of possible loss is possible, as well as for representations and warranties exposures, management currently estimates the aggregate range of reasonably possible loss for these exposures is $i0
to $i1.9 billion in excess of the accrued liability, if any. This estimated range of possible loss is based upon currently available information and is subject to significant judgment and a variety of assumptions and known and unknown uncertainties. The matters underlying the estimated range will change from time to time, and actual results may vary significantly from the current estimate. Therefore, this estimated range of possible loss represents what the Corporation believes to be an estimate
of possible loss only for certain matters meeting these criteria. It does not represent the Corporation’s maximum loss exposure.
Information is provided below regarding the nature of the litigation contingencies and, where specified, the amount of the claim associated with these loss contingencies. Based on current knowledge, management does not believe that loss contingencies arising from pending matters, including the matters described herein, will have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial position or liquidity of the Corporation. However, in light of the inherent uncertainties involved in these matters, some of which are beyond the Corporation’s control, and the very large or indeterminate damages sought in some of these matters, an adverse outcome in one or more of these matters could be material to the Corporation’s results of operations or liquidity for any particular reporting period.
Ambac
Bond Insurance Litigation
Ambac Assurance Corporation and the Segregated Account of Ambac Assurance Corporation (together, Ambac) have filed four separate lawsuits against the Corporation and its subsidiaries relating to bond insurance policies Ambac provided on certain securitized pools of HELOCs, first-lien subprime home equity loans, fixed-rate second-lien mortgage loans and negative amortization pay option adjustable-rate mortgage loans. Ambac alleges that they have paid or will pay claims as a result of defaults in the underlying loans and asserts that the defendants misrepresented the characteristics of the underlying loans and/or breached certain contractual representations and warranties regarding the underwriting and servicing of the loans. In those actions where the Corporation is named as a defendant, Ambac contends the Corporation
is liable on various successor and vicarious liability theories.
Ambac v. Countrywide I
The Corporation, Countrywide and other Countrywide entities are named as defendants in an action filed on September 28, 2010 in New York Supreme Court. Ambac asserts claims for fraudulent inducement as well as breach of contract and seeks damages in excess of $i2.2
billion, plus punitive damages.
On May 16, 2017, the First Department issued its decisions on the parties’ cross-appeals of the trial court’s October 22, 2015 summary judgment rulings. Ambac appealed the First Department’s rulings requiring Ambac to prove all of the elements of its fraudulent inducement claim, including justifiable reliance and loss causation; restricting Ambac’s sole remedy for its breach of contract claims to the repurchase protocol of cure, repurchase or substitution of any materially defective loan; and dismissing Ambac’s claim for reimbursements of attorneys’ fees. On June 27, 2018, the New York Court of Appeals affirmed the First Department
rulings that Ambac appealed.
135Bank of America 2018
Ambac v. Countrywide II
On December
30, 2014, Ambac filed a complaint in New York Supreme Court against the same defendants, claiming fraudulent inducement against Countrywide, and successor and vicarious liability against the Corporation. Ambac seeks damages in excess of $i600 million, plus punitive damages. On December 19, 2016, the Court granted in part and denied in part Countrywide’s motion to dismiss the complaint.
Ambac
v. Countrywide IV
On July 21, 2015, Ambac filed an action in New York Supreme Court against Countrywide asserting the same claims for fraudulent inducement that Ambac asserted in the now-dismissed Ambac v. Countrywide III. The complaint seeks damages in excess of $i350 million, plus punitive damages.
Ambac
v. First Franklin
On April 16, 2012, Ambac filed an action against BANA, First Franklin and various Merrill Lynch entities, including Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated (MLPF&S), in New York Supreme Court relating to guaranty insurance Ambac provided on a First Franklin securitization sponsored by Merrill Lynch. The complaint alleges fraudulent inducement and breach of contract, including breach of contract claims against BANA based upon its servicing of the loans in the securitization. Ambac seeks as damages hundreds of millions of dollars that Ambac alleges it has paid or will pay in claims.
Deposit Insurance Assessment
On
January 9, 2017, the FDIC filed suit against BANA in U.S. District Court for the District of Columbia alleging failure to pay a December 15, 2016 invoice for additional deposit insurance assessments and interest in the amount of $i542 million for the quarters ending June
30, 2013 through December 31, 2014. On April 7, 2017, the FDIC amended its complaint to add a claim for additional deposit insurance and interest in the amount of $i583 million for the quarters ending March 31, 2012 through March
31, 2013. The FDIC asserts these claims based on BANA’s alleged underreporting of counterparty exposures that resulted in underpayment of assessments for those quarters. BANA disagrees with the FDIC’s interpretation of the regulations as they existed during the relevant time period and is defending itself against the FDIC’s claims. Pending final resolution, BANA has pledged security satisfactory to the FDIC related to the disputed additional assessment amounts.
On March 27, 2018, the U.S. District Court for the District of Columbia denied BANA’s partial motion to dismiss certain of the FDIC’s claims.
Interchange and Related Litigation
In 2005, a group of merchants filed a series of putative class actions and individual actions directed at interchange fees associated with Visa and MasterCard
payment card transactions. These actions, which were consolidated in the U.S. District Court for the Eastern District of New York under the caption In re Payment Card Interchange Fee and Merchant Discount Anti-Trust Litigation (Interchange), named Visa, MasterCard and several banks and bank holding companies, including the Corporation, as defendants. Plaintiffs alleged that defendants conspired to fix the level of default interchange rates and that certain rules of Visa and MasterCard were unreasonable restraints of trade. Plaintiffs sought compensatory and treble damages and injunctive relief.
On October 19, 2012, defendants reached a settlement with respect to the putative class actions that the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit rejected. In 2018, defendants reached a
settlement
with the representatives of the putative Rule 23(b)(3) damages class to contribute an additional $i900 million to the approximately $i5.3
billion held in escrow from the prior settlement. The Corporation’s additional contribution is not material to the Corporation. The District Court granted preliminary approval of the settlement with the putative Rule 23(b)(3) damages class in January 2019.
In addition, the putative Rule 23(b)(2) class action seeking injunctive relief is pending, and a number of individual merchant actions continue against the defendants, including one against the Corporation. As a result of various loss-sharing agreements, however, the Corporation remains liable for a portion of any settlement or judgment in individual suits where it is not named as a defendant.
LIBOR, Other Reference Rates, Foreign Exchange (FX) and Bond Trading Matters
Government authorities in the U.S. and various international jurisdictions continue to
conduct investigations, to make inquiries of, and to pursue proceedings against, the Corporation and its subsidiaries regarding FX and other reference rates as well as government, sovereign, supranational and agency bonds in connection with conduct and systems and controls. The Corporation is cooperating with these inquiries and investigations and responding to the proceedings.
Foreign Exchange (FX)
The Corporation, BANA and MLPF&S were named as defendants along with other FX market participants in a putative class action filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York, in which plaintiffs allege that they sustained losses as a result of the defendants’ alleged conspiracy to manipulate the prices of OTC FX transactions and FX transactions on an exchange. Plaintiffs
assert antitrust claims and claims for violations of the Commodity Exchange Act (CEA) and seek compensatory and treble damages, as well as declaratory and injunctive relief. On October 1, 2015, the Corporation, BANA and MLPF&S executed a final settlement agreement, in which they agreed to pay participating class members $i187.5 million to settle the litigation. In 2018,
the District Court granted final approval to the settlement.
LIBOR
The Corporation, BANA and certain Merrill Lynch entities have been named as defendants along with most of the other London InterBank Offered Rate (LIBOR) panel banks in a number of individual and putative class actions by persons alleging they sustained losses on U.S. dollar LIBOR-based financial instruments as a result of collusion or manipulation by defendants regarding the setting of U.S. dollar LIBOR. Plaintiffs assert a variety of claims, including antitrust, CEA, Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organizations (RICO), Securities Exchange Act of 1934, common law fraud and breach of contract claims, and seek compensatory, treble and punitive damages, and injunctive relief. All
cases naming the Corporation and its affiliates relating to U.S. dollar LIBOR are pending in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York.
The District Court has dismissed all RICO claims, and dismissed all manipulation claims based on alleged trader conduct against Bank of America entities. The District Court has also substantially limited the scope of antitrust, CEA and various other claims, including by dismissing in their entirety certain individual and putative class plaintiffs’ antitrust claims for lack of standing and/or personal jurisdiction. Plaintiffs whose antitrust claims were dismissed by the District Court are pursuing appeals in the Second Circuit. Certain individual and putative class actions remain
Bank
of America 2018 136
pending in the District Court against the Corporation, BANA and certain Merrill Lynch entities.
On February 28, 2018, the District Court denied certification of proposed classes of lending institutions and persons that transacted in eurodollar futures, and the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit subsequently denied petitions filed by those plaintiffs for interlocutory appeals of those rulings. Also on February 28, 2018, the District Court granted certification of a class of persons that purchased OTC swaps and notes that referenced U.S. dollar LIBOR from one of the U.S. dollar LIBOR panel banks, limited
to claims under Section 1 of the Sherman Act. The U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit subsequently denied a petition filed by the defendants for interlocutory appeal of that ruling.
Mortgage Appraisal Litigation
The Corporation and certain subsidiaries are named as defendants in itwo
putative class action lawsuits filed in U.S. District Court for the Central District of California (Waldrup and Williams, et al.). In November 2016, the actions were consolidated for pre-trial purposes. Plaintiffs allege that in fulfilling orders made by Countrywide for residential mortgage appraisal services, a former Countrywide subsidiary, LandSafe Appraisal Services, Inc., arranged for and completed appraisals that were not in compliance with applicable laws and appraisal standards. Plaintiffs seek, among other forms of relief, compensatory and treble damages.
On February 8, 2018, the District Court granted plaintiffs’ motion for class certification. On May 22, 2018, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Ninth Circuit denied Defendants’ petition for permission to file an interlocutory
appeal of the District Court’s ruling granting class certification.
Mortgage-backed Securities Litigation
The Corporation and its affiliates, Countrywide entities and their affiliates, and Merrill Lynch entities and their affiliates have been named as defendants in cases relating to their various roles in MBS offerings and, in certain instances, have received claims for contractual indemnification related to the MBS securities actions. Plaintiffs in these cases generally sought unspecified
compensatory and/or rescissory damages, unspecified costs and legal fees and generally alleged false and misleading statements. The indemnification claims include claims from underwriters of MBS that were issued by these entities, and from underwriters and issuers of MBS backed by loans originated by these
entities.
Mortgage Repurchase Litigation
U.S. Bank - Harborview Repurchase Litigation
On August 29, 2011, U.S. Bank, National Association (U.S. Bank), as trustee for the HarborView Mortgage Loan Trust 2005-10 (the Trust), a mortgage pool backed by loans originated by Countrywide Home Loans, Inc. (CHL), filed a complaint in New York Supreme Court against the Corporation and various subsidiaries alleging breaches of representations and warranties. This litigation has been stayed since March 23, 2017, pending finalization of the settlement discussed below.
On December
5, 2016, the defendants and certain certificate-holders in the Trust agreed to settle the litigation in an amount not material to the Corporation, subject to acceptance by U.S. Bank.
U.S. Bank - SURF/OWNIT Repurchase Litigation
On August 29, 2014 and September 2, 2014, U.S. Bank, as trustee for iseven
securitization trusts (the Trusts), served iseven summonses with notice commencing actions against various subsidiaries of the Corporation in New York Supreme Court. The summonses advance breach of contract claims alleging that defendants breached representations
and warranties related to loans securitized in the Trusts. The summonses allege that defendants failed to repurchase breaching mortgage loans from the Trusts, and seek specific performance of defendants’ alleged obligation to repurchase breaching loans, declaratory judgment, compensatory, rescissory and other damages, and indemnity.
U.S. Bank has served complaints regarding isix
of the iseven Trusts. In 2018, for those isix
Trusts, the defendants and certain certificate-holders agreed to settle the respective litigations in amounts not material to the Corporation, subject to acceptance by U.S. Bank.
137Bank of America 2018
NOTE
13iShareholders’ Equity
Common Stock
i
Declared
Quarterly Cash Dividends on Common Stock (1)
The cash dividends paid per share of common stock were $i0.54, $i0.39
and $i0.25 for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
iThe
following table summarizes common stock repurchases during 2018, 2017 and 2016.
Common
Stock Repurchase Summary
(in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Total
share repurchases, including CCAR capital plan repurchases
i676
i509
i333
Purchase
price of shares repurchased and retired (1)
CCAR capital plan repurchases
$
i16,754
$
i9,347
$
i4,312
Other
authorized repurchases
i3,340
i3,467
i800
Total
shares repurchased
$
i20,094
$
i12,814
$
i5,112
(1)
Represents
reductions to shareholders’ equity due to common stock repurchases.
On June 28, 2018, following the non-objection of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve) to the Corporation’s 2018 Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review (CCAR) capital plan, the Board of Directors (Board) authorized the repurchase of approximately $i20.6
billion in common stock from July 1, 2018 through June 30, 2019, which includes approximately $i600 million in repurchases to offset shares awarded under equity-based compensation plans during the same period. The common stock repurchase authorization
includes both common stock and warrants.
During 2018, the Corporation repurchased $i20.1 billion of common stock in connection with the 2018 and 2017 CCAR capital plans and pursuant to a December 5, 2017 authorization to repurchase an additional $i5.0
billion in common stock.
At December 31, 2018, the Corporation had warrants outstanding and exercisable to purchase i121 million shares of common stock. These warrants, substantially all of which were exercised on or before the expiration date of January
16, 2019, were originally issued in connection with a preferred stock issuance to the U.S. Department of the Treasury in 2009 and were listed on the New York Stock Exchange.
On August 24, 2017, the holders of the Corporation’s Series T i6% Non-cumulative preferred stock (Series T) exercised warrants to acquire i700
million shares of the Corporation’s common stock. The carrying value of the preferred stock was $i2.9 billion and, upon conversion, was recorded as additional paid-in capital. For more information, see Note 15 – Earnings Per Common Share.
In connection with employee stock plans, in 2018, the Corporation
issued i75 million shares of its common stock and, to
satisfy tax withholding obligations, repurchased i29
million shares of its common stock.At December 31, 2018, the Corporation had reserved i781 million unissued shares of common stock for future issuances under employee stock plans, common stock warrants, convertible notes and preferred stock.
Preferred Stock
The
cash dividends declared on preferred stock were $i1.5 billion, $i1.6 billion and $i1.7
billion for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
On March 15, 2018, the Corporation issued i94,000 shares of i5.875%
Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series FF for $i2.35 billion. On May 16, 2018, the Corporation issued i54,000
shares of i6.000% Fixed Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series GG for $i1.35
billion. On July 24, 2018, the Corporation issued i34,160 shares of i5.875%
Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series HH for $i854 million.
In 2018, the Corporation fully redeemed Series D, Series I, Series K, Series M and Series 3 preferred stock for a total of $i4.5
billion.
All series of preferred stock in the Preferred Stock Summary table have a par value of $i0.01 per share, are not subject to the operation of a sinking fund, have no participation rights, and with the exception of the Series L Preferred Stock, are not convertible. The holders of the Series B Preferred Stock and Series 1 through 5 Preferred Stock have general voting rights and vote together with the common stock. The holders
of the other series included in the table have no general voting rights. All outstanding series of preferred stock of the Corporation have preference over the Corporation’s common stock with respect to the payment of dividends and distribution of the Corporation’s assets in the event of a liquidation or dissolution. With the exception of the Series B, F, G and T Preferred Stock, if any dividend payable on these series is in arrears for ithree
or more semi-annual or isix or more quarterly dividend periods, as applicable (whether consecutive or not), the holders of these series and any other class or series of preferred stock ranking equally as to payment of dividends and upon which equivalent voting rights have been conferred and are exercisable (voting as a single class) will be
entitled to vote for the election of itwo additional directors. These voting rights terminate when the Corporation has paid in full dividends on these series for at least itwo
semi-annual or ifour quarterly dividend periods, as applicable, following the dividend arrearage.
The i7.25%
Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Preferred Stock, Series L (Series L Preferred Stock) does not have early redemption/call rights. Each share of the Series L Preferred Stock may be converted at any time, at the option of the holder, into i20 shares of the Corporation’s common stock plus cash in lieu of fractional shares. The Corporation may cause some or all of the Series L Preferred Stock, at its option, at any time or
from time to time, to be converted into shares of common stock at the then-applicable conversion rate if, for i20 trading days during any period of i30 consecutive
trading days, the closing price of common stock exceeds i130 percent of the then-applicable conversion price of the Series L Preferred Stock. If a conversion of Series L Preferred Stock occurs at the option of the holder, subsequent to a dividend record date but prior to the dividend payment date, the Corporation will still pay any accrued dividends payable.
The
table on the following page presents a summary of perpetual preferred stock outstanding at December 31, 2018.
The
Corporation may redeem series of preferred stock on or after the redemption date, in whole or in part, at its option, at the liquidation preference plus declared and unpaid dividends. Series B and Series L Preferred Stock do not have early redemption/call rights.
(2)
Ownership is held in the form of depositary shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of preferred stock, paying a quarterly cash dividend, if and when declared.
(3)
Subject to i4.00%
minimum rate per annum.
(4)
Ownership is held in the form of depositary shares, each representing a 1/25th interest in a share of preferred stock, paying a semi-annual cash dividend, if and when declared, until the first redemption date at which time, it adjusts to a quarterly cash dividend, if and when declared, thereafter.
(5)
Ownership is held in the form of depositary shares, each representing a 1/1,200th interest in a share of preferred stock, paying a quarterly cash
dividend, if and when declared.
(6)
Subject to i3.00% minimum rate per annum.
n/a = not
applicable
139Bank of America 2018
NOTE 14iAccumulated
Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)
iThe table below presents the changes in accumulated OCI after-tax for 2016, 2017and2018.
Effective
January 1, 2018, the Corporation adopted the accounting standard on tax effects in accumulated OCI related to the Tax Act. Accordingly, certain tax effects were reclassified from accumulated OCI to retained earnings. For additional information, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles.
(2)
Reflects the Corporation’s adoption of the new hedge accounting standard. For additional information, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles.
iThe
table below presents the net change in fair value recorded in accumulated OCI, net realized gains and losses reclassified into earnings and other changes for each component of OCI pre- and after-tax for 2018, 2017 and 2016.
Changes
in OCI Components Pre- and After-tax
Pretax
Tax
effect
After-
tax
Pretax
Tax
effect
After-
tax
Pretax
Tax
effect
After-
tax
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Debt and equity securities:
Net
increase (decrease) in fair value
$
(i5,189
)
$
i1,329
$
(i3,860
)
$
i240
$
i14
$
i254
$
(i1,694
)
$
i641
$
(i1,053
)
Net
realized (gains) reclassified into earnings (1)
(i123
)
i30
(i93
)
(i304
)
i111
(i193
)
(i471
)
i179
(i292
)
Net
change
(i5,312
)
i1,359
(i3,953
)
(i64
)
i125
i61
(i2,165
)
i820
(i1,345
)
Debit
valuation adjustments:
Net
increase (decrease) in fair value
i952
(i224
)
i728
(i490
)
i171
(i319
)
(i271
)
i104
(i167
)
Net
realized losses reclassified into earnings (1)
i26
(i5
)
i21
i42
(i16
)
i26
i17
(i6
)
i11
Net
change
i978
(i229
)
i749
(i448
)
i155
(i293
)
(i254
)
i98
(i156
)
Derivatives:
Net
(decrease) in fair value
(i232
)
i74
(i158
)
(i50
)
i1
(i49
)
(i299
)
i113
(i186
)
Reclassifications
into earnings:
Net
interest income
i165
(i40
)
i125
i327
(i122
)
i205
i553
(i205
)
i348
Personnel
expense
(i27
)
i7
(i20
)
(i148
)
i56
(i92
)
i32
(i12
)
i20
Net
realized losses reclassified into earnings
i138
(i33
)
i105
i179
(i66
)
i113
i585
(i217
)
i368
Net
change
(i94
)
i41
(i53
)
i129
(i65
)
i64
i286
(i104
)
i182
Employee
benefit plans:
Net
increase (decrease) in fair value
(i703
)
i164
(i539
)
i223
(i55
)
i168
(i921
)
i329
(i592
)
Net
actuarial losses and other reclassified into earnings (2)
i171
(i46
)
i125
i179
(i61
)
i118
i97
(i36
)
i61
Settlements,
curtailments and other
i11
(i2
)
i9
i3
(i1
)
i2
i15
(i8
)
—
i7
Net
change
(i521
)
i116
(i405
)
i405
(i117
)
i288
(i809
)
i285
(i524
)
Foreign
currency:
Net
(decrease) in fair value
(i8
)
(i195
)
(i203
)
(i439
)
i430
(i9
)
i514
(i601
)
(i87
)
Net
realized (gains) losses reclassified into earnings (1)
(i149
)
i98
(i51
)
(i606
)
i701
i95
i—
i—
i—
Net
change
(i157
)
(i97
)
(i254
)
(i1,045
)
i1,131
i86
i514
(i601
)
(i87
)
Total
other comprehensive income (loss)
$
(i5,106
)
$
i1,190
$
(i3,916
)
$
(i1,023
)
$
i1,229
$
i206
$
(i2,428
)
$
i498
$
(i1,930
)
(1)
Reclassifications of pretax debt and equity securities, DVA and foreign currency (gains) losses are recorded in other income in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
(2)
Reclassifications of pretax employee benefit plan costs are recorded in other general operating expense in the Consolidated Statement of Income.
Bank
of America 2018 140
NOTE 15iEarnings Per Common Share
iThe
calculation of EPS and diluted EPS for 2018, 2017 and 2016 is presented below. For more information on the calculation of EPS, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles.
(In
millions, except per share information)
2018
2017
2016
Earnings per common share
Net
income
$
i28,147
$
i18,232
$
i17,822
Preferred
stock dividends
(i1,451
)
(i1,614
)
(i1,682
)
Net
income applicable to common shareholders
$
i26,696
$
i16,618
$
i16,140
Average
common shares issued and outstanding
i10,096.5
i10,195.6
i10,284.1
Earnings
per common share
$
i2.64
$
i1.63
$
i1.57
Diluted
earnings per common share
Net income applicable to common shareholders
$
i26,696
$
i16,618
$
i16,140
Add
preferred stock dividends due to assumed conversions (1)
i—
i186
i300
Net
income allocated to common shareholders
$
i26,696
$
i16,804
$
i16,440
Average
common shares issued and outstanding
i10,096.5
i10,195.6
i10,284.1
Dilutive
potential common shares (2)
i140.4
i582.8
i762.7
Total
diluted average common shares issued and outstanding
i10,236.9
i10,778.4
i11,046.8
Diluted
earnings per common share
$
i2.61
$
i1.56
$
i1.49
(1)
Represents
the Series T dividends under the “if-converted” method prior to conversion.
(2)
Includes incremental dilutive shares from RSUs, restricted stock and warrants.
The Corporation previously issued warrants to purchase i700
million shares of the Corporation’s common stock to the holders of the Series T i6% Non-cumulative preferred stock (Series T) at an exercise price of $i7.142857
per share. On August 24, 2017, the Series T holders exercised the warrants and acquired the i700 million shares of the Corporation’s common stock using the Series T preferred stock as consideration for the exercise price, which increased common shares outstanding, but had no effect on diluted earnings per share as this conversion
was included in the Corporation’s diluted earnings per share calculation under the applicable accounting guidance. For 2016, the average dilutive impact of the i700 million potential common shares was included in the diluted share count under the “if-converted” method.
For 2018,
2017 and 2016, i62 million average dilutive potential common shares associated with the Series L preferred stock were
not included in the diluted share count because the result would have been antidilutive under the “if-converted” method. For 2018, 2017 and 2016, average options to purchase i4 million,
i21 million and i45
million shares of common stock, respectively, were outstanding but not included in the computation of EPS because the result would have been antidilutive under the treasury stock method. For 2017 and 2016, average warrants to purchase i122
million shares of common stock were outstanding but not included in the computation of EPS because the result would have been antidilutive under the treasury stock method. These warrants expired on October 29, 2018. For 2018, 2017 and 2016, average warrants to purchase i136
million, i143 million and i150
million shares of common stock, respectively, were included in the diluted EPS calculation under the treasury stock method. Substantially all of the outstanding warrants were exercised on or before the expiration date of January 16, 2019.
NOTE 16iRegulatory
Requirements andRestrictions
The Federal Reserve, Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (OCC) and FDIC (collectively, U.S. banking regulators) jointly establish regulatory capital adequacy guidelines, including Basel 3, for U.S. banking organizations. As a financial holding company, the Corporation is subject to capital adequacy rules issued by the Federal Reserve. The Corporation’s banking entity affiliates are subject to capital adequacy rules issued by the OCC.
The Corporation and its primary banking entity affiliate, BANA, are Advanced approaches institutions under Basel 3. As Advanced approaches institutions, the Corporation and its banking entity affiliates are required to report regulatory risk-based capital ratios and risk-weighted assets under both the Standardized and Advanced approaches. The approach that yields
the lower ratio is used to assess capital adequacy, including under the Prompt Corrective Action (PCA) framework. At December 31, 2018, Common equity tier 1 and Tier 1 capital ratios were lower under the Standardized approach whereas the Advanced approaches yielded a lower result for the Total capital ratio. All three ratios were lower under the Advanced approaches method at December 31, 2017.
Effective January 1, 2018, the Corporation is required to maintain a minimum supplementary leverage ratio (SLR) of 3.0 percent plus a leverage buffer of 2.0 percent in order to avoid certain restrictions on capital distributions and discretionary bonus payments. The Corporation’s insured depository
institution subsidiaries are required to maintain a minimum 6.0 percent SLR to be considered well capitalized under the PCA framework.
iThe following table presents capital ratios and related information in accordance with Basel 3 Standardized and Advanced approaches as measured at December
31, 2018 and 2017 for the Corporation and BANA.
Adjusted quarterly average assets (in billions) (5)
$
i2,224
$
i2,224
$
i1,672
$
i1,672
Tier
1 leverage ratio
i8.6
%
i8.6
%
i4.0
i9.0
%
i9.0
%
i5.0
(1)
Regulatory
capital metrics at December 31, 2017 reflect Basel 3 transition provisions for regulatory capital adjustments and deductions, which were fully phased-in as of January 1, 2018.
(2)
The December 31, 2018 and 2017 amounts include a transition capital conservation buffer of 1.875 percent and 1.25 percent
and a transition global systemically important bank surcharge of i1.875 percent and i1.5 percent.
The countercyclical capital buffer for both periods is izero.
(3)
Percent required to meet guidelines to be considered “well capitalized” under the PCA framework.
(4)
Total
capital under the Advanced approaches differs from the Standardized approach due to differences in the amount permitted in Tier 2 capital related to the qualifying allowance for credit losses.
(5)
Reflects adjusted average total assets for the three months ended December 31, 2018 and 2017.
The capital adequacy rules issued by the U.S. banking regulators require institutions to meet the established minimums outlined in the table above.
Failure to meet the minimum requirements can lead to certain mandatory and discretionary actions by regulators that could have a material adverse impact on the Corporation’s financial position. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation and its banking entity affiliates were “well capitalized.”
Other Regulatory Matters
The Federal Reserve requires the Corporation’s bank subsidiaries to maintain reserve requirements based on a percentage of certain deposit liabilities. The average daily reserve balance requirements, in excess of vault cash, maintained by the Corporation with the Federal Reserve
Bank were $i11.4 billion and $i8.9
billion for 2018 and 2017. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation had cash and cash equivalents in the amount of $i5.8 billion and $i4.1
billion, and securities with a fair value of $i16.6 billion and $i17.3
billion that were segregated in compliance with securities regulations. Cash held on deposit with the Federal Reserve Bank to meet reserve requirements and cash and cash equivalents segregated in compliance with securities regulations are components of restricted cash. For additional information, see Note 10 – Federal Funds Sold or Purchased, Securities Financing Agreements, Short-term Borrowings and Restricted Cash. In
addition, at December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation had cash deposited with clearing organizations of $i8.1
billion and $i11.9 billion primarily recorded in other assets on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
Bank Subsidiary Distributions
The primary sources of funds for cash distributions by the Corporation to its shareholders are capital distributions received from its bank subsidiaries, BANA and Bank of America
California, N.A. In 2018, the Corporation received dividends of $i26.1 billion from BANA and $i320
million from Bank of America California, N.A. In addition, Bank of America California, N.A. returned capital of $i1.4 billion to the Corporation in 2018.
The amount of dividends that a subsidiary bank may declare in a calendar year without OCC approval is the subsidiary bank’s net profits for that year combined with its retained net profits for the preceding itwo
years. Retained net profits, as defined by the OCC, consist of net income less dividends declared during the period. In 2019, BANA can declare and pay dividends of approximately $i3.1 billion to the Corporation plus an additional amount equal to its
retained net profits for 2019 up to the date of any such dividend declaration. Bank of America California, N.A. can pay dividends of $i40 million in 2019 plus an additional amount equal to its retained net profits for 2019
up to the date of any such dividend declaration.
Bank of America 2018 142
NOTE 17iEmployee
Benefit Plans
Pension and Postretirement Plans
The Corporation sponsors a qualified noncontributory trusteed pension plan (Qualified Pension Plan), a number of noncontributory nonqualified pension plans, and postretirement health and life plans that cover eligible employees. Non-U.S. pension plans sponsored by the Corporation vary based on the country and local practices.
The Qualified Pension Plan has a balance guarantee feature for account balances with participant-selected investments, applied at the time a benefit payment is made from the plan that effectively provides principal protection for participant balances transferred and certain compensation credits. The Corporation is responsible for funding any shortfall on the guarantee feature.
Benefits earned under the Qualified Pension
Plan have been frozen. Thereafter, the cash balance accounts continue to earn investment credits or interest credits in accordance with the terms of the plan document.
The Corporation has an annuity contract that guarantees the payment of benefits vested under a terminated U.S. pension plan (Other Pension Plan). The Corporation, under a supplemental agreement, may be responsible for, or benefit from actual experience and investment performance of the annuity assets. The Corporation made ino
contribution under this agreement in 2018 or 2017. Contributions may be required in the future under this agreement.
The Corporation’s noncontributory, nonqualified pension plans are unfunded and provide supplemental defined pension benefits to certain eligible employees.
In addition to retirement pension benefits, certain benefits-eligible employees may become eligible to continue participation as retirees in health care and/or life insurance plans sponsored by the Corporation. These plans are referred to as the Postretirement Health and Life Plans. During 2017, the Corporation established and funded a Voluntary Employees’ Beneficiary Association trust in the amount of $i300
million for the Postretirement Health and Life Plans.
iiThe
Pension and Postretirement Plans table summarizes the changes in the fair value of plan assets, changes in the projected benefit obligation (PBO), the funded status of both the accumulated benefit obligation (ABO) and the PBO, and the weighted-average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations for the pension plans and postretirement plans at /December 31, 2018 and 2017. The estimate of the Corporation’s PBO associated with these plans considers various actuarial assumptions, including assumptions for mortality rates and discount rates. The discount rate assumptions are derived from a cash flow matching technique
that utilizes rates that are based on Aa-rated corporate bonds with cash flows that match estimated benefit payments of each of the plans. The increases in the weighted-average discount rates in 2018 resulted in decreases to the PBO of approximately $i1.3 billion at December 31, 2018. The
decreases in the weighted-average discount rates in 2017 resulted in increases to the PBO of approximately $i1.1 billion at December 31, 2017. Significant gains and losses related to changes in the PBO for 2018 and 2017 primarily resulted from changes in the discount
rate.
Pension
and Postretirement Plans (1)
Qualified
Pension
Plan
Non-U.S.
Pension Plans
Nonqualified and Other
Pension Plans
Postretirement
Health and Life Plans
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
Fair
value, January 1
$
i19,708
$
i18,239
$
i2,943
$
i2,789
$
i2,724
$
i2,744
$
i300
$
i—
Actual
return on plan assets
(i550
)
i2,285
(i181
)
i118
i8
i128
i5
i—
Company
contributions
i—
i—
i22
i23
i91
i98
i43
i393
Plan
participant contributions
i—
i—
i1
i1
i—
i—
i115
i125
Settlements
and curtailments
i—
i—
(i107
)
(i190
)
i—
i—
i—
i—
Benefits
paid
(i980
)
(i816
)
(i52
)
(i54
)
(i239
)
(i246
)
(i214
)
(i230
)
Federal
subsidy on benefits paid
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
i3
i12
Foreign
currency exchange rate changes
n/a
n/a
(i165
)
i256
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
Fair
value, December 31
$
i18,178
$
i19,708
$
i2,461
$
i2,943
$
i2,584
$
i2,724
$
i252
$
i300
Change
in projected benefit obligation
Projected
benefit obligation, January 1
$
i15,706
$
i14,982
$
i2,814
$
i2,763
$
i3,047
$
i3,047
$
i1,056
$
i1,125
Service
cost
i—
i—
i19
i24
i1
i1
i6
i6
Interest
cost
i563
i606
i65
i72
i105
i117
i36
i43
Plan
participant contributions
i—
i—
i1
i1
i—
i—
i115
i125
Plan
amendments
i—
i—
i13
i—
i—
i—
i—
(i19
)
Settlements
and curtailments
i—
i—
(i107
)
(i200
)
i—
i—
i—
i—
Actuarial
loss (gain)
(i1,145
)
i934
(i29
)
(i26
)
(i135
)
i128
(i73
)
(i7
)
Benefits
paid
(i980
)
(i816
)
(i52
)
(i54
)
(i239
)
(i246
)
(i214
)
(i230
)
Federal
subsidy on benefits paid
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
n/a
i3
i12
Foreign
currency exchange rate changes
n/a
n/a
(i135
)
i234
n/a
n/a
(i1
)
i1
Projected
benefit obligation, December 31
$
i14,144
$
i15,706
$
i2,589
$
i2,814
$
i2,779
$
i3,047
$
i928
$
i1,056
Amounts
recognized on Consolidated Balance Sheet
Other
assets
$
i4,034
$
i4,002
$
i316
$
i610
$
i754
$
i730
$
i—
$
i—
Accrued
expenses and other liabilities
i—
i—
(i444
)
(i481
)
(i949
)
(i1,053
)
(i676
)
(i756
)
Net
amount recognized, December 31
$
i4,034
$
i4,002
$
(i128
)
$
i129
$
(i195
)
$
(i323
)
$
(i676
)
$
(i756
)
Funded
status, December 31
Accumulated
benefit obligation
$
i14,144
$
i15,706
$
i2,542
$
i2,731
$
i2,778
$
i3,046
n/a
n/a
Overfunded
(unfunded) status of ABO
i4,034
i4,002
(i81
)
i212
(i194
)
(i322
)
n/a
n/a
Provision
for future salaries
i—
i—
i47
i83
i1
i1
n/a
n/a
Projected
benefit obligation
i14,144
i15,706
i2,589
i2,814
i2,779
i3,047
$
i928
$
i1,056
Weighted-average
assumptions, December 31
Discount
rate
i4.32
%
i3.68
%
i2.60
%
i2.39
%
i4.26
%
i3.58
%
i4.25
%
i3.58
%
Rate
of compensation increase
n/a
n/a
i4.49
i4.31
i4.00
i4.00
n/a
n/a
Interest-crediting
rate
i5.18
i5.08
i1.47
i1.49
i4.50
i4.53
n/a
n/a
(1)
The
measurement date for the Qualified Pension Plan, Non-U.S. Pension Plans, Nonqualified and Other Pension Plans, and Postretirement Health and Life Plans was December 31 of each year reported.
n/a = not applicable
143Bank of America 2018
The
Corporation’s estimate of its contributions to be made to the Non-U.S. Pension Plans, Nonqualified and Other Pension Plans, and Postretirement Health and Life Plans in 2019 is $i21 million, $i91
million and $i15 million, respectively. The Corporation does not expect to make a contribution to the Qualified Pension Plan in 2019. It is the policy of the Corporation to fund no less than the
minimum
funding amount required by the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (ERISA).
iiPension
Plans with ABO and PBO in excess of plan assets as of /December 31, 2018 and 2017 are presented in the table below. For these plans, funding strategies vary due to legal requirements and local practices.
Plans
with ABO and PBO in Excess of Plan Assets
Non-U.S.
Pension
Plans
Nonqualified
and Other
Pension Plans
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
PBO
$
i615
$
i671
$
i950
$
i1,054
ABO
i605
i644
i949
i1,053
Fair
value of plan assets
i173
i191
i1
i1
i
Components
of Net Periodic Benefit Cost
Qualified
Pension Plan
Non-U.S. Pension Plans
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Components
of net periodic benefit cost (income)
Service cost
$
i—
$
i—
$
i—
$
i19
$
i24
$
i25
Interest
cost
i563
i606
i634
i65
i72
i86
Expected
return on plan assets
(i1,136
)
(i1,068
)
(i1,038
)
(i126
)
(i136
)
(i123
)
Amortization
of net actuarial loss
i147
i154
i139
i10
i8
i6
Other
i—
i—
i—
i12
(i7
)
i2
Net
periodic benefit cost (income)
$
(i426
)
$
(i308
)
$
(i265
)
$
(i20
)
$
(i39
)
$
(i4
)
Weighted-average
assumptions used to determine net cost for years ended December 31
Discount
rate
i3.68
%
i4.16
%
i4.51
%
i2.39
%
i2.56
%
i3.59
%
Expected
return on plan assets
i6.00
i6.00
i6.00
i4.37
i4.73
i4.84
Rate
of compensation increase
n/a
n/a
n/a
i4.31
i4.51
i4.67
Nonqualified
and Other Pension Plans
Postretirement Health and Life Plans
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Components
of net periodic benefit cost (income)
Service cost
$
i1
$
i1
$
i—
$
i6
$
i6
$
i7
Interest
cost
i105
i117
i127
i36
i43
i47
Expected
return on plan assets
(i84
)
(i95
)
(i101
)
(i6
)
i—
i—
Amortization
of net actuarial loss (gain)
i43
i34
i25
(i27
)
(i21
)
(i81
)
Other
i—
i—
i3
(i3
)
i4
i4
Net
periodic benefit cost (income)
$
i65
$
i57
$
i54
$
i6
$
i32
$
(i23
)
Weighted-average
assumptions used to determine net cost for years ended December 31
Discount
rate
i3.58
%
i4.01
%
i4.34
%
i3.58
%
i3.99
%
i4.32
%
Expected
return on plan assets
i3.19
i3.50
i3.66
i2.00
n/a
n/a
Rate
of compensation increase
i4.00
i4.00
i4.00
n/a
n/a
n/a
/
n/a
= not applicable
The asset valuation method used to calculate the expected return on plan assets component of net periodic benefit cost for the Qualified Pension Plan recognizes i60
percent of the prior year’s market gains or losses at the next measurement date with the remaining i40 percent spread equally over the subsequent four years.
Gains
and losses for all benefit plans except postretirement health care are recognized in accordance with the standard amortization provisions of the applicable accounting guidance. Net periodic postretirement health and life expense was determined using the “projected unit credit” actuarial method. For the Postretirement Health and Life Plans, i50
percent of the unrecognized gain or loss at the beginning of the fiscal year (or at
subsequent remeasurement) is recognized on a level basis during the year.
Assumed health care cost trend rates affect the postretirement benefit obligation and benefit cost reported for the Postretirement Health and Life Plans. The assumed health care cost trend rate used to measure the expected cost of benefits covered by the Postretirement Health and Life Plans is i6.50
percent for 2019, reducing in steps to i5.00 percent in 2023 and later years.
The Corporation’s net periodic benefit cost (income) recognized for the plans is sensitive to the discount rate and expected return on plan
assets. For the Qualified Pension Plan, Non-U.S. Pension Plans, Nonqualified and Other Pension Plans, and Postretirement Health and Life Plans, a 25 bp decline in discount rates and expected return on assets would not have a significant impact on the net periodic benefit cost for 2018.
Bank of America 2018 144
i
Pretax
Amounts included in Accumulated OCI
Qualified
Pension
Plan
Non-U.S.
Pension Plans
Nonqualified
and Other
Pension Plans
Postretirement
Health and
Life Plans
Total
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
Net
actuarial loss (gain)
$
i4,386
$
i3,992
$
i454
$
i196
$
i912
$
i1,014
$
(i75
)
$
(i30
)
$
i5,677
$
i5,172
Prior
service cost (credits)
i—
i—
i18
i4
i—
i—
(i9
)
(i11
)
i9
(i7
)
Amounts
recognized in accumulated OCI
$
i4,386
$
i3,992
$
i472
$
i200
$
i912
$
i1,014
$
(i84
)
$
(i41
)
$
i5,686
$
i5,165
/
i
Pretax
Amounts Recognized in OCI
Qualified
Pension
Plan
Non-U.S.
Pension Plans
Nonqualified and Other
Pension Plans
Postretirement Health and
Life Plans
Total
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
2018
2017
Current
year actuarial loss (gain)
$
i541
$
(i283
)
$
i270
$
(i12
)
$
(i59
)
$
i95
$
(i73
)
$
(i7
)
$
i679
$
(i207
)
Amortization
of actuarial gain (loss) and
prior service cost
(i147
)
(i154
)
(i11
)
(i8
)
(i43
)
(i34
)
i30
i21
(i171
)
(i175
)
Current
year prior service cost (credit)
i—
i—
i13
i—
i—
i—
i—
(i23
)
i13
(i23
)
Amounts
recognized in OCI
$
i394
$
(i437
)
$
i272
$
(i20
)
$
(i102
)
$
i61
$
(i43
)
$
(i9
)
$
i521
$
(i405
)
/
Plan
Assets
The Qualified Pension Plan has been established as a retirement vehicle for participants, and trusts have been established to secure benefits promised under the Qualified Pension Plan. The Corporation’s policy is to invest the trust assets in a prudent manner for the exclusive purpose of providing benefits to participants and defraying reasonable expenses of administration. The Corporation’s investment strategy is designed to provide a total return that, over the long term, increases the ratio of assets to liabilities. The strategy attempts to maximize the investment return on assets at a level of risk deemed appropriate by the Corporation while complying with ERISA and any applicable regulations and laws. The investment strategy utilizes asset allocation as a principal determinant for establishing the risk/return profile of the assets. Asset allocation ranges are established, periodically reviewed and adjusted as funding
levels and liability characteristics change. Active and passive investment managers are employed to help enhance the risk/return profile of the assets. An additional aspect of the investment strategy used to minimize risk (part of the asset allocation plan) includes matching the exposure of participant-selected investment measures.
The assets of the Non-U.S. Pension Plans are primarily attributable to a U.K. pension plan. This U.K. pension plan’s assets are invested prudently so that the benefits promised to members are provided with consideration given to the nature and the duration
of the plan’s liabilities. The selected asset allocation strategy is designed to achieve a higher return than the lowest risk strategy.
The expected rate of return on plan assets assumption was developed through
analysis of historical market returns, historical asset class volatility and correlations, current market conditions, anticipated future asset allocations, the funds’ past experience, and expectations on potential future market returns. The expected return on plan assets assumption is determined using the calculated market-related value for the Qualified Pension Plan and the Other Pension Plan and the fair value for the Non-U.S. Pension Plans and Postretirement Health and Life Plans. The expected return on plan assets assumption represents a long-term average view of the performance of the assets in the Qualified Pension Plan, the Non-U.S. Pension Plans, the Other Pension Plan, and Postretirement Health and Life Plans, a return that may or may not be achieved during any one calendar year. The Other Pension Plan is invested solely in an annuity contract which is primarily invested
in fixed-income securities structured such that asset maturities match the duration of the plan’s obligations.
iThe target allocations for 2019 by asset category for the Qualified Pension Plan, Non-U.S. Pension Plans, and Nonqualified and Other Pension Plans are presented in the following table. Equity securities for the Qualified Pension Plan include common stock of the Corporation in the amounts of $i221
million (i1.22 percent of total plan assets) and $i261
million (i1.33 percent of total plan assets) at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
2019
Target Allocation
Percentage
Asset Category
Qualified
Pension Plan
Non-U.S.
Pension Plans
Nonqualified
and Other
Pension
Plans
Equity securities
20-50
5-35
0-5
Debt securities
45-75
40-80
95-100
Real estate
0-10
0-15
0-5
Other
0-5
5-30
0-5
145Bank
of America 2018
Fair Value Measurements
For more information on fair value measurements, including descriptions of Level 1, 2 and 3 of the fair value hierarchy and the valuation methods employed by the Corporation, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles and Note 20 – Fair Value Measurements. iCombined
plan investment assets measured at fair value by level and in total at December 31, 2018 and 2017 are summarized in the Fair Value Measurements table.
Other
investments include commodity and balanced funds of $i305 million and $i451
million, insurance annuity contracts of $i562 million and $i50
million and other various investments of $i178 million and $i323
million at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Bank of America 2018 146
The Level 3 Fair Value Measurements table presents a reconciliation of all plan investment assets measured at fair value using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3)
during 2018, 2017 and 2016.
Level 3
Fair Value Measurements
Balance
January 1
Actual
Return on Plan Assets Still Held at the
Reporting Date
Purchases, Sales and Settlements
Balance
December 31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
Fixed income
U.S.
government and agency securities
$
i9
$
i—
$
i—
$
i9
Real
estate
Private real estate
i93
(i7
)
(i81
)
i5
Real
estate commingled/mutual funds
i831
i52
i2
i885
Limited
partnerships
i85
(i12
)
i9
i82
Other
investments
i74
i—
i514
i588
Total
$
i1,092
$
i33
$
i444
$
i1,569
2017
Fixed
income
U.S. government and agency securities
$
i10
$
i—
$
(i1
)
$
i9
Real
estate
Private real estate
i150
i8
(i65
)
i93
Real
estate commingled/mutual funds
i748
i63
i20
i831
Limited
partnerships
i38
i14
i33
i85
Other
investments
i83
i5
(i14
)
i74
Total
$
i1,029
$
i90
$
(i27
)
$
i1,092
2016
Fixed
income
U.S. government and agency securities
$
i11
$
i—
$
(i1
)
$
i10
Real
estate
Private real estate
i144
i1
i5
i150
Real
estate commingled/mutual funds
i731
i21
(i4
)
i748
Limited
partnerships
i49
(i2
)
(i9
)
i38
Other
investments
i102
i4
(i23
)
i83
Total
$
i1,037
$
i24
$
(i32
)
$
i1,029
Projected
Benefit Payments
iBenefit payments projected to be made from the Qualified Pension Plan, Non-U.S. Pension Plans, Nonqualified and Other Pension Plans, and Postretirement Health and Life Plans are presented in the table below.
Projected
Benefit Payments
(Dollars in millions)
Qualified
Pension Plan (1)
Non-U.S.
Pension
Plans (2)
Nonqualified
and Other
Pension Plans (2)
Postretirement Health and Life Plans (3)
2019
$
i905
$
i98
$
i241
$
i85
2020
i932
i103
i244
i82
2021
i920
i110
i239
i79
2022
i925
i119
i234
i77
2023
i915
i125
i228
i74
2024
- 2028
i4,451
i671
i1,046
i323
(1)
Benefit
payments expected to be made from the plan’s assets.
(2)
Benefit payments expected to be made from a combination of the plans’ and the Corporation’s assets.
(3)
Benefit payments (net of retiree contributions) expected to be made from a combination of the plans’ and the Corporation’s assets.
Defined Contribution Plans
The Corporation
maintains qualified and non-qualified defined contribution retirement plans. The Corporation recorded expense of $i1.0 billion in each of 2018, 2017, and 2016 related to the qualified defined contribution plans. At December 31, 2018 and 2017,
i212 million and i218
million shares of the Corporation’s
common stock were held by these plans. Payments to the plans for dividends on common stock were $i115 million, $i86
million and $i60 million in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
Certain non-U.S. employees are covered under defined contribution pension plans that are separately administered in accordance with local laws.
147Bank
of America 2018
NOTE 18iStock-based
Compensation Plans
The Corporation administers a number of equity compensation plans, with awards being granted predominantly from the Bank of America Key Employee Equity Plan (KEEP). Under this plan, i450 million shares of the Corporation’s common stock are authorized to be used for grants of awards.
During
2018 and 2017, the Corporation granted i71 million and i85
million RSU awards to certain employees under the KEEP. The RSUs were authorized to settle predominantly in shares of common stock of the Corporation. Certain RSUs will be settled in cash or contain settlement provisions that subject these awards to variable accounting whereby compensation expense is adjusted to fair value based on changes in the share price of the Corporation’s common stock up to the settlement date. Of the RSUs granted in 2018 and 2017, i63
million and i85 million will vest in one-third increments on each of the first three anniversaries of the grant date provided that the employee remains
continuously employed with the Corporation during that time, and will be expensed ratably over the vesting period, net of estimated forfeitures, for non-retirement eligible employees based on the grant-date fair value of the shares. Additionally, eight million of the RSUs granted in 2018 will vest in one-fourth increments on each of the first four anniversaries of the grant date provided that the employee remains continuously employed with the Corporation during that time, and will be expensed ratably over the vesting period, net of estimated forfeitures, based on the grant-date fair value of the shares. Awards granted in years prior to 2016 were predominantly cash settled.
Effective October 1, 2017, the Corporation changed its accounting
method for determining when stock-based compensation awards granted to retirement-eligible employees are deemed authorized, changing from the grant date to the beginning of the year preceding the grant date when the incentive award plans are generally approved. As a result, the estimated value of the awards is expensed ratably over the year preceding the grant date. The compensation cost for all periods prior to this change presented herein has been restated.
The compensation cost for the stock-based plans was $i1.8
billion, $i2.2 billion and $i2.2 billion
and the related income tax benefit was $i433 million, $i829
million and $i835 million for 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
Restricted Stock/Units
iThe
table below presents the status at December 31, 2018 of the share-settled restricted stock/units and changes during 2018.
At
December 31, 2018, there was an estimated $i1.1 billion of total unrecognized compensation cost related to certain share-based compensation awards that is expected
to be recognized over a period of up to ifour years, with a weighted-average period of i1.9
years. The total fair value of restricted stock vested in 2018, 2017 and 2016 was $i2.3 billion, $i1.3
billion and $i358 million, respectively. In 2018, 2017 and 2016, the amount of cash paid
to settle equity-based awards for all equity compensation plans was $i1.3 billion, $i1.9
billion and $i1.7 billion, respectively.
Stock Options
Of the i16.6
million stock options with a weighted-average exercise price of $i43.44 outstanding at January 1, 2018, i2.1
million and i14.5 million were exercised and forfeited during 2018 at weighted-average exercise prices of $i30.71
and $i45.29. There were ino
outstanding stock options at December 31, 2018.
NOTE 19iIncome Taxes
iThe
components of income tax expense for 2018, 2017 and 2016 are presented in the table below.
Income
Tax Expense
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Current
income tax expense
U.S. federal
$
i816
$
i1,310
$
i302
U.S.
state and local
i1,377
i557
i120
Non-U.S.
i1,203
i939
i984
Total
current expense
i3,396
i2,806
i1,406
Deferred
income tax expense
U.S. federal
i2,579
i7,238
i5,416
U.S.
state and local
i240
i835
(i279
)
Non-U.S.
i222
i102
i656
Total
deferred expense
i3,041
i8,175
i5,793
Total
income tax expense
$
i6,437
$
i10,981
$
i7,199
Bank
of America 2018 148
Total income tax expense does not reflect the tax effects of items that are included in OCI each period. For more information, see Note 14 – Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss). Other tax effects included in OCI each period resulted in a benefit of $i1.2
billion, $i1.2 billion and $i498
million in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. In addition, prior to 2017, total income tax expense did not reflect tax effects associated with the Corporation’s employee stock plans which decreased common stock and additional paid-in capital $i41 million
in 2016.
Income tax expense for 2018, 2017 and 2016 varied from the amount computed by applying the statutory income tax rate to income before income taxes. The Corporation’s federal statutory tax rate was i21 percent
for 2018 and i35 percent for 2017 and 2016. iA
reconciliation of the expected U.S. federal income tax expense, calculated by applying the federal statutory tax rate, to the Corporation’s actual income tax expense, and the effective tax rates for 2018, 2017 and 2016 are presented in the table below.
On December 22, 2017, the President signed into law the Tax Act which made significant changes to federal income tax law including, among other things, reducing the statutory corporate income tax rate to 21 percent from 35 percent and changing the taxation of the Corporation’s non-U.S. business activities. The impact on net income in 2017
was $i2.9 billion, driven by $i2.3
billion in income tax expense, largely from a lower valuation of certain U.S. deferred tax assets and liabilities. The change in the statutory tax rate also impacted the Corporation’s tax-advantaged energy investments, resulting in a downward valuation adjustment of $i946 million recorded in other income and a related income tax benefit of $i347
million, which when netted against the $i2.3 billion, resulted in a net impact on income tax expense of $i1.9
billion. The Corporation has completed its analysis and accounting under Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 118 for the effects of the Tax Act.
Reconciliation
of Income Tax Expense
Amount
Percent
Amount
Percent
Amount
Percent
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Expected U.S. federal income tax expense
$
i7,263
i21.0
%
$
i10,225
i35.0
%
$
i8,757
i35.0
%
Increase
(decrease) in taxes resulting from:
State tax expense, net of federal benefit
i1,367
i4.0
i881
i3.0
i420
i1.7
Affordable
housing/energy/other credits
(i1,888
)
(i5.5
)
(i1,406
)
(i4.8
)
(i1,203
)
(i4.8
)
Tax-exempt
income, including dividends
(i413
)
(i1.2
)
(i672
)
(i2.3
)
(i562
)
(i2.2
)
Share-based
compensation
(i257
)
(i0.7
)
(i236
)
(i0.8
)
i—
i—
Nondeductible
expenses
i302
i0.9
i97
i0.3
i180
i0.7
Changes
in prior-period UTBs, including interest
i144
i0.4
i133
i0.5
(i328
)
(i1.3
)
Rate
differential on non-US earnings
i98
i0.3
(i272
)
(i0.9
)
(i307
)
(i1.2
)
Tax
law changes (1)
i—
i—
i2,281
i7.8
i348
i1.4
Other
(i179
)
(i0.6
)
(i50
)
(i0.2
)
(i106
)
(i0.5
)
Total
income tax expense
$
i6,437
i18.6
%
$
i10,981
i37.6
%
$
i7,199
i28.8
%
i(1)
Amounts
for 2016 are for non-U.S. tax law changes.
The reconciliation of the beginning unrecognized tax benefits (UTB) balance to the ending balance is presented in the following table.
Reconciliation
of the Change in Unrecognized Tax Benefits
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Balance,
January 1
$
i1,773
$
i875
$
i1,095
Increases
related to positions taken during the current year
i395
i292
i104
Increases
related to positions taken during prior years
i406
i750
i1,318
Decreases
related to positions taken during prior years
(i371
)
(i122
)
(i1,091
)
Settlements
(i6
)
(i17
)
(i503
)
Expiration
of statute of limitations
i—
(i5
)
(i48
)
Balance,
December 31
$
i2,197
$
i1,773
$
i875
At
December 31, 2018, 2017 and 2016, the balance of the Corporation’s UTBs which would, if recognized, affect the Corporation’s effective tax rate was $i1.6 billion, $i1.2
billion and $i0.6 billion, respectively. Included in the UTB balance are some items the recognition of which would not affect the effective tax rate, such as the tax effect of certain temporary differences, the portion of gross state UTBs that would be offset by the tax benefit of the associated federal deduction and the portion of gross non-U.S. UTBs that would be offset by tax reductions in other jurisdictions.
The
Corporation files income tax returns in more than i100 state and non-U.S. jurisdictions each year. The IRS and other tax authorities in countries and states in which the Corporation has significant business operations examine tax returns periodically (continuously in some jurisdictions). The following table
summarizes the status of examinations by major jurisdiction for the Corporation and various subsidiaries
at December 31, 2018.
i
Tax
Examination Status
Years under
Examination (1)
Status at December 31 2018
United States
2012
– 2013
IRS Appeals
United States
2014 – 2016
Field examination
New York
2015
Field examination
United Kingdom
2017
To
begin in 2019
(1)
All tax years subsequent to the years shown remain subject to examination.
It is reasonably possible that the UTB balance may decrease by as much as $i1.2 billion
during the next 12 months, since
149Bank of America 2018
resolved items will be removed from the balance whether their resolution results in payment or recognition.
The
Corporation recognized interest expense of $i43 million, $i1
million and $i56 million in 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively. At December 31, 2018 and 2017, the Corporation’s accrual for interest and penalties that related to income taxes, net
of taxes and remittances, was $i218 million and $i185 million.
iSignificant
components of the Corporation’s net deferred tax assets and liabilities at December 31, 2018 and 2017 are presented in the following table.
Deferred Tax Assets and Liabilities
December 31
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
Deferred tax assets
Net operating loss carryforwards
$
i7,993
$
i8,506
Allowance
for credit losses
i2,400
i2,598
Accrued
expenses
i1,875
i2,021
Available-for-sale
securities
i1,854
i510
Security,
loan and debt valuations
i1,818
i2,939
Employee
compensation and retirement benefits
i1,564
i1,705
Credit
carryforwards
i623
i1,793
Other
i1,037
i1,034
Gross
deferred tax assets
i19,164
i21,106
Valuation
allowance
(i1,569
)
(i1,644
)
Total
deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance
i17,595
i19,462
Deferred
tax liabilities
Equipment lease financing
i2,684
i2,492
Fixed
assets
i1,104
i840
Tax
credit investments
i940
i734
Other
i2,126
i2,771
Gross
deferred tax liabilities
i6,854
i6,837
Net
deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance
$
i10,741
$
i12,625
iiThe
table below summarizes the deferred tax assets and related valuation allowances recognized for the net operating loss (NOL) and tax credit carryforwards at /December 31, 2018.
Net
Operating Loss and Tax Credit Carryforward Deferred Tax Assets
(Dollars in millions)
Deferred
Tax Asset
Valuation
Allowance
Net Deferred
Tax
Asset
First Year
Expiring
Net operating losses - U.S.
$
i592
$
i—
$
i592
After
2027
Net operating losses - U.K. (1)
i5,294
i—
i5,294
None
Net
operating losses - other non-U.S.
i633
(i517
)
i116
Various
Net
operating losses - U.S. states (2)
i1,474
(i517
)
i957
Various
General
business credits
i612
i—
i612
After
2038
Foreign tax credits
i11
(i11
)
i—
n/a
(1)
Represents
U.K. broker-dealer net operating losses that may be carried forward indefinitely.
(2)
The net operating losses and related valuation allowances for U.S. states before considering the benefit of federal deductions were $i1.9 billion
and $i654 million.
n/a = not applicable
Management concluded that no valuation allowance was necessary to reduce the deferred tax assets related to the U.K. NOL carryforwards and U.S. NOL and general business credit carryforwards since estimated future taxable income will be sufficient to utilize these assets prior to their expiration. The majority of the
Corporation’s U.K. net deferred tax assets, which
consist primarily of NOLs, are expected to be realized by certain subsidiaries over an extended number of years. Management’s conclusion is supported by financial results, profit forecasts for the relevant entities and the indefinite period to carry forward NOLs. However, a material change in those estimates could lead management to reassess such valuation allowance conclusions.
At December 31, 2018, U.S. federal income taxes had not been provided on approximately $i5
billion of temporary differences associated with investments in non-U.S. subsidiaries that are essentially permanent in duration. If the Corporation were to record the associated deferred tax liability, the amount would be approximately $i1
billion.
NOTE 20iFair Value Measurements
Under applicable accounting standards, fair value is defined as the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market
participants on the measurement date. The Corporation determines the fair values of its financial instruments under applicable accounting standards that require an entity to maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. The Corporation categorizes its financial instruments into three levels based on the established fair value hierarchy. The Corporation conducts a review of its fair value hierarchy classifications on a quarterly basis. Transfers into or out of fair value hierarchy classifications are made if the significant inputs used in the financial models measuring the fair values of the assets and liabilities became unobservable or observable in the current marketplace. For more information regarding the fair value hierarchy and how the Corporation measures fair value, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles. The Corporation accounts for certain financial instruments
under the fair value option. For additional information, see Note 21 – Fair Value Option.
Valuation Techniques
The following sections outline the valuation methodologies for the Corporation’s assets and liabilities. While the Corporation believes its valuation methods are appropriate and consistent with other market participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine the fair value of certain financial instruments could result in a different estimate of fair value at the reporting date.
During 2018, there were no changes to valuation approaches or techniques that had, or are expected to have, a material impact on the Corporation’s consolidated financial position or results of operations.
Trading
Account Assets and Liabilities and Debt Securities
The fair values of trading account assets and liabilities are primarily based on actively traded markets where prices are based on either direct market quotes or observed transactions. The fair values of debt securities are generally based on quoted market prices or market prices for similar assets. Liquidity is a significant factor in the determination of the fair values of trading account assets and liabilities and debt securities. Market price quotes may not be readily available for some positions such as positions within a market sector where trading activity has slowed significantly or ceased. Some of these instruments are valued using a discounted cash flow model, which estimates the fair value of the securities using internal credit risk, interest rate and prepayment risk models that incorporate management’s best estimate of current key assumptions such as default rates,
loss severity and prepayment
Bank of America 2018 150
rates. Principal and interest cash flows are discounted using an observable discount rate for similar instruments with adjustments that management believes a market participant would consider in determining fair value for the specific security. Other instruments are valued using a net asset value approach which considers the value
of the underlying securities. Underlying assets are valued using external pricing services, where available, or matrix pricing based on the vintages and ratings. Situations of illiquidity generally are triggered by the market’s perception of credit uncertainty regarding a single company or a specific market sector. In these instances, fair value is determined based on limited available market information and other factors, principally from reviewing the issuer’s financial statements and changes in credit ratings made by one or more rating agencies.
Derivative Assets and Liabilities
The fair values of derivative assets and liabilities traded in the OTC market are determined using quantitative models that utilize multiple market inputs including interest rates, prices and indices to generate continuous yield or pricing curves and volatility factors to value the position. The majority
of market inputs are actively quoted and can be validated through external sources, including brokers, market transactions and third-party pricing services. When third-party pricing services are used, the methods and assumptions are reviewed by the Corporation. Estimation risk is greater for derivative asset and liability positions that are either option-based or have longer maturity dates where observable market inputs are less readily available, or are unobservable, in which case, quantitative-based extrapolations of rate, price or index scenarios are used in determining fair values. The fair values of derivative assets and liabilities include adjustments for market liquidity, counterparty credit quality and other instrument-specific factors, where appropriate. In addition, the Corporation incorporates within its fair value measurements of OTC derivatives a valuation adjustment to reflect the credit risk associated with the net position. Positions are netted by counterparty,
and fair value for net long exposures is adjusted for counterparty credit risk while the fair value for net short exposures is adjusted for the Corporation’s own credit risk. The Corporation also incorporates FVA within its fair value measurements to include funding costs on uncollateralized derivatives and derivatives where the Corporation is not permitted to use the collateral it receives. An estimate of severity of loss is also used in the determination of fair value, primarily based on market data.
Loans and Loan Commitments
The fair values of loans and loan commitments are based on market prices, where available, or discounted cash flow analyses using market-based credit spreads of comparable debt instruments or credit derivatives of the specific borrower or comparable borrowers. Results of discounted cash flow analyses may be adjusted, as appropriate, to reflect other market
conditions or the perceived credit risk of the borrower.
Mortgage Servicing Rights
The fair values of MSRs are primarily determined using an option-adjusted spread (OAS) valuation approach, which factors in prepayment risk to determine the fair value of MSRs. This approach consists of projecting servicing cash flows under multiple interest rate scenarios and discounting these cash flows using risk-adjusted discount rates.
Loans Held-for-sale
The fair values of LHFS are based on quoted market prices, where available, or are determined by discounting estimated cash flows using interest rates approximating the Corporation’s current origination rates for similar loans adjusted to reflect the inherent credit risk. The borrower-specific credit risk is
embedded within the quoted market prices or is implied by considering loan performance when selecting comparables.
Short-term Borrowings and Long-term Debt
The Corporation issues structured liabilities that have coupons or repayment terms linked to the performance of debt or equity securities, indices, currencies or commodities. The fair values of these structured liabilities are estimated using quantitative models for the combined derivative and debt portions of the notes. These models incorporate observable and, in some instances, unobservable inputs including security prices, interest rate yield curves, option volatility, currency, commodity or equity rates and correlations among these inputs. The Corporation also considers the impact of its own credit spread in determining the discount rate used to value these liabilities. The credit spread is determined by reference to observable
spreads in the secondary bond market.
Securities Financing Agreements
The fair values of certain reverse repurchase agreements, repurchase agreements and securities borrowed transactions are determined using quantitative models, including discounted cash flow models that require the use of multiple market inputs including interest rates and spreads to generate continuous yield or pricing curves, and volatility factors. The majority of market inputs are actively quoted and can be validated through external sources, including brokers, market transactions and third-party pricing services.
Deposits
The fair values of deposits are determined using quantitative models, including discounted cash flow models that require the use of multiple market inputs including interest rates and spreads to generate
continuous yield or pricing curves, and volatility factors. The majority of market inputs are actively quoted and can be validated through external sources, including brokers, market transactions and third-party pricing services. The Corporation considers the impact of its own credit spread in the valuation of these liabilities. The credit risk is determined by reference to observable credit spreads in the secondary cash market.
Asset-backed Secured Financings
The fair values of asset-backed secured financings are based on external broker bids, where available, or are determined by discounting estimated cash flows using interest rates approximating the Corporation’s current origination rates for similar loans adjusted to reflect the inherent credit risk.
Recurring Fair Value
iAssets
and liabilities carried at fair value on a recurring basis at December 31, 2018 and 2017, including financial instruments which the Corporation accounts for under the fair value option, are summarized in the following tables.
Time
deposits placed and other short-term investments
$
i1,214
$
i—
$
i—
$
—
$
i1,214
Federal
funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell
i—
i56,399
i—
—
i56,399
Trading
account assets:
U.S.
Treasury and agency securities (2)
i53,131
i1,593
i—
—
i54,724
Corporate
securities, trading loans and other
i—
i24,630
i1,558
—
i26,188
Equity
securities
i53,840
i23,163
i276
—
i77,279
Non-U.S.
sovereign debt
i5,818
i19,210
i465
—
i25,493
Mortgage
trading loans, MBS and ABS:
U.S. government-sponsored agency guaranteed
i—
i19,586
i—
—
i19,586
Mortgage
trading loans, ABS and other MBS
i—
i9,443
i1,635
—
i11,078
Total
trading account assets (3)
i112,789
i97,625
i3,934
—
i214,348
Derivative
assets
i9,967
i315,413
i3,466
(i285,121
)
i43,725
AFS
debt securities:
U.S.
Treasury and agency securities
i53,663
i1,260
i—
—
i54,923
Mortgage-backed
securities:
Agency
i—
i121,826
i—
—
i121,826
Agency-collateralized
mortgage obligations
i—
i5,530
i—
—
i5,530
Non-agency
residential
i—
i1,320
i597
—
i1,917
Commercial
i—
i14,078
i—
—
i14,078
Non-U.S.
securities
i—
i9,304
i2
—
i9,306
Other
taxable securities
i—
i4,403
i7
—
i4,410
Tax-exempt
securities
i—
i17,376
i—
—
i17,376
Total
AFS debt securities
i53,663
i175,097
i606
—
i229,366
Other
debt securities carried at fair value:
U.S. Treasury and agency securities
i1,282
i—
i—
—
i1,282
Mortgage-backed
securities:
Non-agency residential
i—
i1,434
i172
—
i1,606
Non-U.S.
securities
i490
i5,354
i—
—
i5,844
Other
taxable securities
i—
i3
i—
—
i3
Total
other debt securities carried at fair value
i1,772
i6,791
i172
—
i8,735
Loans
and leases
i—
i4,011
i338
—
i4,349
Loans
held-for-sale
i—
i2,400
i542
—
i2,942
Other
assets (4)
i15,032
i1,775
i2,932
—
i19,739
Total
assets (5)
$
i194,437
$
i659,511
$
i11,990
$
(i285,121
)
$
i580,817
Liabilities
Interest-bearing
deposits in U.S. offices
$
i—
$
i492
$
i—
$
—
$
i492
Federal
funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase
i—
i28,875
i—
—
i28,875
Trading
account liabilities:
U.S.
Treasury and agency securities
i7,894
i761
i—
—
i8,655
Equity
securities
i33,739
i4,070
i—
—
i37,809
Non-U.S.
sovereign debt
i7,452
i9,182
i—
—
i16,634
Corporate
securities and other
i—
i5,104
i18
—
i5,122
Total
trading account liabilities
i49,085
i19,117
i18
—
i68,220
Derivative
liabilities
i9,931
i303,441
i4,401
(i279,882
)
i37,891
Short-term
borrowings
i—
i1,648
i—
—
i1,648
Accrued
expenses and other liabilities
i18,096
i1,979
i—
—
i20,075
Long-term
debt
i—
i26,820
i817
—
i27,637
Total
liabilities (5)
$
i77,112
$
i382,372
$
i5,236
$
(i279,882
)
$
i184,838
(1)
Amounts
represent the impact of legally enforceable master netting agreements and also cash collateral held or placed with the same counterparties.
(2)
Includes $i20.2 billion
of GSE obligations.
(3)
Includes securities with a fair value of $i16.6 billion that were segregated in compliance with
securities regulations or deposited with clearing organizations. This amount is included in the parenthetical disclosure on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
(4)
Includes MSRs of $i2.0 billionwhich
are classified as Level 3 assets.
(5)
Total recurring Level 3 assets were i0.51 percent of total consolidated assets,
and total recurring Level 3 liabilities were i0.25 percent of total consolidated liabilities.
Time
deposits placed and other short-term investments
$
i2,234
$
i—
$
i—
$
—
$
i2,234
Federal
funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell
i—
i52,906
i—
—
i52,906
Trading
account assets:
U.S.
Treasury and agency securities (2)
i38,720
i1,922
i—
—
i40,642
Corporate
securities, trading loans and other
i—
i28,714
i1,864
—
i30,578
Equity
securities
i60,747
i23,958
i235
—
i84,940
Non-U.S.
sovereign debt
i6,545
i15,839
i556
—
i22,940
Mortgage
trading loans, MBS and ABS:
U.S. government-sponsored agency guaranteed
i—
i20,586
i—
—
i20,586
Mortgage
trading loans, ABS and other MBS
i—
i8,174
i1,498
—
i9,672
Total
trading account assets (3)
i106,012
i99,193
i4,153
—
i209,358
Derivative
assets
i6,305
i341,178
i4,067
(i313,788
)
i37,762
AFS
debt securities:
U.S.
Treasury and agency securities
i51,915
i1,608
i—
—
i53,523
Mortgage-backed
securities:
Agency
i—
i192,929
i—
—
i192,929
Agency-collateralized
mortgage obligations
i—
i6,804
i—
—
i6,804
Non-agency
residential
i—
i2,669
i—
—
i2,669
Commercial
i—
i13,684
i—
—
i13,684
Non-U.S.
securities
i772
i5,880
i25
—
i6,677
Other
taxable securities
i—
i5,261
i509
—
i5,770
Tax-exempt
securities
i—
i20,106
i469
—
i20,575
Total
AFS debt securities
i52,687
i248,941
i1,003
—
i302,631
Other
debt securities carried at fair value:
Mortgage-backed securities:
Non-agency
residential
i—
i2,769
i—
—
i2,769
Non-U.S.
securities
i8,191
i1,297
i—
—
i9,488
Other
taxable securities
i—
i229
i—
—
i229
Total
other debt securities carried at fair value
i8,191
i4,295
i—
—
i12,486
Loans
and leases
i—
i5,139
i571
—
i5,710
Loans
held-for-sale
i—
i1,466
i690
—
i2,156
Other
assets (4)
i19,367
i789
i2,425
—
i22,581
Total
assets (5)
$
i194,796
$
i753,907
$
i12,909
$
(i313,788
)
$
i647,824
Liabilities
Interest-bearing
deposits in U.S. offices
$
i—
$
i449
$
i—
$
—
$
i449
Federal
funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase
i—
i36,182
i—
—
i36,182
Trading
account liabilities:
U.S.
Treasury and agency securities
i17,266
i734
i—
—
i18,000
Equity
securities
i33,019
i3,885
i—
—
i36,904
Non-U.S.
sovereign debt
i11,976
i7,382
i—
—
i19,358
Corporate
securities and other
i—
i6,901
i24
—
i6,925
Total
trading account liabilities
i62,261
i18,902
i24
—
i81,187
Derivative
liabilities
i6,029
i334,261
i5,781
(i311,771
)
i34,300
Short-term
borrowings
i—
i1,494
i—
—
i1,494
Accrued
expenses and other liabilities
i21,887
i945
i8
—
i22,840
Long-term
debt
i—
i29,923
i1,863
—
i31,786
Total
liabilities (5)
$
i90,177
$
i422,156
$
i7,676
$
(i311,771
)
$
i208,238
(1)
Amounts
represent the impact of legally enforceable master netting agreements and also cash collateral held or placed with the same counterparties.
(2)
Includes $i21.3 billion
of GSE obligations.
(3)
Includes securities with a fair value of $i16.8 billion that were segregated in compliance with
securities regulations or deposited with clearing organizations. This amount is included in the parenthetical disclosure on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
(4)
Includes MSRs of $i2.3 billion which
are classified as Level 3 assets.
(5)
Total recurring Level 3 assets were i0.57 percent of total consolidated assets,
and total recurring Level 3 liabilities were i0.38 percent of total consolidated liabilities.
153Bank
of America 2018
The following tables present a reconciliation of all assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis using significant unobservable inputs (Level 3) during 2018, 2017 and 2016, including net realized and unrealized gains (losses) included
in earnings and accumulated OCI.
Level 3 –
Fair Value Measurements in 2018 (1)
(Dollars in millions)
Balance
January 1
2018
Total Realized/Unrealized Gains (Losses) in Net Income (2)
Gains (Losses) in OCI (3)
Gross
Gross Transfers into
Level
3
Gross Transfers out of
Level 3
Balance December 31 2018
Change in Unrealized Gains (Losses) in Net Income Related to Financial Instruments Still Held (2)
Purchases
Sales
Issuances
Settlements
Trading account assets:
Corporate
securities, trading loans and other
$
i1,864
$
(i32
)
$
(i1
)
$
i436
$
(i403
)
$
i5
$
(i568
)
$
i804
$
(i547
)
$
i1,558
$
(i117
)
Equity
securities
i235
(i17
)
i—
i44
(i11
)
i—
(i4
)
i78
(i49
)
i276
(i22
)
Non-U.S.
sovereign debt
i556
i47
(i44
)
i13
(i57
)
i—
(i30
)
i117
(i137
)
i465
i48
Mortgage
trading loans, ABS and other MBS
i1,498
i148
i3
i585
(i910
)
i—
(i158
)
i705
(i236
)
i1,635
i97
Total
trading account assets
i4,153
i146
(i42
)
i1,078
(i1,381
)
i5
(i760
)
i1,704
(i969
)
i3,934
i6
Net
derivative assets (4)
(i1,714
)
i106
i—
i531
(i1,179
)
i—
i778
i39
i504
(i935
)
(i116
)
AFS
debt securities:
Non-agency
residential MBS
i—
i27
(i33
)
i—
(i71
)
i—
(i25
)
i774
(i75
)
i597
i—
Non-U.S.
securities
i25
i—
(i1
)
i—
(i10
)
i—
(i15
)
i3
i—
i2
i—
Other
taxable securities
i509
i1
(i3
)
i—
(i23
)
i—
(i11
)
i60
(i526
)
i7
i—
Tax-exempt
securities
i469
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
(i1
)
i1
(i469
)
i—
i—
Total
AFS debt securities (5)
i1,003
i28
(i37
)
i—
(i104
)
i—
(i52
)
i838
(i1,070
)
i606
i—
Other
debt securities carried at fair value – Non-agency residential MBS
i—
(i18
)
i—
i—
(i8
)
i—
(i34
)
i365
(i133
)
i172
(i18
)
Loans
and leases (6, 7)
i571
(i16
)
i—
i—
(i134
)
i—
(i83
)
i—
i—
i338
(i9
)
Loans
held-for-sale (6)
i690
i44
(i26
)
i71
i—
i1
(i201
)
i23
(i60
)
i542
i31
Other
assets (5, 7, 8)
i2,425
i414
(i38
)
i2
(i69
)
i96
(i792
)
i929
(i35
)
i2,932
i149
Trading
account liabilities – Corporate securities and other
(i24
)
i11
i—
i9
(i12
)
(i2
)
i—
i—
i—
(i18
)
(i7
)
Accrued
expenses and other liabilities (6)
(i8
)
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i8
i—
i—
i—
i—
Long-term
debt (6)
(i1,863
)
i103
i4
i9
i—
(i141
)
i486
(i262
)
i847
(i817
)
i95
(1)
Assets
(liabilities). For assets, increase (decrease) to Level 3 and for liabilities, (increase) decrease to Level 3.
(2)
Includes gains (losses) reported in earnings in the following income statement line items: Trading account assets/liabilities - predominantly trading account profits; Net derivative assets - primarily trading account profits and other income; Other debt securities carried at fair value - other income; Loans and leases - other income; Loans held-for-sale - other income; Other assets - primarily other income related to MSRs; Long-term debt - primarily trading account profits. For MSRs, the amounts reflect the changes in modeled MSR fair value due to observed changes in interest rates, volatility, spreads and
the shape of the forward swap curve, and periodic adjustments to the valuation model to reflect changes in the modeled relationships between inputs and projected cash flows, as well as changes in cash flow assumptions including cost to service.
(3)
Includes unrealized gains (losses) in OCI on AFS debt securities, foreign currency translation adjustments and the impact of changes in the Corporation’s credit spreads on long-term debt accounted for under the fair value option. Total gains (losses) in OCI include net unrealized losses of $i105
million related to financial instruments still held at December 31, 2018. For additional information, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles.
(4)
Net derivative assets include derivative assets of $i3.5
billion and derivative liabilities of $i4.4 billion.
(5)
Transfers
out of AFS debt securities and into other assets primarily relate to the reclassification of certain securities.
(6)
Amounts represent instruments that are accounted for under the fair value option.
(7)
Issuances represent loan originations and MSRs recognized following securitizations or whole-loan sales.
(8)
Settlements
primarily represent the net change in fair value of the MSR asset due to the recognition of modeled cash flows and the passage of time.
Transfers into Level 3, primarily due to decreased price observability, during 2018 included $i1.7
billion of trading account assets, $i838 million of AFS debt securities, $i365
million of other debt securities carried at fair value and $i262 million of long-term debt. Transfers occur on a regular basis for long-term debt instruments due to changes in the impact of unobservable inputs
on the value of the
embedded derivative in relation to the instrument as a whole.
Transfers out of Level 3, primarily due to increased price observability, during 2018 included $i969 million of trading account assets, $i504
million of net derivatives assets, $i1.1 billion of AFS debt securities and $i847
million of long-term debt.
Bank of America 2018 154
ii
Level 3 –
Fair Value Measurements in 2017 (1)
Balance January 1
2017
Total Realized/Unrealized Gains (Losses) in Net Income (2)
Gains (Losses) in OCI (3)
Gross
Gross Transfers into Level
3
Gross Transfers out of
Level 3
Balance December 31 2017
Change in Unrealized Gains (Losses) in Net Income Related to Financial Instruments Still Held (2)
(Dollars in millions)
Purchases
Sales
Issuances
Settlements
Trading
account assets:
Corporate
securities, trading loans and other
$
i2,777
$
i229
$
i—
$
i547
$
(i702
)
$
i5
$
(i666
)
$
i728
$
(i1,054
)
$
i1,864
$
i2
Equity
securities
i281
i18
i—
i55
(i70
)
i—
(i10
)
i146
(i185
)
i235
(i1
)
Non-U.S.
sovereign debt
i510
i74
(i8
)
i53
(i59
)
i—
(i73
)
i72
(i13
)
i556
i70
Mortgage
trading loans, ABS and other MBS
i1,211
i165
(i2
)
i1,210
(i990
)
i—
(i233
)
i218
(i81
)
i1,498
i72
Total
trading account assets
i4,779
i486
(i10
)
i1,865
(i1,821
)
i5
(i982
)
i1,164
(i1,333
)
i4,153
i143
Net
derivative assets (4)
(i1,313
)
(i984
)
i—
i664
(i979
)
i—
i949
i48
(i99
)
(i1,714
)
(i409
)
AFS
debt securities:
Non-U.S.
securities
i229
i2
i16
i49
i—
i—
(i271
)
i—
i—
i25
i—
Other
taxable securities
i594
i4
i8
i5
i—
i—
(i42
)
i34
(i94
)
i509
i—
Tax-exempt
securities
i542
i1
i3
i14
(i70
)
i—
(i11
)
i35
(i45
)
i469
i—
Total
AFS debt securities
i1,365
i7
i27
i68
(i70
)
i—
(i324
)
i69
(i139
)
i1,003
i—
Other
debt securities carried at fair value – Non-agency residential MBS
i25
(i1
)
i—
i—
(i21
)
i—
(i3
)
i—
i—
i—
i—
Loans
and leases (5)
i720
i15
i—
i3
(i34
)
i—
(i126
)
i—
(i7
)
i571
i11
Loans
held-for-sale (5, 6)
i656
i100
(i3
)
i3
(i189
)
i—
(i346
)
i501
(i32
)
i690
i14
Other
assets (6, 7)
i2,986
i144
(i57
)
i2
(i214
)
i258
(i758
)
i64
i—
i2,425
(i226
)
Federal
funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase (5)
(i359
)
(i5
)
i—
i—
i—
(i12
)
i171
(i58
)
i263
i—
i—
Trading
account liabilities – Corporate securities and other
(i27
)
i14
i—
i8
(i17
)
(i2
)
i—
i—
i—
(i24
)
i2
Accrued
expenses and other liabilities (5)
(i9
)
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i1
i—
i—
(i8
)
i—
Long-term
debt (5)
(i1,514
)
(i135
)
(i31
)
i84
i—
(i288
)
i514
(i711
)
i218
(i1,863
)
(i196
)
//
(1)
Assets
(liabilities). For assets, increase (decrease) to Level 3 and for liabilities, (increase) decrease to Level 3.
(2)
Includes gains (losses) reported in earnings in the following income statement line items: Trading account assets/liabilities - predominantly trading account profits; Net derivative assets - primarily trading account profits and other income; Other debt securities carried at fair value - other income; Loans and leases - other income; Loans held-for-sale - other income; Other assets - primarily other income related to MSRs; Long-term debt - trading account profits. For MSRs, the amounts reflect the changes in modeled MSR fair value due to observed changes in interest rates, volatility, spreads and the shape
of the forward swap curve, and periodic adjustments to the valuation model to reflect changes in the modeled relationships between inputs and projected cash flows, as well as changes in cash flow assumptions including cost to service.
(3)
Includes unrealized gains (losses) in OCI on AFS debt securities, foreign currency translation adjustments and the impact of changes in the Corporation’s credit spreads on long-term debt accounted for under the fair value option. For additional information, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles.
(4)
Net
derivative assets include derivative assets of $i4.1 billion and derivative liabilities of $i5.8
billion.
(5)
Amounts represent instruments that are accounted for under the fair value option.
(6)
Issuances represent loan originations and MSRs recognized following securitizations or whole-loan sales.
(7)
Settlements
primarily represent the net change in fair value of the MSR asset due to the recognition of modeled cash flows and the passage of time.
Transfers into Level 3, primarily due to decreased price observability, during 2017 included $i1.2
billion of trading account assets, $i501 million of LHFS and $i711
million of long-term debt. Transfers occur on a regular basis for long-term debt instruments due to changes in the impact of unobservable inputs on the value of the embedded derivative in relation to the instrument as a whole.
Transfers out of Level 3, primarily due to increased price observability, during 2017 included $i1.3
billion of trading account assets, $i139 million of AFS debt securities, $i263
million of federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase and $i218 million of long-term debt.
155Bank
of America 2018
Level 3 –
Fair Value Measurements in 2016 (1)
(Dollars
in millions)
Balance January 1 2016
Total Realized/Unrealized Gains/(Losses) in Net Income (2)
Gains/ (Losses) in OCI (3)
Gross
Gross Transfers into Level 3
Gross Transfers out of Level 3
Balance December 31 2016
Change
in Unrealized Gains/(Losses) in Net Income Related to Financial Instruments Still Held (2)
Purchases
Sales
Issuances
Settlements
Trading account assets:
Corporate
securities, trading loans and other
$
i2,838
$
i78
$
i2
$
i1,508
$
(i847
)
$
i—
$
(i725
)
$
i728
$
(i805
)
$
i2,777
$
(i82
)
Equity
securities
i407
i74
i—
i73
(i169
)
i—
(i82
)
i70
(i92
)
i281
(i59
)
Non-U.S.
sovereign debt
i521
i122
i91
i12
(i146
)
i—
(i90
)
i—
i—
i510
i120
Mortgage
trading loans, ABS and other MBS
i1,868
i188
(i2
)
i988
(i1,491
)
i—
(i344
)
i158
(i154
)
i1,211
i64
Total
trading account assets
i5,634
i462
i91
i2,581
(i2,653
)
i—
(i1,241
)
i956
(i1,051
)
i4,779
i43
Net
derivative assets (4)
(i441
)
i285
i—
i470
(i1,155
)
i—
i76
(i186
)
(i362
)
(i1,313
)
(i376
)
AFS
debt securities:
Non-agency
residential MBS
i106
i—
i—
i—
(i106
)
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
Non-U.S.
securities
i—
i—
(i6
)
i584
(i92
)
i—
(i263
)
i6
i—
i229
i—
Other
taxable securities
i757
i4
(i2
)
i—
i—
i—
(i83
)
i—
(i82
)
i594
i—
Tax-exempt
securities
i569
i—
(i1
)
i1
i—
i—
(i2
)
i10
(i35
)
i542
i—
Total
AFS debt securities
i1,432
i4
(i9
)
i585
(i198
)
i—
(i348
)
i16
(i117
)
i1,365
i—
Other
debt securities carried at fair value – Non-agency residential MBS
i30
(i5
)
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i25
i—
Loans
and leases (5, 6)
i1,620
(i44
)
i—
i69
(i553
)
i50
(i194
)
i6
(i234
)
i720
i17
Loans
held-for-sale (5)
i787
i79
i50
i22
(i256
)
i—
(i93
)
i173
(i106
)
i656
i70
Other
assets (6, 7)
i3,461
i136
i—
i38
(i191
)
i411
(i872
)
i3
i—
i2,986
(i143
)
Federal
funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase (5)
(i335
)
(i11
)
i—
i—
i—
(i22
)
i27
(i19
)
i1
(i359
)
i4
Trading
account liabilities – Corporate securities and other
(i21
)
i5
i—
i—
(i11
)
i—
i—
i—
i—
(i27
)
i4
Short-term
borrowings (5)
(i30
)
i1
i—
i—
i—
i—
i29
i—
i—
i—
i—
Accrued
expenses and other liabilities (5)
(i9
)
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
(i9
)
i—
Long-term
debt (5)
(i1,513
)
(i74
)
(i20
)
i140
i—
(i521
)
i948
(i939
)
i465
(i1,514
)
(i184
)
(1)
Assets
(liabilities). For assets, increase (decrease) to Level 3 and for liabilities, (increase) decrease to Level 3.
(2)
Includes gains/losses reported in earnings in the following income statement line items: Trading account assets/liabilities - trading account profits; Net derivative assets - primarily trading account profits and other income; Other debt securities carried at fair value - other income; Loans and leases - other income; Loans held-for-sale - other income; Other assets - primarily other income related to MSRs; Long-term debt - predominantly trading account profits. For MSRs, the amounts reflect the changes in modeled MSR fair value due to observed changes in interest rates, volatility, spreads and the shape
of the forward swap curve, and periodic adjustments to the valuation model to reflect changes in the modeled relationships between inputs and projected cash flows, as well as changes in cash flow assumptions including cost to service.
(3)
Includes unrealized gains/losses in OCI on AFS debt securities, foreign currency translation adjustments and the impact of changes in the Corporation’s credit spreads on long-term debt accounted for under the fair value option. For more information, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles.
(4)
Net
derivatives include derivative assets of $i3.9 billion and derivative liabilities of $i5.2
billion.
(5)
Amounts represent instruments that are accounted for under the fair value option.
(6)
Issuances represent loan originations and MSRs recognized following securitizations or whole-loan sales.
(7)
Settlements
represent the net change in fair value of the MSR asset due to the recognition of modeled cash flows and the passage of time.
Transfers into Level 3, primarily due to decreased price observability, during 2016 included $i956
million of trading account assets, $i186 million of net derivative assets, $i173
million of LHFS and $i939 million of long-term debt. Transfers occur on a regular basis for long-term debt instruments due to changes in the impact of unobservable inputs on the value of the embedded derivative in relation to the instrument as a whole.
Transfers
out of Level 3, primarily due to increased price observability, during 2016 included $i1.1 billion of trading account assets, $i362
million of net derivative assets, $i117 million of AFS debt securities, $i234
million of loans and leases, $i106 million of LHFS and $i465
million of long-term debt.
Bank of America 2018 156
iThe
following tables present information about significant unobservable inputs related to the Corporation’s material categories of Level 3 financial assets and liabilities at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Quantitative
Information about Level 3 Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2018
(Dollars in millions)
Inputs
Financial Instrument
Fair
Value
Valuation
Technique
Significant Unobservable
Inputs
Ranges of
Inputs
Weighted Average (1)
Loans and Securities (2)
Instruments
backed by residential real estate assets
$
i1,536
Discounted
cash flow, Market comparables
Yield
0% to 25%
8%
Trading account assets – Mortgage trading loans, ABS and other MBS
Other
debt securities carried at fair value - Non-agency residential
i172
Instruments
backed by commercial real estate assets
$
i291
Discounted
cash flow
Yield
0% to 25%
7%
Trading account assets – Corporate securities, trading loans and other
i200
Price
$0
to $100
$i79
Trading
account assets – Mortgage trading loans, ABS and other MBS
i91
Commercial
loans, debt securities and other
$
i3,489
Discounted cash flow, Market comparables
Yield
1%
to 18%
13%
Trading account assets – Corporate securities, trading loans and other
i1,358
Prepayment
speed
10% to 20%
15%
Trading account assets – Non-U.S. sovereign debt
i465
Default
rate
3% to 4%
4%
Trading account assets – Mortgage trading loans, ABS and other MBS
i1,125
Loss
severity
35% to 40%
38%
Loans held-for-sale
i541
Price
$0
to $141
$i68
Other
assets, primarily auction rate securities
$
i890
Discounted
cash flow, Market comparables
Price
$10 to $100
$i95
MSRs
$
i2,042
Discounted
cash flow
Weighted-average life, fixed rate (5)
0 to 14 years
5 years
Weighted-average life, variable rate (5)
0 to 10 years
3 years
Option-adjusted
spread, fixed rate
7% to 14%
9%
Option-adjusted spread, variable rate
9% to 15%
12%
Structured liabilities
Long-term
debt
$
(i817
)
Discounted cash flow, Market comparables, Industry standard derivative pricing (3)
Equity
correlation
11% to 100%
67%
Long-dated equity volatilities
4% to 84%
32%
Yield
7% to 18%
16%
Price
$0
to $100
$i72
Net derivative assets
Credit
derivatives
$
(i565
)
Discounted
cash flow, Stochastic recovery correlation model
Yield
0% to 5%
4%
Upfront points
0 points to 100 points
70 points
Credit correlation
70%
n/a
Prepayment
speed
15% to 20% CPR
15%
Default rate
1% to 4% CDR
2%
Loss severity
35%
n/a
Price
$0
to $138
$i93
Equity
derivatives
$
(i348
)
Industry standard
derivative pricing (3)
Equity correlation
11% to 100%
67%
Long-dated equity volatilities
4% to 84%
32%
Commodity derivatives
$
i10
Discounted
cash flow, Industry standard derivative pricing (3)
Natural gas forward price
$1/MMBtu to $12/MMBtu
$3/MMBtu
Correlation
38% to 87%
71%
Volatilities
15%
to 132%
38%
Interest rate derivatives
$
(i32
)
Industry
standard derivative pricing (4)
Correlation (IR/IR)
15% to 70%
61%
Correlation (FX/IR)
0% to 46%
1%
Long-dated inflation rates
-20%
to 38%
2%
Long-dated inflation volatilities
0% to 1%
1%
Total net derivative assets
$
(i935
)
(1)
For
loans and securities, structured liabilities and net derivative assets, the weighted average is calculated based upon the absolute fair value of the instruments.
(2)
The categories are aggregated based upon product type which differs from financial statement classification. The following is a reconciliation to the line items in the table on page 152: Trading account assets – Corporate securities, trading loans and other of $i1.6
billion, Trading account assets – Non-U.S. sovereign debt of $i465 million, Trading account assets – Mortgage trading loans, ABS and other MBS of $i1.6
billion, AFS debt securities of $i606 million, Other debt securities carried at fair value - Non-agency residential of $i172
million, Other assets, including MSRs, of $i2.9 billion, Loans and leases of $i338
million and LHFS of $i542 million.
(3)
Includes
models such as Monte Carlo simulation and Black-Scholes.
(4)
Includes models such as Monte Carlo simulation, Black-Scholes and other methods that model the joint dynamics of interest, inflation and foreign exchange rates.
(5)
The weighted-average life is a product of changes in market rates of interest, prepayment rates and other model and cash flow assumptions.
CPR = Constant Prepayment Rate
CDR
= Constant Default Rate
MMBtu = Million British thermal units
IR = Interest Rate
FX = Foreign Exchange
n/a = not applicable
157Bank of America 2018
Quantitative
Information about Level 3 Fair Value Measurements at December 31, 2017
(Dollars in millions)
Inputs
Financial Instrument
Fair Value
Valuation
Technique
Significant Unobservable Inputs
Ranges of Inputs
Weighted Average (1)
Loans and Securities (2)
Instruments backed by residential real estate assets
$
i871
Discounted
cash flow
Yield
0% to 25%
6%
Trading account assets – Mortgage trading loans, ABS and other MBS
i298
Prepayment
speed
0% to 22% CPR
12%
Loans and leases
i570
Default
rate
0% to 3% CDR
1%
Loans held-for-sale
i3
Loss
severity
0% to 53%
17%
Instruments backed by commercial real estate assets
$
i286
Discounted
cash flow
Yield
0% to 25%
9%
Trading account assets – Corporate securities, trading loans and other
i244
Price
$0
to $100
$i67
Trading
account assets – Mortgage trading loans, ABS and other MBS
i42
Commercial
loans, debt securities and other
$
i4,023
Discounted cash flow, Market comparables
Yield
0%
to 12%
5%
Trading account assets – Corporate securities, trading loans and other
i1,613
Prepayment
speed
10% to 20%
16%
Trading account assets – Non-U.S. sovereign debt
i556
Default
rate
3% to 4%
4%
Trading account assets – Mortgage trading loans, ABS and other MBS
i1,158
Loss
severity
35% to 40%
37%
AFS debt securities – Other taxable securities
i8
Price
$0
to $145
$i63
Loans
and leases
i1
Loans
held-for-sale
i687
Auction
rate securities
$
i977
Discounted cash flow, Market comparables
Price
$10
to $100
$i94
Trading account assets – Corporate securities,
trading loans and other
i7
AFS
debt securities – Other taxable securities
i501
AFS
debt securities – Tax-exempt securities
i469
MSRs
$
i2,302
Discounted
cash flow
Weighted-average life, fixed rate (5)
0 to 14 years
5 years
Weighted-average life, variable rate (5)
0 to 10 years
3 years
Option-adjusted
spread, fixed rate
9% to 14%
10%
Option-adjusted spread, variable rate
9% to 15%
12%
Structured liabilities
Long-term
debt
$
(i1,863
)
Discounted cash flow, Market comparables, Industry standard derivative pricing (3)
Equity
correlation
15% to 100%
63%
Long-dated equity volatilities
4% to 84%
22%
Yield
7.5%
n/a
Price
$0
to $100
$i66
Net derivative assets
Credit
derivatives
$
(i282
)
Discounted
cash flow, Stochastic recovery correlation model
Yield
1% to 5%
3%
Upfront points
0 points to 100 points
71 points
Credit correlation
35% to 83%
42%
Prepayment
speed
15% to 20% CPR
16%
Default rate
1% to 4% CDR
2%
Loss severity
35%
n/a
Price
$0
to $102
$i82
Equity
derivatives
$
(i2,059
)
Industry standard
derivative pricing (3)
Equity correlation
15% to 100%
63%
Long-dated equity volatilities
4% to 84%
22%
Commodity derivatives
$
(i3
)
Discounted
cash flow, Industry standard derivative pricing (3)
Natural gas forward price
$1/MMBtu to $5/MMBtu
$3/MMBtu
Correlation
71% to 87%
81%
Volatilities
26%
to 132%
57%
Interest rate derivatives
$
i630
Industry
standard derivative pricing (4)
Correlation (IR/IR)
15% to 92%
50%
Correlation (FX/IR)
0% to 46%
1%
Long-dated inflation rates
-14%
to 38%
4%
Long-dated inflation volatilities
0% to 1%
1%
Total net derivative assets
$
(i1,714
)
(1)
For
loans and securities, structured liabilities and net derivative assets, the weighted average is calculated based upon the absolute fair value of the instruments.
(2)
The categories are aggregated based upon product type which differs from financial statement classification. The following is a reconciliation to the line items in the table on page 153: Trading account assets – Corporate securities, trading loans and other of $i1.9
billion, Trading account assets – Non-U.S. sovereign debt of $i556 million, Trading account assets – Mortgage trading loans, ABS and other MBS of $i1.5
billion, AFS debt securities – Other taxable securities of $i509 million, AFS debt securities – Tax-exempt securities of $i469
million, Loans and leases of $i571 million and LHFS of $i690
million.
(3)
Includes models such as Monte Carlo simulation and Black-Scholes.
(4)
Includes models such as Monte Carlo simulation, Black-Scholes and other methods that model the joint dynamics of interest, inflation and foreign exchange rates.
(5)
The
weighted-average life is a product of changes in market rates of interest, prepayment rates and other model and cash flow assumptions.
CPR = Constant Prepayment Rate
CDR = Constant Default Rate
MMBtu = Million British thermal units
IR = Interest Rate
FX = Foreign Exchange
n/a = not applicable
Bank
of America 2018 158
In the previous tables, instruments backed by residential and commercial real estate assets include RMBS, commercial MBS, whole loans and mortgage CDOs. Commercial loans, debt securities and other include corporate CLOs and CDOs, commercial loans and bonds, and securities backed by non-real estate assets. Structured liabilities primarily include equity-linked notes that are accounted for under the fair value option.
The Corporation uses multiple market approaches in valuing certain of its Level 3 financial instruments. For example, market comparables and discounted cash flows are used together. For a given product, such as corporate debt securities, market comparables may be used to estimate some of the unobservable
inputs and then these inputs are incorporated into a discounted cash flow model. Therefore, the balances disclosed encompass both of these techniques.
The level of aggregation and diversity within the products disclosed in the tables results in certain ranges of inputs being wide and unevenly distributed across asset and liability categories.
Uncertainty of Fair Value Measurements from Unobservable Inputs
Loans and Securities
A significant increase in market yields, default rates, loss severities or duration would have resulted in a significantly lower fair value for long positions. Short positions would have been impacted in a directionally opposite way. The impact of changes in prepayment speeds would have resulted in differing impacts depending on the seniority of the instrument and, in
the case of CLOs, whether prepayments can be reinvested. A significant increase in price would have resulted in a significantly higher fair value for long positions, and short positions would have been impacted in a directionally opposite way.
Structured Liabilities and Derivatives
For credit derivatives, a significant increase in market yield, upfront points (i.e., a single upfront payment made by a protection buyer at inception), credit spreads, default rates or loss severities would have resulted in a significantly lower fair value for protection sellers and higher fair value for protection buyers. The impact of changes in prepayment speeds would have resulted in differing impacts depending on the seniority of the instrument.
Structured credit derivatives are impacted by credit correlation. Default correlation is a parameter that describes
the degree of
dependence among credit default rates within a credit portfolio that underlies a credit derivative instrument. The sensitivity of this input on the fair value varies depending on the level of subordination of the tranche. For senior tranches that are net purchases of protection, a significant increase in default correlation would have resulted in a significantly higher fair value. Net short protection positions would have been impacted in a directionally opposite way.
For equity derivatives, commodity derivatives, interest rate derivatives and structured liabilities, a significant change in long-dated rates and volatilities and correlation inputs (i.e., the degree of correlation between an equity security and an index, between two different commodities, between two different interest rates, or between interest rates and
foreign exchange rates) would have resulted in a significant impact to the fair value; however, the magnitude and direction of the impact depend on whether the Corporation is long or short the exposure. For structured liabilities, a significant increase in yield or decrease in price would have resulted in a significantly lower fair value. A significant decrease in duration would have resulted in a significantly higher fair value.
Sensitivity of Fair Value Measurements for Mortgage Servicing Rights
The weighted-average lives and fair value of MSRs are sensitive to changes in modeled assumptions. The weighted-average life is a product of changes in market rates of interest, prepayment rates and other model and cash flow assumptions. The weighted-average life represents the average period of time that the MSRs’ cash flows are expected to be received. Absent other changes, an increase
(decrease) to the weighted-average life would generally result in an increase (decrease) in the fair value of the MSRs. For example, a 10 percent or 20 percent decrease in prepayment rates, which impacts the weighted-average life, could result in an increase in fair value of $i64 million or $i133
million, while a 10 percent or 20 percent increase in prepayment rates could result in a decrease in fair value of $i59 million or $i115
million. A 100 bp or 200 bp decrease in OAS levels could result in an increase in fair value of $i63 million or $i131
million, while a 100 bp or 200 bp increase in OAS levels could result in a decrease in fair value of $i59 million or $i115
million. These sensitivities are hypothetical and actual amounts may vary materially.
159Bank of America 2018
Nonrecurring
Fair Value
The Corporation holds certain assets that are measured at fair value, but only in certain situations (e.g., impairment) and these measurements are referred to herein as nonrecurring. iThe amounts below represent assets still held as of the reporting date for which a nonrecurring fair value adjustment was recorded during 2018, 2017 and 2016.
Assets
Measured at Fair Value on a Nonrecurring Basis
Includes
$i83 million, $i135
million and $i150 million of losses on loans that were written down to a collateral value of zero during 2018, 2017 and 2016, respectively.
(2)
Amounts
are included in other assets on the Consolidated Balance Sheet and represent the carrying value of foreclosed properties that were written down subsequent to their initial classification as foreclosed properties. Losses on foreclosed properties include losses recorded during the first 90 days after transfer of a loan to foreclosed properties.
(3)
Excludes $i488
million and $i801 million of properties acquired upon foreclosure of certain government-guaranteed loans (principally FHA-insured loans) at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
iThe
table below presents information about significant unobservable inputs related to the Corporation’s nonrecurring Level 3 financial assets and liabilities at December 31, 2018 and 2017. Loans and leases backed by residential real estate assets represent residential mortgages where the loan has been written down to the fair value of the underlying collateral.
Quantitative
Information about Nonrecurring Level 3 Fair Value Measurements
Loans and leases backed by residential real estate assets
$
i894
Market
comparables
OREO discount
15% to 58%
i23
%
Costs
to sell
5% to 49%
i7
%
(1)
The weighted average is calculated based upon the fair value of the loans.
NOTE 21iFair Value Option
Loans and Loan Commitments
The Corporation elects to account for certain loans and loan commitments that exceed the Corporation’s single-name credit risk
concentration guidelines under the fair value option. Lending commitments are actively managed and, as appropriate, credit risk for these lending relationships may be mitigated through the use of credit derivatives, with the Corporation’s public side credit view and market perspectives determining the size and timing of the hedging activity. These credit derivatives do not meet the requirements for designation as accounting hedges and therefore are carried at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in other income. The fair value option allows the Corporation to carry these loans and loan commitments at fair value, which is more consistent with management’s view of the underlying economics and the manner in which they are managed. In addition, the fair value option allows the Corporation to reduce the accounting volatility that would otherwise result from the asymmetry created by accounting for the financial instruments at historical cost and the credit derivatives
at fair value.
Loans Held-for-sale
The Corporation elects to account for residential mortgage LHFS, commercial mortgage LHFS and certain other LHFS under the fair value option with interest income on these LHFS recorded in other interest income. These loans are actively managed and monitored and, as appropriate, certain market risks of the loans may be mitigated through the use of derivatives. The Corporation has elected not to designate the derivatives as qualifying accounting hedges and therefore they are carried at fair value with changes in fair value recorded in other income. The changes in fair value of the loans are largely offset by changes in the fair value of the derivatives. The fair value option allows the Corporation to reduce the accounting volatility that would otherwise result from the asymmetry created by accounting for
the financial instruments at the lower of cost or fair value and the derivatives at fair value. The Corporation has not elected to account for certain other LHFS under the fair value option primarily because these loans are floating-rate loans that are not hedged using derivative instruments.
Bank of America 2018 160
Loans Reported as Trading Account Assets
The
Corporation elects to account for certain loans that are held for the purpose of trading and are risk-managed on a fair value basis under the fair value option.
Other Assets
The Corporation elects to account for certain long-term fixed-rate margin loans that are hedged with derivatives under the fair value option. Election of the fair value option allows the Corporation to reduce the accounting volatility that would otherwise result from the asymmetry created by accounting for the financial instruments at historical cost and the derivatives at fair value.
Securities Financing Agreements
The Corporation elects to account for certain securities financing agreements, including resale and repurchase agreements, under the fair value option based on the tenor of the agreements, which reflects the magnitude
of the interest rate risk. The majority of securities financing agreements collateralized by U.S. government securities are not accounted for under the fair value option as these contracts are generally short-dated and therefore the interest rate risk is not significant.
Long-term Deposits
The Corporation elects to account for certain long-term fixed-rate and rate-linked deposits that are hedged with derivatives that do not qualify for hedge accounting under the fair value option. Election of the fair value option allows the Corporation to reduce
the accounting volatility that would otherwise result from the asymmetry created by accounting for the financial instruments at historical cost and the derivatives
at fair value. The Corporation has not elected to carry other long-term deposits at fair value because they are not hedged using derivatives.
Short-term Borrowings
The Corporation elects to account for certain short-term borrowings, primarily short-term structured liabilities, under the fair value option because this debt is risk-managed on a fair value basis.
The Corporation elects to account for certain asset-backed secured financings, which are also classified in short-term borrowings, under the fair value option. Election of the fair value option allows the Corporation to reduce the accounting volatility that would otherwise result from the asymmetry created by accounting for the asset-backed secured financings at historical cost and the corresponding mortgage LHFS securing these financings at fair value.
Long-term
Debt
The Corporation elects to account for certain long-term debt, primarily structured liabilities, under the fair value option. This long-term debt is either risk-managed on a fair value basis or the related hedges do not qualify for hedge accounting.
Fair Value Option Elections
iThe table below provides information about the fair value carrying amount and the contractual principal outstanding of assets and liabilities accounted for under
the fair value option at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
Federal funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell
$
i56,399
$
i56,376
$
i23
$
i52,906
$
i52,907
$
(i1
)
Loans
reported as trading account assets (1)
i6,195
i13,088
(i6,893
)
i5,735
i11,804
(i6,069
)
Trading
inventory – other
i13,778
n/a
n/a
i12,027
n/a
n/a
Consumer
and commercial loans
i4,349
i4,399
(i50
)
i5,710
i5,744
(i34
)
Loans
held-for-sale (1)
i2,942
i4,749
(i1,807
)
i2,156
i3,717
(i1,561
)
Other
assets
i3
n/a
n/a
i3
n/a
n/a
Long-term
deposits
i492
i454
i38
i449
i421
i28
Federal
funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase
i28,875
i28,881
(i6
)
i36,182
i36,187
(i5
)
Short-term
borrowings
i1,648
i1,648
i—
i1,494
i1,494
i—
Unfunded
loan commitments
i169
n/a
n/a
i120
n/a
n/a
Long-term
debt (2)
i27,637
i29,147
(i1,510
)
i31,786
i31,512
i274
(1)
A
significant portion of the loans reported as trading account assets and LHFS are distressed loans that were purchased at a deep discount to par, and the remainder are loans with a fair value near contractual principal outstanding.
(2)
Includes structured liabilities with a fair value of $i27.3
billion and $i31.4 billion, and contractual principal outstanding of $i28.8
billion and $i31.1 billion at December 31, 2018 and 2017.
n/a = not applicable
161Bank
of America 2018
The following tables provide information about where changes in the fair value of assets and liabilities accounted for under the fair value option are included in the Consolidated Statement of Income for 2018, 2017 and 2016.
Gains
(Losses) Relating to Assets and Liabilities Accounted for Under the Fair Value Option
Trading Account Profits
Other Income
Total
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
Loans reported as trading account assets (1)
$
i8
$
i—
$
i8
Trading
inventory – other (2)
i1,750
i—
i1,750
Consumer
and commercial loans (1)
(i422
)
(i53
)
(i475
)
Loans
held-for-sale (1, 3)
i1
i24
i25
Unfunded
loan commitments
i—
(i49
)
(i49
)
Long-term
debt (4, 5)
i2,157
(i93
)
i2,064
Other
(6)
i8
i18
i26
Total
$
i3,502
$
(i153
)
$
i3,349
2017
Loans
reported as trading account assets (1)
$
i318
$
i—
$
i318
Trading
inventory – other (2)
i3,821
i—
i3,821
Consumer
and commercial loans (1)
(i9
)
i35
i26
Loans
held-for-sale (1, 3)
i—
i298
i298
Unfunded
loan commitments
i—
i36
i36
Long-term
debt (4, 5)
(i1,044
)
(i146
)
(i1,190
)
Other
(6)
(i93
)
i13
(i80
)
Total
$
i2,993
$
i236
$
i3,229
2016
Loans
reported as trading account assets (1)
$
i301
$
i—
$
i301
Trading
inventory – other (2)
i57
i—
i57
Consumer
and commercial loans (1)
i49
(i37
)
i12
Loans
held-for-sale (1, 3)
i11
i524
i535
Unfunded
loan commitments
i—
i487
i487
Long-term
debt (4, 5)
(i489
)
(i97
)
(i586
)
Other
(6)
(i85
)
i53
(i32
)
Total
$
(i156
)
$
i930
$
i774
(1)
Gains (losses) related to borrower-specific credit risk were not significant.
(2)
The gains in trading account profits are primarily offset by losses on trading liabilities that hedge these assets.
(3)
Includes the value of IRLCs on funded loans, including those sold during the period.
(4)
The
majority of the net gains (losses) in trading account profits relate to the embedded derivatives in structured liabilities and are offset by gains (losses) on derivatives and securities that hedge these liabilities.
(5)
For the cumulative impact of changes in the Corporation’s own credit spreads and the amount recognized in accumulated OCI, see . For more information on how the Corporation’s own credit spread is determined, see .
(6)
Includes
gains (losses) on federal funds sold and securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell, other assets, long-term deposits, federal funds purchased and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase and short-term borrowings.
NOTE 22iFair Value of Financial Instruments
Financial
instruments are classified within the fair value hierarchy using the methodologies described in Note 20 – Fair Value Measurements. Certain loans, deposits, long-term debt and unfunded lending commitments are accounted for under the fair value option. For additional information, see Note 21 – Fair Value Option. The following disclosures include financial instruments that are not carried at fair value or only a portion of the ending balance is carried at fair value on the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
Short-term Financial Instruments
The carrying value of short-term financial instruments, including cash and cash equivalents, certain time deposits placed and other short-term investments, federal funds sold and purchased, certain resale and repurchase agreements and short-term borrowings,
approximates the fair value of these instruments. These financial instruments generally expose the Corporation to limited credit risk and have no stated maturities or have short-term maturities and carry interest rates that approximate market. The Corporation accounts for certain resale and repurchase agreements under the fair value option.
Under the fair value hierarchy, cash and cash equivalents are classified as Level 1. Time deposits placed and other short-term investments, such as U.S. government securities and short-term commercial paper, are classified as Level 1 or Level 2. Federal funds sold and purchased are classified as Level 2. Resale and repurchase agreements are classified as Level 2 because they are generally short-dated and/or variable-rate instruments collateralized by U.S. government or agency securities. Short-term
borrowings are classified as Level 2.
Bank of America 2018 162
Fair Value of Financial Instruments
iThe
carrying values and fair values by fair value hierarchy of certain financial instruments where only a portion of the ending balance was carried at fair value at December 31, 2018 and 2017 are presented in the following table.
(1) Includes
demand deposits of $i531.9 billion and $i519.6 billion with no stated maturities at December
31, 2018 and 2017.
(2)
The carrying value of commercial unfunded lending commitments is included in accrued expenses and other liabilities on the Consolidated Balance Sheet. The Corporation does not estimate the fair value of consumer unfunded lending commitments because, in many instances, the Corporation can reduce or cancel these commitments by providing notice to the borrower. For more information on commitments, see .
NOTE
23iBusiness Segment Information
The Corporation reports its results of operations through the following ifour
business segments: Consumer Banking, GWIM, Global Banking and Global Markets, with the remaining operations recorded in All Other.
Consumer Banking
Consumer Banking offers a diversified range of credit, banking and investment products and services to consumers and small businesses.Consumer Banking product offerings include traditional savings accounts, money market savings accounts, CDs and IRAs,checking accounts, and investment
accounts and products, as well as credit and debit cards, residential mortgages and home equity loans, and direct and indirect loans to consumers and small businesses in the U.S. ConsumerBanking includes the impact of servicing residential mortgages and home equity loans in the core portfolio.
Global Wealth & Investment Management
GWIMprovides a high-touch client experience through a network of financial advisors focused on clients with over $250,000 in total investable assets, including tailored solutions to meet clients’ needs through a full set of investment management,
brokerage, banking and retirement products.GWIM also provides comprehensive wealth management solutions targeted to high net worth and ultra high net worth clients, as well as customized solutions to meet clients’ wealth structuring, investment
management, trust and banking needs, including specialty asset management services.
Global Banking
Global Bankingprovides a wide range of lending-related products and services, integrated working capital management and treasury solutions, and underwriting and advisory services through the Corporation’s network of offices and client relationship teams.
Global Banking also provides investment banking products to clients. The economics of certain investment banking and underwriting activities are shared primarily between Global Banking and Global Markets under an internal revenue-sharing arrangement.Global Banking clients generally include middle-market companies, commercial real estate firms, not-for-profit companies, large global corporations, financial institutions, leasing clients, and mid-sized U.S.-based businesses requiring customized and integrated financial advice
and solutions.
Global Markets
Global Marketsoffers sales and trading services and research services to institutional clients across fixed-income, credit, currency, commodity and equity businesses. Global Markets provides market-making, financing, securities clearing, settlement and custody services globally toinstitutional investor clients in support of their investing and trading activities. Global Markets product coverage includes securities and derivative products in both the primary and secondary markets.Global Markets also works with commercial
and corporate clients to provide risk management products. As a result of market-making activities, Global Markets may be required to manage risk in a broad range of financial products. In addition, the economics of certain investment banking and underwriting activities are shared primarily betweenGlobal Markets and Global Bankingunder an internal revenue-sharing arrangement.
All Other
All Otherconsists of ALM activities, equity investments, non-core mortgage loans and servicing activities, the net impact of periodic revisions to the MSR valuation
model for core and non-core MSRs and the related economic hedge results, liquidating businesses and residual expense allocations. ALM activities encompass certain residential mortgages, debt securities, interest rate and foreign currency risk management activities, the impact of certain allocation methodologies and hedge ineffectiveness. The results of certain ALM activities are allocated to the business segments. Equity investments include the merchant services joint venture as well as a portfolio of equity, real estate and other alternative investments.
Basis of Presentation
The management accounting and reporting process derives segment and business results by utilizing allocation methodologies for revenue and expense. The net income derived for the businesses
is dependent upon revenue and cost allocations using an activity-based costing model, funds transfer pricing, and other methodologies and assumptions management believes are appropriate to reflect the results of the business.
Total revenue, net of interest expense, includes net interest income on an FTE basis and noninterest income. The adjustment of net interest income to an FTE basis results in a corresponding increase in income tax expense. The segment results also reflect certain revenue and expense methodologies that are utilized to determine net income. The net interest income of the businesses includes the results of a funds transfer pricing process that
163Bank
of America 2018
matches assets and liabilities with similar interest rate sensitivity and maturity characteristics. In segments where the total of liabilities and equity exceeds assets, which are generally deposit-taking segments, the Corporation allocates assets to match liabilities. Net interest income of the business segments also includes an allocation of net interest income generated by certain of the Corporation’s ALM activities.
The Corporation’s
ALM activities include an overall interest rate risk management strategy that incorporates the use of various derivatives and cash instruments to manage fluctuations in earnings and capital that are caused by interest rate volatility. The Corporation’s goal is to manage interest rate sensitivity so that movements in interest rates do not significantly adversely affect earnings and capital. The results of a majority of the Corporation’s ALM activities are allocated to the business segments and
fluctuate based on the performance of the ALM activities. ALM activities include external product pricing decisions including deposit pricing strategies, the effects of the Corporation’s internal funds transfer pricing process and the net effects of other ALM activities.
Certain expenses not directly attributable to a specific business segment are
allocated to the segments. The costs of certain centralized or shared functions are allocated based on methodologies that reflect utilization.
iThe following table presents net income (loss) and the components thereto (with net interest income on an FTE basis for the business segments, All Other and the total Corporation) for 2018, 2017 and 2016,
and total assets at December 31, 2018 and 2017 for each business segment, as well as All Other.
Results
of Business Segments and All Other
At
and for the year ended December 31
Total Corporation (1)
Consumer Banking
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Net
interest income
$
i48,042
$
i45,592
$
i41,996
$
i27,123
$
i24,307
$
i21,290
Noninterest
income
i43,815
i42,685
i42,605
i10,400
i10,214
i10,441
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
i91,857
i88,277
i84,601
i37,523
i34,521
i31,731
Provision
for credit losses
i3,282
i3,396
i3,597
i3,664
i3,525
i2,715
Noninterest
expense
i53,381
i54,743
i55,083
i17,713
i17,795
i17,664
Income
before income taxes
i35,194
i30,138
i25,921
i16,146
i13,201
i11,352
Income
tax expense
i7,047
i11,906
i8,099
i4,117
i4,999
i4,186
Net
income
$
i28,147
$
i18,232
$
i17,822
$
i12,029
$
i8,202
$
i7,166
Year-end
total assets
$
i2,354,507
$
i2,281,234
$
i768,877
$
i749,325
Global
Wealth & Investment Management
Global Banking
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Net
interest income
$
i6,294
$
i6,173
$
i5,759
$
i10,881
$
i10,504
$
i9,471
Noninterest
income
i13,044
i12,417
i11,891
i8,763
i9,495
i8,974
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
i19,338
i18,590
i17,650
i19,644
i19,999
i18,445
Provision
for credit losses
i86
i56
i68
i8
i212
i883
Noninterest
expense
i13,777
i13,556
i13,166
i8,591
i8,596
i8,486
Income
before income taxes
i5,475
i4,978
i4,416
i11,045
i11,191
i9,076
Income
tax expense
i1,396
i1,885
i1,635
i2,872
i4,238
i3,347
Net
income
$
i4,079
$
i3,093
$
i2,781
$
i8,173
$
i6,953
$
i5,729
Year-end
total assets
$
i305,906
$
i284,321
$
i441,477
$
i424,533
Global
Markets
All Other
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Net
interest income
$
i3,171
$
i3,744
$
i4,557
$
i573
$
i864
$
i919
Noninterest
income
i12,892
i12,207
i11,533
(i1,284
)
(i1,648
)
(i234
)
Total
revenue, net of interest expense
i16,063
i15,951
i16,090
(i711
)
(i784
)
i685
Provision
for credit losses
i—
i164
i31
(i476
)
(i561
)
(i100
)
Noninterest
expense
i10,686
i10,731
i10,171
i2,614
i4,065
i5,596
Income
(loss) before income taxes
i5,377
i5,056
i5,888
(i2,849
)
(i4,288
)
(i4,811
)
Income
tax expense (benefit)
i1,398
i1,763
i2,071
(i2,736
)
(i979
)
(i3,140
)
Net
income (loss)
$
i3,979
$
i3,293
$
i3,817
$
(i113
)
$
(i3,309
)
$
(i1,671
)
Year-end
total assets
$
i641,922
$
i629,013
$
i196,325
$
i194,042
(1)
There
were no material intersegment revenues.
Bank of America 2018 164
The table below presents noninterest income and the components thereto for 2018, 2017 and 2016 for each business segment, as well as All Other. For more
information, see Note 1 – Summary of Significant Accounting Principles and Note 2 – Noninterest Income.
Noninterest
Income by Business Segment and All Other
Total
Corporation
Consumer Banking
Global Wealth & Investment Management
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Card
income
Interchange
fees
$
i4,093
$
i3,942
$
i3,960
$
i3,383
$
i3,224
$
i3,271
$
i82
$
i109
$
i106
Other
card income
i1,958
i1,960
i1,891
i1,906
i1,846
i1,664
i46
i44
i44
Total
card income
i6,051
i5,902
i5,851
i5,289
i5,070
i4,935
i128
i153
i150
Service
charges
Deposit-related
fees
i6,667
i6,708
i6,545
i4,300
i4,266
i4,142
i73
i76
i74
Lending-related
fees
i1,100
i1,110
i1,093
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
Total
service charges
i7,767
i7,818
i7,638
i4,300
i4,266
i4,142
i73
i76
i74
Investment
and brokerage services
Asset
management fees
i10,189
i9,310
i8,328
i147
i133
i120
i10,042
i9,177
i8,208
Brokerage
fees
i3,971
i4,526
i5,021
i172
i184
i200
i1,917
i2,217
i2,666
Total
investment and brokerage services
i14,160
i13,836
i13,349
i319
i317
i320
i11,959
i11,394
i10,874
Investment
banking income
Underwriting
income
i2,722
i2,821
i2,585
(i1
)
i—
i2
i335
i316
i225
Syndication
fees
i1,347
i1,499
i1,388
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i1
Financial
advisory services
i1,258
i1,691
i1,268
i—
i—
i—
i2
i2
i1
Total
investment banking income
i5,327
i6,011
i5,241
(i1
)
i—
i2
i337
i318
i227
Trading
account profits
i8,540
i7,277
i6,902
i8
i3
i—
i112
i144
i175
Other
income
i1,970
i1,841
i3,624
i485
i558
i1,042
i435
i332
i391
Total
noninterest income
$
i43,815
$
i42,685
$
i42,605
$
i10,400
$
i10,214
$
i10,441
$
i13,044
$
i12,417
$
i11,891
Global
Banking
Global Markets
All Other (1)
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
2018
2017
2016
Card
income
Interchange
fees
$
i533
$
i506
$
i483
$
i95
$
i94
$
i79
$
i—
$
i9
$
i21
Other
card income
i8
i12
i20
(i2
)
(i2
)
(i5
)
i—
i60
i168
Total
card income
i541
i518
i503
i93
i92
i74
i—
i69
i189
Service
charges
Deposit-related
fees
i2,111
i2,197
i2,170
i161
i147
i143
i22
i22
i16
Lending-related
fees
i916
i928
i924
i184
i182
i169
i—
i—
i—
Total
service charges
i3,027
i3,125
i3,094
i345
i329
i312
i22
i22
i16
Investment
and brokerage services
Asset
management fees
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
i—
Brokerage
fees
i94
i97
i74
i1,780
i2,049
i2,102
i8
(i21
)
(i21
)
Total
investment and brokerage services
i94
i97
i74
i1,780
i2,049
i2,102
i8
(i21
)
(i21
)
Investment
banking income
Underwriting
income
i502
i511
i426
i2,084
i2,249
i2,100
(i198
)
(i255
)
(i168
)
Syndication
fees
i1,237
i1,403
i1,302
i109
i95
i85
i1
i1
i—
Financial
advisory services
i1,152
i1,557
i1,156
i103
i132
i111
i1
i—
i—
Total
investment banking income
i2,891
i3,471
i2,884
i2,296
i2,476
i2,296
(i196
)
(i254
)
(i168
)
Trading
account profits
i260
i134
i133
i7,932
i6,710
i6,550
i228
i286
i44
Other
income
i1,950
i2,150
i2,286
i446
i551
i199
(i1,346
)
(i1,750
)
(i294
)
Total
noninterest income
$
i8,763
$
i9,495
$
i8,974
$
i12,892
$
i12,207
$
i11,533
$
(i1,284
)
$
(i1,648
)
$
(i234
)
(1)
All
Other includes eliminations of intercompany transactions.
The tables below present a reconciliation of the ifour business segments’ total revenue, net of interest expense, on an FTE basis, and net income to the Consolidated Statement of Income, and total assets to the Consolidated Balance Sheet.
(Dollars
in millions)
2018
2017
2016
Segments’ total revenue, net of interest expense
$
i92,568
$
i89,061
$
i83,916
Adjustments
(1):
ALM activities
i588
i312
(i299
)
Liquidating
businesses, eliminations and other
(i1,299
)
(i1,096
)
i984
FTE
basis adjustment
(i610
)
(i925
)
(i900
)
Consolidated
revenue, net of interest expense
$
i91,247
$
i87,352
$
i83,701
Segments’
total net income
i28,260
i21,541
i19,493
Adjustments,
net-of-tax (1):
ALM activities
(i46
)
(i355
)
(i651
)
Liquidating
businesses, eliminations and other
(i67
)
(i2,954
)
(i1,020
)
Consolidated
net income
$
i28,147
$
i18,232
$
i17,822
(1)
Adjustments
include consolidated income, expense and asset amounts not specifically allocated to individual business segments.
165Bank of America 2018
December
31
(Dollars in millions)
2018
2017
Segments’ total assets
$
i2,158,182
$
i2,087,192
Adjustments
(1):
ALM activities, including securities portfolio
i670,057
i625,483
Elimination
of segment asset allocations to match liabilities
(i540,801
)
(i520,448
)
Other
i67,069
i89,007
Consolidated
total assets
$
i2,354,507
$
i2,281,234
(1)
Adjustments
include consolidated income, expense and asset amounts not specifically allocated to individual business segments.
NOTE 24iParent Company Information
iThe
following tables present the Parent Company-only financial information. This financial information is presented in accordance with bank regulatory reporting requirements.
The Corporation’s operations are highly integrated with operations in both U.S. and non-U.S. markets. The non-U.S. business activities are largely conducted in Europe, the Middle East and Africa and in Asia. The Corporation identifies its geographic performance based on the business unit structure used to manage the capital or expense deployed in the region as applicable. This requires certain judgments related to the allocation of revenue so that
revenue can be appropriately matched with the related capital or expense deployed in the region. iCertain asset, liability, income and expense amounts have been allocated to arrive at total assets, total revenue, net of interest expense, income before income taxes and net income by geographic area as presented below.
(Dollars
in millions)
Total Assets at Year End (1)
Total Revenue, Net of Interest Expense (2)
Income Before Income Taxes
Net Income
U.S. (3)
2018
$
i2,051,182
$
i81,004
$
i31,904
$
i26,407
2017
i1,965,490
i74,830
i25,108
i15,550
2016
i72,418
i22,282
i16,183
Asia
2018
i94,865
i3,507
i865
i520
2017
i103,255
i3,405
i676
i464
2016
i3,365
i674
i488
Europe,
Middle East and Africa
2018
i185,285
i5,632
i1,543
i1,126
2017
i189,661
i7,907
i2,990
i1,926
2016
i6,608
i1,705
i925
Latin
America and the Caribbean
2018
i23,175
i1,104
i272
i94
2017
i22,828
i1,210
i439
i292
2016
i1,310
i360
i226
Total
Non-U.S.
2018
i303,325
i10,243
i2,680
i1,740
2017
i315,744
i12,522
i4,105
i2,682
2016
i11,283
i2,739
i1,639
Total
Consolidated
2018
$
i2,354,507
$
i91,247
$
i34,584
$
i28,147
2017
i2,281,234
i87,352
i29,213
i18,232
2016
i83,701
i25,021
i17,822
(1)
Total
assets include long-lived assets, which are primarily located in the U.S.
(2)
There were no material intercompany revenues between geographic regions for any of the periods presented.
(3)
Substantially reflects the U.S.
167Bank
of America 2018
Glossary
Alt-A Mortgage –A type of U.S. mortgage that is considered riskier than A-paper, or “prime,” and less risky than “subprime,” the riskiest category. Typically, Alt-A mortgages are characterized by borrowers with less than full
documentation, lower credit scores and higher LTVs.
Assets Under Management (AUM) – The total market value of assets under the investment advisory and/or discretion of GWIM which generate asset management fees based on a percentage of the assets’ market values. AUM reflects assets that are generally managed for institutional, high net worth and retail clients, and are distributed through various investment products including mutual funds, other commingled vehicles and separate accounts.
Banking Book – All on- and off-balance sheet financial instruments of the Corporation except for those positions that are held for trading purposes.
Brokerage and Other Assets– Non-discretionary client assets
which are held in brokerage accounts or held for safekeeping.
Committed Credit Exposure– Any funded portion of a facility plus the unfunded portion of a facility on which the lender is legally bound to advance funds during a specified period under prescribed conditions.
Credit Derivatives – Contractual agreements that provide protection against a specified credit event on one or more referenced obligations.
Credit Valuation Adjustment (CVA) – A portfolio adjustment required to properly reflect the counterparty credit risk exposure as part of the fair value of derivative instruments.
Debit Valuation Adjustment (DVA)– A portfolio adjustment required
to properly reflect the Corporation’s own credit risk exposure as part of the fair value of derivative instruments and/or structured liabilities.
Funding Valuation Adjustment (FVA)– A portfolio adjustment required to include funding costs on uncollateralized derivatives and derivatives where the Corporation is not permitted to use the collateral it receives.
Interest Rate Lock Commitment (IRLC)– Commitment with a loan applicant in which the loan terms are guaranteed for a designated period of time subject to credit approval.
Letter of Credit– A document issued on behalf of a customer to a third party promising to pay the third party upon presentation of specified documents. A letter of credit
effectively substitutes the issuer’s credit for that of the customer.
Loan-to-value (LTV)– A commonly used credit quality metric. LTV is calculated as the outstanding carrying value of the loan divided by the estimated value of the property securing the loan.
Margin Receivable– An extension of credit secured by eligible securities in certain brokerage accounts.
Matched Book – Repurchase and resale agreements or securities borrowed and loaned transactions where the overall asset and liability position is similar in size and/or maturity. Generally, these are entered into to accommodate customers where the Corporation earns the interest rate spread.
Mortgage
Servicing Rights (MSR) – The right to service a mortgage loan when the underlying loan is sold or securitized. Servicing includes collections for principal, interest and escrow payments from borrowers and accounting for and remitting principal and interest payments to investors.
Net Interest Yield– Net interest income divided by average total interest-earning assets.
Nonperforming Loans and Leases– Includes loans and leases that have been placed on nonaccrual status, including nonaccruing loans whose contractual terms have been restructured in a manner that grants a concession to a borrower experiencing financial difficulties.
Operating Margin – Income before income taxes divided by total revenue,
net of interest expense.
Prompt Corrective Action (PCA)– A framework established by the U.S. banking regulators requiring banks to maintain certain levels of regulatory capital ratios, comprised of five categories of capitalization: “well capitalized,”“adequately capitalized,”“undercapitalized,”“significantly undercapitalized” and “critically undercapitalized.” Insured depository institutions that fail to meet certain of these capital levels are subject to increasingly strict limits on their activities, including their ability to make capital distributions, pay management compensation, grow assets and take other actions.
Subprime Loans – Although a standard industry definition for subprime loans (including subprime mortgage loans) does not exist, the Corporation defines
subprime loans as specific product offerings for higher risk borrowers.
Troubled Debt Restructurings (TDRs)– Loans whose contractual terms have been restructured in a manner that grants a concession to a borrower experiencing financial difficulties. Certain consumer loans for which a binding offer to restructure has been extended are also classified as TDRs.
Value-at-Risk (VaR)– VaR is a model that simulates the value of a portfolio under a range of hypothetical scenarios in order to generate a distribution of potential gains and losses. VaR represents the loss the portfolio is expected to experience with a given confidence level based on historical data. A VaR model is an effective tool in estimating ranges of potential gains and losses on our trading portfolios.
Bank
of America 2018 168
Acronyms
ABS
Asset-backed securities
AFS
Available-for-sale
ALM
Asset and liability management
AUM
Assets
under management
AVM
Automated valuation model
BANA
Bank of America, National Association
BHC
Bank holding company
bps
basis points
CCAR
Comprehensive Capital Analysis and Review
CDO
Collateralized
debt obligation
CDS
Credit default swap
CET1
Common equity tier 1
CGA
Corporate General Auditor
CLO
Collateralized loan obligation
CLTV
Combined loan-to-value
CVA
Credit
valuation adjustment
DIF
Deposit Insurance Fund
DVA
Debit valuation adjustment
EAD
Exposure at default
EPS
Earnings per common share
ERC
Enterprise Risk Committee
EU
European
Union
FCA
Financial Conduct Authority
FDIC
Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation
FHA
Federal Housing Administration
FHLB
Federal Home Loan Bank
FHLMC
Freddie Mac
FICC
Fixed-income,
currencies and commodities
FICO
Fair Isaac Corporation (credit score)
FLUs
Front line units
FNMA
Fannie Mae
FTE
Fully taxable-equivalent
FVA
Funding valuation adjustment
GAAP
Accounting
principles generally accepted in the United States of America
GDPR
General Data Protection Regulation
GLS
Global Liquidity Sources
GM&CA
Global Marketing and Corporate Affairs
GNMA
Government National Mortgage Association
GSE
Government-sponsored enterprise
G-SIB
Global
systemically important bank
GWIM
Global Wealth & Investment Management
HELOC
Home equity line of credit
HQLA
High Quality Liquid Assets
HTM
Held-to-maturity
ICAAP
Internal
Capital Adequacy Assessment Process
IRM
Independent Risk Management
IRLC
Interest rate lock commitment
ISDA
International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc.
LCR
Liquidity Coverage Ratio
LGD
Loss given default
LHFS
Loans
held-for-sale
LIBOR
London InterBank Offered Rate
LTV
Loan-to-value
MBS
Mortgage-backed securities
MD&A
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
MLGWM
Merrill Lynch Global Wealth Management
MLI
Merrill
Lynch International
MLPCC
Merrill Lynch Professional Clearing Corp
MLPF&S
Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated
MRC
Management Risk Committee
MSA
Metropolitan Statistical Area
MSR
Mortgage servicing right
NSFR
Net
Stable Funding Ratio
OAS
Option-adjusted spread
OCC
Office of the Comptroller of the Currency
OCI
Other comprehensive income
OREO
Other real estate owned
OTC
Over-the-counter
OTTI
Other-than-temporary
impairment
PCA
Prompt Corrective Action
PCI
Purchased credit-impaired
RMBS
Residential mortgage-backed securities
RSU
Restricted stock unit
SBLC
Standby letter of credit
SCCL
Single-counterparty
credit limits
SEC
Securities and Exchange Commission
SLR
Supplementary leverage ratio
TDR
Troubled debt restructurings
TLAC
Total loss-absorbing capacity
VA
U.S. Department of Veterans Affairs
VaR
Value-at-Risk
VIE
Variable
interest entity
169Bank of America 2018
Item
9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
None
Item 9A. Controls and Procedures
Disclosure Controls and Procedures
As of the end of the period covered by this report and pursuant to Rule 13a-15 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (Exchange Act), Bank of America’s management, including the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness and design of our disclosure controls and procedures (as that term is defined in Rule 13a-15(e) of the Exchange Act). Based upon that evaluation, Bank of America’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that Bank
of America’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective, as of the end of the period covered by this report.
Report of Management on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
The Report of Management on Internal Control over Financial Reporting is set forth on page 86 and incorporated herein by reference. The Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm with respect to the Corporation’s internal control over financial reporting is set forth on page 87
and incorporated herein by reference.
Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting
There have been no changes in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) of the Exchange Act) during the quarter ended December 31, 2018, that materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
The name, age,
position and office, and business experience during the last five years of our current executive officers are:
Dean C. Athanasia (52)President, Retail and Preferred & Small Business Bankingsince December2018; President, Preferred & Small Business Banking, and Co-Head -- Consumer Banking from September 2014 to December 2018; and Preferred and Small Business Banking Executive from April 2011 to September 2014.
Catherine P. Bessant (58) Chief Operations and Technology Officer since July 2015; Global Technology & Operations Executive from January 2010 to July 2015.
Sheri Bronstein (50) Chief
Human Resources Officer since July 2015; and HR Executive for Global Banking & Markets from March 2010 to July 2015.
Paul M. Donofrio (58) Chief Financial Officer since August 2015; Strategic Finance Executive from April 2015 to August 2015; and Global Head of Corporate Credit and Transaction Banking from January 2012 to April 2015.
Geoffrey S. Greener (54) Chief Risk Officersince April 2014; Head of Enterprise Capital Management from April 2011 to April 2014.
Kathleen A. Knox (55) President, U.S. Trustsince November 2017; Head of Business Banking from October 2014 to November 2017; and Retail Banking &
Distribution Executive from June 2011 to October 2014.
David G. Leitch (58) Global General Counsel since January 2016; General Counsel of Ford Motor Company from April 2005 to December 2015.
Thomas K. Montag (62) Chief Operating Officersince September 2014; Co-Chief Operating OfficerfromSeptember2011to September 2014.
Brian T. Moynihan (59) Chairman of the Boardsince October 2014, and President, and Chief Executive
Officer and member of the Board of Directors since January 2010.
Thong M. Nguyen (60)Vice Chairman, Bank of America since December 2018; President, Retail Banking and Co-Head -- Consumer Banking from September 2014 to December 2018; Retail Banking Executive from April 2014 to September 2014; and Retail Strategy, and Operations & Digital Banking Executive from September 2012 to April 2014.
Andrew M. Sieg (51) President, Merrill Lynch Wealth Management since January 2017; and Head of Global Wealth & Retirement Solutions from October 2011 to January 2017.
Andrea B. Smith (52) Chief Administrative Officer since July 2015; Global Head of Human Resources from January
2010 to July 2015.
Information included under the following captions in the Corporation’s proxy statement relating to its 2019 annual meeting of stockholders (the 2019 Proxy Statement), is incorporated herein by reference:
●
“Proposal 1: Electing Directors – Our Director Nominees;”
“Stock Ownership of Directors, Executive Officers, and Certain Beneficial Owners.”
The table below presents information on equity compensation plans at December 31, 2018:
Plan
Category (1)
(a) Number of Shares to be Issued Under Outstanding Options, Warrants and Rights (2)
(b) Weighted-average Exercise Price of Outstanding Options, Warrants and Rights (3)
(c) Number of Shares Remaining for Future Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans (excluding securities reflected in column (a)) (4)
Plans approved by shareholders
165,953,835
—
239,064,952
Plans
not approved by shareholders
—
—
—
Total
165,953,835
—
239,064,952
(1)
This
table does not include 873,557 vested restricted stock units and stock option gain deferrals at December 31, 2018 that were assumed by the Corporation in connection with prior acquisitions under whose plans the awards were originally granted.
(2)
Consists of outstanding restricted stock units.
(3)
Restricted stock units do not have an exercise price and are delivered without
any payment or consideration.
(4)
Includes 239,005,498 shares of common stock available for future issuance under the Bank of America Corporation Key Employee Equity Plan and 59,454 shares of common stock which are available for future issuance under the Bank of America Corporation Directors’ Stock Plan. As of January 1, 2019, grants of stock awards to the Corporation’s non-employee directors will be made under the Bank of America Corporation Key Employee Equity Plan.
Item 13. Certain
Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
With the exception of the information expressly incorporated herein by reference, the 2019 Proxy Statement shall not be deemed filed as part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
Registrant and its subsidiaries have other long-term debt agreements, but these are omitted pursuant to Item 601(b)(4)(iii) of Regulation S-K. Copies of these agreements will be furnished to the Commission on request
(3) The instance document does not appear in the interactive data file
because its XBRL tags are embedded within the inline XBRL document.
Bank of America 2018 176
Item 16. Form 10-K Summary
Not
applicable.
Signatures
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.